1039f4c27bbf80aad7c2d8817f38f57600059384
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 @node Sample Session
550 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
551
552 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
553 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
554 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
555
556 @iftex
557 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
558 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
559 @end iftex
560
561 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
562 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
563
564 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
565 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
566 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
567 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
568 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
569 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
570 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
571 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
572 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
573
574 @smallexample
575 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
576 $ @b{./m4}
577 @b{define(foo,0000)}
578
579 @b{foo}
580 0000
581 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
582
583 @b{bar}
584 0000
585 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
586
587 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
588 @b{baz}
589 @b{Ctrl-d}
590 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
591 @end smallexample
592
593 @noindent
594 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
595
596 @smallexample
597 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
598 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
599 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
600 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
601 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
602 the conditions.
603 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
604 for details.
605
606 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
607 (@value{GDBP})
608 @end smallexample
609
610 @noindent
611 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
612 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
613 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
614 that examples fit in this manual.
615
616 @smallexample
617 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
618 @end smallexample
619
620 @noindent
621 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
622 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
623 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
624 @code{break} command.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
628 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
633 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
634 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
635
636 @smallexample
637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
638 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
639 @b{define(foo,0000)}
640
641 @b{foo}
642 0000
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
647 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
648 context where it stops.
649
650 @smallexample
651 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
652
653 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
654 at builtin.c:879
655 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
660 the next line of the current function.
661
662 @smallexample
663 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
664 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
665 : nil,
666 @end smallexample
667
668 @noindent
669 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
670 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
671 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
672 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
673
674 @smallexample
675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
676 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
677 at input.c:530
678 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
679 @end smallexample
680
681 @noindent
682 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
683 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
684 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
685 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
686 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
687 stack frame for each active subroutine.
688
689 @smallexample
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
691 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
692 at input.c:530
693 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
694 at builtin.c:882
695 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
696 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
697 at macro.c:71
698 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
699 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
700 @end smallexample
701
702 @noindent
703 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
704 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
705 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
706
707 @smallexample
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
709 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
711 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
712 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
714 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
715 : xstrdup(rq);
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
717 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
718 @end smallexample
719
720 @noindent
721 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
722 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
723 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
724 (@code{print}) to see their values.
725
726 @smallexample
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
728 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
730 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
735 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
736 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
737
738 @smallexample
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
740 533 xfree(rquote);
741 534
742 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
743 : xstrdup (lq);
744 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
745 : xstrdup (rq);
746 537
747 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
748 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
749 540 @}
750 541
751 542 void
752 @end smallexample
753
754 @noindent
755 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
756 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
757
758 @smallexample
759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
760 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
761 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
762 540 @}
763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
764 $3 = 9
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
766 $4 = 7
767 @end smallexample
768
769 @noindent
770 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
771 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
772 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
773 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
774 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
775 assignments.
776
777 @smallexample
778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
779 $5 = 7
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
781 $6 = 9
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
786 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
787 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
788 example that caused trouble initially:
789
790 @smallexample
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
792 Continuing.
793
794 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
795
796 baz
797 0000
798 @end smallexample
799
800 @noindent
801 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
802 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
803 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
804
805 @smallexample
806 @b{Ctrl-d}
807 Program exited normally.
808 @end smallexample
809
810 @noindent
811 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
812 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
813 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
814
815 @smallexample
816 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
817 @end smallexample
818
819 @node Invocation
820 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
821
822 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
823 The essentials are:
824 @itemize @bullet
825 @item
826 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
827 @item
828 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
829 @end itemize
830
831 @menu
832 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
833 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
834 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
835 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
836 @end menu
837
838 @node Invoking GDB
839 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
840
841 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
842 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
843
844 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
845 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
846
847 The command-line options described here are designed
848 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
849 options may effectively be unavailable.
850
851 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
852 specifying an executable program:
853
854 @smallexample
855 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
856 @end smallexample
857
858 @noindent
859 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
860 specified:
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
864 @end smallexample
865
866 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
867 to debug a running process:
868
869 @smallexample
870 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
875 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
876
877 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
878 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
879 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
880 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
881 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
882
883 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
884 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
885 option processing.
886 @smallexample
887 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
888 @end smallexample
889 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
890 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
891
892 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
893 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
894 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
895
896 @smallexample
897 @value{GDBP} --silent
898 @end smallexample
899
900 @noindent
901 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
902 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
903
904 @noindent
905 Type
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} -help
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
913 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
914
915 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
916 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
917 @samp{-x} option is used.
918
919
920 @menu
921 * File Options:: Choosing files
922 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
923 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
924 @end menu
925
926 @node File Options
927 @subsection Choosing Files
928
929 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
930 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
931 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
932 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
933 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
934 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
935 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
936 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
937 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
938 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
939 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
940 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
941 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
942
943 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
944 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
945 argument and ignore it.
946
947 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
948 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
949 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
950 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
951 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
952
953 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
954 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
955 @c it.
956
957 @table @code
958 @item -symbols @var{file}
959 @itemx -s @var{file}
960 @cindex @code{--symbols}
961 @cindex @code{-s}
962 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
963
964 @item -exec @var{file}
965 @itemx -e @var{file}
966 @cindex @code{--exec}
967 @cindex @code{-e}
968 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
969 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
970
971 @item -se @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--se}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
974 file.
975
976 @item -core @var{file}
977 @itemx -c @var{file}
978 @cindex @code{--core}
979 @cindex @code{-c}
980 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
981
982 @item -pid @var{number}
983 @itemx -p @var{number}
984 @cindex @code{--pid}
985 @cindex @code{-p}
986 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
987
988 @item -command @var{file}
989 @itemx -x @var{file}
990 @cindex @code{--command}
991 @cindex @code{-x}
992 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
993 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
994 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
995
996 @item -eval-command @var{command}
997 @itemx -ex @var{command}
998 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
999 @cindex @code{-ex}
1000 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1001
1002 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1003 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1004
1005 @smallexample
1006 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1007 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1008 @end smallexample
1009
1010 @item -init-command @var{file}
1011 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1012 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1013 @cindex @code{-ix}
1014 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1015 after loading gdbinit files).
1016 @xref{Startup}.
1017
1018 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1019 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1020 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1021 @cindex @code{-iex}
1022 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1023 after loading gdbinit files).
1024 @xref{Startup}.
1025
1026 @item -directory @var{directory}
1027 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1028 @cindex @code{--directory}
1029 @cindex @code{-d}
1030 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1031
1032 @item -r
1033 @itemx -readnow
1034 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1035 @cindex @code{-r}
1036 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1037 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1038 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1039
1040 @item --readnever
1041 @anchor{--readnever}
1042 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1043 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1044 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1045 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1046 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1047 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1048 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1049 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1050 @end table
1051
1052 @node Mode Options
1053 @subsection Choosing Modes
1054
1055 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1056 batch mode or quiet mode.
1057
1058 @table @code
1059 @anchor{-nx}
1060 @item -nx
1061 @itemx -n
1062 @cindex @code{--nx}
1063 @cindex @code{-n}
1064 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1065 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1066
1067 @table @code
1068 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1069 This is the system-wide init file.
1070 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1071 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1072 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1073 have been processed.
1074 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1075 This is the init file in your home directory.
1076 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1077 command options have been processed.
1078 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1079 This is the init file in the current directory.
1080 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1081 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1082 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1083 @end table
1084
1085 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1086 For documentation on how to write command files,
1087 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1088
1089 @anchor{-nh}
1090 @item -nh
1091 @cindex @code{--nh}
1092 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1093 in your home directory.
1094 @xref{Startup}.
1095
1096 @item -quiet
1097 @itemx -silent
1098 @itemx -q
1099 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1100 @cindex @code{--silent}
1101 @cindex @code{-q}
1102 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1103 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1104
1105 @item -batch
1106 @cindex @code{--batch}
1107 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1108 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1109 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1110 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1111 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1112 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1113 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1114
1115 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1116 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1117 make this more useful, the message
1118
1119 @smallexample
1120 Program exited normally.
1121 @end smallexample
1122
1123 @noindent
1124 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1125 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1126 mode.
1127
1128 @item -batch-silent
1129 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1130 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1131 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1132 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1133 for an interactive session.
1134
1135 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1136 messages, for example.
1137
1138 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1139 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1140
1141 @item -return-child-result
1142 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1143 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1144 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1145
1146 @itemize @bullet
1147 @item
1148 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1149 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1150 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1151 @item
1152 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1153 @item
1154 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1155 the exit code will be -1.
1156 @end itemize
1157
1158 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1159 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1160 interface.
1161
1162 @item -nowindows
1163 @itemx -nw
1164 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1165 @cindex @code{-nw}
1166 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1167 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1168 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1169
1170 @item -windows
1171 @itemx -w
1172 @cindex @code{--windows}
1173 @cindex @code{-w}
1174 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1175 used if possible.
1176
1177 @item -cd @var{directory}
1178 @cindex @code{--cd}
1179 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1180 instead of the current directory.
1181
1182 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1183 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1184 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1185 @cindex @code{-D}
1186 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1187 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1188 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1189
1190 @item -fullname
1191 @itemx -f
1192 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1193 @cindex @code{-f}
1194 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1195 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1196 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1197 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1198 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1199 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1200 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1201 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1202 frame.
1203
1204 @item -annotate @var{level}
1205 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1206 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1207 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1208 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1209 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1210 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1211 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1212 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1213 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1214
1215 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1216 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1217
1218 @item --args
1219 @cindex @code{--args}
1220 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1221 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1222 This option stops option processing.
1223
1224 @item -baud @var{bps}
1225 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1226 @cindex @code{--baud}
1227 @cindex @code{-b}
1228 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1229 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1230
1231 @item -l @var{timeout}
1232 @cindex @code{-l}
1233 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1234 for remote debugging.
1235
1236 @item -tty @var{device}
1237 @itemx -t @var{device}
1238 @cindex @code{--tty}
1239 @cindex @code{-t}
1240 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1241 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1242
1243 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1244 @item -tui
1245 @cindex @code{--tui}
1246 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1247 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1248 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1249 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1250 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1251 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1252
1253 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1254 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1255 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1256 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1257 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1258 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1259
1260 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1261 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1262 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1263 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1264 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1265 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1266
1267 @item -write
1268 @cindex @code{--write}
1269 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1270 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1271 (@pxref{Patching}).
1272
1273 @item -statistics
1274 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1275 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1276 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1277
1278 @item -version
1279 @cindex @code{--version}
1280 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1281 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1282
1283 @item -configuration
1284 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1285 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1286 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1287 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1288
1289 @end table
1290
1291 @node Startup
1292 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1293 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1294
1295 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1296
1297 @enumerate
1298 @item
1299 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1300 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1301
1302 @item
1303 @cindex init file
1304 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1305 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1306 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1307 that file.
1308
1309 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1310 @item
1311 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1312 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1313 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1314 that file.
1315
1316 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1317 @item
1318 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1319 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1320 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1321 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1322 gets loaded.
1323
1324 @item
1325 Processes command line options and operands.
1326
1327 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1328 @item
1329 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1330 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1331 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1332 This is only done if the current directory is
1333 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1334 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1335 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1336 @value{GDBN}.
1337
1338 @item
1339 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1340 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1341 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1342 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1343
1344 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1345 you must do something like the following:
1346
1347 @smallexample
1348 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1349 @end smallexample
1350
1351 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1352 off too late.
1353
1354 @item
1355 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1356 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1357 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1358
1359 @item
1360 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1361 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1362 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1363 @end enumerate
1364
1365 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1366 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1367 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1368 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1369 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1370 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1371
1372 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1373 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1374
1375 @cindex init file name
1376 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1377 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1378 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1379 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1380 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1381 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1382 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1383 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1384
1385
1386 @node Quitting GDB
1387 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1388 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1389 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1390
1391 @table @code
1392 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1393 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1394 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1395 @itemx q
1396 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1397 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1398 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1399 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1400 error code.
1401 @end table
1402
1403 @cindex interrupt
1404 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1405 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1406 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1407 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1408 until a time when it is safe.
1409
1410 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1411 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1412 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1413
1414 @node Shell Commands
1415 @section Shell Commands
1416
1417 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1418 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1419 just use the @code{shell} command.
1420
1421 @table @code
1422 @kindex shell
1423 @kindex !
1424 @cindex shell escape
1425 @item shell @var{command-string}
1426 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1427 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1428 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1429 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1430 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1431 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1432 @end table
1433
1434 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1435 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1436 @value{GDBN}:
1437
1438 @table @code
1439 @kindex make
1440 @cindex calling make
1441 @item make @var{make-args}
1442 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1443 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1444 @end table
1445
1446 @node Logging Output
1447 @section Logging Output
1448 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1449 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1450
1451 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1452 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1453
1454 @table @code
1455 @kindex set logging
1456 @item set logging on
1457 Enable logging.
1458 @item set logging off
1459 Disable logging.
1460 @cindex logging file name
1461 @item set logging file @var{file}
1462 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1463 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1464 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1465 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1466 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1467 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1468 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1469 @kindex show logging
1470 @item show logging
1471 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1472 @end table
1473
1474 @node Commands
1475 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1476
1477 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1478 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1479 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1480 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1481 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1482
1483 @menu
1484 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1485 * Completion:: Command completion
1486 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1487 @end menu
1488
1489 @node Command Syntax
1490 @section Command Syntax
1491
1492 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1493 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1494 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1495 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1496 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1497 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1498
1499 @cindex abbreviation
1500 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1501 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1502 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1503 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1504 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1505 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1506 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1507
1508 @cindex repeating commands
1509 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1510 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1511 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1512 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1513 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1514 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1515 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1516
1517 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1518 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1519 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1520
1521 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1522 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1523 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1524 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1525 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1526
1527 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1528 @cindex comment
1529 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1530 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1531 Files,,Command Files}).
1532
1533 @cindex repeating command sequences
1534 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1535 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1536 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1537 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1538 for editing.
1539
1540 @node Completion
1541 @section Command Completion
1542
1543 @cindex completion
1544 @cindex word completion
1545 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1546 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1547 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1548 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1549
1550 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1551 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1552 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1553 enter it). For example, if you type
1554
1555 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1556 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1557 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1558 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1559 @smallexample
1560 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1561 @end smallexample
1562
1563 @noindent
1564 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1565 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1566
1567 @smallexample
1568 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1569 @end smallexample
1570
1571 @noindent
1572 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1573 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1574 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1575 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1576 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1577 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1578
1579 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1580 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1581 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1582 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1583 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1584 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1585 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1586 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1587 example:
1588
1589 @smallexample
1590 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1591 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1592 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1593 make_abs_section make_function_type
1594 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1595 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1596 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1597 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1598 @end smallexample
1599
1600 @noindent
1601 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1602 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1603 command.
1604
1605 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1606 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1607 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1608 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1609 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1610
1611 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1612 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1613 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1614
1615 @smallexample
1616 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1617 main
1618 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1619 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1620 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1621 @end smallexample
1622
1623 @noindent
1624 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1625
1626 @table @code
1627 @kindex set max-completions
1628 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1629 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1630 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1631 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1632 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1633 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1634 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1635 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1636 completion slow.
1637 @kindex show max-completions
1638 @item show max-completions
1639 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1640 during completion.
1641 @end table
1642
1643 @cindex quotes in commands
1644 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1645 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1646 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1647 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1648 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1649 @value{GDBN} commands.
1650
1651 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1652 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1653 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1654 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1655 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1656 Operators}).
1657
1658 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1659 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1660 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1661 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1662 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1663 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1664 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1665 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1666 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1667
1668 @smallexample
1669 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1670 func<int>() func<float>()
1671 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1672 @end smallexample
1673
1674 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1675 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1676 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1677 function:
1678
1679 @smallexample
1680 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1681 func<int>() func<float>()
1682 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1683 @end smallexample
1684
1685 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1686 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1687 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1688 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1689 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1690 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1691
1692 @smallexample
1693 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1694 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1695 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1696 bubble(double)
1697 @end smallexample
1698
1699 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1700 require quoting.
1701
1702 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1703 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1704 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1705 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1706
1707 @cindex completion of structure field names
1708 @cindex structure field name completion
1709 @cindex completion of union field names
1710 @cindex union field name completion
1711 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1712 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1713 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1714 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1715 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1716 left-hand-side:
1717
1718 @smallexample
1719 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1720 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1721 to_data to_isatty to_write
1722 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1723 to_flush to_read
1724 @end smallexample
1725
1726 @noindent
1727 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1728 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1729 follows:
1730
1731 @smallexample
1732 struct ui_file
1733 @{
1734 int *magic;
1735 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1736 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1737 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1738 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1739 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1740 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1741 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1742 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1743 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1744 void *to_data;
1745 @}
1746 @end smallexample
1747
1748
1749 @node Help
1750 @section Getting Help
1751 @cindex online documentation
1752 @kindex help
1753
1754 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1755 using the command @code{help}.
1756
1757 @table @code
1758 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1759 @item help
1760 @itemx h
1761 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1762 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help
1766 List of classes of commands:
1767
1768 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1769 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1770 data -- Examining data
1771 files -- Specifying and examining files
1772 internals -- Maintenance commands
1773 obscure -- Obscure features
1774 running -- Running the program
1775 stack -- Examining the stack
1776 status -- Status inquiries
1777 support -- Support facilities
1778 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1779 stopping the program
1780 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1781
1782 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1783 commands in that class.
1784 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1785 documentation.
1786 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1787 (@value{GDBP})
1788 @end smallexample
1789 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1790
1791 @item help @var{class}
1792 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1793 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1794 help display for the class @code{status}:
1795
1796 @smallexample
1797 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1798 Status inquiries.
1799
1800 List of commands:
1801
1802 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1803 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1804 info -- Generic command for showing things
1805 about the program being debugged
1806 show -- Generic command for showing things
1807 about the debugger
1808
1809 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1810 documentation.
1811 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1812 (@value{GDBP})
1813 @end smallexample
1814
1815 @item help @var{command}
1816 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1817 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1818
1819 @kindex apropos
1820 @item apropos @var{args}
1821 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1822 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1823 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1824
1825 @smallexample
1826 apropos alias
1827 @end smallexample
1828
1829 @noindent
1830 results in:
1831
1832 @smallexample
1833 @c @group
1834 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1835 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1836 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1837 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1838 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1839 @c @end group
1840 @end smallexample
1841
1842 @kindex complete
1843 @item complete @var{args}
1844 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1845 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1846 command you want completed. For example:
1847
1848 @smallexample
1849 complete i
1850 @end smallexample
1851
1852 @noindent results in:
1853
1854 @smallexample
1855 @group
1856 if
1857 ignore
1858 info
1859 inspect
1860 @end group
1861 @end smallexample
1862
1863 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1864 @end table
1865
1866 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1867 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1868 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1869 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1870 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1871 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1872 Index}.
1873
1874 @c @group
1875 @table @code
1876 @kindex info
1877 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1878 @item info
1879 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1880 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1881 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1882 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1883 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1884 @w{@code{help info}}.
1885
1886 @kindex set
1887 @item set
1888 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1889 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1890 @code{set prompt $}.
1891
1892 @kindex show
1893 @item show
1894 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1895 @value{GDBN} itself.
1896 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1897 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1898 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1899 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1900
1901 @kindex info set
1902 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1903 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1904 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1905 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1906 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1907 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1908 @end table
1909 @c @end group
1910
1911 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1912 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1913
1914 @table @code
1915 @kindex show version
1916 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1917 @item show version
1918 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1919 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1920 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1921 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1922 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1923 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1924 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1925 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1926 @value{GDBN}.
1927
1928 @kindex show copying
1929 @kindex info copying
1930 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1931 @item show copying
1932 @itemx info copying
1933 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1934
1935 @kindex show warranty
1936 @kindex info warranty
1937 @item show warranty
1938 @itemx info warranty
1939 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1940 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1941
1942 @kindex show configuration
1943 @item show configuration
1944 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1945 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1946 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1947 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1948 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1949 your report.
1950
1951 @end table
1952
1953 @node Running
1954 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1955
1956 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1957 debugging information when you compile it.
1958
1959 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1960 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1961 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1962 kill a child process.
1963
1964 @menu
1965 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1966 * Starting:: Starting your program
1967 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1968 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1969
1970 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1971 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1972 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1973 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1974
1975 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1976 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1977 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1978 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1979 @end menu
1980
1981 @node Compilation
1982 @section Compiling for Debugging
1983
1984 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1985 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1986 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1987 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1988 and addresses in the executable code.
1989
1990 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1991 the compiler.
1992
1993 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1994 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1995 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1996 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1997 executables containing debugging information.
1998
1999 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2000 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2001 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2002 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2003 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2004
2005 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2006 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2007 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2008
2009 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2010 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2011 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2012 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2013 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2014 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2015
2016 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2017 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2018 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2019
2020 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2021 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2022 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2023 format in @value{GDBN}.
2024
2025 @need 2000
2026 @node Starting
2027 @section Starting your Program
2028 @cindex starting
2029 @cindex running
2030
2031 @table @code
2032 @kindex run
2033 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2034 @item run
2035 @itemx r
2036 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2037 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2038 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2039 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2040 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2041
2042 @end table
2043
2044 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2045 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2046 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2047 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2048 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2049 message like this one:
2050
2051 @smallexample
2052 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2053 Try "help target" or "continue".
2054 @end smallexample
2055
2056 @noindent
2057 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2058 first (@pxref{load}).
2059
2060 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2061 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2062 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2063 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2064 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2065 divided into four categories:
2066
2067 @table @asis
2068 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2069 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2070 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2071 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2072 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2073 the arguments.
2074 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2075 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2076 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2077 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2078 below for details).
2079
2080 @item The @emph{environment.}
2081 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2082 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2083 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2084 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2085
2086 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2087 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2088 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2089 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2090 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2091 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2092 Directory}.
2093
2094 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2095 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2096 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2097 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2098 set a different device for your program.
2099 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2100
2101 @cindex pipes
2102 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2103 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2104 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2105 wrong program.
2106 @end table
2107
2108 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2109 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2110 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2111 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2112 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2113
2114 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2115 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2116 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2117 your current breakpoints.
2118
2119 @table @code
2120 @kindex start
2121 @item start
2122 @cindex run to main procedure
2123 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2124 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2125 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2126 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2127 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2128 procedure, depending on the language used.
2129
2130 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2131 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2132 the @samp{run} command.
2133
2134 @cindex elaboration phase
2135 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2136 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2137 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2138 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2139 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2140 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2141 will remain to halt execution.
2142
2143 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2144 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2145 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2146 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2147 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2148
2149 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2150 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2151 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2152 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2153 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2154 use the @code{starti} command.
2155
2156 @kindex starti
2157 @item starti
2158 @cindex run to first instruction
2159 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2160 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2161 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2162 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2163 the start of the elaboration phase.
2164
2165 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2166 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2167 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2168 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2169 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2170 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2171 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2172 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2173 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2174 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2175 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2176 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2177
2178 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2179 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2180 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2181 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2182
2183 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2184 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2185 environment:
2186
2187 @smallexample
2188 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2189 (@value{GDBP}) run
2190 @end smallexample
2191
2192 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2193 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2194
2195 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2196 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2197 @item set startup-with-shell
2198 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2199 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2200 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2201 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2202 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2203 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2204 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2205 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2206 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2207 startup failures such as:
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) run
2211 Starting program: ./a.out
2212 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2213 @end smallexample
2214
2215 @noindent
2216 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2217 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2218 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2219 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2220 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2221 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2222
2223 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2224 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2225 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2226 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2227 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2228 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2229
2230 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2231 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2232 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2233 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2234 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2235 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2236
2237 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2238 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2239 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2240
2241 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2242 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2243
2244 @smallexample
2245 (@value{GDBP}) run
2246 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2247 @end smallexample
2248
2249 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2250 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2251
2252 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2253 @code{target native} command. For example,
2254
2255 @smallexample
2256 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2257 (@value{GDBP}) run
2258 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2259 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2260 (@value{GDBP}) run
2261 Starting program: ./a.out
2262 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2263 @end smallexample
2264
2265 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2266 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2267 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2268 disconnect.
2269
2270 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2271 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2272 proc}, @code{info os}.
2273
2274 @kindex set disable-randomization
2275 @item set disable-randomization
2276 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2277 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2278 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2279 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2280 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2281
2282 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2283 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2284
2285 @smallexample
2286 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2287 @end smallexample
2288
2289 @item set disable-randomization off
2290 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2291 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2292 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2293 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2294 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2295 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2296
2297 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2298 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2299 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2300 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2301 a code at its expected addresses.
2302
2303 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2304 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2305 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2306 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2307 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2308 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2309 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2310 a randomly chosen address.
2311
2312 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2313 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2314 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2315 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2316 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2317
2318 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2319 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2320
2321 @item show disable-randomization
2322 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2323 the virtual address space of the started program.
2324
2325 @end table
2326
2327 @node Arguments
2328 @section Your Program's Arguments
2329
2330 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2331 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2332 @code{run} command.
2333 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2334 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2335 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2336 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2337 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2338
2339 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2340 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2341 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2342 the program, not by the shell.
2343
2344 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2345 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2346
2347 @table @code
2348 @kindex set args
2349 @item set args
2350 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2351 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2352 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2353 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2354 it again without arguments.
2355
2356 @kindex show args
2357 @item show args
2358 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2359 @end table
2360
2361 @node Environment
2362 @section Your Program's Environment
2363
2364 @cindex environment (of your program)
2365 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2366 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2367 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2368 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2369 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2370 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2371 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2372
2373 @table @code
2374 @kindex path
2375 @item path @var{directory}
2376 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2377 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2378 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2379 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2380 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2381 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2382 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2383
2384 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2385 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2386 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2387 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2388 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2389 @var{directory} to the search path.
2390 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2391 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2392
2393 @kindex show paths
2394 @item show paths
2395 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2396 environment variable).
2397
2398 @kindex show environment
2399 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2400 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2401 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2402 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2403 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2404
2405 @kindex set environment
2406 @anchor{set environment}
2407 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2408 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2409 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2410 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2411 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2412 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2413 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2414 null value.
2415 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2416 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2417
2418 For example, this command:
2419
2420 @smallexample
2421 set env USER = foo
2422 @end smallexample
2423
2424 @noindent
2425 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2426 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2427 are not actually required.)
2428
2429 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2430 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2431 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2432 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2433 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2434
2435 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2436 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2437 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2438
2439 @kindex unset environment
2440 @anchor{unset environment}
2441 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2442 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2443 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2444 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2445 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2446
2447 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2448 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2449 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2450 @end table
2451
2452 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2453 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2454 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2455 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2456 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2457 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2458 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2459 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2460 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2461 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2462
2463 @node Working Directory
2464 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2465
2466 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2467 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2468 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2469 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2470 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2471 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2472 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2473 debugging.
2474
2475 @table @code
2476 @kindex set cwd
2477 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2478 @anchor{set cwd command}
2479 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2480 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2481 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2482 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2483 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2484 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2485 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2486 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2487 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2488 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2489 fallback.
2490
2491 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2492 the @code{cd} command.
2493 @xref{cd command}
2494
2495 @kindex show cwd
2496 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2497 @item show cwd
2498 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2499 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2500 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2501
2502 @kindex cd
2503 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2504 @anchor{cd command}
2505 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2506 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2507 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2508
2509 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2510 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2511 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2512 @xref{set cwd command}
2513
2514 @kindex pwd
2515 @item pwd
2516 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2517 @end table
2518
2519 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2520 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2521 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2522 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2523 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2524 current working directory of the debuggee.
2525
2526 @node Input/Output
2527 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2528
2529 @cindex redirection
2530 @cindex i/o
2531 @cindex terminal
2532 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2533 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2534 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2535 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2536 running your program.
2537
2538 @table @code
2539 @kindex info terminal
2540 @item info terminal
2541 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2542 program is using.
2543 @end table
2544
2545 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2546 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2547
2548 @smallexample
2549 run > outfile
2550 @end smallexample
2551
2552 @noindent
2553 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2554
2555 @kindex tty
2556 @cindex controlling terminal
2557 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2558 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2559 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2560 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2561 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2562
2563 @smallexample
2564 tty /dev/ttyb
2565 @end smallexample
2566
2567 @noindent
2568 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2569 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2570 that as their controlling terminal.
2571
2572 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2573 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2574 terminal.
2575
2576 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2577 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2578 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2579 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2580
2581 @cindex inferior tty
2582 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2583 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2584 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2585 program.
2586
2587 @table @code
2588 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2589 @kindex set inferior-tty
2590 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2591 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2592 @value{GDBN}.
2593
2594 @item show inferior-tty
2595 @kindex show inferior-tty
2596 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2597 @end table
2598
2599 @node Attach
2600 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2601 @kindex attach
2602 @cindex attach
2603
2604 @table @code
2605 @item attach @var{process-id}
2606 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2607 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2608 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2609 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2610 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2611
2612 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2613 executing the command.
2614 @end table
2615
2616 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2617 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2618 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2619 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2620
2621 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2622 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2623 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2624 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2625 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2626 Specify Files}.
2627
2628 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2629 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2630 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2631 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2632 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2633 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2634 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2635
2636 @table @code
2637 @kindex detach
2638 @item detach
2639 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2640 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2641 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2642 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2643 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2644 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2645 executing the command.
2646 @end table
2647
2648 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2649 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2650 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2651 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2652 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2653 Messages}).
2654
2655 @node Kill Process
2656 @section Killing the Child Process
2657
2658 @table @code
2659 @kindex kill
2660 @item kill
2661 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2662 @end table
2663
2664 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2665 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2666 is running.
2667
2668 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2669 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2670 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2671 outside the debugger.
2672
2673 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2674 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2675 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2676 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2677 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2678 breakpoint settings).
2679
2680 @node Inferiors and Programs
2681 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2682
2683 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2684 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2685 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2686 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2687 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2688 from multiple executables.
2689
2690 @cindex inferior
2691 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2692 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2693 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2694 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2695 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2696 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2697 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2698 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2699 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2700 threads running in it.
2701
2702 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2703 inferiors}}:
2704
2705 @table @code
2706 @kindex info inferiors
2707 @item info inferiors
2708 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2709
2710 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2711
2712 @enumerate
2713 @item
2714 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2715
2716 @item
2717 the target system's inferior identifier
2718
2719 @item
2720 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2721
2722 @end enumerate
2723
2724 @noindent
2725 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2726 indicates the current inferior.
2727
2728 For example,
2729 @end table
2730 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2731
2732 @smallexample
2733 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2734 Num Description Executable
2735 2 process 2307 hello
2736 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2737 @end smallexample
2738
2739 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2740
2741 @table @code
2742 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2743 @item inferior @var{infno}
2744 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2745 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2746 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2747 @end table
2748
2749 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2750 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2751 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2752 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2753 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2754 information on convenience variables.
2755
2756 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2757 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2758 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2759 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2760 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2761 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2762
2763 @table @code
2764 @kindex add-inferior
2765 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2766 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2767 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2768 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2769 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2770 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2771
2772 @kindex clone-inferior
2773 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2774 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2775 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2776 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2777 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2778
2779 @smallexample
2780 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2781 Num Description Executable
2782 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2783 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2784 Added inferior 2.
2785 1 inferiors added.
2786 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2787 Num Description Executable
2788 2 <null> helloworld
2789 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2790 @end smallexample
2791
2792 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2793
2794 @kindex remove-inferiors
2795 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2796 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2797 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2798 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2799
2800 @end table
2801
2802 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2803 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2804 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2805 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2806
2807 @table @code
2808 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2809 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2810 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2811 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2812 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2813 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2814
2815 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2816 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2817 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2818 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2819 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2820 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2821 @end table
2822
2823 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2824 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2825 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2826 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2827
2828
2829 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2830 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2831
2832 @table @code
2833 @kindex set print inferior-events
2834 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2835 @item set print inferior-events
2836 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2837 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2838 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2839 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2840 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2841 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2842
2843 @kindex show print inferior-events
2844 @item show print inferior-events
2845 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2846 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2847 @end table
2848
2849 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2850 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2851 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2852
2853
2854 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2855 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2856 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2857 info program-spaces}} command.
2858
2859 @table @code
2860 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2861 @item maint info program-spaces
2862 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2863 @value{GDBN}.
2864
2865 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2866
2867 @enumerate
2868 @item
2869 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2870
2871 @item
2872 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2873 the @code{file} command.
2874
2875 @end enumerate
2876
2877 @noindent
2878 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2879 indicates the current program space.
2880
2881 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2882 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2883 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2884
2885 @smallexample
2886 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2887 Id Executable
2888 * 1 hello
2889 2 goodbye
2890 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2891 @end smallexample
2892
2893 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2894 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2895 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2896 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2897 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2898
2899 @smallexample
2900 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2901 Id Executable
2902 * 1 vfork-test
2903 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2904 @end smallexample
2905
2906 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2907 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2908 @end table
2909
2910 @node Threads
2911 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2912
2913 @cindex threads of execution
2914 @cindex multiple threads
2915 @cindex switching threads
2916 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2917 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2918 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2919 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2920 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2921 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2922 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2923
2924 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2925 programs:
2926
2927 @itemize @bullet
2928 @item automatic notification of new threads
2929 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2930 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2931 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2932 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2933 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2934 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2935 messages on thread start and exit.
2936 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2937 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2938 isn't compatible with the program.
2939 @end itemize
2940
2941 @cindex focus of debugging
2942 @cindex current thread
2943 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2944 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2945 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2946 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2947 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2948
2949 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2950 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2951 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2952 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2953 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2954 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2955 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2956 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2957 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2958 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2959
2960 @smallexample
2961 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2962 @end smallexample
2963
2964 @noindent
2965 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2966 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2967 further qualifier.
2968
2969 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2970 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2971 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2972 @c program?
2973 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2974 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2975 @c threads ab initio?
2976
2977 @anchor{thread numbers}
2978 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2979 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2980 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2981 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2982 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2983 between threads of different inferiors.
2984
2985 @cindex qualified thread ID
2986 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2987 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2988 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2989 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2990 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2991 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2992 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2993 inferior.
2994
2995 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2996 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2997 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2998 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2999
3000 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3001 @cindex thread ID lists
3002 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3003 argument. A list element can be:
3004
3005 @enumerate
3006 @item
3007 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3008 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3009 @samp{1}.
3010
3011 @item
3012 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3013 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3014 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3015
3016 @item
3017 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3018 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3019 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3020 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3021 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3022
3023 @end enumerate
3024
3025 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3026 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3027 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3028 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3029 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3030 7.1}.
3031
3032
3033 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3034 @cindex global thread number
3035 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3036 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3037 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3038 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3039 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3040 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3041
3042 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3043 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3044 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3045
3046 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3047 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3048 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3049 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3050 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3051 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3052 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3053 general information on convenience variables.
3054
3055 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3056 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3057 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3058
3059 @smallexample
3060 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3061 @end smallexample
3062
3063 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3064
3065 @smallexample
3066 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3067 @end smallexample
3068
3069 @table @code
3070 @kindex info threads
3071 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3072
3073 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3074 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3075 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3076 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3077
3078 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3079
3080 @enumerate
3081 @item
3082 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3083
3084 @item
3085 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3086 option was specified
3087
3088 @item
3089 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3090
3091 @item
3092 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3093 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3094 program itself.
3095
3096 @item
3097 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3098 @end enumerate
3099
3100 @noindent
3101 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3102 indicates the current thread.
3103
3104 For example,
3105 @end table
3106 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3107
3108 @smallexample
3109 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3110 Id Target Id Frame
3111 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3112 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3113 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3114 at threadtest.c:68
3115 @end smallexample
3116
3117 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3118 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3119 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3120
3121 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3122 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3123
3124 @smallexample
3125 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3126 Id GId Target Id Frame
3127 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3128 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3129 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3130 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3131 @end smallexample
3132
3133 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3134 Solaris-specific command:
3135
3136 @table @code
3137 @item maint info sol-threads
3138 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3139 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3140 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3141 @end table
3142
3143 @table @code
3144 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3145 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3146 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3147 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3148 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3149 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3150
3151 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3152 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3153
3154 @smallexample
3155 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3156 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3157 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3158 8 printf ("hello\n");
3159 @end smallexample
3160
3161 @noindent
3162 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3163 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3164 threads.
3165
3166 @kindex thread apply
3167 @cindex apply command to several threads
3168 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3169 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3170 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3171 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3172 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3173 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3174 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3175 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3176
3177
3178 @kindex thread name
3179 @cindex name a thread
3180 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3181 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3182 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3183 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3184
3185 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3186 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3187 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3188 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3189 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3190
3191 @kindex thread find
3192 @cindex search for a thread
3193 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3194 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3195 matches the supplied regular expression.
3196
3197 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3198 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3199 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3200 is the LWP id.
3201
3202 @smallexample
3203 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3204 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3205 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3206 Id Target Id Frame
3207 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3208 @end smallexample
3209
3210 @kindex set print thread-events
3211 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3212 @item set print thread-events
3213 @itemx set print thread-events on
3214 @itemx set print thread-events off
3215 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3216 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3217 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3218 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3219 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3220
3221 @kindex show print thread-events
3222 @item show print thread-events
3223 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3224 have started and exited.
3225 @end table
3226
3227 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3228 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3229 programs with multiple threads.
3230
3231 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3232 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3233
3234 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3235 @table @code
3236 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3237 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3238 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3239 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3240 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3241 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3242 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3243 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3244 macro.
3245
3246 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3247 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3248 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3249 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3250 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3251 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3252
3253 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3254 refers to the default system directories that are
3255 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3256 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3257 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3258
3259 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3260 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3261 was loaded in the inferior process.
3262
3263 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3264 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3265 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3266 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3267 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3268 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3269 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3270
3271 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3272 only on some platforms.
3273
3274 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3275 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3276 Display current libthread_db search path.
3277
3278 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3279 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3280 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3281 @item set debug libthread-db
3282 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3283 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3284 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3285 @end table
3286
3287 @node Forks
3288 @section Debugging Forks
3289
3290 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3291 @cindex multiple processes
3292 @cindex processes, multiple
3293 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3294 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3295 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3296 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3297 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3298 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3299 will cause it to terminate.
3300
3301 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3302 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3303 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3304 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3305 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3306 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3307 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3308 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3309 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3310 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3311
3312 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3313 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3314 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3315 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3316
3317 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3318 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3319 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3320
3321 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3322 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3323
3324 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3325 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3326
3327 @table @code
3328 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3329 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3330 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3331 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3332 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3333
3334 @table @code
3335 @item parent
3336 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3337 unimpeded. This is the default.
3338
3339 @item child
3340 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3341 unimpeded.
3342
3343 @end table
3344
3345 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3346 @item show follow-fork-mode
3347 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3348 @end table
3349
3350 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3351 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3352 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3353
3354 @table @code
3355 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3356 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3357 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3358 retain debugger control over them both.
3359
3360 @table @code
3361 @item on
3362 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3363 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3364 independently. This is the default.
3365
3366 @item off
3367 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3368 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3369 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3370 is held suspended.
3371
3372 @end table
3373
3374 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3375 @item show detach-on-fork
3376 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3377 @end table
3378
3379 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3380 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3381 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3382 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3383 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3384 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3385
3386 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3387 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3388 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3389 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3390 and Programs}.
3391
3392 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3393 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3394 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3395 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3396 the child process's @code{main}.
3397
3398 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3399 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3400
3401 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3402 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3403 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3404 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3405 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3406 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3407 command.
3408
3409 @table @code
3410 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3411 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3412
3413 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3414 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3415
3416 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3417
3418 @table @code
3419 @item new
3420 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3421 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3422 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3423 original inferior.
3424
3425 For example:
3426
3427 @smallexample
3428 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3429 (gdb) info inferior
3430 Id Description Executable
3431 * 1 <null> prog1
3432 (@value{GDBP}) run
3433 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3434 Program exited normally.
3435 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3436 Id Description Executable
3437 1 <null> prog1
3438 * 2 <null> prog2
3439 @end smallexample
3440
3441 @item same
3442 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3443 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3444 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3445 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3446 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3447
3448 For example:
3449
3450 @smallexample
3451 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3452 Id Description Executable
3453 * 1 <null> prog1
3454 (@value{GDBP}) run
3455 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3456 Program exited normally.
3457 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3458 Id Description Executable
3459 * 1 <null> prog2
3460 @end smallexample
3461
3462 @end table
3463 @end table
3464
3465 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3466 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3467
3468 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3469 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3470 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3471
3472 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3473 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3474
3475 @cindex checkpoint
3476 @cindex restart
3477 @cindex bookmark
3478 @cindex snapshot of a process
3479 @cindex rewind program state
3480
3481 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3482 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3483 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3484 later.
3485
3486 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3487 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3488 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3489 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3490 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3491
3492 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3493 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3494 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3495 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3496 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3497 start again from there.
3498
3499 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3500 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3501
3502 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3503
3504 @table @code
3505 @kindex checkpoint
3506 @item checkpoint
3507 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3508 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3509 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3510
3511 @kindex info checkpoints
3512 @item info checkpoints
3513 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3514 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3515 listed:
3516
3517 @table @code
3518 @item Checkpoint ID
3519 @item Process ID
3520 @item Code Address
3521 @item Source line, or label
3522 @end table
3523
3524 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3525 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3526 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3527 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3528 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3529 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3530 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3531
3532 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3533 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3534 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3535 the debugger.
3536
3537 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3538 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3539 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3540
3541 @end table
3542
3543 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3544 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3545 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3546 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3547 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3548 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3549 previously read data can be read again.
3550
3551 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3552 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3553 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3554 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3555 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3556 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3557
3558 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3559 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3560 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3561 different execution path this time.
3562
3563 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3564 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3565 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3566 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3567 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3568 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3569 potentially pose a problem.
3570
3571 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3572
3573 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3574 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3575 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3576 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3577 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3578 next.
3579
3580 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3581 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3582 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3583 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3584 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3585
3586 @node Stopping
3587 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3588
3589 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3590 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3591 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3592
3593 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3594 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3595 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3596 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3597 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3598 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3599 explicitly request this information at any time.
3600
3601 @table @code
3602 @kindex info program
3603 @item info program
3604 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3605 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3606 @end table
3607
3608 @menu
3609 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3610 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3611 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3612 Skipping over functions and files
3613 * Signals:: Signals
3614 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3615 @end menu
3616
3617 @node Breakpoints
3618 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3619
3620 @cindex breakpoints
3621 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3622 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3623 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3624 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3625 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3626 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3627 program.
3628
3629 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3630 the executable is run.
3631
3632 @cindex watchpoints
3633 @cindex data breakpoints
3634 @cindex memory tracing
3635 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3636 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3637 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3638 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3639 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3640 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3641 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3642 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3643 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3644 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3645 same commands.
3646
3647 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3648 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3649 Automatic Display}.
3650
3651 @cindex catchpoints
3652 @cindex breakpoint on events
3653 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3654 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3655 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3656 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3657 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3658 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3659 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3660
3661 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3662 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3663 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3664 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3665 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3666 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3667 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3668 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3669 enable it again.
3670
3671 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3672 @cindex breakpoint lists
3673 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3674 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3675 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3676 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3677 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3678 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3679 are operated on.
3680
3681 @menu
3682 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3683 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3684 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3685 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3686 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3687 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3688 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3689 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3690 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3691 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3692 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3693 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3694 @end menu
3695
3696 @node Set Breaks
3697 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3698
3699 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3700 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3701 @c
3702 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3703
3704 @kindex break
3705 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3706 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3707 @cindex latest breakpoint
3708 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3709 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3710 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3711 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3712 convenience variables.
3713
3714 @table @code
3715 @item break @var{location}
3716 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3717 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3718 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3719 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3720 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3721
3722 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3723 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3724 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3725 that situation.
3726
3727 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3728 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3729 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3730
3731 @item break
3732 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3733 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3734 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3735 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3736 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3737 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3738 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3739 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3740 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3741 inside loops.
3742
3743 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3744 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3745 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3746 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3747 existed when your program stopped.
3748
3749 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3750 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3751 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3752 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3753 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3754 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3755 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3756
3757 @kindex tbreak
3758 @item tbreak @var{args}
3759 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3760 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3761 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3762 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3763
3764 @kindex hbreak
3765 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3766 @item hbreak @var{args}
3767 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3768 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3769 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3770 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3771 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3772 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3773 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3774 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3775 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3776 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3777 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3778 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3779 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3780 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3781 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3782 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3783 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3784 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3785
3786 @kindex thbreak
3787 @item thbreak @var{args}
3788 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3789 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3790 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3791 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3792 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3793 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3794 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3795 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3796
3797 @kindex rbreak
3798 @cindex regular expression
3799 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3800 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3801 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3802 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3803 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3804 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3805 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3806 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3807 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3808
3809 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3810 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3811 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3812 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3813 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3814 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3815
3816 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3817 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3818 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3819 classes.
3820
3821 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3822 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3823 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3824
3825 @smallexample
3826 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3827 @end smallexample
3828
3829 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3830 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3831 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3832 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3833 every function in a given file:
3834
3835 @smallexample
3836 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3837 @end smallexample
3838
3839 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3840 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3841
3842 @kindex info breakpoints
3843 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3844 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3845 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3846 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3847 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3848 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3849 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3850
3851 @table @emph
3852 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3853 @item Type
3854 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3855 @item Disposition
3856 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3857 @item Enabled or Disabled
3858 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3859 that are not enabled.
3860 @item Address
3861 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3862 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3863 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3864 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3865 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3866 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3867 @item What
3868 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3869 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3870 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3871 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3872 @end table
3873
3874 @noindent
3875 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3876 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3877 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3878 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3879 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3880 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3881
3882 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3883 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3884 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3885 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3886
3887 @noindent
3888 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3889 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3890 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3891 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3892 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3893
3894 @noindent
3895 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3896 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3897 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3898 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3899 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3900 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3901
3902 @noindent
3903 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3904 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3905
3906 @end table
3907
3908 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3909 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3910 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3911 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3912
3913 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3914 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3915 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3916 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3917
3918 @itemize @bullet
3919 @item
3920 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3921
3922 @item
3923 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3924 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3925
3926 @item
3927 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3928 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3929
3930 @item
3931 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3932 several places where that function is inlined.
3933 @end itemize
3934
3935 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3936 the relevant locations.
3937
3938 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3939 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3940 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3941 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3942 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3943 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3944 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3945
3946 For example:
3947
3948 @smallexample
3949 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3950 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3951 stop only if i==1
3952 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3953 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3954 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3955 @end smallexample
3956
3957 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
3958 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3959 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3960 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
3961 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
3962 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
3963 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
3964 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
3965 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
3966 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
3967 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
3968
3969 @cindex pending breakpoints
3970 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3971 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3972 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3973 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3974 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3975 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3976 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3977 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3978 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3979 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3980 is not yet resolved.
3981
3982 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3983 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3984 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3985 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3986 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3987 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3988
3989 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3990 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3991 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3992 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3993
3994 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3995 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3996 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3997
3998 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3999 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4000 address specification to an address:
4001
4002 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4003 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4004 @table @code
4005 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4006 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4007 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4008
4009 @item set breakpoint pending on
4010 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4011 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4012
4013 @item set breakpoint pending off
4014 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4015 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4016 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4017
4018 @item show breakpoint pending
4019 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4020 @end table
4021
4022 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4023 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4024 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4025
4026 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4027 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4028 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4029 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4030 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4031 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4032 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4033 breakpoints.
4034
4035 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4036
4037 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4038 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4039 @table @code
4040 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4041 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4042 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4043 breakpoint must be used.
4044
4045 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4046 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4047 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4048 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4049 @end table
4050
4051 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4052 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4053 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4054 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4055 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4056 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4057 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4058 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4059 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4060
4061 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4062 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4063 @table @code
4064 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4065 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4066 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4067 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4068
4069 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4070 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4071 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4072 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4073 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4074 @end table
4075
4076 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4077 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4078 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4079
4080 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4081 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4082
4083 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4084
4085 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4086 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4087 @table @code
4088 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4089 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4090 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4091 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4092 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4093
4094 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4095 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4096 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4097 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4098 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4099 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4100 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4101 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4102 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4103 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4104 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4105 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4106 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4107
4108 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4109 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4110 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4111 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4112 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4113 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4114 @end table
4115
4116
4117 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4118 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4119 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4120 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4121 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4122 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4123 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4124 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4125
4126
4127 @node Set Watchpoints
4128 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4129
4130 @cindex setting watchpoints
4131 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4132 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4133 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4134 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4135 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4136
4137 @itemize @bullet
4138 @item
4139 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4140
4141 @item
4142 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4143 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4144 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4145
4146 @item
4147 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4148 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4149 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4150 @end itemize
4151
4152 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4153 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4154 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4155 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4156 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4157 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4158 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4159 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4160 the expression changes.
4161
4162 @cindex software watchpoints
4163 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4164 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4165 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4166 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4167 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4168 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4169 culprit.)
4170
4171 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4172 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4173 slow down the running of your program.
4174
4175 @table @code
4176 @kindex watch
4177 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4178 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4179 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4180 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4181 to watch the value of a single variable:
4182
4183 @smallexample
4184 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4185 @end smallexample
4186
4187 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4188 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4189 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4190 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4191 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4192 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4193
4194 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4195 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4196 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4197 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4198 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4199 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4200 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4201 error.
4202
4203 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4204 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4205 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4206 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4207 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4208 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4209 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4210 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4211 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4212 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4213 Examples:
4214
4215 @smallexample
4216 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4217 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4218 @end smallexample
4219
4220 @kindex rwatch
4221 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4222 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4223 by the program.
4224
4225 @kindex awatch
4226 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4227 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4228 or written into by the program.
4229
4230 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4231 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4232 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4233 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4234 @end table
4235
4236 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4237 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4238 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4239 a never-changing value:
4240
4241 @smallexample
4242 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4243 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4244 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4245 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4246 @end smallexample
4247
4248 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4249 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4250 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4251 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4252 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4253 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4254
4255 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4256 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4257 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4258 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4259 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4260 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4261 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4262 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4263
4264 @table @code
4265 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4266 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4267 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4268
4269 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4270 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4271 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4272 @end table
4273
4274 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4275 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4276 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4277
4278 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4279
4280 @smallexample
4281 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4282 @end smallexample
4283
4284 @noindent
4285 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4286
4287 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4288 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4289 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4290 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4291 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4292 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4293 will print a message like this:
4294
4295 @smallexample
4296 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4297 @end smallexample
4298
4299 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4300 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4301 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4302 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4303 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4304 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4305 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4306 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4307
4308 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4309 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4310 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4311 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4312 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4313 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4314
4315 @smallexample
4316 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4317 @end smallexample
4318
4319 @noindent
4320 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4321
4322 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4323 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4324 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4325 expression with separately allocated resources.
4326
4327 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4328 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4329 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4330
4331 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4332 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4333 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4334 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4335 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4336 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4337 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4338 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4339 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4340
4341 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4342 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4343 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4344 watched expression from every thread.
4345
4346 @quotation
4347 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4348 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4349 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4350 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4351 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4352 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4353 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4354 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4355 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4356 @end quotation
4357
4358 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4359
4360 @node Set Catchpoints
4361 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4362 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4363 @cindex exception handlers
4364 @cindex event handling
4365
4366 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4367 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4368 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4369
4370 @table @code
4371 @kindex catch
4372 @item catch @var{event}
4373 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4374
4375 @table @code
4376 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4377 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4378 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4379 @kindex catch throw
4380 @kindex catch rethrow
4381 @kindex catch catch
4382 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4383 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4384
4385 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4386 regular expression will be caught.
4387
4388 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4389 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4390 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4391 exception being thrown.
4392
4393 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4394 @value{GDBN}:
4395
4396 @itemize @bullet
4397 @item
4398 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4399 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4400 supported.
4401
4402 @item
4403 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4404 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4405 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4406 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4407 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4408 built.
4409
4410 @item
4411 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4412 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4413
4414 @item
4415 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4416 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4417 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4418 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4419
4420 @item
4421 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4422 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4423 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4424 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4425 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4426 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4427 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4428 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4429 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4430
4431 @item
4432 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4433
4434 @item
4435 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4436 @end itemize
4437
4438 @item exception
4439 @kindex catch exception
4440 @cindex Ada exception catching
4441 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4442 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4443 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4444 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4445 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4446
4447 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4448 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4449 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4450 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4451 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4452 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4453 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4454 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4455
4456 @item exception unhandled
4457 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4458 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4459
4460 @item assert
4461 @kindex catch assert
4462 A failed Ada assertion.
4463
4464 @item exec
4465 @kindex catch exec
4466 @cindex break on fork/exec
4467 A call to @code{exec}.
4468
4469 @item syscall
4470 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4471 @kindex catch syscall
4472 @cindex break on a system call.
4473 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4474 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4475 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4476 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4477 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4478 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4479 will be caught.
4480
4481 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4482 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4483 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4484 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4485
4486 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4487 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4488 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4489 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4490
4491 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4492 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4493 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4494 available choices.
4495
4496 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4497 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4498 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4499 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4500 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4501 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4502 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4503 behind the OS upgrades).
4504
4505 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4506 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4507 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4508 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4509 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4510 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4511 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4512 syscall groups available on your environment.
4513
4514 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4515 arguments to it:
4516
4517 @smallexample
4518 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4519 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4520 (@value{GDBP}) r
4521 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4522
4523 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4524 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4525 (@value{GDBP}) c
4526 Continuing.
4527
4528 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4529 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4530 (@value{GDBP})
4531 @end smallexample
4532
4533 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4534
4535 @smallexample
4536 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4537 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4538 (@value{GDBP}) r
4539 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4540
4541 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4542 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4543 (@value{GDBP}) c
4544 Continuing.
4545
4546 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4547 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4548 (@value{GDBP})
4549 @end smallexample
4550
4551 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4552 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4553 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4554
4555 @smallexample
4556 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4557 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4558 (@value{GDBP}) r
4559 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4560
4561 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4562 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4563 (@value{GDBP}) c
4564 Continuing.
4565
4566 Program exited normally.
4567 (@value{GDBP})
4568 @end smallexample
4569
4570 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4571
4572 @smallexample
4573 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4574 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4575 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4576 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4577 (@value{GDBP}) r
4578 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4579
4580 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4581 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4582
4583 (@value{GDBP}) c
4584 Continuing.
4585 @end smallexample
4586
4587 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4588 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4589 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4590 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4591
4592 @smallexample
4593 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4594 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4595 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4596 (@value{GDBP})
4597 @end smallexample
4598
4599 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4600 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4601 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4602 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4603 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4604 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4605
4606 @smallexample
4607 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4608 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4609 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4610 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4611 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4612 (@value{GDBP})
4613 @end smallexample
4614
4615 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4616
4617 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4618 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4619
4620 @smallexample
4621 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4622 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4623 @end smallexample
4624
4625 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4626
4627 @item fork
4628 @kindex catch fork
4629 A call to @code{fork}.
4630
4631 @item vfork
4632 @kindex catch vfork
4633 A call to @code{vfork}.
4634
4635 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4636 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4637 @kindex catch load
4638 @kindex catch unload
4639 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4640 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4641 matches one of the affected libraries.
4642
4643 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4644 @kindex catch signal
4645 The delivery of a signal.
4646
4647 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4648 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4649 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4650
4651 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4652 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4653 signal names.
4654
4655 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4656 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4657 will be caught.
4658
4659 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4660 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4661 catchpoint.
4662
4663 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4664 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4665 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4666 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4667 commands.
4668
4669 @end table
4670
4671 @item tcatch @var{event}
4672 @kindex tcatch
4673 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4674 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4675
4676 @end table
4677
4678 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4679
4680
4681 @node Delete Breaks
4682 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4683
4684 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4685 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4686 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4687 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4688 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4689 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4690
4691 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4692 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4693 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4694 their breakpoint numbers.
4695
4696 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4697 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4698 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4699
4700 @table @code
4701 @kindex clear
4702 @item clear
4703 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4704 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4705 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4706 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4707
4708 @item clear @var{location}
4709 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4710 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4711 most useful ones are listed below:
4712
4713 @table @code
4714 @item clear @var{function}
4715 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4716 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4717
4718 @item clear @var{linenum}
4719 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4720 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4721 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4722 @end table
4723
4724 @cindex delete breakpoints
4725 @kindex delete
4726 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4727 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4728 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4729 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4730 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4731 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4732 @end table
4733
4734 @node Disabling
4735 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4736
4737 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4738 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4739 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4740 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4741 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4742
4743 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4744 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4745 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4746 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4747 do not know which numbers to use.
4748
4749 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4750 affects all of its locations.
4751
4752 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4753 different states of enablement:
4754
4755 @itemize @bullet
4756 @item
4757 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4758 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4759 @item
4760 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4761 @item
4762 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4763 disabled.
4764 @item
4765 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4766 N times, then becomes disabled.
4767 @item
4768 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4769 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4770 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4771 @end itemize
4772
4773 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4774 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4775
4776 @table @code
4777 @kindex disable
4778 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4779 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4780 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4781 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4782 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4783 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4784 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4785
4786 @kindex enable
4787 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4788 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4789 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4790
4791 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4792 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4793 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4794
4795 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4796 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4797 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4798 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4799 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4800 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4801 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4802
4803 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4804 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4805 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4806 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4807 @end table
4808
4809 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4810 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4811 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4812 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4813 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4814 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4815 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4816 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4817 Stepping}.)
4818
4819 @node Conditions
4820 @subsection Break Conditions
4821 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4822 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4823
4824 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4825 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4826 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4827 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4828 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4829 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4830 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4831 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4832
4833 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4834 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4835 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4836 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4837 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4838
4839 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4840 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4841 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4842 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4843 one.
4844
4845 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4846 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4847 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4848 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4849 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4850 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4851 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4852 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4853 conditions for the
4854 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4855 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4856
4857 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4858 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4859 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4860 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4861 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4862 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4863
4864 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4865 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4866 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4867 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4868 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4869
4870 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4871 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4872 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4873 with the @code{condition} command.
4874
4875 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4876 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4877 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4878 catchpoint.
4879
4880 @table @code
4881 @kindex condition
4882 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4883 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4884 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4885 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4886 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4887 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4888 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4889 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4890 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4891 prints an error message:
4892
4893 @smallexample
4894 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4895 @end smallexample
4896
4897 @noindent
4898 @value{GDBN} does
4899 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4900 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4901 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4902
4903 @item condition @var{bnum}
4904 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4905 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4906 @end table
4907
4908 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4909 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4910 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4911 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4912 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4913 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4914 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4915 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4916 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4917 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4918 your program reaches it.
4919
4920 @table @code
4921 @kindex ignore
4922 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4923 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4924 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4925 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4926 takes no action.
4927
4928 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4929 a count of zero.
4930
4931 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4932 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4933 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4934 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4935
4936 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4937 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4938 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4939
4940 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4941 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4942 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4943 Variables}.
4944 @end table
4945
4946 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4947
4948
4949 @node Break Commands
4950 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4951
4952 @cindex breakpoint commands
4953 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4954 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4955 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4956 enable other breakpoints.
4957
4958 @table @code
4959 @kindex commands
4960 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4961 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4962 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4963 @itemx end
4964 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4965 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4966 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4967
4968 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4969 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4970
4971 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4972 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4973 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4974 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4975 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4976 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4977 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4978 Expressions}).
4979 @end table
4980
4981 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4982 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4983
4984 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4985 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4986 that resumes execution.
4987
4988 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4989 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4990 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4991 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4992 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4993
4994 @kindex silent
4995 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4996 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4997 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4998 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4999 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5000 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5001
5002 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5003 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5004 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5005
5006 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5007 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5008
5009 @smallexample
5010 break foo if x>0
5011 commands
5012 silent
5013 printf "x is %d\n",x
5014 cont
5015 end
5016 @end smallexample
5017
5018 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5019 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5020 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5021 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5022 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5023 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5024 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5025
5026 @smallexample
5027 break 403
5028 commands
5029 silent
5030 set x = y + 4
5031 cont
5032 end
5033 @end smallexample
5034
5035 @node Dynamic Printf
5036 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5037
5038 @cindex dynamic printf
5039 @cindex dprintf
5040 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5041 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5042 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5043 having to recompile it.
5044
5045 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5046 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5047 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5048 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5049 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5050 redirects to files and so forth.
5051
5052 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5053 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5054 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5055 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5056 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5057 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5058 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5059
5060 @table @code
5061 @kindex dprintf
5062 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5063 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5064 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5065 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5066
5067 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5068 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5069 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5070 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5071 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5072 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5073
5074 @table @code
5075 @item gdb
5076 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5077 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5078
5079 @item call
5080 @kindex dprintf-style call
5081 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5082 @code{printf}).
5083
5084 @item agent
5085 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5086 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5087 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5088 support running commands on the target.
5089 @end table
5090
5091 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5092 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5093 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5094 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5095 command.
5096
5097 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5098 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5099 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5100 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5101 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5102 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5103
5104 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5105 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5106 you could do the following:
5107
5108 @example
5109 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5110 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5111 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5112 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5113 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5114 (gdb) info break
5115 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5116 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5117 continue
5118 (gdb)
5119 @end example
5120
5121 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5122 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5123 the variable settings.
5124
5125 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5126 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5127 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5128 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5129 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5130 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5131
5132 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5133 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5134 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5135
5136 @end table
5137
5138 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5139 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5140 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5141 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5142 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5143 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5144
5145 @node Save Breakpoints
5146 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5147
5148 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5149 breakpoints}} command.
5150
5151 @table @code
5152 @kindex save breakpoints
5153 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5154 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5155 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5156 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5157 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5158 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5159 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5160 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5161 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5162 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5163 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5164 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5165 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5166 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5167 that can no longer be recreated.
5168 @end table
5169
5170 @node Static Probe Points
5171 @subsection Static Probe Points
5172
5173 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5174 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5175 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5176 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5177 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5178
5179 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5180 ELF-compatible systems:
5181
5182 @itemize @bullet
5183
5184 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5185 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5186 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5187 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5188 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5189 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5190 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5191 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5192
5193 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5194 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5195 C@t{++} languages.
5196 @end itemize
5197
5198 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5199 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5200 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5201 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5202 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5203 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5204 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5205 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5206 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5207
5208 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5209 probes}, with optional arguments:
5210
5211 @table @code
5212 @kindex info probes
5213 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5214 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5215 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5216 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5217
5218 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5219 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5220 probes from all providers are listed.
5221
5222 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5223 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5224 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5225
5226 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5227 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5228 given, all object files are considered.
5229
5230 @item info probes all
5231 List the available static probes, from all types.
5232 @end table
5233
5234 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5235 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5236 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5237 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5238 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5239
5240 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5241 commands, with optional arguments:
5242
5243 @table @code
5244 @kindex enable probes
5245 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5246 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5247 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5248 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5249
5250 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5251 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5252 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5253
5254 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5255 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5256 given, all object files are considered.
5257
5258 @kindex disable probes
5259 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5260 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5261 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5262 @end table
5263
5264 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5265 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5266 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5267 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5268 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5269 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5270 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5271 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5272 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5273 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5274 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5275 at the current probe point.
5276
5277 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5278 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5279 an error message.
5280
5281
5282 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5283 @node Error in Breakpoints
5284 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5285
5286 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5287 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5288
5289 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5290 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5291 @smallexample
5292 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5293 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5294 @end smallexample
5295
5296 @noindent
5297 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5298 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5299 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5300
5301 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5302 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5303
5304 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5305 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5306 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5307
5308 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5309 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5310 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5311 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5312
5313 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5314 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5315 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5316 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5317 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5318 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5319 first in the bundle.
5320
5321 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5322 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5323 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5324 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5325 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5326 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5327 is hit.
5328
5329 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5330 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5331
5332 @smallexample
5333 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5334 @end smallexample
5335
5336 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5337 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5338 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5339 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5340 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5341 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5342 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5343 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5344
5345 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5346 adjusted breakpoints:
5347
5348 @smallexample
5349 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5350 to 0x00010410.
5351 @end smallexample
5352
5353 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5354 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5355 frequently than expected.
5356
5357 @node Continuing and Stepping
5358 @section Continuing and Stepping
5359
5360 @cindex stepping
5361 @cindex continuing
5362 @cindex resuming execution
5363 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5364 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5365 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5366 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5367 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5368 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5369 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5370 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5371 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5372 handlers}).)
5373
5374 @table @code
5375 @kindex continue
5376 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5377 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5378 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5379 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5380 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5381 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5382 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5383 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5384 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5385 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5386
5387 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5388 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5389 @code{continue} is ignored.
5390
5391 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5392 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5393 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5394 @code{continue}.
5395 @end table
5396
5397 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5398 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5399 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5400 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5401
5402 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5403 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5404 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5405 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5406 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5407 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5408
5409 @table @code
5410 @kindex step
5411 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5412 @item step
5413 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5414 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5415 abbreviated @code{s}.
5416
5417 @quotation
5418 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5419 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5420 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5421 @c distinction here.
5422 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5423 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5424 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5425 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5426 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5427 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5428 below.
5429 @end quotation
5430
5431 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5432 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5433 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5434 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5435 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5436 called within the line.
5437
5438 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5439 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5440 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5441 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5442 was any debugging information about the routine.
5443
5444 @item step @var{count}
5445 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5446 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5447 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5448
5449 @kindex next
5450 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5451 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5452 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5453 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5454 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5455 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5456 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5457 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5458
5459 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5460
5461
5462 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5463 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5464 @c
5465 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5466 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5467 @c function are executed without stopping.
5468
5469 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5470 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5471 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5472
5473 @kindex set step-mode
5474 @item set step-mode
5475 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5476 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5477 @itemx set step-mode on
5478 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5479 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5480 information rather than stepping over it.
5481
5482 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5483 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5484 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5485
5486 @item set step-mode off
5487 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5488 debug information. This is the default.
5489
5490 @item show step-mode
5491 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5492 source line debug information.
5493
5494 @kindex finish
5495 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5496 @item finish
5497 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5498 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5499 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5500
5501 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5502 ,Returning from a Function}).
5503
5504 @kindex until
5505 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5506 @cindex run until specified location
5507 @item until
5508 @itemx u
5509 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5510 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5511 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5512 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5513 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5514 than the address of the jump.
5515
5516 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5517 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5518 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5519 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5520 through the next iteration.
5521
5522 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5523 stack frame.
5524
5525 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5526 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5527 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5528 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5529 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5530
5531 @smallexample
5532 (@value{GDBP}) f
5533 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5534 206 expand_input();
5535 (@value{GDBP}) until
5536 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5537 @end smallexample
5538
5539 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5540 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5541 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5542 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5543 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5544 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5545 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5546
5547 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5548 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5549 argument.
5550
5551 @item until @var{location}
5552 @itemx u @var{location}
5553 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5554 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5555 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5556 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5557 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5558 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5559 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5560 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5561 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5562 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5563 invocations have returned.
5564
5565 @smallexample
5566 94 int factorial (int value)
5567 95 @{
5568 96 if (value > 1) @{
5569 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5570 98 @}
5571 99 return (value);
5572 100 @}
5573 @end smallexample
5574
5575
5576 @kindex advance @var{location}
5577 @item advance @var{location}
5578 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5579 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5580 @ref{Specify Location}.
5581 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5582 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5583 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5584 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5585
5586
5587 @kindex stepi
5588 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5589 @item stepi
5590 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5591 @itemx si
5592 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5593
5594 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5595 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5596 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5597 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5598
5599 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5600
5601 @need 750
5602 @kindex nexti
5603 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5604 @item nexti
5605 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5606 @itemx ni
5607 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5608 proceed until the function returns.
5609
5610 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5611
5612 @end table
5613
5614 @anchor{range stepping}
5615 @cindex range stepping
5616 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5617 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5618 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5619 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5620 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5621 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5622 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5623 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5624 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5625 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5626 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5627 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5628 if necessary:
5629
5630 @table @code
5631 @kindex set range-stepping
5632 @kindex show range-stepping
5633 @item set range-stepping
5634 @itemx show range-stepping
5635 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5636
5637 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5638 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5639 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5640 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5641 default is @code{on}.
5642
5643 @end table
5644
5645 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5646 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5647 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5648
5649 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5650 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5651 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5652 a particular file when stepping.
5653
5654 For example, consider the following C function:
5655
5656 @smallexample
5657 101 int func()
5658 102 @{
5659 103 foo(boring());
5660 104 bar(boring());
5661 105 @}
5662 @end smallexample
5663
5664 @noindent
5665 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5666 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5667 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5668 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5669
5670 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5671 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5672 is called from many places.
5673
5674 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5675 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5676 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5677 @code{foo}.
5678
5679 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5680 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5681 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5682
5683 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5684 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5685 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5686 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5687 the underlying system.
5688 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5689 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5690
5691 @table @code
5692 @kindex skip
5693 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5694 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5695 that specify what to skip.
5696 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5697
5698 @table @code
5699 @item -file @var{file}
5700 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5701 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5702
5703 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5704 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5705 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5706 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5707 over when stepping.
5708
5709 @smallexample
5710 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5711 @end smallexample
5712
5713 @item -function @var{linespec}
5714 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5715 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5716 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5717 @xref{Specify Location}.
5718
5719 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5720 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5721 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5722 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5723
5724 This form is useful for complex function names.
5725 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5726 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5727 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5728 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5729 regular expression makes this easier.
5730
5731 @smallexample
5732 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5733 @end smallexample
5734
5735 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5736 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5737
5738 @smallexample
5739 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5740 @end smallexample
5741 @end table
5742
5743 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5744 will be skipped.
5745
5746 @kindex skip function
5747 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5748 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5749 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5750 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5751
5752 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5753 will be skipped.
5754
5755 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5756 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5757
5758 @kindex skip file
5759 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5760 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5761 will be skipped over when stepping.
5762
5763 @smallexample
5764 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5765 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5766 @end smallexample
5767
5768 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5769 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5770 @end table
5771
5772 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5773 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5774
5775 @table @code
5776 @kindex info skip
5777 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5778 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5779 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5780 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5781
5782 @table @emph
5783 @item Identifier
5784 A number identifying this skip.
5785 @item Enabled or Disabled
5786 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5787 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5788 @item Glob
5789 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5790 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5791 @item File
5792 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5793 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5794 @item RE
5795 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5796 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5797 @item Function
5798 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5799 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5800 @end table
5801
5802 @kindex skip delete
5803 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5804 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5805 skips.
5806
5807 @kindex skip enable
5808 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5809 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5810 skips.
5811
5812 @kindex skip disable
5813 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5814 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5815 skips.
5816
5817 @end table
5818
5819 @node Signals
5820 @section Signals
5821 @cindex signals
5822
5823 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5824 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5825 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5826 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5827 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5828 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5829 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5830 requested an alarm).
5831
5832 @cindex fatal signals
5833 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5834 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5835 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5836 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5837 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5838 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5839
5840 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5841 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5842 signal.
5843
5844 @cindex handling signals
5845 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5846 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5847 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5848 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5849 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5850
5851 @table @code
5852 @kindex info signals
5853 @kindex info handle
5854 @item info signals
5855 @itemx info handle
5856 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5857 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5858 the defined types of signals.
5859
5860 @item info signals @var{sig}
5861 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5862
5863 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5864
5865 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5866 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5867 for details about this command.
5868
5869 @kindex handle
5870 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5871 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5872 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5873 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5874 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5875 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5876 say what change to make.
5877 @end table
5878
5879 @c @group
5880 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5881 Their full names are:
5882
5883 @table @code
5884 @item nostop
5885 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5886 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5887
5888 @item stop
5889 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5890 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5891
5892 @item print
5893 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5894
5895 @item noprint
5896 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5897 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5898
5899 @item pass
5900 @itemx noignore
5901 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5902 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5903 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5904
5905 @item nopass
5906 @itemx ignore
5907 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5908 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5909 @end table
5910 @c @end group
5911
5912 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5913 program until you
5914 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5915 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5916 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5917 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5918 program sees that signal when you continue.
5919
5920 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5921 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5922 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5923 erroneous signals.
5924
5925 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5926 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5927 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5928 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5929 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5930 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5931 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5932 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5933 Program a Signal}.
5934
5935 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5936 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5937
5938 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5939 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5940 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5941 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5942 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5943 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5944 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5945 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5946 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5947 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5948 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5949 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5950 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5951
5952 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5953
5954 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5955 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5956 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5957 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5958
5959 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5960 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5961 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5962 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5963
5964 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5965 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5966
5967 @smallexample
5968 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5969 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5970 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5971 (@value{GDBP}) c
5972 Continuing.
5973
5974 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5975 main () sigusr1.c:28
5976 28 p = 0;
5977 (@value{GDBP}) si
5978 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5979 9 @{
5980 @end smallexample
5981
5982 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5983 program to receive the signal first:
5984
5985 @smallexample
5986 (@value{GDBP}) n
5987 28 p = 0;
5988 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5989 (@value{GDBP}) si
5990 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5991 9 @{
5992 (@value{GDBP})
5993 @end smallexample
5994
5995 @cindex extra signal information
5996 @anchor{extra signal information}
5997
5998 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5999 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6000 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6001 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6002 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6003 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6004 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6005 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6006 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6007 system header.
6008
6009 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6010 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6011
6012 @smallexample
6013 @group
6014 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6015 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6016 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6017 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6018 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6019 type = struct @{
6020 int si_signo;
6021 int si_errno;
6022 int si_code;
6023 union @{
6024 int _pad[28];
6025 struct @{...@} _kill;
6026 struct @{...@} _timer;
6027 struct @{...@} _rt;
6028 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6029 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6030 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6031 @} _sifields;
6032 @}
6033 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6034 type = struct @{
6035 void *si_addr;
6036 @}
6037 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6038 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6039 @end group
6040 @end smallexample
6041
6042 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6043
6044 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6045 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6046 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6047 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6048 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6049 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6050 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6051 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6052 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6053 information is displayed.
6054
6055 The usual output of a segfault is:
6056 @smallexample
6057 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6058 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6059 68 value = *(p + len);
6060 @end smallexample
6061
6062 While a bound violation is presented as:
6063 @smallexample
6064 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6065 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6066 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6067 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6068 68 value = *(p + len);
6069 @end smallexample
6070
6071 @node Thread Stops
6072 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6073
6074 @cindex stopped threads
6075 @cindex threads, stopped
6076
6077 @cindex continuing threads
6078 @cindex threads, continuing
6079
6080 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6081 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6082 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6083 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6084 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6085 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6086 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6087 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6088 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6089
6090 @menu
6091 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6092 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6093 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6094 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6095 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6096 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6097 @end menu
6098
6099 @node All-Stop Mode
6100 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6101
6102 @cindex all-stop mode
6103
6104 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6105 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6106 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6107 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6108 underfoot.
6109
6110 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6111 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6112 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6113
6114 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6115 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6116 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6117 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6118 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6119 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6120 stops.
6121
6122 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6123 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6124 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6125 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6126
6127 @cindex automatic thread selection
6128 @cindex switching threads automatically
6129 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6130 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6131 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6132 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6133 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6134 thread.
6135
6136 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6137 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6138
6139 @table @code
6140 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6141 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6142 @cindex lock scheduler
6143 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6144 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6145 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6146 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6147 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6148 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6149 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6150 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6151 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6152 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6153 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6154 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6155 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6156 @code{on} in replay mode.
6157
6158 @item show scheduler-locking
6159 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6160 @end table
6161
6162 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6163 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6164 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6165 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6166 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6167 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6168 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6169 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6170 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6171 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6172 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6173 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6174 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6175 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6176
6177 @table @code
6178 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6179 @item set schedule-multiple
6180 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6181 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6182 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6183 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6184 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6185 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6186
6187 @item show schedule-multiple
6188 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6189 multiple processes.
6190 @end table
6191
6192 @node Non-Stop Mode
6193 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6194
6195 @cindex non-stop mode
6196
6197 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6198 @c with more details.
6199
6200 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6201 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6202 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6203 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6204 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6205 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6206
6207 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6208 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6209 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6210 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6211 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6212 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6213 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6214 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6215 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6216 independently and simultaneously.
6217
6218 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6219 or attach to your program:
6220
6221 @smallexample
6222 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6223 set pagination off
6224
6225 # Finally, turn it on!
6226 set non-stop on
6227 @end smallexample
6228
6229 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6230
6231 @table @code
6232 @kindex set non-stop
6233 @item set non-stop on
6234 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6235 @item set non-stop off
6236 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6237 @kindex show non-stop
6238 @item show non-stop
6239 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6240 @end table
6241
6242 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6243 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6244 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6245 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6246 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6247 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6248 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6249 default.
6250
6251 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6252 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6253 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6254
6255 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6256 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6257 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6258 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6259 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6260
6261 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6262 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6263 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6264 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6265 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6266
6267 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6268
6269 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6270 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6271 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6272 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6273 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6274 previously current thread.
6275
6276 @node Background Execution
6277 @subsection Background Execution
6278
6279 @cindex foreground execution
6280 @cindex background execution
6281 @cindex asynchronous execution
6282 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6283
6284 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6285 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6286 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6287 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6288 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6289 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6290
6291 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6292 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6293
6294 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6295 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6296 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6297 are:
6298
6299 @table @code
6300 @kindex run&
6301 @item run
6302 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6303
6304 @item attach
6305 @kindex attach&
6306 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6307
6308 @item step
6309 @kindex step&
6310 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6311
6312 @item stepi
6313 @kindex stepi&
6314 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6315
6316 @item next
6317 @kindex next&
6318 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6319
6320 @item nexti
6321 @kindex nexti&
6322 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6323
6324 @item continue
6325 @kindex continue&
6326 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6327
6328 @item finish
6329 @kindex finish&
6330 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6331
6332 @item until
6333 @kindex until&
6334 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6335
6336 @end table
6337
6338 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6339 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6340 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6341 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6342 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6343 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6344
6345 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6346 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6347
6348 @table @code
6349 @kindex interrupt
6350 @item interrupt
6351 @itemx interrupt -a
6352
6353 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6354 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6355 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6356 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6357 @end table
6358
6359 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6360 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6361
6362 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6363 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6364 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6365
6366 @table @code
6367 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6368 @cindex thread breakpoints
6369 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6370 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6371 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6372 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6373 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6374 specify some source line.
6375
6376 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6377 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6378 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6379 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6380 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6381
6382 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6383 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6384 program.
6385
6386 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6387 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6388 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6389
6390 @smallexample
6391 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6392 @end smallexample
6393
6394 @end table
6395
6396 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6397 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6398 thread list. For example:
6399
6400 @smallexample
6401 (@value{GDBP}) c
6402 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6403 @end smallexample
6404
6405 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6406 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6407 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6408 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6409 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6410 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6411 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6412 command.
6413
6414 @node Interrupted System Calls
6415 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6416
6417 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6418 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6419 @cindex premature return from system calls
6420 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6421 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6422 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6423 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6424 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6425 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6426 stop execution.
6427
6428 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6429 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6430 style anyways.
6431
6432 For example, do not write code like this:
6433
6434 @smallexample
6435 sleep (10);
6436 @end smallexample
6437
6438 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6439 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6440
6441 Instead, write this:
6442
6443 @smallexample
6444 int unslept = 10;
6445 while (unslept > 0)
6446 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6447 @end smallexample
6448
6449 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6450 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6451 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6452 @value{GDBN}.
6453
6454 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6455 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6456 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6457 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6458
6459 @node Observer Mode
6460 @subsection Observer Mode
6461
6462 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6463 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6464 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6465 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6466 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6467
6468 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6469 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6470 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6471 mode.
6472
6473 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6474 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6475 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6476 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6477 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6478
6479 @table @code
6480
6481 @kindex observer
6482 @item set observer on
6483 @itemx set observer off
6484 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6485 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6486 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6487 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6488
6489 @item show observer
6490 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6491
6492 @kindex may-write-registers
6493 @item set may-write-registers on
6494 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6495 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6496 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6497 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6498
6499 @item show may-write-registers
6500 Show the current permission to write registers.
6501
6502 @kindex may-write-memory
6503 @item set may-write-memory on
6504 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6505 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6506 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6507 defaults to @code{on}.
6508
6509 @item show may-write-memory
6510 Show the current permission to write memory.
6511
6512 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6513 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6514 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6515 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6516 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6517 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6518
6519 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6520 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6521
6522 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6523 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6524 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6525 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6526 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6527 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6528 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6529
6530 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6531 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6532
6533 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6534 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6535 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6536 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6537 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6538 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6539 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6540
6541 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6542 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6543
6544 @kindex may-interrupt
6545 @item set may-interrupt on
6546 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6547 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6548 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6549 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6550 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6551
6552 @item show may-interrupt
6553 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6554
6555 @end table
6556
6557 @node Reverse Execution
6558 @chapter Running programs backward
6559 @cindex reverse execution
6560 @cindex running programs backward
6561
6562 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6563 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6564 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6565 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6566
6567 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6568 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6569 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6570 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6571 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6572 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6573
6574 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6575 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6576 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6577 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6578 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6579 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6580 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6581 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6582 prior values@footnote{
6583 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6584 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6585 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6586
6587 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6588 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6589 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6590 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6591 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6592 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6593 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6594 }.
6595
6596 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6597 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6598
6599 @table @code
6600 @kindex reverse-continue
6601 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6602 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6603 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6604 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6605 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6606 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6607 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6608
6609 @kindex reverse-step
6610 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6611 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6612 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6613 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6614
6615 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6616 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6617 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6618 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6619 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6620 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6621
6622 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6623 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6624
6625 @kindex reverse-stepi
6626 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6627 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6628 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6629 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6630 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6631 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6632 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6633
6634 @kindex reverse-next
6635 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6636 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6637 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6638 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6639 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6640 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6641 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6642 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6643 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6644 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6645
6646 @kindex reverse-nexti
6647 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6648 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6649 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6650 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6651 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6652 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6653 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6654 frame) is reached.
6655
6656 @kindex reverse-finish
6657 @item reverse-finish
6658 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6659 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6660 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6661 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6662
6663 @kindex set exec-direction
6664 @item set exec-direction
6665 Set the direction of target execution.
6666 @item set exec-direction reverse
6667 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6668 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6669 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6670 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6671 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6672 @item set exec-direction forward
6673 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6674 This is the default.
6675 @end table
6676
6677
6678 @node Process Record and Replay
6679 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6680 @cindex process record and replay
6681 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6682
6683 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6684 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6685 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6686
6687 @cindex replay mode
6688 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6689 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6690 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6691 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6692 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6693 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6694 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6695 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6696 execution log.
6697
6698 @cindex record mode
6699 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6700 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6701 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6702 for future replay.
6703
6704 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6705 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6706 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6707 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6708 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6709 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6710
6711 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6712 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6713 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6714 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6715
6716 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6717 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6718
6719 @table @code
6720 @kindex target record
6721 @kindex target record-full
6722 @kindex target record-btrace
6723 @kindex record
6724 @kindex record full
6725 @kindex record btrace
6726 @kindex record btrace bts
6727 @kindex record btrace pt
6728 @kindex record bts
6729 @kindex record pt
6730 @kindex rec
6731 @kindex rec full
6732 @kindex rec btrace
6733 @kindex rec btrace bts
6734 @kindex rec btrace pt
6735 @kindex rec bts
6736 @kindex rec pt
6737 @item record @var{method}
6738 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6739 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6740 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6741 recording methods are available:
6742
6743 @table @code
6744 @item full
6745 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6746 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6747 execution.
6748
6749 @item btrace @var{format}
6750 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6751 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6752 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6753 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6754 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6755 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6756 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6757
6758 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6759 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6760 formats are available:
6761
6762 @table @code
6763 @item bts
6764 @cindex branch trace store
6765 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6766 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6767 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6768
6769 @item pt
6770 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6771 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6772 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6773 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6774
6775 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6776 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6777 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6778
6779 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6780 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6781 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6782 buffer-size with care.
6783 @end table
6784
6785 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6786 @end table
6787
6788 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6789 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6790 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6791 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6792
6793 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6794 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6795 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6796 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6797 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6798
6799 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6800 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6801 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6802 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6803 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6804 does not support these two modes.
6805
6806 @kindex record stop
6807 @kindex rec s
6808 @item record stop
6809 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6810 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6811 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6812
6813 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6814 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6815 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6816 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6817 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6818
6819 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6820 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6821 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6822 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6823 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6824
6825 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6826 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6827
6828 @kindex record goto
6829 @item record goto
6830 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6831 ways to specify the location to go to:
6832
6833 @table @code
6834 @item record goto begin
6835 @itemx record goto start
6836 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6837
6838 @item record goto end
6839 Go to the end of the execution log.
6840
6841 @item record goto @var{n}
6842 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6843 @end table
6844
6845 @kindex record save
6846 @item record save @var{filename}
6847 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6848 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6849 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6850
6851 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6852
6853 @kindex record restore
6854 @item record restore @var{filename}
6855 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6856 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6857
6858 @kindex set record full
6859 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6860 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6861 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6862 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6863
6864 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6865 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6866 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6867 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6868 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6869 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6870 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6871 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6872
6873 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6874 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6875 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6876
6877 @kindex show record full
6878 @item show record full insn-number-max
6879 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6880 recording method.
6881
6882 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6883 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6884 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6885 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6886 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6887 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6888 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6889 oldest one to be deleted.
6890
6891 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6892 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6893
6894 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6895 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6896
6897 @item set record full memory-query
6898 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6899 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6900 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6901 case.
6902
6903 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6904 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6905 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6906 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6907 results.
6908
6909 @item show record full memory-query
6910 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6911
6912 @kindex set record btrace
6913 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6914 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6915 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6916 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6917 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6918 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6919 You can use the following command for that:
6920
6921 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6922 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6923 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6924 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6925 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6926 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6927 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6928 position.
6929
6930 @kindex show record btrace
6931 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6932 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6933
6934 @kindex set record btrace bts
6935 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6936 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6937 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6938 format. Default is 64KB.
6939
6940 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6941 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6942 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6943 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6944 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6945 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6946 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6947
6948 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6949 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6950
6951 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6952 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6953
6954 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6955 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6956 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6957
6958 @kindex set record btrace pt
6959 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6960 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6961 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6962 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6963
6964 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6965 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6966 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6967 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6968 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6969 actual buffer size for each thread.
6970
6971 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6972 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6973
6974 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6975 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6976
6977 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6978 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6979 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6980
6981 @kindex info record
6982 @item info record
6983 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6984 method:
6985
6986 @table @code
6987 @item full
6988 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6989 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6990
6991 @itemize @bullet
6992 @item
6993 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6994 @item
6995 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6996 @item
6997 Highest recorded instruction number.
6998 @item
6999 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7000 @item
7001 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7002 @item
7003 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7004 @end itemize
7005
7006 @item btrace
7007 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7008
7009 @itemize @bullet
7010 @item
7011 Recording format.
7012 @item
7013 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7014 @item
7015 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7016 instructions.
7017 @item
7018 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7019 @end itemize
7020
7021 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7022 @itemize @bullet
7023 @item
7024 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7025 @end itemize
7026
7027 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7028 @itemize @bullet
7029 @item
7030 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7031 @end itemize
7032 @end table
7033
7034 @kindex record delete
7035 @kindex rec del
7036 @item record delete
7037 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7038 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7039 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7040 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7041
7042 @kindex record instruction-history
7043 @kindex rec instruction-history
7044 @item record instruction-history
7045 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7046 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7047 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7048 are printed in execution order.
7049
7050 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7051 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7052 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7053
7054 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7055 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7056 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7057 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7058 @code{/p} modifier.
7059
7060 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7061 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7062 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7063
7064 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7065 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7066
7067 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7068 disassemble:
7069
7070 @table @code
7071 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7072 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7073 @var{insn}.
7074
7075 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7076 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7077 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7078 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7079 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7080 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7081
7082 @item record instruction-history
7083 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7084
7085 @item record instruction-history -
7086 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7087
7088 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7089 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7090 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7091 number @var{end} is included.
7092 @end table
7093
7094 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7095
7096 @kindex set record
7097 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7098 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7099 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7100 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7101 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7102
7103 @kindex show record
7104 @item show record instruction-history-size
7105 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7106 instruction-history} command.
7107
7108 @kindex record function-call-history
7109 @kindex rec function-call-history
7110 @item record function-call-history
7111 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7112 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7113 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7114 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7115 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7116 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7117 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7118 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7119 given together.
7120
7121 @smallexample
7122 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7123 1 void foo (void)
7124 2 @{
7125 3 @}
7126 4
7127 5 void bar (void)
7128 6 @{
7129 7 ...
7130 8 foo ();
7131 9 ...
7132 10 @}
7133 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7134 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7135 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7136 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7137 @end smallexample
7138
7139 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7140 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7141 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7142 to print:
7143
7144 @table @code
7145 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7146 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7147
7148 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7149 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7150 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7151 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7152 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7153
7154 @item record function-call-history
7155 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7156
7157 @item record function-call-history -
7158 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7159
7160 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7161 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7162 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7163 @end table
7164
7165 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7166
7167 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7168 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7169 Define how many lines to print in the
7170 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7171 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7172
7173 @item show record function-call-history-size
7174 Show how many lines to print in the
7175 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7176 @end table
7177
7178
7179 @node Stack
7180 @chapter Examining the Stack
7181
7182 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7183 stopped and how it got there.
7184
7185 @cindex call stack
7186 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7187 is generated.
7188 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7189 the arguments of the call,
7190 and the local variables of the function being called.
7191 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7192 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7193 stack}.
7194
7195 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7196 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7197
7198 @cindex selected frame
7199 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7200 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7201 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7202 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7203 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7204 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7205
7206 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7207 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7208 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7209
7210 @menu
7211 * Frames:: Stack frames
7212 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7213 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7214 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7215 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7216
7217 @end menu
7218
7219 @node Frames
7220 @section Stack Frames
7221
7222 @cindex frame, definition
7223 @cindex stack frame
7224 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7225 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7226 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7227 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7228 which the function is executing.
7229
7230 @cindex initial frame
7231 @cindex outermost frame
7232 @cindex innermost frame
7233 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7234 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7235 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7236 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7237 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7238 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7239 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7240 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7241
7242 @cindex frame pointer
7243 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7244 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7245 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7246 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7247 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7248 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7249
7250 @cindex frame number
7251 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7252 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7253 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7254 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7255 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7256
7257 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7258 @c underflow problems.
7259 @cindex frameless execution
7260 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7261 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7262 @smallexample
7263 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7264 @end smallexample
7265 generates functions without a frame.)
7266 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7267 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7268 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7269 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7270 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7271 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7272 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7273
7274 @node Backtrace
7275 @section Backtraces
7276
7277 @cindex traceback
7278 @cindex call stack traces
7279 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7280 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7281 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7282 stack.
7283
7284 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7285 @table @code
7286 @kindex backtrace
7287 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7288 @item backtrace
7289 @itemx bt
7290 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7291 frames in the stack.
7292
7293 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7294 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7295
7296 @item backtrace @var{n}
7297 @itemx bt @var{n}
7298 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7299
7300 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7301 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7302 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7303
7304 @item backtrace full
7305 @itemx bt full
7306 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7307 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7308 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7309 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7310
7311 @item backtrace no-filters
7312 @itemx bt no-filters
7313 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7314 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7315 @itemx bt no-filters full
7316 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7317 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7318 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7319 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7320 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7321 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7322 support.
7323 @end table
7324
7325 @kindex where
7326 @kindex info stack
7327 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7328 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7329
7330 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7331 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7332 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7333 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7334 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7335 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7336 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7337 multi-threaded program.
7338
7339 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7340 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7341 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7342 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7343 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7344 line number.
7345
7346 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7347 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7348
7349 @smallexample
7350 @group
7351 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7352 at builtin.c:993
7353 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7354 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7355 at macro.c:71
7356 (More stack frames follow...)
7357 @end group
7358 @end smallexample
7359
7360 @noindent
7361 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7362 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7363 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7364
7365 @noindent
7366 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7367 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7368 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7369 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7370 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7371
7372 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7373 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7374 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7375 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7376 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7377 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7378 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7379 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7380 such a backtrace might look like:
7381
7382 @smallexample
7383 @group
7384 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7385 at builtin.c:993
7386 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7387 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7388 at macro.c:71
7389 (More stack frames follow...)
7390 @end group
7391 @end smallexample
7392
7393 @noindent
7394 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7395 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7396
7397 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7398 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7399 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7400
7401 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7402 @cindex program entry point
7403 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7404 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7405 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7406 @code{main}@footnote{
7407 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7408 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7409 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7410 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7411 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7412 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7413
7414 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7415 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7416
7417 @table @code
7418 @item set backtrace past-main
7419 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7420 @kindex set backtrace
7421 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7422
7423 @item set backtrace past-main off
7424 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7425 default.
7426
7427 @item show backtrace past-main
7428 @kindex show backtrace
7429 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7430
7431 @item set backtrace past-entry
7432 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7433 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7434 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7435 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7436
7437 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7438 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7439 application. This is the default.
7440
7441 @item show backtrace past-entry
7442 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7443
7444 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7445 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7446 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7447 @cindex backtrace limit
7448 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7449 or zero means unlimited levels.
7450
7451 @item show backtrace limit
7452 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7453 @end table
7454
7455 You can control how file names are displayed.
7456
7457 @table @code
7458 @item set filename-display
7459 @itemx set filename-display relative
7460 @cindex filename-display
7461 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7462
7463 @item set filename-display basename
7464 Display only basename of a filename.
7465
7466 @item set filename-display absolute
7467 Display an absolute filename.
7468
7469 @item show filename-display
7470 Show the current way to display filenames.
7471 @end table
7472
7473 @node Selection
7474 @section Selecting a Frame
7475
7476 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7477 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7478 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7479 of the stack frame just selected.
7480
7481 @table @code
7482 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7483 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7484 @item frame @var{n}
7485 @itemx f @var{n}
7486 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7487 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7488 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7489 @code{main}.
7490
7491 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7492 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7493 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7494 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7495 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7496 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7497 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7498 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7499
7500 @kindex up
7501 @item up @var{n}
7502 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7503 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7504 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7505
7506 @kindex down
7507 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7508 @item down @var{n}
7509 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7510 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7511 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7512 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7513 @end table
7514
7515 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7516 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7517 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7518 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7519
7520 @need 1000
7521 For example:
7522
7523 @smallexample
7524 @group
7525 (@value{GDBP}) up
7526 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7527 at env.c:10
7528 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7529 @end group
7530 @end smallexample
7531
7532 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7533 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7534 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7535 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7536 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7537 for details.
7538
7539 @table @code
7540 @kindex select-frame
7541 @item select-frame
7542 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7543 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7544 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7545 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7546
7547 @kindex down-silently
7548 @kindex up-silently
7549 @item up-silently @var{n}
7550 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7551 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7552 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7553 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7554 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7555 distracting.
7556 @end table
7557
7558 @node Frame Info
7559 @section Information About a Frame
7560
7561 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7562 stack frame.
7563
7564 @table @code
7565 @item frame
7566 @itemx f
7567 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7568 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7569 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7570 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7571 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7572
7573 @kindex info frame
7574 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7575 @item info frame
7576 @itemx info f
7577 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7578 including:
7579
7580 @itemize @bullet
7581 @item
7582 the address of the frame
7583 @item
7584 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7585 @item
7586 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7587 @item
7588 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7589 @item
7590 the address of the frame's arguments
7591 @item
7592 the address of the frame's local variables
7593 @item
7594 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7595 @item
7596 which registers were saved in the frame
7597 @end itemize
7598
7599 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7600 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7601 the usual conventions.
7602
7603 @item info frame @var{addr}
7604 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7605 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7606 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7607 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7608 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7609 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7610
7611 @kindex info args
7612 @item info args
7613 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7614
7615 @item info locals
7616 @kindex info locals
7617 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7618 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7619 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7620
7621 @end table
7622
7623 @node Frame Filter Management
7624 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7625 @cindex managing frame filters
7626
7627 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7628 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7629
7630 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7631 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7632
7633 @table @code
7634 @kindex info frame-filter
7635 @item info frame-filter
7636 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7637 their name, priority and enabled status.
7638
7639 @kindex disable frame-filter
7640 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7641 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7642 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7643 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7644 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7645 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7646 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7647 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7648 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7649 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7650 may be enabled again later.
7651
7652 @kindex enable frame-filter
7653 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7654 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7655 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7656 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7657 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7658 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7659 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7660 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7661 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7662
7663 Example:
7664
7665 @smallexample
7666 (gdb) info frame-filter
7667
7668 global frame-filters:
7669 Priority Enabled Name
7670 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7671 100 Yes Reverse
7672
7673 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7674 Priority Enabled Name
7675 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7676
7677 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7678 Priority Enabled Name
7679 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7680
7681 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7682 (gdb) info frame-filter
7683
7684 global frame-filters:
7685 Priority Enabled Name
7686 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7687 100 Yes Reverse
7688
7689 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7690 Priority Enabled Name
7691 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7692
7693 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7694 Priority Enabled Name
7695 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7696
7697 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7698 (gdb) info frame-filter
7699
7700 global frame-filters:
7701 Priority Enabled Name
7702 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7703 100 Yes Reverse
7704
7705 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7706 Priority Enabled Name
7707 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7708
7709 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7710 Priority Enabled Name
7711 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7712 @end smallexample
7713
7714 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7715 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7716 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7717 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7718 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7719 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7720 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7721
7722 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7723 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7724 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7725 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7726 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7727 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7728 dictionary resides.
7729
7730 Example:
7731
7732 @smallexample
7733 (gdb) info frame-filter
7734
7735 global frame-filters:
7736 Priority Enabled Name
7737 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7738 100 Yes Reverse
7739
7740 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7741 Priority Enabled Name
7742 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7743
7744 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7745 Priority Enabled Name
7746 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7747
7748 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7749 (gdb) info frame-filter
7750
7751 global frame-filters:
7752 Priority Enabled Name
7753 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7754 50 Yes Reverse
7755
7756 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7757 Priority Enabled Name
7758 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7759
7760 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7761 Priority Enabled Name
7762 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7763 @end smallexample
7764 @end table
7765
7766 @node Source
7767 @chapter Examining Source Files
7768
7769 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7770 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7771 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7772 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7773 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7774 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7775 source files by explicit command.
7776
7777 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7778 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7779 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7780
7781 @menu
7782 * List:: Printing source lines
7783 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7784 * Edit:: Editing source files
7785 * Search:: Searching source files
7786 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7787 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7788 @end menu
7789
7790 @node List
7791 @section Printing Source Lines
7792
7793 @kindex list
7794 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7795 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7796 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7797 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7798 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7799
7800 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7801
7802 @table @code
7803 @item list @var{linenum}
7804 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7805 current source file.
7806
7807 @item list @var{function}
7808 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7809 @var{function}.
7810
7811 @item list
7812 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7813 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7814 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7815 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7816 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7817
7818 @item list -
7819 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7820 @end table
7821
7822 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7823 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7824 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7825
7826 @table @code
7827 @kindex set listsize
7828 @item set listsize @var{count}
7829 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7830 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7831 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7832 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7833
7834 @kindex show listsize
7835 @item show listsize
7836 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7837 @end table
7838
7839 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7840 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7841 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7842 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7843 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7844
7845 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7846 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7847 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7848 to specify some source line.
7849
7850 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7851
7852 @table @code
7853 @item list @var{location}
7854 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7855
7856 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7857 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7858 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7859 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7860 the same source file as the first location.
7861
7862 @item list ,@var{last}
7863 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7864
7865 @item list @var{first},
7866 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7867
7868 @item list +
7869 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7870
7871 @item list -
7872 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7873
7874 @item list
7875 As described in the preceding table.
7876 @end table
7877
7878 @node Specify Location
7879 @section Specifying a Location
7880 @cindex specifying location
7881 @cindex location
7882 @cindex source location
7883
7884 @menu
7885 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7886 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7887 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7888 @end menu
7889
7890 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7891 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7892 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7893 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7894 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7895
7896 @node Linespec Locations
7897 @subsection Linespec Locations
7898 @cindex linespec locations
7899
7900 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7901 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7902 specifying a linespec:
7903
7904 @table @code
7905 @item @var{linenum}
7906 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7907
7908 @item -@var{offset}
7909 @itemx +@var{offset}
7910 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7911 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7912 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7913 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7914 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7915 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7916 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7917 linespec.
7918
7919 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7920 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7921 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7922 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7923 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7924 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7925 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7926
7927 @item @var{function}
7928 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7929 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7930
7931 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
7932 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
7933 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
7934 means in all packages.
7935
7936 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
7937 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
7938 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
7939
7940 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
7941 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
7942 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
7943 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
7944
7945 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
7946
7947 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7948 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7949
7950 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7951 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7952 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7953 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7954 functions in different source files.
7955
7956 @item @var{label}
7957 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7958 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7959 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7960 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7961
7962 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7963 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7964 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7965 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7966 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7967 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7968
7969 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7970 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7971 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7972 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7973 each one of those probes.
7974 @end table
7975
7976 @node Explicit Locations
7977 @subsection Explicit Locations
7978 @cindex explicit locations
7979
7980 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7981 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7982
7983 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7984 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7985 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7986 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7987 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7988
7989 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7990 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7991 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7992 the symbol table to know.
7993
7994 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7995 following table:
7996
7997 @table @code
7998 @item -source @var{filename}
7999 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8000 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8001 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8002 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8003 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8004
8005 @item -function @var{function}
8006 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8007 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8008 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8009 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8010
8011 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8012 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8013 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8014 means in all packages.
8015
8016 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8017 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8018 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8019 breakpoint on both symbols.
8020
8021 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8022
8023 @item -qualified
8024
8025 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8026 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8027
8028 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8029 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8030 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8031
8032 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8033 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8034 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8035
8036 @item -label @var{label}
8037 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8038 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8039 selected stack frame.
8040
8041 @item -line @var{number}
8042 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8043 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8044 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8045 relative to the current line.
8046 @end table
8047
8048 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8049 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8050
8051 @node Address Locations
8052 @subsection Address Locations
8053 @cindex address locations
8054
8055 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8056 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8057
8058 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8059 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8060 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8061 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8062 source files.
8063
8064 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8065 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8066 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8067 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8068 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8069 of @var{address}:
8070
8071 @table @code
8072 @item @var{expression}
8073 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8074
8075 @item @var{funcaddr}
8076 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8077 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8078 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8079 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8080 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8081 (although the Pascal form also works).
8082
8083 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8084 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8085
8086 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8087 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8088 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8089 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8090 functions with identical names in different source files.
8091 @end table
8092
8093 @node Edit
8094 @section Editing Source Files
8095 @cindex editing source files
8096
8097 @kindex edit
8098 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8099 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8100 The editing program of your choice
8101 is invoked with the current line set to
8102 the active line in the program.
8103 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8104 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8105
8106 @table @code
8107 @item edit @var{location}
8108 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8109 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8110 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8111 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8112 command most commonly used:
8113
8114 @table @code
8115 @item edit @var{number}
8116 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8117
8118 @item edit @var{function}
8119 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8120 @end table
8121
8122 @end table
8123
8124 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8125 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8126 @footnote{
8127 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8128 following command-line syntax:
8129 @smallexample
8130 ex +@var{number} file
8131 @end smallexample
8132 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8133 the file where to start editing.}.
8134 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8135 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8136 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8137 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8138 @smallexample
8139 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8140 export EDITOR
8141 gdb @dots{}
8142 @end smallexample
8143 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8144 @smallexample
8145 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8146 gdb @dots{}
8147 @end smallexample
8148
8149 @node Search
8150 @section Searching Source Files
8151 @cindex searching source files
8152
8153 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8154 regular expression.
8155
8156 @table @code
8157 @kindex search
8158 @kindex forward-search
8159 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8160 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8161 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8162 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8163 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8164 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8165 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8166 @code{fo}.
8167
8168 @kindex reverse-search
8169 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8170 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8171 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8172 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8173 this command as @code{rev}.
8174 @end table
8175
8176 @node Source Path
8177 @section Specifying Source Directories
8178
8179 @cindex source path
8180 @cindex directories for source files
8181 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8182 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8183 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8184 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8185 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8186 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8187 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8188
8189 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8190 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8191 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8192 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8193 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8194 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8195 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8196 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8197 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8198 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8199 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8200
8201 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8202 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8203 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8204 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8205 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8206 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8207
8208 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8209 source files.
8210
8211 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8212 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8213 each line is in the file.
8214
8215 @kindex directory
8216 @kindex dir
8217 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8218 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8219 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8220
8221 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8222 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8223
8224 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8225 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8226 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8227 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8228 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8229 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8230 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8231 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8232 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8233 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8234 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8235 name to look up the sources.
8236
8237 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8238 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8239 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8240 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8241 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8242 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8243 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8244 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8245
8246 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8247 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8248 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8249 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8250 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8251 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8252 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8253
8254 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8255 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8256 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8257 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8258 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8259 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8260 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8261 command.
8262
8263 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8264 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8265 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8266 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8267 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8268 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8269 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8270
8271 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8272 @cindex default source path substitution
8273 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8274 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8275 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8276 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8277 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8278 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8279 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8280 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8281 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8282 together.
8283
8284 @table @code
8285 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8286 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8287 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8288 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8289 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8290 part of absolute file names) or
8291 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8292 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8293
8294 @kindex cdir
8295 @kindex cwd
8296 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8297 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8298 @cindex compilation directory
8299 @cindex current directory
8300 @cindex working directory
8301 @cindex directory, current
8302 @cindex directory, compilation
8303 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8304 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8305 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8306 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8307 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8308 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8309
8310 @item directory
8311 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8312
8313 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8314 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8315
8316 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8317 @kindex set directories
8318 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8319 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8320
8321 @item show directories
8322 @kindex show directories
8323 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8324
8325 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8326 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8327 @kindex set substitute-path
8328 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8329 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8330 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8331
8332 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8333 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8334
8335 @smallexample
8336 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8337 @end smallexample
8338
8339 @noindent
8340 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8341 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8342 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8343
8344 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8345 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8346 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8347 the substitution.
8348
8349 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8350
8351 @smallexample
8352 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8353 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8354 @end smallexample
8355
8356 @noindent
8357 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8358 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8359 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8360 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8361
8362
8363 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8364 @kindex unset substitute-path
8365 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8366 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8367 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8368
8369 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8370
8371 @item show substitute-path [path]
8372 @kindex show substitute-path
8373 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8374 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8375
8376 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8377 rules.
8378
8379 @end table
8380
8381 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8382 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8383 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8384
8385 @enumerate
8386 @item
8387 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8388
8389 @item
8390 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8391 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8392 directories in one command.
8393 @end enumerate
8394
8395 @node Machine Code
8396 @section Source and Machine Code
8397 @cindex source line and its code address
8398
8399 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8400 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8401 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8402 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8403 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8404 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8405 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8406 well as hex.
8407
8408 @table @code
8409 @kindex info line
8410 @item info line @var{location}
8411 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8412 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8413 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8414 @end table
8415
8416 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8417 the object code for the first line of function
8418 @code{m4_changequote}:
8419
8420 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8421 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8422 @smallexample
8423 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8424 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8425 @end smallexample
8426
8427 @noindent
8428 @cindex code address and its source line
8429 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8430 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8431 @smallexample
8432 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8433 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8434 @end smallexample
8435
8436 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8437 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8438 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8439 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8440 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8441 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8442 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8443 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8444 Variables}).
8445
8446 @table @code
8447 @kindex disassemble
8448 @cindex assembly instructions
8449 @cindex instructions, assembly
8450 @cindex machine instructions
8451 @cindex listing machine instructions
8452 @item disassemble
8453 @itemx disassemble /m
8454 @itemx disassemble /s
8455 @itemx disassemble /r
8456 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8457 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8458 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8459 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8460 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8461 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8462 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8463 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8464 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8465 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8466
8467 @table @code
8468 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8469 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8470 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8471 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8472 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8473 @end table
8474
8475 @noindent
8476 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8477 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8478
8479 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8480 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8481
8482 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8483 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8484 @end table
8485
8486 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8487 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8488
8489 @smallexample
8490 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8491 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8492 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8493 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8494 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8495 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8496 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8497 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8498 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8499 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8500 End of assembler dump.
8501 @end smallexample
8502
8503 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8504 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8505 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8506
8507 @smallexample
8508 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8509 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8510 5 @{
8511 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8512 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8513 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8514 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8515 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8516
8517 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8518 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8519 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8520
8521 7 return 0;
8522 8 @}
8523 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8524 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8525 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8526
8527 End of assembler dump.
8528 @end smallexample
8529
8530 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8531 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8532 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8533 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8534 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8535 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8536 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8537 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8538 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8539
8540 @file{foo.h}:
8541
8542 @smallexample
8543 int
8544 foo (int a)
8545 @{
8546 if (a < 0)
8547 return a * 2;
8548 if (a == 0)
8549 return 1;
8550 return a + 10;
8551 @}
8552 @end smallexample
8553
8554 @file{foo.c}:
8555
8556 @smallexample
8557 #include "foo.h"
8558 volatile int x, y;
8559 int
8560 main ()
8561 @{
8562 x = foo (y);
8563 return 0;
8564 @}
8565 @end smallexample
8566
8567 @smallexample
8568 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8569 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8570 5 @{
8571
8572 6 x = foo (y);
8573 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8574 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8575
8576 7 return 0;
8577 8 @}
8578 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8579 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8580 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8581 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8582
8583 End of assembler dump.
8584 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8585 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8586 foo.c:
8587 5 @{
8588 6 x = foo (y);
8589 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8590
8591 foo.h:
8592 4 if (a < 0)
8593 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8594 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8595
8596 6 if (a == 0)
8597 7 return 1;
8598 8 return a + 10;
8599 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8600 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8601 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8602 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8603
8604 foo.c:
8605 6 x = foo (y);
8606 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8607
8608 7 return 0;
8609 8 @}
8610 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8611 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8612
8613 foo.h:
8614 5 return a * 2;
8615 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8616 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8617 End of assembler dump.
8618 @end smallexample
8619
8620 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8621
8622 @smallexample
8623 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8624 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8625 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8626 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8627 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8628 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8629 End of assembler dump.
8630 @end smallexample
8631
8632 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8633 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8634 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8635 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8636
8637 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8638 mnemonics or other syntax.
8639
8640 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8641 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8642 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8643 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8644 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8645
8646 @table @code
8647 @kindex set disassembler-options
8648 @cindex disassembler options
8649 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8650 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8651 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8652 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8653 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8654 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8655 The default value is the empty string.
8656
8657 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8658 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8659 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, PowerPC
8660 and S/390.
8661
8662 @kindex show disassembler-options
8663 @item show disassembler-options
8664 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8665 @end table
8666
8667 @table @code
8668 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8669 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8670 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8671 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8672 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8673 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8674
8675 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8676 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8677 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8678 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8679
8680 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8681 @item show disassembly-flavor
8682 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8683 @end table
8684
8685 @table @code
8686 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8687 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8688 @item set disassemble-next-line
8689 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8690 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8691 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8692 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8693 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8694 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8695 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8696 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8697 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8698 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8699 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8700 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8701 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8702 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8703 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8704 instruction.
8705 @end table
8706
8707
8708 @node Data
8709 @chapter Examining Data
8710
8711 @cindex printing data
8712 @cindex examining data
8713 @kindex print
8714 @kindex inspect
8715 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8716 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8717 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8718 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8719 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8720 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8721
8722 @table @code
8723 @item print @var{expr}
8724 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8725 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8726 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8727 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8728 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8729 Formats}.
8730
8731 @item print
8732 @itemx print /@var{f}
8733 @cindex reprint the last value
8734 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8735 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8736 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8737 @end table
8738
8739 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8740 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8741 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8742
8743 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8744 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8745 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8746 Table}.
8747
8748 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8749 @kindex explore
8750 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8751 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8752 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8753 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8754 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8755 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8756 embedded in the higher level data types.
8757
8758 @table @code
8759 @item explore @var{arg}
8760 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8761 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8762 @end table
8763
8764 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8765 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8766 C program as
8767
8768 @smallexample
8769 struct SimpleStruct
8770 @{
8771 int i;
8772 double d;
8773 @};
8774
8775 struct ComplexStruct
8776 @{
8777 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8778 int arr[10];
8779 @};
8780 @end smallexample
8781
8782 @noindent
8783 followed by variable declarations as
8784
8785 @smallexample
8786 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8787 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8788 @end smallexample
8789
8790 @noindent
8791 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8792 @code{explore} command as follows.
8793
8794 @smallexample
8795 (gdb) explore cs
8796 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8797 the following fields:
8798
8799 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8800 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8801
8802 Enter the field number of choice:
8803 @end smallexample
8804
8805 @noindent
8806 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8807 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8808 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8809 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8810 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8811 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8812 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8813 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8814
8815 @smallexample
8816 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8817 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8818 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8819 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8820
8821 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8822 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8823
8824 Press enter to return to parent value:
8825 @end smallexample
8826
8827 @noindent
8828 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8829 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8830 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8831 to explore.
8832
8833 @smallexample
8834 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8835 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8836
8837 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8838
8839 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8840
8841 Press enter to return to parent value:
8842 @end smallexample
8843
8844 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8845 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8846 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8847 level data structure).
8848
8849 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8850 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8851 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8852 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8853 same example as above, your can explore the type
8854 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8855 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8856
8857 @smallexample
8858 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8859 @end smallexample
8860
8861 @noindent
8862 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8863 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8864 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8865 example.
8866
8867 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8868 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8869 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8870 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8871 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8872
8873 @table @code
8874 @item explore value @var{expr}
8875 @cindex explore value
8876 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8877 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8878 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8879 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8880 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8881
8882 @item explore type @var{arg}
8883 @cindex explore type
8884 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8885 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8886 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8887 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8888 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8889 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8890 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8891 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8892 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8893 @end table
8894
8895 @menu
8896 * Expressions:: Expressions
8897 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8898 * Variables:: Program variables
8899 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8900 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8901 * Memory:: Examining memory
8902 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8903 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8904 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8905 * Value History:: Value history
8906 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8907 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8908 * Registers:: Registers
8909 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8910 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8911 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8912 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8913 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8914 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8915 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8916 character set than GDB does
8917 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8918 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8919 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8920 @end menu
8921
8922 @node Expressions
8923 @section Expressions
8924
8925 @cindex expressions
8926 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8927 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8928 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8929 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8930 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8931 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8932 @ref{Compilation}.
8933
8934 @cindex arrays in expressions
8935 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8936 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8937 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8938 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8939 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8940 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8941
8942 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8943 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8944 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8945 languages.
8946
8947 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8948 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8949
8950 @cindex casts, in expressions
8951 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8952 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8953 at that address in memory.
8954 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8955
8956 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8957 to programming languages:
8958
8959 @table @code
8960 @item @@
8961 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8962 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8963
8964 @item ::
8965 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8966 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8967
8968 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8969 @cindex type casting memory
8970 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8971 @cindex casts, to view memory
8972 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8973 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8974 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8975 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8976 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8977 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8978 @end table
8979
8980 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8981 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8982 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8983
8984 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8985 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8986 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8987 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8988 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8989 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8990 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8991
8992 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8993 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8994 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8995 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8996 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8997 as well.
8998
8999 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9000 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9001 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9002 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9003 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9004 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9005 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9006 choices.
9007
9008 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9009 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9010 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9011
9012 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9013 @smallexample
9014 @group
9015 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9016 [0] cancel
9017 [1] all
9018 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9019 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9020 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9021 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9022 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9023 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9024 > 2 4 6
9025 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9026 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9027 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9028 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9029 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9030 breakpoints.
9031 (@value{GDBP})
9032 @end group
9033 @end smallexample
9034
9035 @table @code
9036 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9037 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9038 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9039
9040 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9041 is ambiguous.
9042
9043 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9044 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9045 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9046 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9047 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9048 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9049 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9050 in the use of the menu.
9051
9052 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9053 when an ambiguity is detected.
9054
9055 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9056 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9057
9058 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9059 @item show multiple-symbols
9060 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9061 @end table
9062
9063 @node Variables
9064 @section Program Variables
9065
9066 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9067 in your program.
9068
9069 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9070 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9071
9072 @itemize @bullet
9073 @item
9074 global (or file-static)
9075 @end itemize
9076
9077 @noindent or
9078
9079 @itemize @bullet
9080 @item
9081 visible according to the scope rules of the
9082 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9083 @end itemize
9084
9085 @noindent This means that in the function
9086
9087 @smallexample
9088 foo (a)
9089 int a;
9090 @{
9091 bar (a);
9092 @{
9093 int b = test ();
9094 bar (b);
9095 @}
9096 @}
9097 @end smallexample
9098
9099 @noindent
9100 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9101 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9102 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9103 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9104
9105 @cindex variable name conflict
9106 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9107 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9108 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9109 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9110 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9111 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9112 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9113
9114 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9115 @ifnotinfo
9116 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9117 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9118 @end ifnotinfo
9119 @smallexample
9120 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9121 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9122 @end smallexample
9123
9124 @noindent
9125 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9126 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9127 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9128 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9129
9130 @smallexample
9131 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9132 @end smallexample
9133
9134 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9135 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9136 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9137 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9138 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9139
9140 @smallexample
9141 void
9142 foo (int a)
9143 @{
9144 if (a < 10)
9145 bar (a);
9146 else
9147 process (a); /* Stop here */
9148 @}
9149
9150 int
9151 bar (int a)
9152 @{
9153 foo (a + 5);
9154 @}
9155 @end smallexample
9156
9157 @noindent
9158 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9159 here is what you might see
9160 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9161
9162 @smallexample
9163 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9164 $1 = 10
9165 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9166 $2 = 5
9167 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9168 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9169 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9170 $3 = 5
9171 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9172 $4 = 0
9173 @end smallexample
9174
9175 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9176 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9177 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9178 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9179 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9180
9181 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9182 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9183 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9184 @code{some_global}.
9185
9186 @smallexample
9187 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9188 $1 = 23
9189 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9190 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9191 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9192 $2 = 27
9193 @end smallexample
9194
9195 @cindex wrong values
9196 @cindex variable values, wrong
9197 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9198 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9199 @quotation
9200 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9201 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9202 scope, and just before exit.
9203 @end quotation
9204 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9205 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9206 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9207 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9208 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9209 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9210 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9211 variable definitions may be gone.
9212
9213 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9214 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9215 when compiling.
9216
9217 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9218 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9219 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9220 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9221 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9222 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9223 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9224
9225 @smallexample
9226 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9227 @end smallexample
9228
9229 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9230 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9231 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9232 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9233 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9234
9235 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9236 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9237 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9238 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9239
9240 @cindex no debug info variables
9241 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9242 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9243 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9244 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9245 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9246 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9247 example, in a C program:
9248
9249 @smallexample
9250 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9251 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9252 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9253 $1 = 3.14
9254 @end smallexample
9255
9256 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9257 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9258 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9259 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9260 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9261
9262 @smallexample
9263 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9264 29 i++;
9265 (gdb) next
9266 30 e (i);
9267 (gdb) print i
9268 $1 = 31
9269 (gdb) print i@@entry
9270 $2 = 30
9271 @end smallexample
9272
9273 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9274 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9275 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9276 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9277 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9278 For program code
9279
9280 @smallexample
9281 char var0[] = "A";
9282 signed char var1[] = "A";
9283 @end smallexample
9284
9285 You get during debugging
9286 @smallexample
9287 (gdb) print var0
9288 $1 = "A"
9289 (gdb) print var1
9290 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9291 @end smallexample
9292
9293 @node Arrays
9294 @section Artificial Arrays
9295
9296 @cindex artificial array
9297 @cindex arrays
9298 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9299 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9300 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9301 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9302 program.
9303
9304 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9305 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9306 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9307 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9308 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9309 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9310 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9311 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9312 example. If a program says
9313
9314 @smallexample
9315 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9316 @end smallexample
9317
9318 @noindent
9319 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9320
9321 @smallexample
9322 p *array@@len
9323 @end smallexample
9324
9325 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9326 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9327 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9328 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9329 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9330
9331 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9332 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9333 The value need not be in memory:
9334 @smallexample
9335 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9336 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9337 @end smallexample
9338
9339 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9340 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9341 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9342 @smallexample
9343 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9344 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9345 @end smallexample
9346
9347 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9348 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9349 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9350 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9351 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9352 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9353 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9354 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9355 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9356 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9357
9358 @smallexample
9359 set $i = 0
9360 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9361 @key{RET}
9362 @key{RET}
9363 @dots{}
9364 @end smallexample
9365
9366 @node Output Formats
9367 @section Output Formats
9368
9369 @cindex formatted output
9370 @cindex output formats
9371 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9372 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9373 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9374 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9375 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9376
9377 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9378 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9379 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9380 letters supported are:
9381
9382 @table @code
9383 @item x
9384 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9385 hexadecimal.
9386
9387 @item d
9388 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9389
9390 @item u
9391 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9392
9393 @item o
9394 Print as integer in octal.
9395
9396 @item t
9397 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9398 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9399 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9400 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9401
9402 @item a
9403 @cindex unknown address, locating
9404 @cindex locate address
9405 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9406 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9407 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9408
9409 @smallexample
9410 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9411 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9412 @end smallexample
9413
9414 @noindent
9415 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9416 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9417
9418 @item c
9419 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9420 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9421 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9422 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9423
9424 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9425 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9426 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9427 data.
9428
9429 @item f
9430 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9431 using typical floating point syntax.
9432
9433 @item s
9434 @cindex printing strings
9435 @cindex printing byte arrays
9436 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9437 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9438 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9439 natural types.
9440
9441 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9442 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9443 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9444 array.
9445
9446 @item z
9447 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9448 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9449 to the size of the integer type.
9450
9451 @item r
9452 @cindex raw printing
9453 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9454 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9455 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9456 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9457 pretty-printer which might exist.
9458 @end table
9459
9460 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9461
9462 @smallexample
9463 p/x $pc
9464 @end smallexample
9465
9466 @noindent
9467 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9468 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9469
9470 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9471 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9472 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9473
9474 @node Memory
9475 @section Examining Memory
9476
9477 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9478 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9479
9480 @cindex examining memory
9481 @table @code
9482 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9483 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9484 @itemx x @var{addr}
9485 @itemx x
9486 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9487 @end table
9488
9489 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9490 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9491 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9492 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9493 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9494
9495 @table @r
9496 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9497 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9498 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9499 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9500 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9501 @c 4.1.2.
9502
9503 @item @var{f}, the display format
9504 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9505 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9506 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9507 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9508 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9509
9510 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9511 The unit size is any of
9512
9513 @table @code
9514 @item b
9515 Bytes.
9516 @item h
9517 Halfwords (two bytes).
9518 @item w
9519 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9520 @item g
9521 Giant words (eight bytes).
9522 @end table
9523
9524 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9525 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9526 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9527 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9528 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9529 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9530 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9531 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9532 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9533 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9534 be altered.
9535
9536 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9537 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9538 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9539 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9540 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9541 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9542 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9543 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9544 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9545 a value from memory).
9546 @end table
9547
9548 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9549 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9550 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9551 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9552 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9553
9554 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9555 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9556 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9557
9558 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9559 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9560 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9561 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9562 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9563
9564 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9565 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9566 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9567 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9568 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9569 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9570 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9571 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9572 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9573
9574 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9575 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9576 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9577 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9578 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9579 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9580
9581 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9582 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9583 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9584 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9585 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9586 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9587 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9588
9589 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9590 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9591
9592 @smallexample
9593 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9594 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9595 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9596 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9597 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9598 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9599 @end smallexample
9600
9601 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9602 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9603 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9604 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9605 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9606 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9607 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9608 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9609 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9610
9611 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9612 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9613 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9614
9615 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9616 @cindex addressable memory unit
9617 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9618 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9619 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9620 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9621 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9622 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9623 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9624 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9625 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9626
9627 @cindex remote memory comparison
9628 @cindex target memory comparison
9629 @cindex verify remote memory image
9630 @cindex verify target memory image
9631 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9632 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9633 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9634 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9635 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9636 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9637
9638 @table @code
9639 @kindex compare-sections
9640 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9641 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9642 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9643 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9644 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9645 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9646
9647 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9648 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9649 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9650 @end table
9651
9652 @node Auto Display
9653 @section Automatic Display
9654 @cindex automatic display
9655 @cindex display of expressions
9656
9657 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9658 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9659 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9660 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9661 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9662 The automatic display looks like this:
9663
9664 @smallexample
9665 2: foo = 38
9666 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9667 @end smallexample
9668
9669 @noindent
9670 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9671 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9672 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9673 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9674 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9675 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9676
9677 @table @code
9678 @kindex display
9679 @item display @var{expr}
9680 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9681 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9682
9683 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9684
9685 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9686 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9687 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9688 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9689 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9690
9691 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9692 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9693 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9694 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9695 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9696 @end table
9697
9698 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9699 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9700 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9701
9702 @table @code
9703 @kindex delete display
9704 @kindex undisplay
9705 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9706 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9707 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9708 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9709 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9710 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9711 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9712
9713 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9714 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9715
9716 @kindex disable display
9717 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9718 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9719 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9720 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9721 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9722 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9723 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9724 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9725
9726 @kindex enable display
9727 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9728 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9729 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9730 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9731 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9732 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9733 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9734
9735 @item display
9736 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9737 done when your program stops.
9738
9739 @kindex info display
9740 @item info display
9741 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9742 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9743 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9744 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9745 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9746 @end table
9747
9748 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9749 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9750 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9751 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9752 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9753 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9754 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9755 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9756 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9757 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9758 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9759
9760 @node Print Settings
9761 @section Print Settings
9762
9763 @cindex format options
9764 @cindex print settings
9765 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9766 and symbols are printed.
9767
9768 @noindent
9769 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9770
9771 @table @code
9772 @kindex set print
9773 @item set print address
9774 @itemx set print address on
9775 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9776 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9777 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9778 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9779 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9780 @code{set print address on}:
9781
9782 @smallexample
9783 @group
9784 (@value{GDBP}) f
9785 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9786 at input.c:530
9787 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9788 @end group
9789 @end smallexample
9790
9791 @item set print address off
9792 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9793 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9794
9795 @smallexample
9796 @group
9797 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9798 (@value{GDBP}) f
9799 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9800 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9801 @end group
9802 @end smallexample
9803
9804 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9805 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9806 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9807 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9808
9809 @kindex show print
9810 @item show print address
9811 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9812 @end table
9813
9814 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9815 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9816 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9817 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9818 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9819 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9820 it prints a symbolic address:
9821
9822 @table @code
9823 @item set print symbol-filename on
9824 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9825 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9826 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9827 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9828
9829 @item set print symbol-filename off
9830 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9831 default.
9832
9833 @item show print symbol-filename
9834 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9835 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9836 @end table
9837
9838 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9839 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9840 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9841
9842 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9843 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9844
9845 @table @code
9846 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9847 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9848 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9849 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9850 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9851 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9852 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9853 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9854
9855 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9856 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9857 symbolic address.
9858 @end table
9859
9860 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9861 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9862 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9863 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9864 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9865 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9866 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9867 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9868
9869 @smallexample
9870 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9871 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9872 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9873 @end smallexample
9874
9875 @quotation
9876 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9877 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9878 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9879 @end quotation
9880
9881 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9882 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9883
9884 @table @code
9885 @item set print symbol on
9886 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9887 one exists.
9888
9889 @item set print symbol off
9890 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9891 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9892 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9893
9894 @item show print symbol
9895 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9896 address.
9897 @end table
9898
9899 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9900
9901 @table @code
9902 @item set print array
9903 @itemx set print array on
9904 @cindex pretty print arrays
9905 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9906 but uses more space. The default is off.
9907
9908 @item set print array off
9909 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9910
9911 @item show print array
9912 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9913 arrays.
9914
9915 @cindex print array indexes
9916 @item set print array-indexes
9917 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9918 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9919 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9920 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9921
9922 @item set print array-indexes off
9923 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9924
9925 @item show print array-indexes
9926 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9927 arrays.
9928
9929 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9930 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9931 @cindex number of array elements to print
9932 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9933 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9934 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9935 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9936 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9937 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9938 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9939 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9940
9941 @item show print elements
9942 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9943 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9944
9945 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9946 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9947 @cindex printing frame argument values
9948 @cindex print all frame argument values
9949 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9950 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9951 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9952 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9953 values are:
9954
9955 @table @code
9956 @item all
9957 The values of all arguments are printed.
9958
9959 @item scalars
9960 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9961 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9962 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9963 only scalar arguments are shown:
9964
9965 @smallexample
9966 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9967 at frame-args.c:23
9968 @end smallexample
9969
9970 @item none
9971 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9972 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9973
9974 @smallexample
9975 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9976 at frame-args.c:23
9977 @end smallexample
9978 @end table
9979
9980 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9981 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9982 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9983 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9984 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9985 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9986 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9987 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9988 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9989 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9990
9991 @item show print frame-arguments
9992 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9993
9994 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9995 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9996
9997 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9998 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9999 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10000 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10001 This is the default.
10002
10003 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10004 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10005
10006 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10007 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10008 @kindex set print entry-values
10009 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10010 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10011 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10012 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10013 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10014
10015 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10016 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10017 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10018 @code{no} setting.
10019
10020 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10021 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10022 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10023 this information.
10024
10025 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10026
10027 @table @code
10028 @item no
10029 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10030 point.
10031 @smallexample
10032 #0 equal (val=5)
10033 #0 different (val=6)
10034 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10035 #0 born (val=10)
10036 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10037 @end smallexample
10038
10039 @item only
10040 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10041 values are never printed.
10042 @smallexample
10043 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10044 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10045 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10046 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10047 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10048 @end smallexample
10049
10050 @item preferred
10051 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10052 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10053 value for such parameter.
10054 @smallexample
10055 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10056 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10057 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10058 #0 born (val=10)
10059 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10060 @end smallexample
10061
10062 @item if-needed
10063 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10064 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10065 parameter.
10066 @smallexample
10067 #0 equal (val=5)
10068 #0 different (val=6)
10069 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10070 #0 born (val=10)
10071 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10072 @end smallexample
10073
10074 @item both
10075 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10076 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10077 optimizations.
10078 @smallexample
10079 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10080 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10081 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10082 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10083 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10084 @end smallexample
10085
10086 @item compact
10087 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10088 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10089 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10090 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10091 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10092 @smallexample
10093 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10094 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10095 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10096 #0 born (val=10)
10097 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10098 @end smallexample
10099
10100 @item default
10101 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10102 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10103 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10104 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10105 @smallexample
10106 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10107 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10108 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10109 #0 born (val=10)
10110 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10111 @end smallexample
10112 @end table
10113
10114 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10115 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10116
10117 @item show print entry-values
10118 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10119 entry.
10120
10121 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10122 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10123 @cindex repeated array elements
10124 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10125 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10126 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10127 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10128 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10129 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10130 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10131 is 10.
10132
10133 @item show print repeats
10134 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10135 elements.
10136
10137 @item set print null-stop
10138 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10139 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10140 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10141 contain only short strings.
10142 The default is off.
10143
10144 @item show print null-stop
10145 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10146 @sc{null} character.
10147
10148 @item set print pretty on
10149 @cindex print structures in indented form
10150 @cindex indentation in structure display
10151 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10152 per line, like this:
10153
10154 @smallexample
10155 @group
10156 $1 = @{
10157 next = 0x0,
10158 flags = @{
10159 sweet = 1,
10160 sour = 1
10161 @},
10162 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10163 @}
10164 @end group
10165 @end smallexample
10166
10167 @item set print pretty off
10168 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10169
10170 @smallexample
10171 @group
10172 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10173 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10174 @end group
10175 @end smallexample
10176
10177 @noindent
10178 This is the default format.
10179
10180 @item show print pretty
10181 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10182
10183 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10184 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10185 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10186 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10187 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10188 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10189 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10190 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10191
10192 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10193 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10194 international character sets, and is the default.
10195
10196 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10197 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10198
10199 @item set print union on
10200 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10201 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10202 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10203
10204 @item set print union off
10205 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10206 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10207 instead.
10208
10209 @item show print union
10210 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10211 structures and other unions.
10212
10213 For example, given the declarations
10214
10215 @smallexample
10216 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10217 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10218 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10219 Bug_forms;
10220
10221 struct thing @{
10222 Species it;
10223 union @{
10224 Tree_forms tree;
10225 Bug_forms bug;
10226 @} form;
10227 @};
10228
10229 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10230 @end smallexample
10231
10232 @noindent
10233 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10234
10235 @smallexample
10236 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10237 @end smallexample
10238
10239 @noindent
10240 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10241
10242 @smallexample
10243 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10244 @end smallexample
10245
10246 @noindent
10247 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10248 and in Pascal.
10249 @end table
10250
10251 @need 1000
10252 @noindent
10253 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10254
10255 @table @code
10256 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10257 @item set print demangle
10258 @itemx set print demangle on
10259 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10260 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10261 linkage. The default is on.
10262
10263 @item show print demangle
10264 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10265
10266 @item set print asm-demangle
10267 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10268 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10269 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10270 The default is off.
10271
10272 @item show print asm-demangle
10273 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10274 or demangled form.
10275
10276 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10277 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10278 @kindex set demangle-style
10279 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10280 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10281 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10282
10283 @table @code
10284 @item auto
10285 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10286 This is the default.
10287
10288 @item gnu
10289 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10290
10291 @item hp
10292 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10293
10294 @item lucid
10295 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10296
10297 @item arm
10298 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10299 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10300 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10301 require further enhancement to permit that.
10302
10303 @end table
10304 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10305
10306 @item show demangle-style
10307 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10308
10309 @item set print object
10310 @itemx set print object on
10311 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10312 @cindex display derived types
10313 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10314 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10315 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10316 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10317 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10318 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10319 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10320
10321 @item set print object off
10322 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10323 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10324
10325 @item show print object
10326 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10327
10328 @item set print static-members
10329 @itemx set print static-members on
10330 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10331 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10332
10333 @item set print static-members off
10334 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10335
10336 @item show print static-members
10337 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10338
10339 @item set print pascal_static-members
10340 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10341 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10342 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10343 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10344
10345 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10346 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10347
10348 @item show print pascal_static-members
10349 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10350
10351 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10352 @item set print vtbl
10353 @itemx set print vtbl on
10354 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10355 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10356 @cindex VTBL display
10357 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10358 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10359 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10360
10361 @item set print vtbl off
10362 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10363
10364 @item show print vtbl
10365 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10366 @end table
10367
10368 @node Pretty Printing
10369 @section Pretty Printing
10370
10371 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10372 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10373 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10374
10375 @menu
10376 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10377 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10378 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10379 @end menu
10380
10381 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10382 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10383
10384 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10385 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10386 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10387
10388 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10389 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10390 pretty-printers with their names.
10391 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10392 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10393 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10394 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10395
10396 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10397 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10398 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10399 do anything special.
10400
10401 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10402
10403 @itemize @bullet
10404 @item
10405 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10406 all inferiors.
10407
10408 @item
10409 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10410 when debugging that program.
10411 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10412
10413 @item
10414 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10415 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10416 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10417 @end itemize
10418
10419 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10420 pretty-printers are selected,
10421
10422 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10423 for new types.
10424
10425 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10426 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10427
10428 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10429
10430 @smallexample
10431 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10432 $1 = @{
10433 static npos = 4294967295,
10434 _M_dataplus = @{
10435 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10436 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10437 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10438 @},
10439 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10440 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10441 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10442 @}
10443 @}
10444 @end smallexample
10445
10446 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10447
10448 @smallexample
10449 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10450 $2 = "abcd"
10451 @end smallexample
10452
10453 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10454 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10455 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10456
10457 @table @code
10458 @kindex info pretty-printer
10459 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10460 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10461 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10462
10463 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10464 whose pretty-printers to list.
10465 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10466 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10467 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10468 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10469 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10470
10471 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10472 to list.
10473
10474 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10475 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10476 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10477 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10478
10479 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10480 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10481 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10482 @end table
10483
10484 Example:
10485
10486 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10487 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10488 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10489 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10490
10491 @smallexample
10492 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10493 library1.so:
10494 foo
10495 library2.so:
10496 bar
10497 bar1
10498 bar2
10499 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10500 library2.so:
10501 bar
10502 bar1
10503 bar2
10504 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10505 1 printer disabled
10506 2 of 3 printers enabled
10507 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10508 library1.so:
10509 foo [disabled]
10510 library2.so:
10511 bar
10512 bar1
10513 bar2
10514 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10515 1 printer disabled
10516 1 of 3 printers enabled
10517 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10518 library1.so:
10519 foo [disabled]
10520 library2.so:
10521 bar
10522 bar1 [disabled]
10523 bar2
10524 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10525 1 printer disabled
10526 0 of 3 printers enabled
10527 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10528 library1.so:
10529 foo [disabled]
10530 library2.so:
10531 bar [disabled]
10532 bar1 [disabled]
10533 bar2
10534 @end smallexample
10535
10536 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10537 as can each individual subprinter.
10538
10539 @node Value History
10540 @section Value History
10541
10542 @cindex value history
10543 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10544 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10545 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10546 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10547 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10548 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10549 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10550 symbol table.
10551
10552 @cindex @code{$}
10553 @cindex @code{$$}
10554 @cindex history number
10555 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10556 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10557 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10558 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10559 history number.
10560
10561 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10562 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10563 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10564 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10565 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10566 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10567 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10568
10569 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10570 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10571
10572 @smallexample
10573 p *$
10574 @end smallexample
10575
10576 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10577 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10578
10579 @smallexample
10580 p *$.next
10581 @end smallexample
10582
10583 @noindent
10584 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10585 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10586
10587 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10588 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10589
10590 @smallexample
10591 print x
10592 set x=5
10593 @end smallexample
10594
10595 @noindent
10596 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10597 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10598
10599 @table @code
10600 @kindex show values
10601 @item show values
10602 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10603 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10604 values} does not change the history.
10605
10606 @item show values @var{n}
10607 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10608
10609 @item show values +
10610 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10611 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10612 @end table
10613
10614 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10615 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10616
10617 @node Convenience Vars
10618 @section Convenience Variables
10619
10620 @cindex convenience variables
10621 @cindex user-defined variables
10622 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10623 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10624 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10625 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10626 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10627
10628 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10629 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10630 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10631 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10632 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10633
10634 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10635 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10636 For example:
10637
10638 @smallexample
10639 set $foo = *object_ptr
10640 @end smallexample
10641
10642 @noindent
10643 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10644 @code{object_ptr}.
10645
10646 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10647 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10648 value with another assignment at any time.
10649
10650 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10651 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10652 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10653 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10654
10655 @table @code
10656 @kindex show convenience
10657 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10658 @item show convenience
10659 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10660 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10661 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10662
10663 @kindex init-if-undefined
10664 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10665 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10666 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10667 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10668 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10669 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10670 override default values used in a command script.
10671
10672 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10673 any side-effects do not occur.
10674 @end table
10675
10676 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10677 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10678 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10679
10680 @smallexample
10681 set $i = 0
10682 print bar[$i++]->contents
10683 @end smallexample
10684
10685 @noindent
10686 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10687
10688 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10689 values likely to be useful.
10690
10691 @table @code
10692 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10693 @item $_
10694 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10695 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10696 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10697 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10698 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10699 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10700 to the type of @code{$__}.
10701
10702 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10703 @item $__
10704 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10705 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10706 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10707
10708 @item $_exitcode
10709 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10710 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10711 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10712 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10713
10714 @item $_exitsignal
10715 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10716 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10717 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10718 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10719
10720 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10721 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10722 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10723 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10724 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10725
10726 @smallexample
10727 #include <signal.h>
10728
10729 int
10730 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10731 @{
10732 raise (SIGALRM);
10733 return 0;
10734 @}
10735 @end smallexample
10736
10737 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10738 or signalled would be:
10739
10740 @smallexample
10741 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10742 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10743 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10744 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10745 >echo The program has exited\n
10746 >else
10747 >echo The program has signalled\n
10748 >end
10749 >end
10750 (@value{GDBP}) run
10751 Starting program:
10752
10753 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10754 The program no longer exists.
10755 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10756 The program has signalled
10757 @end smallexample
10758
10759 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10760 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10761 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10762 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10763
10764 @smallexample
10765 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10766 The program has exited
10767 @end smallexample
10768
10769 @item $_exception
10770 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10771 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10772
10773 @item $_probe_argc
10774 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10775 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10776
10777 @item $_sdata
10778 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10779 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10780 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10781 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10782 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10783
10784 @item $_siginfo
10785 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10786 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10787 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10788 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10789 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10790
10791 @item $_tlb
10792 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10793 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10794 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10795 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10796 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10797 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10798
10799 @item $_inferior
10800 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10801 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10802
10803 @item $_thread
10804 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10805
10806 @item $_gthread
10807 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10808
10809 @end table
10810
10811 @node Convenience Funs
10812 @section Convenience Functions
10813
10814 @cindex convenience functions
10815 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10816 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10817 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10818 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10819 @value{GDBN}.
10820
10821 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10822 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10823
10824 @table @code
10825
10826 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10827 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10828 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10829 returns zero.
10830
10831 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10832 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10833 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10834 it is @code{void}:
10835
10836 @smallexample
10837 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10838 $1 = void
10839 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10840 $2 = 1
10841 (@value{GDBP}) run
10842 Starting program: ./a.out
10843 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10844 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10845 $3 = 0
10846 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10847 $4 = 0
10848 @end smallexample
10849
10850 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10851 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10852 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10853 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10854 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10855 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10856 anymore.
10857
10858 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10859 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10860
10861 @smallexample
10862 void
10863 foo (void)
10864 @{
10865 @}
10866 @end smallexample
10867
10868 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10869
10870 @smallexample
10871 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10872 $1 = void
10873 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10874 $2 = 1
10875 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10876 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10877 $3 = void
10878 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10879 $4 = 1
10880 @end smallexample
10881
10882 @end table
10883
10884 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10885 @code{Python} support.
10886
10887 @table @code
10888
10889 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10890 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10891 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10892 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10893 Otherwise it returns zero.
10894
10895 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10896 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10897 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10898 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10899 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10900 regular expression support.
10901
10902 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10903 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10904 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10905 Otherwise it returns zero.
10906
10907 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10908 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10909 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10910
10911 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10912 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10913 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10914 Otherwise it returns zero.
10915
10916 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10917 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10918 The default is 1.
10919
10920 Example:
10921
10922 @smallexample
10923 (gdb) backtrace
10924 #0 bottom_func ()
10925 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10926 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10927 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10928 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10929 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10930 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10931 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10932 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10933 $1 = 1
10934 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10935 $1 = 1
10936 @end smallexample
10937
10938 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10939 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10940 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10941 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10942
10943 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10944 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10945 The default is 1.
10946
10947 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10948 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10949 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10950 Otherwise it returns zero.
10951
10952 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10953 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10954 The default is 1.
10955
10956 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10957 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10958 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10959 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10960
10961 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10962 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10963 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10964 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10965
10966 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10967 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10968 The default is 1.
10969
10970 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10971 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10972 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10973 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10974
10975 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
10976 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10977 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10978
10979 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10980 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10981 an enumerated type:
10982
10983 @smallexample
10984 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10985 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10986 @end smallexample
10987
10988 @end table
10989
10990 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10991 convenience functions.
10992
10993 @table @code
10994 @item help function
10995 @kindex help function
10996 @cindex show all convenience functions
10997 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10998 @end table
10999
11000 @node Registers
11001 @section Registers
11002
11003 @cindex registers
11004 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11005 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11006 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11007 your machine.
11008
11009 @table @code
11010 @kindex info registers
11011 @item info registers
11012 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11013 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11014
11015 @kindex info all-registers
11016 @cindex floating point registers
11017 @item info all-registers
11018 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11019 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11020
11021 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11022 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11023 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11024 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11025 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11026 @end table
11027
11028 @anchor{standard registers}
11029 @cindex stack pointer register
11030 @cindex program counter register
11031 @cindex process status register
11032 @cindex frame pointer register
11033 @cindex standard registers
11034 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11035 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11036 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11037 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11038 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11039 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11040 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11041 you could print the program counter in hex with
11042
11043 @smallexample
11044 p/x $pc
11045 @end smallexample
11046
11047 @noindent
11048 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11049
11050 @smallexample
11051 x/i $pc
11052 @end smallexample
11053
11054 @noindent
11055 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11056 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11057 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11058 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11059 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11060 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11061 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11062
11063 @smallexample
11064 set $sp += 4
11065 @end smallexample
11066
11067 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11068 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11069 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11070 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11071 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11072 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11073 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11074
11075 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11076 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11077 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11078 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11079 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11080 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11081 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11082
11083 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11084 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11085 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11086 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11087 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11088 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11089 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11090 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11091 prints the data in both formats.
11092
11093 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11094 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11095 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11096 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11097 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11098 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11099 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11100
11101 @smallexample
11102 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11103 $1 = @{
11104 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11105 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11106 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11107 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11108 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11109 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11110 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11111 @}
11112 @end smallexample
11113
11114 @noindent
11115 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11116 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11117 value to a @code{struct} member:
11118
11119 @smallexample
11120 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11121 @end smallexample
11122
11123 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11124 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11125 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11126 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11127 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11128 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11129
11130 @cindex caller-saved registers
11131 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11132 @cindex volatile registers
11133 @cindex <not saved> values
11134 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11135 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11136 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11137 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11138 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11139 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11140 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11141 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11142 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11143 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11144 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11145 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11146 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11147 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11148 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11149 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11150 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11151 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11152 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11153 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11154 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11155 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11156 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11157
11158 @node Floating Point Hardware
11159 @section Floating Point Hardware
11160 @cindex floating point
11161
11162 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11163 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11164
11165 @table @code
11166 @kindex info float
11167 @item info float
11168 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11169 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11170 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11171 the ARM and x86 machines.
11172 @end table
11173
11174 @node Vector Unit
11175 @section Vector Unit
11176 @cindex vector unit
11177
11178 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11179 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11180
11181 @table @code
11182 @kindex info vector
11183 @item info vector
11184 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11185 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11186 @end table
11187
11188 @node OS Information
11189 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11190 @cindex OS information
11191
11192 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11193 you debug your program.
11194
11195 @cindex auxiliary vector
11196 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11197 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11198 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11199 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11200 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11201 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11202 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11203 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11204 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11205 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11206 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11207 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11208
11209 @table @code
11210 @kindex info auxv
11211 @item info auxv
11212 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11213 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11214 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11215 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11216 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11217 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11218 an unrecognized tag.
11219 @end table
11220
11221 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11222 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11223 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11224 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11225 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11226 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11227 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11228
11229 @table @code
11230 @kindex info os
11231 @item info os @var{infotype}
11232
11233 Display OS information of the requested type.
11234
11235 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11236
11237 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11238 @table @code
11239 @kindex info os cpus
11240 @item cpus
11241 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11242 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11243 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11244 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11245 kernel initialization.
11246
11247 @kindex info os files
11248 @item files
11249 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11250 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11251 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11252 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11253
11254 @kindex info os modules
11255 @item modules
11256 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11257 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11258 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11259 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11260 in memory.
11261
11262 @kindex info os msg
11263 @item msg
11264 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11265 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11266 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11267 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11268 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11269 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11270 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11271 the message queue was last changed.
11272
11273 @kindex info os processes
11274 @item processes
11275 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11276 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11277 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11278 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11279 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11280 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11281
11282 @kindex info os procgroups
11283 @item procgroups
11284 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11285 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11286 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11287 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11288 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11289 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11290 and the process group leader is listed first.
11291
11292 @kindex info os semaphores
11293 @item semaphores
11294 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11295 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11296 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11297 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11298 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11299
11300 @kindex info os shm
11301 @item shm
11302 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11303 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11304 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11305 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11306 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11307 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11308 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11309
11310 @kindex info os sockets
11311 @item sockets
11312 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11313 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11314 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11315 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11316 connection.
11317
11318 @kindex info os threads
11319 @item threads
11320 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11321 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11322 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11323 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11324 process is not listed.
11325 @end table
11326
11327 @item info os
11328 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11329 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11330 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11331 types, this command will report an error.
11332 @end table
11333
11334 @node Memory Region Attributes
11335 @section Memory Region Attributes
11336 @cindex memory region attributes
11337
11338 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11339 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11340 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11341 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11342 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11343 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11344 user can override the fetched regions.
11345
11346 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11347 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11348 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11349 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11350 all memory.
11351
11352 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11353 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11354
11355 @table @code
11356 @kindex mem
11357 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11358 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11359 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11360 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11361 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11362 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11363
11364 @item mem auto
11365 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11366 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11367
11368 @kindex delete mem
11369 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11370 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11371 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11372
11373 @kindex disable mem
11374 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11375 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11376 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11377 It may be enabled again later.
11378
11379 @kindex enable mem
11380 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11381 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11382
11383 @kindex info mem
11384 @item info mem
11385 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11386 for each region:
11387
11388 @table @emph
11389 @item Memory Region Number
11390 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11391 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11392 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11393
11394 @item Lo Address
11395 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11396
11397 @item Hi Address
11398 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11399
11400 @item Attributes
11401 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11402 @end table
11403 @end table
11404
11405
11406 @subsection Attributes
11407
11408 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11409 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11410 write accesses to a memory region.
11411
11412 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11413 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11414 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11415
11416 @table @code
11417 @item ro
11418 Memory is read only.
11419 @item wo
11420 Memory is write only.
11421 @item rw
11422 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11423 @end table
11424
11425 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11426 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11427 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11428 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11429 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11430
11431 @table @code
11432 @item 8
11433 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11434 @item 16
11435 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11436 @item 32
11437 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11438 @item 64
11439 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11440 @end table
11441
11442 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11443 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11444 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11445 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11446 @c
11447 @c @table @code
11448 @c @item hwbreak
11449 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11450 @c @item swbreak (default)
11451 @c @end table
11452
11453 @subsubsection Data Cache
11454 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11455 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11456 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11457 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11458 registers.
11459
11460 @table @code
11461 @item cache
11462 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11463 @item nocache
11464 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11465 @end table
11466
11467 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11468 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11469 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11470 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11471 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11472
11473 @table @code
11474 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11475 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11476 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11477 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11478 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11479 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11480 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11481 The default value is @code{on}.
11482 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11483 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11484 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11485 @end table
11486
11487
11488 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11489 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11490 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11491 @c
11492 @c @table @code
11493 @c @item verify
11494 @c @item noverify (default)
11495 @c @end table
11496
11497 @node Dump/Restore Files
11498 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11499 @cindex dump/restore files
11500 @cindex append data to a file
11501 @cindex dump data to a file
11502 @cindex restore data from a file
11503
11504 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11505 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11506 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11507 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11508 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11509 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11510 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11511
11512 @table @code
11513
11514 @kindex dump
11515 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11516 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11517 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11518 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11519
11520 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11521 @table @code
11522 @item binary
11523 Raw binary form.
11524 @item ihex
11525 Intel hex format.
11526 @item srec
11527 Motorola S-record format.
11528 @item tekhex
11529 Tektronix Hex format.
11530 @item verilog
11531 Verilog Hex format.
11532 @end table
11533
11534 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11535 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11536 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11537 form.
11538
11539 @kindex append
11540 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11541 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11542 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11543 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11544 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11545
11546 @kindex restore
11547 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11548 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11549 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11550 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11551 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11552
11553 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11554 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11555 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11556 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11557 from that location.
11558
11559 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11560 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11561 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11562 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11563
11564 @end table
11565
11566 @node Core File Generation
11567 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11568 @cindex dump core from inferior
11569
11570 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11571 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11572 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11573 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11574 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11575 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11576 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11577
11578 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11579 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11580 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11581
11582 @table @code
11583 @kindex gcore
11584 @kindex generate-core-file
11585 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11586 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11587 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11588 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11589 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11590 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11591
11592 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11593 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11594
11595 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11596 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11597 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
11598 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
11599 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
11600
11601 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11602 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11603 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11604 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11605 Enable or disable the use of the file
11606 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11607 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11608 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11609 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11610
11611 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11612 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11613 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11614 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11615 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11616 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11617 about the bits that can be set in the
11618 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11619 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11620
11621 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11622 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11623 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11624 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11625 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11626 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11627 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11628 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11629
11630 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
11631 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
11632 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
11633 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
11634 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
11635 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
11636 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
11637
11638 The default value is @code{off}.
11639 @end table
11640
11641 @node Character Sets
11642 @section Character Sets
11643 @cindex character sets
11644 @cindex charset
11645 @cindex translating between character sets
11646 @cindex host character set
11647 @cindex target character set
11648
11649 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11650 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11651 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11652 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11653 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11654 @dfn{target character set}.
11655
11656 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11657 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11658 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11659 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11660 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11661 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11662 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11663 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11664 character and string literals in expressions.
11665
11666 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11667 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11668 target-charset} command, described below.
11669
11670 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11671 support:
11672
11673 @table @code
11674 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11675 @kindex set target-charset
11676 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11677 list of supported target character sets, type
11678 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11679
11680 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11681 @kindex set host-charset
11682 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11683
11684 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11685 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11686 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11687 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11688 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11689
11690 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11691 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11692 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11693
11694 @item set charset @var{charset}
11695 @kindex set charset
11696 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11697 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11698 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11699 for both host and target.
11700
11701 @item show charset
11702 @kindex show charset
11703 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11704
11705 @item show host-charset
11706 @kindex show host-charset
11707 Show the name of the current host character set.
11708
11709 @item show target-charset
11710 @kindex show target-charset
11711 Show the name of the current target character set.
11712
11713 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11714 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11715 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11716 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11717 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11718 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11719
11720 @item show target-wide-charset
11721 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11722 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11723 @end table
11724
11725 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11726 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11727 @file{charset-test.c}:
11728
11729 @smallexample
11730 #include <stdio.h>
11731
11732 char ascii_hello[]
11733 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11734 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11735 char ibm1047_hello[]
11736 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11737 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11738
11739 main ()
11740 @{
11741 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11742 @}
11743 @end smallexample
11744
11745 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11746 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11747 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11748
11749 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11750
11751 @smallexample
11752 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11753 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11754 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11755 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11756 @dots{}
11757 (@value{GDBP})
11758 @end smallexample
11759
11760 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11761 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11762 strings:
11763
11764 @smallexample
11765 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11766 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11767 (@value{GDBP})
11768 @end smallexample
11769
11770 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11771 initial character set:
11772 @smallexample
11773 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11774 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11775 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11776 (@value{GDBP})
11777 @end smallexample
11778
11779 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11780 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11781 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11782 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11783 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11784
11785 @smallexample
11786 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11787 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11788 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11789 $2 = 72 'H'
11790 (@value{GDBP})
11791 @end smallexample
11792
11793 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11794 literals you use in expressions:
11795
11796 @smallexample
11797 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11798 $3 = 43 '+'
11799 (@value{GDBP})
11800 @end smallexample
11801
11802 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11803 character.
11804
11805 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11806 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11807 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11808
11809 @smallexample
11810 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11811 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11812 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11813 $5 = 200 '\310'
11814 (@value{GDBP})
11815 @end smallexample
11816
11817 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11818 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11819
11820 @smallexample
11821 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11822 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11823 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11824 @end smallexample
11825
11826 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11827 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11828 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11829 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11830 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11831
11832 @smallexample
11833 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11834 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11835 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11836 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11837 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11838 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11839 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11840 $7 = 72 '\110'
11841 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11842 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11843 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11844 $9 = 200 'H'
11845 (@value{GDBP})
11846 @end smallexample
11847
11848 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11849 string literals you use in expressions:
11850
11851 @smallexample
11852 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11853 $10 = 78 '+'
11854 (@value{GDBP})
11855 @end smallexample
11856
11857 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11858 character.
11859
11860 @node Caching Target Data
11861 @section Caching Data of Targets
11862 @cindex caching data of targets
11863
11864 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11865 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11866 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11867 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11868 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11869 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11870 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11871 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11872 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11873 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11874 is executing.
11875 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11876 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11877 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11878 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11879 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11880 in the code segment.
11881 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11882 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11883
11884 @table @code
11885 @kindex set remotecache
11886 @item set remotecache on
11887 @itemx set remotecache off
11888 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11889 with old scripts.
11890
11891 @kindex show remotecache
11892 @item show remotecache
11893 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11894
11895 @kindex set stack-cache
11896 @item set stack-cache on
11897 @itemx set stack-cache off
11898 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11899 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11900
11901 @kindex show stack-cache
11902 @item show stack-cache
11903 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11904
11905 @kindex set code-cache
11906 @item set code-cache on
11907 @itemx set code-cache off
11908 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11909 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11910 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11911
11912 @kindex show code-cache
11913 @item show code-cache
11914 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11915 accesses.
11916
11917 @kindex info dcache
11918 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11919 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11920 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11921 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11922 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11923 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11924
11925 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11926 printed in hex.
11927
11928 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11929 @cindex dcache size
11930 @kindex set dcache size
11931 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11932
11933 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11934 @cindex dcache line-size
11935 @kindex set dcache line-size
11936 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11937 Must be a power of 2.
11938
11939 @item show dcache size
11940 @kindex show dcache size
11941 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11942
11943 @item show dcache line-size
11944 @kindex show dcache line-size
11945 Show default size of dcache lines.
11946
11947 @end table
11948
11949 @node Searching Memory
11950 @section Search Memory
11951 @cindex searching memory
11952
11953 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11954 @code{find} command.
11955
11956 @table @code
11957 @kindex find
11958 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11959 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11960 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11961 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11962 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11963 @end table
11964
11965 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11966 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11967
11968 @table @r
11969 @item @var{s}, search query size
11970 The size of each search query value.
11971
11972 @table @code
11973 @item b
11974 bytes
11975 @item h
11976 halfwords (two bytes)
11977 @item w
11978 words (four bytes)
11979 @item g
11980 giant words (eight bytes)
11981 @end table
11982
11983 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11984 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11985 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11986 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
11987 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
11988
11989 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11990 value's type in the current language.
11991 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11992 pattern as a mixture of types.
11993 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11994 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11995 which is typically four bytes.
11996
11997 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11998 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11999 @end table
12000
12001 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12002 (@code{"}).
12003 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12004 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12005
12006 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12007 number of matches found.
12008
12009 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12010 @samp{$_}.
12011 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12012
12013 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12014
12015 @smallexample
12016 void
12017 hello ()
12018 @{
12019 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12020 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12021 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12022 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12023 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12024 @}
12025 @end smallexample
12026
12027 @noindent
12028 you get during debugging:
12029
12030 @smallexample
12031 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12032 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12033 1 pattern found
12034 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12035 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12036 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12037 2 patterns found.
12038 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12039 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12040 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12041 2 patterns found.
12042 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12043 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12044 1 pattern found
12045 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12046 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12047 1 pattern found
12048 (gdb) print $numfound
12049 $1 = 1
12050 (gdb) print $_
12051 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12052 @end smallexample
12053
12054 @node Value Sizes
12055 @section Value Sizes
12056
12057 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12058 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12059 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12060 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12061 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12062
12063 @table @code
12064 @kindex set max-value-size
12065 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12066 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12067 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12068 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12069 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12070
12071 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12072 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12073
12074 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12075 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12076 currently 16 bytes.
12077
12078 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12079 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12080 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12081 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12082 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12083 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12084 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12085 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12086
12087 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12088
12089 @kindex show max-value-size
12090 @item show max-value-size
12091 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12092 allocate for the contents of a value.
12093 @end table
12094
12095 @node Optimized Code
12096 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12097 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12098 @cindex debugging optimized code
12099
12100 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12101 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12102 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12103 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12104 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12105 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12106 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12107
12108 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12109 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12110 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12111 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12112
12113 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12114 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12115 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12116 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12117 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12118 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12119
12120 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12121 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12122 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12123 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12124 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12125
12126 @menu
12127 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12128 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12129 @end menu
12130
12131 @node Inline Functions
12132 @section Inline Functions
12133 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12134
12135 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12136 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12137 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12138 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12139 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12140 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12141 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12142 @code{info frame} command.
12143
12144 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12145 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12146 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12147 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12148 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12149 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12150 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12151 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12152 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12153 local variables in the caller.
12154
12155 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12156 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12157 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12158 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12159 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12160 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12161 instructions are executed.
12162
12163 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12164 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12165 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12166 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12167
12168 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12169 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12170
12171 @itemize @bullet
12172 @item
12173 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12174 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12175 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12176 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12177 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12178 or inside the inlined function instead.
12179
12180 @item
12181 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12182 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12183 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12184 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12185
12186 @end itemize
12187
12188 @node Tail Call Frames
12189 @section Tail Call Frames
12190 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12191
12192 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12193 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12194 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12195 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12196 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12197
12198 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12199 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12200 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12201 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12202 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12203 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12204 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12205
12206 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12207 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12208 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12209 this information.
12210
12211 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12212 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12213
12214 @smallexample
12215 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12216 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12217 (gdb) info frame
12218 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12219 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12220 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12221 source language c++.
12222 Arglist at unknown address.
12223 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12224 @end smallexample
12225
12226 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12227 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12228 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12229 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12230 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12231 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12232
12233 @table @code
12234 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12235 @item set debug entry-values
12236 @kindex set debug entry-values
12237 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12238 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12239 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12240 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12241 result.
12242
12243 @item show debug entry-values
12244 @kindex show debug entry-values
12245 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12246 values at function entry and tail calls.
12247 @end table
12248
12249 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12250 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12251 reference by variable @code{x}):
12252
12253 @smallexample
12254 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12255 void (*x) (void) = c;
12256 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12257 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12258 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12259
12260 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12261 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12262 a () at t.c:3
12263 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12264 (gdb) bt
12265 #0 a () at t.c:3
12266 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12267 @end smallexample
12268
12269 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12270
12271 @smallexample
12272 int i;
12273 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12274 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12275 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12276 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12277 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12278 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12279 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12280 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12281
12282 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12283 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12284 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12285 (gdb) bt
12286 #0 f () at t.c:2
12287 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12288 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12289 @end smallexample
12290
12291 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12292 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12293
12294 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12295 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12296 @set ARROW @click{}
12297 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12298 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12299 @end ifset
12300 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12301 @set ARROW ->
12302 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12303 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12304 @end ifclear
12305
12306 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12307 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12308 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12309
12310 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12311 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12312 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12313 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12314 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12315 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12316
12317 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12318 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12319 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12320 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12321 omitted.
12322
12323 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12324 entry may fail:
12325
12326 @smallexample
12327 int v;
12328 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12329 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12330 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12331 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12332 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12333 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12334
12335 (gdb) bt
12336 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12337 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12338 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12339 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12340 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12341 @end smallexample
12342
12343 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12344 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12345 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12346 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12347 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12348
12349 @node Macros
12350 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12351
12352 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12353 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12354 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12355 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12356 where it was defined.
12357
12358 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12359 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12360 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12361 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12362
12363 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12364 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12365 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12366 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12367 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12368 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12369 see @ref{List}.
12370
12371 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12372 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12373 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12374
12375 @table @code
12376
12377 @kindex macro expand
12378 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12379 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12380 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12381 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12382 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12383 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12384 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12385 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12386 it can be any string of tokens.
12387
12388 @kindex macro exp1
12389 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12390 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12391 @cindex expand macro once
12392 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12393 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12394 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12395 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12396 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12397 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12398 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12399 can be any string of tokens.
12400
12401 @kindex info macro
12402 @cindex macro definition, showing
12403 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12404 @cindex macros, from debug info
12405 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12406 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12407 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12408 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12409 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12410 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12411
12412 @kindex info macros
12413 @item info macros @var{location}
12414 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12415 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12416 command-line where those definitions were established.
12417
12418 @kindex macro define
12419 @cindex user-defined macros
12420 @cindex defining macros interactively
12421 @cindex macros, user-defined
12422 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12423 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12424 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12425 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12426 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12427 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12428 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12429 @var{arglist}.
12430
12431 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12432 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12433 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12434 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12435 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12436
12437 @kindex macro undef
12438 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12439 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12440 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12441 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12442 in the program being debugged.
12443
12444 @kindex macro list
12445 @item macro list
12446 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12447 @end table
12448
12449 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12450 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12451 show our source files:
12452
12453 @smallexample
12454 $ cat sample.c
12455 #include <stdio.h>
12456 #include "sample.h"
12457
12458 #define M 42
12459 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12460
12461 main ()
12462 @{
12463 #define N 28
12464 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12465 #undef N
12466 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12467 #define N 1729
12468 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12469 @}
12470 $ cat sample.h
12471 #define Q <
12472 $
12473 @end smallexample
12474
12475 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12476 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12477 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12478 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12479 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12480 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12481 information.
12482
12483 @smallexample
12484 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12485 $
12486 @end smallexample
12487
12488 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12489
12490 @smallexample
12491 $ gdb -nw sample
12492 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12493 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12494 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12495 (@value{GDBP})
12496 @end smallexample
12497
12498 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12499 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12500 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12501
12502 @smallexample
12503 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12504 3
12505 4 #define M 42
12506 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12507 6
12508 7 main ()
12509 8 @{
12510 9 #define N 28
12511 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12512 11 #undef N
12513 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12514 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12515 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12516 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12517 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12518 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12519 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12520 #define Q <
12521 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12522 expands to: (42 + 1)
12523 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12524 expands to: once (M + 1)
12525 (@value{GDBP})
12526 @end smallexample
12527
12528 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12529 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12530 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12531 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12532
12533 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12534 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12535
12536 @smallexample
12537 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12538 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12539 (@value{GDBP}) run
12540 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12541
12542 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12543 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12544 (@value{GDBP})
12545 @end smallexample
12546
12547 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12548
12549 @smallexample
12550 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12551 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12552 #define N 28
12553 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12554 expands to: 28 < 42
12555 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12556 $1 = 1
12557 (@value{GDBP})
12558 @end smallexample
12559
12560 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12561 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12562 thereof) in force at each point:
12563
12564 @smallexample
12565 (@value{GDBP}) next
12566 Hello, world!
12567 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12568 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12569 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12570 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12571 (@value{GDBP}) next
12572 We're so creative.
12573 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12574 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12575 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12576 #define N 1729
12577 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12578 expands to: 1729 < 42
12579 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12580 $2 = 0
12581 (@value{GDBP})
12582 @end smallexample
12583
12584 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12585 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12586 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12587 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12588
12589 @smallexample
12590 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12591 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12592 -D__STDC__=1
12593 (@value{GDBP})
12594 @end smallexample
12595
12596
12597 @node Tracepoints
12598 @chapter Tracepoints
12599 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12600 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12601
12602 @cindex tracepoints
12603 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12604 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12605 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12606 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12607 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12608 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12609 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12610
12611 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12612 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12613 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12614 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12615 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12616 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12617 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12618 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12619 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12620 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12621 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12622
12623 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12624 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12625 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12626 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12627 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12628 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12629 Packets}.
12630
12631 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12632 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12633 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12634
12635 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12636
12637 @menu
12638 * Set Tracepoints::
12639 * Analyze Collected Data::
12640 * Tracepoint Variables::
12641 * Trace Files::
12642 @end menu
12643
12644 @node Set Tracepoints
12645 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12646
12647 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12648 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12649 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12650 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12651 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12652 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12653 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12654
12655 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12656 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12657 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12658 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12659 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12660 tracepoint was hit.
12661
12662 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12663 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12664 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12665 either.
12666
12667 @cindex fast tracepoints
12668 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12669 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12670 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12671
12672 @cindex static tracepoints
12673 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12674 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12675 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12676 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12677 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12678 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12679 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12680 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12681 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12682 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12683 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12684 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12685 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12686 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12687 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12688 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12689 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12690 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12691 static tracepoint marker.
12692
12693 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12694 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12695
12696 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12697 conditions and actions.
12698
12699 @menu
12700 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12701 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12702 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12703 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12704 * Trace State Variables::
12705 * Tracepoint Actions::
12706 * Listing Tracepoints::
12707 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12708 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12709 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12710 @end menu
12711
12712 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12713 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12714
12715 @table @code
12716 @cindex set tracepoint
12717 @kindex trace
12718 @item trace @var{location}
12719 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12720 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12721 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12722 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12723 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12724 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12725 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12726 in tracing}).
12727 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12728 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12729 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12730 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12731 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12732 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12733 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12734 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12735 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12736 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12737 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12738 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12739
12740 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12741
12742 @smallexample
12743 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12744
12745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12746
12747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12748
12749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12750
12751 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12752 @end smallexample
12753
12754 @noindent
12755 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12756
12757 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12758 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12759 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12760 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12761 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12762 information on tracepoint conditions.
12763
12764 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12765 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12766 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12767 @kindex ftrace
12768 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12769 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12770 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12771 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12772 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12773 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12774 message.
12775
12776 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12777 @code{trace}.
12778
12779 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12780 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12781 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12782 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12783 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12784 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12785 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12786 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12787
12788 @example
12789 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12790 @end example
12791
12792 @noindent
12793 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12794 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12795
12796 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12797 @cindex set static tracepoint
12798 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12799 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12800 @kindex strace
12801 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12802 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12803 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12804 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12805 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12806
12807 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12808 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12809 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12810 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12811 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12812 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12813 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12814 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12815 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12816 tracing engine:
12817
12818 @smallexample
12819 main ()
12820 @{
12821 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12822 @}
12823 @end smallexample
12824
12825 @noindent
12826 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12827 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12828
12829 @smallexample
12830 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12831 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12832 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12833 Data: "str %s"
12834 [etc...]
12835 @end smallexample
12836
12837 @noindent
12838 so you may probe the marker above with:
12839
12840 @smallexample
12841 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12842 @end smallexample
12843
12844 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12845 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12846 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12847 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12848 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12849 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12850 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12851 the @samp{Data:} field.
12852
12853 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12854 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12855 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12856
12857 @vindex $tpnum
12858 @cindex last tracepoint number
12859 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12860 @cindex tracepoint number
12861 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12862 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12863
12864 @kindex delete tracepoint
12865 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12866 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12867 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12868 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12869 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12870
12871 Examples:
12872
12873 @smallexample
12874 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12875
12876 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12877 @end smallexample
12878
12879 @noindent
12880 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12881 @end table
12882
12883 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12884 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12885
12886 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12887
12888 @table @code
12889 @kindex disable tracepoint
12890 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12891 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12892 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12893 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12894 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12895 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12896 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12897 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12898 next trace experiment.
12899
12900 @kindex enable tracepoint
12901 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12902 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12903 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12904 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12905 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12906 next time a trace experiment is run.
12907 @end table
12908
12909 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12910 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12911
12912 @table @code
12913 @kindex passcount
12914 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12915 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12916 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12917 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12918 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12919 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12920 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12921 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12922 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12923 user.
12924
12925 Examples:
12926
12927 @smallexample
12928 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12929 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12930
12931 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12932 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12933 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12934 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12935 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12936 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12937 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12938 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12939 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12940 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12941 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12942 @end smallexample
12943 @end table
12944
12945 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12946 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12947 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12948 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12949
12950 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12951 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12952 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12953 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12954 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12955 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12956 is true.
12957
12958 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12959 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12960 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12961 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12962 just as with breakpoints.
12963
12964 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12965 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12966 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12967 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12968 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12969 accesses, and so forth.
12970
12971 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12972 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12973 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12974 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12975 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12976 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12977 search through.
12978
12979 @smallexample
12980 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12981 @end smallexample
12982
12983 @node Trace State Variables
12984 @subsection Trace State Variables
12985 @cindex trace state variables
12986
12987 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12988 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12989 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12990 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12991 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12992 integers.
12993
12994 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12995 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12996 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12997 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12998
12999 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13000 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13001 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13002 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13003 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13004 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13005 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13006 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13007 variable with the same name.
13008
13009 @table @code
13010
13011 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13012 @kindex tvariable
13013 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13014 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13015 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13016 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13017 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13018 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13019 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13020 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13021 value. The default initial value is 0.
13022
13023 @item info tvariables
13024 @kindex info tvariables
13025 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13026 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13027 currently running.
13028
13029 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13030 @kindex delete tvariable
13031 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13032 are specified.
13033
13034 @end table
13035
13036 @node Tracepoint Actions
13037 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13038
13039 @table @code
13040 @kindex actions
13041 @cindex tracepoint actions
13042 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13043 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13044 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13045 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13046 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13047 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13048 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13049 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13050 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13051 @code{while-stepping}.
13052
13053 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13054 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13055 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13056
13057 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13058 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13059 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13060
13061 @smallexample
13062 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13063
13064 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13065
13066 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13067 @end smallexample
13068
13069 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13070 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13071 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13072 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13073 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13074 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13075 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13076 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13077
13078 @smallexample
13079 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13080 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13081 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13082 > collect bar,baz
13083 > collect $regs
13084 > while-stepping 12
13085 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13086 > end
13087 end
13088 @end smallexample
13089
13090 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13091 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13092 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13093 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13094 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13095 special arguments are supported:
13096
13097 @table @code
13098 @item $regs
13099 Collect all registers.
13100
13101 @item $args
13102 Collect all function arguments.
13103
13104 @item $locals
13105 Collect all local variables.
13106
13107 @item $_ret
13108 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13109 of a backtrace.
13110
13111 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13112 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13113 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13114 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13115 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13116 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13117
13118 @item $_probe_argc
13119 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13120 tracepoint is located.
13121 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13122
13123 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13124 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13125 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13126 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13127
13128 @item $_sdata
13129 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13130 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13131 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13132 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13133 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13134 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13135 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13136 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13137 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13138
13139 @smallexample
13140 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13141 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13142 @end smallexample
13143
13144 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13145 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13146 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13147 @value{GDBN}.
13148 @end table
13149
13150 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13151 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13152 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13153
13154 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13155 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13156 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13157 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13158 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13159 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13160 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13161 @samp{mystr}.
13162
13163 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13164 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13165
13166 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13167 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13168 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13169 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13170 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13171 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13172 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13173 action were used.
13174
13175 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13176 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13177 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13178 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13179 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13180 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13181
13182 @smallexample
13183 > while-stepping 12
13184 > collect $regs, myglobal
13185 > end
13186 >
13187 @end smallexample
13188
13189 @noindent
13190 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13191 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13192 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13193 @code{stepping}.
13194
13195 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13196 @kindex set default-collect
13197 @cindex default collection action
13198 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13199 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13200 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13201 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13202 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13203 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13204
13205 @item show default-collect
13206 @kindex show default-collect
13207 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13208 tracepoint hit.
13209
13210 @end table
13211
13212 @node Listing Tracepoints
13213 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13214
13215 @table @code
13216 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13217 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13218 @cindex information about tracepoints
13219 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13220 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13221 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13222 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13223 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13224 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13225
13226 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13227 tracing:
13228
13229 @itemize @bullet
13230 @item
13231 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13232
13233 @item
13234 the state about installed on target of each location
13235 @end itemize
13236
13237 @smallexample
13238 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13239 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13240 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13241 while-stepping 20
13242 collect globfoo, $regs
13243 end
13244 collect globfoo2
13245 end
13246 pass count 1200
13247 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13248 collect $eip
13249 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13250 installed on target
13251 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13252 installed on target
13253 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13254 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13255 not installed on target
13256 (@value{GDBP})
13257 @end smallexample
13258
13259 @noindent
13260 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13261 @end table
13262
13263 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13264 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13265
13266 @table @code
13267 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13268 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13269 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13270 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13271 program.
13272
13273 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13274
13275 @table @emph
13276 @item Count
13277 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13278 stable identifier.
13279 @item ID
13280 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13281 @item Enabled or Disabled
13282 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13283 that are not enabled.
13284 @item Address
13285 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13286 @item What
13287 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13288 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13289 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13290 will be left blank.
13291 @end table
13292
13293 @noindent
13294 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13295
13296 @table @emph
13297 @item Data
13298 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13299 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13300 marker call.
13301 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13302 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13303 @end table
13304
13305 @smallexample
13306 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13307 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13308 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13309 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13310 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13311 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13312 Data: str %s
13313 (@value{GDBP})
13314 @end smallexample
13315 @end table
13316
13317 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13318 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13319
13320 @table @code
13321 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13322 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13323 @cindex collected data discarded
13324 @item tstart
13325 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13326 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13327 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13328 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13329 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13330 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13331 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13332 information, and so forth.
13333
13334 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13335 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13336 @item tstop
13337 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13338 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13339 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13340 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13341 needs to be stopped quickly.
13342
13343 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13344 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13345 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13346
13347 @kindex tstatus
13348 @cindex status of trace data collection
13349 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13350 @item tstatus
13351 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13352 collection.
13353 @end table
13354
13355 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13356
13357 @smallexample
13358 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13359 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13360 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13361 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13362 > while-stepping 11
13363 > collect $regs
13364 > end
13365 > end
13366 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13367 [time passes @dots{}]
13368 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13369 @end smallexample
13370
13371 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13372 @cindex disconnected tracing
13373 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13374 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13375 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13376 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13377 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13378 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13379 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13380 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13381
13382 @table @code
13383 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13384 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13385 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13386 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13387 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13388 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13389 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13390 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13391
13392 @item show disconnected-tracing
13393 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13394 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13395
13396 @end table
13397
13398 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13399 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13400 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13401 it will continue after reconnection.
13402
13403 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13404 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13405 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13406 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13407 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13408 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13409 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13410 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13411 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13412 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13413
13414 @cindex circular trace buffer
13415 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13416 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13417 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13418 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13419 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13420 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13421 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13422 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13423 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13424 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13425 the next run.
13426
13427 @table @code
13428 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13429 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13430 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13431 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13432 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13433 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13434 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13435
13436 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13437 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13438 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13439 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13440 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13441 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13442
13443 @end table
13444
13445 @table @code
13446 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13447 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13448 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13449 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13450 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13451 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13452 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13453 likes. This is also the default.
13454
13455 @item show trace-buffer-size
13456 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13457 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13458 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13459 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13460 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13461 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13462 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13463 @end table
13464
13465 @table @code
13466 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13467 @kindex set trace-user
13468
13469 @item show trace-user
13470 @kindex show trace-user
13471
13472 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13473 @kindex set trace-notes
13474 Set the trace run's notes.
13475
13476 @item show trace-notes
13477 @kindex show trace-notes
13478 Show the trace run's notes.
13479
13480 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13481 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13482 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13483 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13484 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13485
13486 @item show trace-stop-notes
13487 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13488 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13489
13490 @end table
13491
13492 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13493 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13494
13495 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13496 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13497 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13498 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13499 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13500 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13501 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13502 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13503 mentioned here.
13504
13505 @itemize @bullet
13506
13507 @item
13508 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13509 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13510 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13511 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13512 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13513 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13514 cannot be collected either.
13515
13516 @item
13517 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13518 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13519 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13520 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13521 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13522 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13523 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13524 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13525 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13526 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13527
13528 @item
13529 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13530 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13531 in a misleading way.
13532
13533 @item
13534 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13535 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13536 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13537 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13538 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13539 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13540 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13541 by @code{ptr}.
13542
13543 @item
13544 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13545 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13546 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13547 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13548 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13549 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13550 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13551 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13552 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13553 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13554 invalid address.
13555
13556 @item
13557 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13558 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13559 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13560 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13561 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13562 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13563 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13564 it to zero.
13565
13566 @end itemize
13567
13568 @node Analyze Collected Data
13569 @section Using the Collected Data
13570
13571 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13572 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13573 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13574 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13575 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13576 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13577 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13578 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13579 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13580 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13581 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13582 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13583 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13584 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13585 the buffer will fail.
13586
13587 @menu
13588 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13589 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13590 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13591 @end menu
13592
13593 @node tfind
13594 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13595
13596 @kindex tfind
13597 @cindex select trace snapshot
13598 @cindex find trace snapshot
13599 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13600 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13601 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13602 snapshot is selected.
13603
13604 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13605
13606 @table @code
13607 @item tfind start
13608 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13609 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13610
13611 @item tfind none
13612 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13613
13614 @item tfind end
13615 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13616
13617 @item tfind
13618 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13619 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13620
13621 @item tfind -
13622 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13623 retracing earlier steps.
13624
13625 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13626 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13627 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13628 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13629 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13630
13631 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13632 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13633 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13634 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13635 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13636
13637 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13638 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13639 addresses (exclusive).
13640
13641 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13642 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13643 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13644
13645 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13646 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13647 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13648 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13649 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13650 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13651 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13652 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13653 @end table
13654
13655 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13656 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13657 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13658 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13659 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13660 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13661 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13662 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13663 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13664 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13665 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13666 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13667 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13668 tracepoint as the current one.
13669
13670 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13671 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13672 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13673 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13674 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13675
13676 @smallexample
13677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13678 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13679 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13680 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13681 > tfind
13682 > end
13683
13684 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13685 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13686 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13687 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13688 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13689 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13690 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13691 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13692 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13693 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13694 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13695 @end smallexample
13696
13697 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13698 the buffer:
13699
13700 @smallexample
13701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13702 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13703 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13704 > tfind line
13705 > end
13706
13707 Frame 0, X = 1
13708 Frame 7, X = 2
13709 Frame 13, X = 255
13710 @end smallexample
13711
13712 @node tdump
13713 @subsection @code{tdump}
13714 @kindex tdump
13715 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13716 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13717
13718 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13719 the current trace snapshot.
13720
13721 @smallexample
13722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13724 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13725 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13726 > end
13727
13728 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13729
13730 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13731 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13732 at gdb_test.c:444
13733 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13734
13735 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13736 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13737 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13738 d1 0x18 24
13739 d2 0x80 128
13740 d3 0x33 51
13741 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13742 d5 0x22 34
13743 d6 0xe0 224
13744 d7 0x380035 3670069
13745 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13746 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13747 a2 0x100 256
13748 a3 0x322000 3284992
13749 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13750 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13751 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13752 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13753 ps 0x0 0
13754 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13755 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13756 fpstatus 0x0 0
13757 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13758 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13759 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13760 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13761 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13762 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13763 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13764 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13765 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13766
13767 (@value{GDBP})
13768 @end smallexample
13769
13770 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13771 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13772 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13773 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13774
13775 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13776 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13777 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13778 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13779 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13780 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13781 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13782 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13783 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13784 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13785
13786 @node save tracepoints
13787 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13788 @kindex save tracepoints
13789 @kindex save-tracepoints
13790 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13791
13792 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13793 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13794 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13795 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13796 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13797 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13798
13799 @node Tracepoint Variables
13800 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13801 @cindex tracepoint variables
13802 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13803
13804 @table @code
13805 @vindex $trace_frame
13806 @item (int) $trace_frame
13807 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13808 snapshot is selected.
13809
13810 @vindex $tracepoint
13811 @item (int) $tracepoint
13812 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13813
13814 @vindex $trace_line
13815 @item (int) $trace_line
13816 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13817
13818 @vindex $trace_file
13819 @item (char []) $trace_file
13820 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13821
13822 @vindex $trace_func
13823 @item (char []) $trace_func
13824 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13825 @end table
13826
13827 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13828 use @code{output} instead.
13829
13830 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13831 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13832 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13833 which are managed by the target.
13834
13835 @smallexample
13836 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13837
13838 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13839 > output $trace_file
13840 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13841 > tfind
13842 > end
13843 @end smallexample
13844
13845 @node Trace Files
13846 @section Using Trace Files
13847 @cindex trace files
13848
13849 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13850 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13851 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13852 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13853 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13854
13855 @table @code
13856
13857 @kindex tsave
13858 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13859 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13860 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13861 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13862 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13863 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13864 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13865 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13866 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13867 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13868 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13869 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
13870 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13871 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13872 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13873
13874 @kindex target tfile
13875 @kindex tfile
13876 @kindex target ctf
13877 @kindex ctf
13878 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13879 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13880 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13881 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13882 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13883 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13884 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13885 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13886 the host.
13887
13888 @smallexample
13889 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13890 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13891 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13892 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13893 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13894 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13895 i = 0
13896 a = 0
13897 b = 1 '\001'
13898 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13899 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13900 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13901 $1 = 1
13902 @end smallexample
13903
13904 @end table
13905
13906 @node Overlays
13907 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13908 @cindex overlays
13909
13910 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13911 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13912 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13913 use overlays.
13914
13915 @menu
13916 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13917 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13918 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13919 mapped by asking the inferior.
13920 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13921 @end menu
13922
13923 @node How Overlays Work
13924 @section How Overlays Work
13925 @cindex mapped overlays
13926 @cindex unmapped overlays
13927 @cindex load address, overlay's
13928 @cindex mapped address
13929 @cindex overlay area
13930
13931 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13932 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13933 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13934 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13935 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13936
13937 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13938 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13939 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13940 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13941 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13942 largest overlay as well.
13943
13944 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13945 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13946 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13947 there.
13948
13949 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13950 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13951 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13952
13953 @smallexample
13954 @group
13955 Data Instruction Larger
13956 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13957 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13958 | | | | | |
13959 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13960 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13961 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13962 | and heap | | | | | |
13963 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13964 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13965 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13966 | | | | | |
13967 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13968 address | | | | | |
13969 | overlay | <-' | | |
13970 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13971 | | <---. | | load address
13972 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13973 | | | |
13974 +-----------+ | |
13975 +-----------+
13976 | |
13977 +-----------+
13978
13979 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13980 @end group
13981 @end smallexample
13982
13983 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13984 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13985 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13986 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13987 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13988 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13989 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13990 program and the overlay area.
13991
13992 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13993 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13994 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13995 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13996 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13997 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13998 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13999
14000 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14001 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14002 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14003
14004 @itemize @bullet
14005
14006 @item
14007 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14008 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14009 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14010 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14011
14012 @item
14013 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14014 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14015 your program's performance.
14016
14017 @item
14018 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14019 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14020 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14021 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14022 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14023 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14024 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14025
14026 @item
14027 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14028 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14029 instruction and data spaces.
14030
14031 @end itemize
14032
14033 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14034 improved in many ways:
14035
14036 @itemize @bullet
14037
14038 @item
14039 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14040 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14041 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14042 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14043 area in the usual way.
14044
14045 @item
14046 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14047 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14048
14049 @item
14050 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14051 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14052 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14053 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14054 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14055 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14056 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14057
14058 @end itemize
14059
14060
14061 @node Overlay Commands
14062 @section Overlay Commands
14063
14064 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14065 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14066 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14067 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14068 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14069 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14070
14071 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14072 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14073
14074 @table @code
14075 @item overlay off
14076 @kindex overlay
14077 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14078 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14079 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14080 overlay support is disabled.
14081
14082 @item overlay manual
14083 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14084 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14085 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14086 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14087 commands described below.
14088
14089 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14090 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14091 @cindex map an overlay
14092 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14093 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14094 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14095 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14096 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14097 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14098
14099 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14100 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14101 @cindex unmap an overlay
14102 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14103 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14104 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14105 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14106
14107 @item overlay auto
14108 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14109 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14110 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14111 Overlay Debugging}.
14112
14113 @item overlay load-target
14114 @itemx overlay load
14115 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14116 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14117 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14118 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14119 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14120 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14121
14122 @item overlay list-overlays
14123 @itemx overlay list
14124 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14125 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14126 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14127
14128 @end table
14129
14130 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14131 of the function the address falls in:
14132
14133 @smallexample
14134 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14135 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14136 @end smallexample
14137 @noindent
14138 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14139 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14140 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14141 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14142
14143 @smallexample
14144 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14145 No sections are mapped.
14146 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14147 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14148 @end smallexample
14149 @noindent
14150 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14151 name normally:
14152
14153 @smallexample
14154 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14155 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14156 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14157 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14158 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14159 @end smallexample
14160
14161 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14162 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14163 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14164 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14165 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14166
14167 @itemize @bullet
14168 @item
14169 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14170 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14171 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14172 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14173 @item
14174 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14175 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14176 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14177 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14178 breakpoints properly.
14179 @end itemize
14180
14181
14182 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14183 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14184 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14185
14186 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14187 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14188 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14189 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14190 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14191 current state of the overlays.
14192
14193 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14194 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14195
14196 @table @asis
14197
14198 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14199 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14200
14201 @smallexample
14202 struct
14203 @{
14204 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14205 unsigned long vma;
14206
14207 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14208 unsigned long size;
14209
14210 /* The overlay's load address. */
14211 unsigned long lma;
14212
14213 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14214 zero otherwise. */
14215 unsigned long mapped;
14216 @}
14217 @end smallexample
14218
14219 @item @code{_novlys}:
14220 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14221 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14222
14223 @end table
14224
14225 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14226 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14227 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14228 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14229 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14230 currently mapped.
14231
14232 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14233 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14234 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14235 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14236 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14237 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14238 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14239 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14240 are not being executed.
14241
14242 @node Overlay Sample Program
14243 @section Overlay Sample Program
14244 @cindex overlay example program
14245
14246 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14247 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14248 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14249 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14250 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14251 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14252 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14253
14254 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14255 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14256 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14257 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14258
14259 @table @file
14260 @item overlays.c
14261 The main program file.
14262 @item ovlymgr.c
14263 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14264 @item foo.c
14265 @itemx bar.c
14266 @itemx baz.c
14267 @itemx grbx.c
14268 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14269 @item d10v.ld
14270 @itemx m32r.ld
14271 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14272 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14273 @end table
14274
14275 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14276 cross-compiler like this:
14277
14278 @smallexample
14279 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14280 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14281 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14282 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14283 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14284 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14285 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14286 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14287 @end smallexample
14288
14289 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14290 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14291 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14292
14293
14294 @node Languages
14295 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14296 @cindex languages
14297
14298 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14299 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14300 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14301 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14302 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14303 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14304
14305 @cindex working language
14306 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14307 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14308 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14309 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14310 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14311 language}.
14312
14313 @menu
14314 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14315 * Show:: Displaying the language
14316 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14317 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14318 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14319 @end menu
14320
14321 @node Setting
14322 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14323
14324 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14325 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14326 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14327 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14328 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14329 are printed, etc.
14330
14331 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14332 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14333 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14334 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14335 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14336 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14337 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14338 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14339 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14340 Displaying the Language}.
14341
14342 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14343 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14344 another language. In that case, make the
14345 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14346 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14347 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14348
14349 @menu
14350 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14351 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14352 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14353 @end menu
14354
14355 @node Filenames
14356 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14357
14358 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14359 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14360
14361 @table @file
14362 @item .ada
14363 @itemx .ads
14364 @itemx .adb
14365 @itemx .a
14366 Ada source file.
14367
14368 @item .c
14369 C source file
14370
14371 @item .C
14372 @itemx .cc
14373 @itemx .cp
14374 @itemx .cpp
14375 @itemx .cxx
14376 @itemx .c++
14377 C@t{++} source file
14378
14379 @item .d
14380 D source file
14381
14382 @item .m
14383 Objective-C source file
14384
14385 @item .f
14386 @itemx .F
14387 Fortran source file
14388
14389 @item .mod
14390 Modula-2 source file
14391
14392 @item .s
14393 @itemx .S
14394 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14395 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14396 @end table
14397
14398 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14399 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14400
14401 @node Manually
14402 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14403
14404 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14405 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14406 your program.
14407
14408 @kindex set language
14409 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14410 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14411 a language, such as
14412 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14413 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14414
14415 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14416 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14417 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14418 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14419 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14420 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14421 command such as:
14422
14423 @smallexample
14424 print a = b + c
14425 @end smallexample
14426
14427 @noindent
14428 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14429 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14430 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14431 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14432
14433 @node Automatically
14434 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14435
14436 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14437 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14438 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14439 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14440 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14441 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14442 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14443 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14444 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14445
14446 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14447 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14448 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14449 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14450 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14451
14452 @node Show
14453 @section Displaying the Language
14454
14455 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14456 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14457
14458 @table @code
14459 @item show language
14460 @anchor{show language}
14461 @kindex show language
14462 Display the current working language. This is the
14463 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14464 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14465
14466 @item info frame
14467 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14468 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14469 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14470 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14471 information listed here.
14472
14473 @item info source
14474 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14475 Display the source language of this source file.
14476 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14477 information listed here.
14478 @end table
14479
14480 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14481 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14482 with a language explicitly:
14483
14484 @table @code
14485 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14486 @kindex set extension-language
14487 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14488 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14489
14490 @item info extensions
14491 @kindex info extensions
14492 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14493 @end table
14494
14495 @node Checks
14496 @section Type and Range Checking
14497
14498 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14499 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14500 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14501 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14502 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14503 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14504 errors when your program is running.
14505
14506 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14507 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14508 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14509 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14510
14511 @menu
14512 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14513 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14514 @end menu
14515
14516 @cindex type checking
14517 @cindex checks, type
14518 @node Type Checking
14519 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14520
14521 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14522 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14523 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14524 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14525
14526 @smallexample
14527 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14528
14529 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14530 $1 = 2
14531 @exdent but
14532 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14533 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14534 @end smallexample
14535
14536 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14537 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14538
14539 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14540 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14541 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14542 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14543 expressions like the second example above.
14544
14545 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14546 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14547 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14548 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14549 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14550 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14551
14552 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14553
14554 @kindex set check type
14555 @kindex show check type
14556 @table @code
14557 @item set check type on
14558 @itemx set check type off
14559 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14560 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14561 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14562
14563 @item show check type
14564 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14565 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14566 @end table
14567
14568 @cindex range checking
14569 @cindex checks, range
14570 @node Range Checking
14571 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14572
14573 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14574 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14575 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14576 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14577 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14578
14579 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14580 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14581 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14582 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14583
14584 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14585 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14586 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14587 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14588 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14589 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14590
14591 @smallexample
14592 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14593 @end smallexample
14594
14595 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14596 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14597 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14598
14599 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14600
14601 @kindex set check range
14602 @kindex show check range
14603 @table @code
14604 @item set check range auto
14605 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14606 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14607 each language.
14608
14609 @item set check range on
14610 @itemx set check range off
14611 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14612 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14613 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14614 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14615
14616 @item set check range warn
14617 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14618 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14619 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14620 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14621 systems).
14622
14623 @item show range
14624 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14625 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14626 @end table
14627
14628 @node Supported Languages
14629 @section Supported Languages
14630
14631 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14632 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14633 @c This is false ...
14634 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14635 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14636 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14637 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14638 language.
14639
14640 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14641 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14642 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14643 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14644 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14645 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14646 language reference or tutorial.
14647
14648 @menu
14649 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14650 * D:: D
14651 * Go:: Go
14652 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14653 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14654 * Fortran:: Fortran
14655 * Pascal:: Pascal
14656 * Rust:: Rust
14657 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14658 * Ada:: Ada
14659 @end menu
14660
14661 @node C
14662 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14663
14664 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14665 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14666
14667 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14668 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14669 together.
14670
14671 @cindex C@t{++}
14672 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14673 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14674 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14675 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14676 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14677 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14678 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14679
14680 @menu
14681 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14682 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14683 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14684 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14685 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14686 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14687 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14688 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14689 @end menu
14690
14691 @node C Operators
14692 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14693
14694 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14695
14696 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14697 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14698 often defined on groups of types.
14699
14700 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14701
14702 @itemize @bullet
14703
14704 @item
14705 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14706 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14707
14708 @item
14709 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14710 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14711
14712 @item
14713 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14714
14715 @item
14716 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14717
14718 @end itemize
14719
14720 @noindent
14721 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14722 in order of increasing precedence:
14723
14724 @table @code
14725 @item ,
14726 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14727 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14728 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14729
14730 @item =
14731 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14732 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14733
14734 @item @var{op}=
14735 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14736 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14737 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14738 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14739 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14740
14741 @item ?:
14742 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14743 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14744 should be of an integral type.
14745
14746 @item ||
14747 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14748
14749 @item &&
14750 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14751
14752 @item |
14753 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14754
14755 @item ^
14756 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14757
14758 @item &
14759 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14760
14761 @item ==@r{, }!=
14762 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14763 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14764
14765 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14766 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14767 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14768 and non-zero for true.
14769
14770 @item <<@r{, }>>
14771 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14772
14773 @item @@
14774 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14775
14776 @item +@r{, }-
14777 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14778 pointer types.
14779
14780 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14781 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14782 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14783 integral types.
14784
14785 @item ++@r{, }--
14786 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14787 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14788 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14789 operation takes place.
14790
14791 @item *
14792 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14793 @code{++}.
14794
14795 @item &
14796 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14797
14798 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14799 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14800 to examine the address
14801 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14802 stored.
14803
14804 @item -
14805 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14806 precedence as @code{++}.
14807
14808 @item !
14809 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14810 @code{++}.
14811
14812 @item ~
14813 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14814 @code{++}.
14815
14816
14817 @item .@r{, }->
14818 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14819 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14820 pointer based on the stored type information.
14821 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14822
14823 @item .*@r{, }->*
14824 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14825
14826 @item []
14827 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14828 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14829
14830 @item ()
14831 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14832
14833 @item ::
14834 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14835 and @code{class} types.
14836
14837 @item ::
14838 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14839 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14840 above.
14841 @end table
14842
14843 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14844 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14845 predefined meaning.
14846
14847 @node C Constants
14848 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14849
14850 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14851
14852 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14853 following ways:
14854
14855 @itemize @bullet
14856 @item
14857 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14858 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14859 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14860 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14861 @code{long} value.
14862
14863 @item
14864 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14865 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14866 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14867 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14868 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14869 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14870 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14871 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14872 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14873 constant.
14874
14875 @item
14876 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14877 integral equivalents.
14878
14879 @item
14880 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14881 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14882 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14883 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14884 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14885 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14886 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14887 @samp{\n} for newline.
14888
14889 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14890 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14891 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14892 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14893
14894 @item
14895 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14896 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14897 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14898 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14899 characters.
14900
14901 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14902 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14903 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14904
14905 @item
14906 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14907 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14908
14909 @item
14910 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14911 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14912 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14913 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14914 @end itemize
14915
14916 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14917 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14918
14919 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14920 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14921
14922 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14923 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14924 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14925 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14926 @quotation
14927 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14928 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14929 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14930 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14931 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14932 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14933 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14934 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14935 @end quotation
14936
14937 @enumerate
14938
14939 @cindex member functions
14940 @item
14941 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14942
14943 @smallexample
14944 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14945 @end smallexample
14946
14947 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14948 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14949 @item
14950 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14951 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14952 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14953 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14954 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14955
14956 @cindex call overloaded functions
14957 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14958 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14959 @item
14960 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14961 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14962 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14963 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14964 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14965 default arguments.
14966
14967 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14968 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14969 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14970 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14971 number of function arguments.
14972
14973 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14974 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14975 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14976
14977 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14978 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14979 @smallexample
14980 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14981 @end smallexample
14982
14983 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14984 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14985
14986 @cindex reference declarations
14987 @item
14988 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
14989 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
14990 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
14991
14992 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14993 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14994 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14995 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14996 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14997
14998 @item
14999 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15000 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15001 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15002 necessary, for example in an expression like
15003 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15004 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15005 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15006
15007 @item
15008 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15009 specification.
15010 @end enumerate
15011
15012 @node C Defaults
15013 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15014
15015 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15016
15017 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15018 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15019 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15020 selects the working language.
15021
15022 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15023 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15024 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15025 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15026 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15027 for further details.
15028
15029 @node C Checks
15030 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15031
15032 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15033
15034 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15035 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15036 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15037 constants to pointers.
15038
15039 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15040 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15041 that is not itself an array.
15042
15043 @node Debugging C
15044 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15045
15046 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15047 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15048 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15049 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15050
15051 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15052 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15053 ,Expressions}.
15054
15055 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15056 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15057
15058 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15059
15060 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15061 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15062
15063 @table @code
15064 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15065 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15066 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15067 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15068 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15069 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15070
15071 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15072 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15073 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15074 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15075 classes.
15076 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15077
15078 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15079 @item catch throw
15080 @itemx catch rethrow
15081 @itemx catch catch
15082 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15083 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15084
15085 @cindex inheritance
15086 @item ptype @var{typename}
15087 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15088 @var{typename}.
15089 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15090
15091 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15092 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15093 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15094 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15095 multiple inheritance is in use.
15096
15097 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15098 @item demangle @var{name}
15099 Demangle @var{name}.
15100 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15101
15102 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15103 @item set print demangle
15104 @itemx show print demangle
15105 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15106 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15107 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15108 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15109 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15110
15111 @item set print object
15112 @itemx show print object
15113 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15114 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15115
15116 @item set print vtbl
15117 @itemx show print vtbl
15118 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15119 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15120 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15121 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15122
15123 @kindex set overload-resolution
15124 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15125 @item set overload-resolution on
15126 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15127 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15128 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15129 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15130 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15131 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15132
15133 @item set overload-resolution off
15134 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15135 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15136 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15137 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15138 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15139 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15140 argument types.
15141
15142 @kindex show overload-resolution
15143 @item show overload-resolution
15144 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15145
15146 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15147 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15148 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15149 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15150 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15151 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15152 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15153
15154 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15155
15156 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15157 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15158 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15159 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15160 for more detail.
15161
15162 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15163 function that returns a std::string:
15164
15165 @smallexample
15166 std::string function(int);
15167 @end smallexample
15168
15169 @noindent
15170 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15171 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15172
15173 @smallexample
15174 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15175 @end smallexample
15176
15177 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15178 tag. For example:
15179
15180 @smallexample
15181 (gdb) b function(int)
15182 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15183 (gdb) info breakpoints
15184 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15185 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15186 at main.cc:10
15187 @end smallexample
15188
15189 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15190 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15191 name, like:
15192
15193 @smallexample
15194 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15195 @end smallexample
15196 @end table
15197
15198 @node Decimal Floating Point
15199 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15200 @cindex decimal floating point format
15201
15202 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15203 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15204 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15205 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15206
15207 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15208 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15209 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15210 configured target.
15211
15212 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15213 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15214 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15215
15216 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15217 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15218 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15219
15220 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15221 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15222 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15223
15224 @node D
15225 @subsection D
15226
15227 @cindex D
15228 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15229 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15230 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15231
15232 @node Go
15233 @subsection Go
15234
15235 @cindex Go (programming language)
15236 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15237 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15238
15239 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15240
15241 @table @code
15242 @cindex current Go package
15243 @item The current Go package
15244 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15245 specifying global variables and functions.
15246
15247 For example, given the program:
15248
15249 @example
15250 package main
15251 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15252 func main () @{
15253 // ...
15254 @}
15255 @end example
15256
15257 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15258
15259 @example
15260 (gdb) p myglob
15261 (gdb) p main.myglob
15262 @end example
15263
15264 @cindex builtin Go types
15265 @item Builtin Go types
15266 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15267 as a string.
15268
15269 @cindex builtin Go functions
15270 @item Builtin Go functions
15271 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15272 function and handles it internally.
15273
15274 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15275 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15276 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15277 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15278 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15279 @end table
15280
15281 @node Objective-C
15282 @subsection Objective-C
15283
15284 @cindex Objective-C
15285 This section provides information about some commands and command
15286 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15287 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15288 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15289
15290 @menu
15291 * Method Names in Commands::
15292 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15293 @end menu
15294
15295 @node Method Names in Commands
15296 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15297
15298 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15299 names as line specifications:
15300
15301 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15302 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15303 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15304 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15305 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15306 @itemize
15307 @item @code{clear}
15308 @item @code{break}
15309 @item @code{info line}
15310 @item @code{jump}
15311 @item @code{list}
15312 @end itemize
15313
15314 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15315
15316 @smallexample
15317 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15318 @end smallexample
15319
15320 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15321 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15322 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15323 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15324 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15325 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15326 debugged, enter:
15327
15328 @smallexample
15329 break -[Fruit create]
15330 @end smallexample
15331
15332 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15333 enter:
15334
15335 @smallexample
15336 list +[NSText initialize]
15337 @end smallexample
15338
15339 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15340 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15341 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15342 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15343
15344 @smallexample
15345 break create
15346 @end smallexample
15347
15348 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15349 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15350 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15351 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15352 none apply.
15353
15354 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15355 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15356
15357 @smallexample
15358 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15359 @end smallexample
15360
15361 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15362 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15363 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15364 @kindex print-object
15365 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15366
15367 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15368
15369 @smallexample
15370 print -[@var{object} hash]
15371 @end smallexample
15372
15373 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15374 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15375 @noindent
15376 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15377 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15378 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15379 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15380 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15381 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15382
15383 @node OpenCL C
15384 @subsection OpenCL C
15385
15386 @cindex OpenCL C
15387 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15388
15389 @menu
15390 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15391 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15392 * OpenCL C Operators::
15393 @end menu
15394
15395 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15396 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15397
15398 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15399 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15400 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15401 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15402 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15403
15404 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15405 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15406
15407 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15408 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15409 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15410 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15411
15412 @node OpenCL C Operators
15413 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15414
15415 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15416 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15417 vector data types.
15418
15419 @node Fortran
15420 @subsection Fortran
15421 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15422
15423 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15424 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15425
15426 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15427 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15428 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15429 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15430 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15431 underscore.
15432
15433 @menu
15434 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15435 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15436 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15437 @end menu
15438
15439 @node Fortran Operators
15440 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15441
15442 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15443
15444 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15445 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15446 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15447
15448 @table @code
15449 @item **
15450 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15451 of the second one.
15452
15453 @item :
15454 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15455 represent a section of array.
15456
15457 @item %
15458 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15459 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15460 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15461 union type.
15462 @end table
15463
15464 @node Fortran Defaults
15465 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15466
15467 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15468
15469 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15470 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15471 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15472 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15473
15474 @node Special Fortran Commands
15475 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15476
15477 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15478
15479 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15480 such as displaying common blocks.
15481
15482 @table @code
15483 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15484 @kindex info common
15485 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15486 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15487 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15488 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15489 printed.
15490 @end table
15491
15492 @node Pascal
15493 @subsection Pascal
15494
15495 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15496 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15497 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15498 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15499 syntax.
15500
15501 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15502 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15503 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15504
15505 @node Rust
15506 @subsection Rust
15507
15508 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15509 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15510 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15511 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15512
15513 @itemize @bullet
15514 @item
15515 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15516 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15517 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15518
15519 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15520 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15521 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15522 @samp{B}.
15523
15524 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15525 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15526
15527 @item
15528 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15529 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15530 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15531 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15532 @samp{K::x::y}.
15533
15534 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15535 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15536 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15537 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15538 scope.
15539
15540 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15541 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15542
15543 @item
15544 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15545 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15546
15547 @item
15548 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15549
15550 @item
15551 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15552 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15553 never be destroyed.
15554
15555 @item
15556 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15557 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15558 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15559
15560 @item
15561 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15562 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15563 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15564 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15565 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15566 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15567 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15568 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15569
15570 @item
15571 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15572 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15573 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15574 @itemize @bullet
15575
15576 @item
15577 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15578
15579 @item
15580 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15581
15582 @item
15583 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15584 type names.
15585
15586 @item
15587 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15588
15589 @item
15590 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15591 available in the crate.
15592 @end itemize
15593 @end itemize
15594
15595 @node Modula-2
15596 @subsection Modula-2
15597
15598 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15599
15600 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15601 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15602 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15603 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15604 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15605 table.
15606
15607 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15608 @menu
15609 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15610 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15611 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15612 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15613 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15614 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15615 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15616 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15617 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15618 @end menu
15619
15620 @node M2 Operators
15621 @subsubsection Operators
15622 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15623
15624 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15625 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15626 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15627 following definitions hold:
15628
15629 @itemize @bullet
15630
15631 @item
15632 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15633 their subranges.
15634
15635 @item
15636 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15637
15638 @item
15639 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15640
15641 @item
15642 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15643 @var{type}}.
15644
15645 @item
15646 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15647
15648 @item
15649 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15650
15651 @item
15652 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15653 @end itemize
15654
15655 @noindent
15656 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15657 increasing precedence:
15658
15659 @table @code
15660 @item ,
15661 Function argument or array index separator.
15662
15663 @item :=
15664 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15665 @var{value}.
15666
15667 @item <@r{, }>
15668 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15669 types.
15670
15671 @item <=@r{, }>=
15672 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15673 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15674 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15675
15676 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15677 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15678 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15679 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15680 comment character.
15681
15682 @item IN
15683 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15684 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15685
15686 @item OR
15687 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15688
15689 @item AND@r{, }&
15690 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15691
15692 @item @@
15693 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15694
15695 @item +@r{, }-
15696 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15697 and difference on set types.
15698
15699 @item *
15700 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15701 on set types.
15702
15703 @item /
15704 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15705 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15706
15707 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15708 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15709 precedence as @code{*}.
15710
15711 @item -
15712 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15713
15714 @item ^
15715 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15716
15717 @item NOT
15718 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15719 @code{^}.
15720
15721 @item .
15722 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15723 precedence as @code{^}.
15724
15725 @item []
15726 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15727
15728 @item ()
15729 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15730 as @code{^}.
15731
15732 @item ::@r{, }.
15733 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15734 @end table
15735
15736 @quotation
15737 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15738 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15739 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15740 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15741 @end quotation
15742
15743
15744 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15745 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15746 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15747
15748 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15749 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15750
15751 @table @var
15752
15753 @item a
15754 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15755
15756 @item c
15757 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15758
15759 @item i
15760 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15761
15762 @item m
15763 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15764 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15765 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15766
15767 @item n
15768 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15769
15770 @item r
15771 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15772
15773 @item t
15774 represents a type.
15775
15776 @item v
15777 represents a variable.
15778
15779 @item x
15780 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15781 explanation of the function for details.
15782 @end table
15783
15784 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15785
15786 @table @code
15787 @item ABS(@var{n})
15788 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15789
15790 @item CAP(@var{c})
15791 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15792 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15793
15794 @item CHR(@var{i})
15795 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15796
15797 @item DEC(@var{v})
15798 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15799
15800 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15801 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15802 new value.
15803
15804 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15805 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15806 set.
15807
15808 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15809 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15810
15811 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15812 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15813
15814 @item INC(@var{v})
15815 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15816
15817 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15818 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15819 new value.
15820
15821 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15822 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15823 there. Returns the new set.
15824
15825 @item MAX(@var{t})
15826 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15827
15828 @item MIN(@var{t})
15829 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15830
15831 @item ODD(@var{i})
15832 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15833
15834 @item ORD(@var{x})
15835 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15836 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15837 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15838 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15839
15840 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15841 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15842 variable or a type.
15843
15844 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15845 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15846
15847 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15848 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15849 variable or a type.
15850
15851 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15852 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15853 @end table
15854
15855 @quotation
15856 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15857 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15858 an error.
15859 @end quotation
15860
15861 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15862 @node M2 Constants
15863 @subsubsection Constants
15864
15865 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15866 ways:
15867
15868 @itemize @bullet
15869
15870 @item
15871 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15872 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15873 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15874 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15875
15876 @item
15877 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15878 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15879 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15880 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15881 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15882 digits.
15883
15884 @item
15885 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15886 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15887 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15888 followed by a @samp{C}.
15889
15890 @item
15891 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15892 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15893 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15894 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15895 sequences.
15896
15897 @item
15898 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15899
15900 @item
15901 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15902 @code{FALSE}.
15903
15904 @item
15905 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15906
15907 @item
15908 Set constants are not yet supported.
15909 @end itemize
15910
15911 @node M2 Types
15912 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15913 @cindex Modula-2 types
15914
15915 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15916 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15917 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15918 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15919 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15920 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15921
15922 The first example contains the following section of code:
15923
15924 @smallexample
15925 VAR
15926 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15927 r: [20..40] ;
15928 @end smallexample
15929
15930 @noindent
15931 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15932 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15933
15934 @smallexample
15935 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15936 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15937 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15938 SET OF CHAR
15939 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15940 21
15941 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15942 [20..40]
15943 @end smallexample
15944
15945 @noindent
15946 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15947
15948 @smallexample
15949 VAR
15950 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15951 @end smallexample
15952
15953 @noindent
15954 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15955
15956 @smallexample
15957 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15958 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15959 @end smallexample
15960
15961 @noindent
15962 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15963 expressions using the debugger.
15964
15965 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15966 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15967
15968 @smallexample
15969 VAR
15970 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15971 @end smallexample
15972
15973 @smallexample
15974 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15975 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15976 @end smallexample
15977
15978 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15979 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15980 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15981 above.
15982
15983 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15984
15985 @smallexample
15986 TYPE
15987 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15988 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15989 VAR
15990 s: t ;
15991 BEGIN
15992 s := blue ;
15993 @end smallexample
15994
15995 @noindent
15996 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15997 and value of a variable.
15998
15999 @smallexample
16000 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16001 $1 = blue
16002 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16003 type = [blue..yellow]
16004 @end smallexample
16005
16006 @noindent
16007 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16008 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16009 their @code{C} counterparts.
16010
16011 @smallexample
16012 VAR
16013 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16014 BEGIN
16015 s[1] := 1 ;
16016 @end smallexample
16017
16018 @smallexample
16019 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16020 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16021 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16022 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16023 @end smallexample
16024
16025 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16026 pointer types as shown in this example:
16027
16028 @smallexample
16029 VAR
16030 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16031 BEGIN
16032 NEW(s) ;
16033 s^[1] := 1 ;
16034 @end smallexample
16035
16036 @noindent
16037 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16038
16039 @smallexample
16040 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16041 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16042 @end smallexample
16043
16044 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16045 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16046 types:
16047
16048 @smallexample
16049 TYPE
16050 foo = RECORD
16051 f1: CARDINAL ;
16052 f2: CHAR ;
16053 f3: myarray ;
16054 END ;
16055
16056 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16057 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16058 VAR
16059 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16060 @end smallexample
16061
16062 @noindent
16063 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16064 below.
16065
16066 @smallexample
16067 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16068 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16069 f1 : CARDINAL;
16070 f2 : CHAR;
16071 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16072 END
16073 @end smallexample
16074
16075 @node M2 Defaults
16076 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16077 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16078
16079 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16080 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16081 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16082 selected the working language.
16083
16084 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16085 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16086 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16087 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16088
16089 @node Deviations
16090 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16091 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16092
16093 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16094 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16095
16096 @itemize @bullet
16097 @item
16098 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16099 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16100 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16101 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16102 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16103 returned a pointer.)
16104
16105 @item
16106 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16107 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16108 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16109 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16110
16111 @item
16112 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16113 argument.
16114
16115 @item
16116 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16117 @end itemize
16118
16119 @node M2 Checks
16120 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16121 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16122
16123 @quotation
16124 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16125 range checking.
16126 @end quotation
16127 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16128
16129 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16130
16131 @itemize @bullet
16132 @item
16133 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16134 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16135
16136 @item
16137 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16138 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16139 @end itemize
16140
16141 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16142 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16143
16144 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16145 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16146
16147 @node M2 Scope
16148 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16149 @cindex scope
16150 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16151 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16152 @ifinfo
16153 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16154 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16155 @end ifinfo
16156 @ifnotinfo
16157 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16158 @end ifnotinfo
16159
16160 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16161 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16162 similar syntax:
16163
16164 @smallexample
16165
16166 @var{module} . @var{id}
16167 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16168 @end smallexample
16169
16170 @noindent
16171 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16172 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16173 identifier within your program, except another module.
16174
16175 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16176 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16177 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16178 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16179
16180 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16181 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16182 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16183 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16184 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16185 @var{module}.
16186
16187 @node GDB/M2
16188 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16189
16190 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16191 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16192 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16193 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16194 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16195 analogue in Modula-2.
16196
16197 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16198 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16199 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16200 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16201 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16202 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16203
16204 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16205 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16206 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16207
16208 @node Ada
16209 @subsection Ada
16210 @cindex Ada
16211
16212 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16213 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16214 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16215 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16216 to be difficult.
16217
16218
16219 @cindex expressions in Ada
16220 @menu
16221 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16222 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16223 in @value{GDBN}.
16224 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16225 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16226 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16227 subprograms.
16228 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16229 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16230 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16231 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16232 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16233 Profile
16234 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16235 @end menu
16236
16237 @node Ada Mode Intro
16238 @subsubsection Introduction
16239 @cindex Ada mode, general
16240
16241 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16242 syntax, with some extensions.
16243 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16244
16245 @itemize @bullet
16246 @item
16247 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16248 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16249 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16250 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16251
16252 @item
16253 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16254 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16255
16256 @item
16257 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16258 @end itemize
16259
16260 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16261 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16262 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16263 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16264 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16265
16266 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16267 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16268 was translated from an Ada source file.
16269
16270 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16271 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16272 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16273 middle (to allow based literals).
16274
16275 @node Omissions from Ada
16276 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16277 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16278
16279 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16280
16281 @itemize @bullet
16282 @item
16283 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16284
16285 @itemize @minus
16286 @item
16287 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16288 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16289
16290 @item
16291 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16292
16293 @item
16294 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16295
16296 @item
16297 @t{'Tag}.
16298
16299 @item
16300 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16301 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16302
16303 @item
16304 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16305 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16306
16307 @item
16308 @t{'Address}.
16309 @end itemize
16310
16311 @item
16312 The names in
16313 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16314 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16315 not currently available.
16316
16317 @item
16318 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16319 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16320 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16321 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16322 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16323 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16324 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16325 indeterminate values.
16326
16327 @item
16328 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16329 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16330 are not implemented.
16331
16332 @item
16333 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16334 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16335 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16336 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16337 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16338
16339 @smallexample
16340 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16341 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16342 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16343 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16344 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16345 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16346 @end smallexample
16347
16348 Changing a
16349 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16350 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16351 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16352 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16353 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16354 declared to have a type such as:
16355
16356 @smallexample
16357 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16358 Id : Integer;
16359 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16360 end record;
16361 @end smallexample
16362
16363 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16364 assignments:
16365
16366 @smallexample
16367 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16368 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16369 @end smallexample
16370
16371 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16372 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16373 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16374 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16375 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16376 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16377 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16378 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16379
16380 @item
16381 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16382
16383 @item
16384 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16385 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16386 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16387 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16388 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16389 the proper resolution.
16390
16391 @item
16392 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16393
16394 @item
16395 Entry calls are not implemented.
16396
16397 @item
16398 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16399 formats are not supported.
16400
16401 @item
16402 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16403
16404 @item
16405 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16406 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16407 context.
16408 Should your program
16409 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16410 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16411 @end itemize
16412
16413 @node Additions to Ada
16414 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16415 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16416
16417 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16418 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16419
16420 @itemize @bullet
16421 @item
16422 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16423 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16424 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16425 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16426 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16427 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16428 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16429 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16430
16431 @item
16432 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16433 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16434 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16435
16436 @item
16437 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16438 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16439
16440 @item
16441 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16442 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16443 @end itemize
16444
16445 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16446 additions specific to Ada:
16447
16448 @itemize @bullet
16449 @item
16450 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16451 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16452
16453 @smallexample
16454 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16455 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16456 @end smallexample
16457
16458 @item
16459 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16460 the value of its right-hand operand.
16461 This allows, for example,
16462 complex conditional breaks:
16463
16464 @smallexample
16465 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16466 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16467 @end smallexample
16468
16469 @item
16470 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16471 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16472 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16473 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16474 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16475 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16476 in strings. For example,
16477 @smallexample
16478 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16479 @end smallexample
16480 @noindent
16481 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16482 after each period.
16483
16484 @item
16485 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16486 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16487 to write
16488
16489 @smallexample
16490 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16491 @end smallexample
16492
16493 @item
16494 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16495 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16496 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16497 of 3 might print as
16498
16499 @smallexample
16500 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16501 @end smallexample
16502
16503 @noindent
16504 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16505 clause.
16506
16507 @item
16508 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16509 multi-character subsequence of
16510 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16511 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16512 in place of @t{a'length}.
16513
16514 @item
16515 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16516 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16517 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16518 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16519 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16520 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16521 For example,
16522 @smallexample
16523 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16524 @end smallexample
16525
16526 @item
16527 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16528 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16529 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16530 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16531 object.
16532
16533 @end itemize
16534
16535 @node Overloading support for Ada
16536 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16537 @cindex overloading, Ada
16538
16539 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16540 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16541 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16542 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16543 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16544 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16545
16546 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16547 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16548 use, for instance:
16549
16550 @smallexample
16551 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16552 Multiple matches for f
16553 [0] cancel
16554 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16555 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16556 >
16557 @end smallexample
16558
16559 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16560 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16561 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16562
16563 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16564 case:
16565
16566 @table @code
16567
16568 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16569 @item set ada print-signatures
16570 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16571 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16572 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16573
16574 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16575 @item show ada print-signatures
16576 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16577 overloads selection menu.
16578 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16579
16580 @end table
16581
16582 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16583 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16584
16585 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16586 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16587 before reaching the main procedure.
16588 As defined in the Ada Reference
16589 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16590 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16591 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16592 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16593
16594 @node Ada Exceptions
16595 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16596
16597 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16598
16599 @table @code
16600 @kindex info exceptions
16601 @item info exceptions
16602 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16603 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16604 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16605 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16606 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16607 @end table
16608
16609 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16610 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16611 argument.
16612
16613 @smallexample
16614 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16615 All defined Ada exceptions:
16616 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16617 program_error: 0x613d20
16618 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16619 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16620 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16621 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16622 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16623 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16624 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16625 @end smallexample
16626
16627 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16628 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16629
16630 @node Ada Tasks
16631 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16632 @cindex Ada, tasking
16633
16634 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16635 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16636
16637 @table @code
16638 @kindex info tasks
16639 @item info tasks
16640 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16641
16642
16643 @smallexample
16644 @iftex
16645 @leftskip=0.5cm
16646 @end iftex
16647 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16648 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16649 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16650 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16651 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16652 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16653
16654 @end smallexample
16655
16656 @noindent
16657 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16658 task currently being inspected.
16659
16660 @table @asis
16661 @item ID
16662 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16663
16664 @item TID
16665 The Ada task ID.
16666
16667 @item P-ID
16668 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16669
16670 @item Pri
16671 The base priority of the task.
16672
16673 @item State
16674 Current state of the task.
16675
16676 @table @code
16677 @item Unactivated
16678 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16679 executing.
16680
16681 @item Runnable
16682 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16683 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16684
16685 @item Terminated
16686 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16687 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16688 terminated themselves.
16689
16690 @item Child Activation Wait
16691 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16692
16693 @item Accept Statement
16694 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16695
16696 @item Waiting on entry call
16697 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16698
16699 @item Async Select Wait
16700 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16701 select statement.
16702
16703 @item Delay Sleep
16704 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16705 alternative open.
16706
16707 @item Child Termination Wait
16708 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16709 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16710 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16711
16712 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16713 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16714 finish terminating.
16715
16716 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16717 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16718 @end table
16719
16720 @item Name
16721 Name of the task in the program.
16722
16723 @end table
16724
16725 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16726 @item info task @var{taskno}
16727 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16728 the following example:
16729 @smallexample
16730 @iftex
16731 @leftskip=0.5cm
16732 @end iftex
16733 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16734 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16735 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16736 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16737 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16738 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16739 Name: task_1
16740 Thread: 0x807f378
16741 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16742 Base Priority: 15
16743 State: Runnable
16744 @end smallexample
16745
16746 @item task
16747 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16748 @cindex current Ada task ID
16749 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16750
16751 @smallexample
16752 @iftex
16753 @leftskip=0.5cm
16754 @end iftex
16755 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16756 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16757 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16758 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16759 (@value{GDBP}) task
16760 [Current task is 2]
16761 @end smallexample
16762
16763 @item task @var{taskno}
16764 @cindex Ada task switching
16765 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16766 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16767 from the current task to the given task.
16768
16769 @smallexample
16770 @iftex
16771 @leftskip=0.5cm
16772 @end iftex
16773 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16774 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16775 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16776 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16777 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16778 [Switching to task 1]
16779 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16780 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16781 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16782 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16783 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16784 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16785 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16786 @end smallexample
16787
16788 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16789 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16790 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16791 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16792 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16793 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16794 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16795 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16796 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16797
16798 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16799 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16800 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16801 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16802 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16803
16804 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16805 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16806 program.
16807
16808 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16809 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16810 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16811
16812 For example,
16813
16814 @smallexample
16815 @iftex
16816 @leftskip=0.5cm
16817 @end iftex
16818 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16819 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16820 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16821 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16822 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16823 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16824 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16825 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16826 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16827 Continuing.
16828 task # 1 running
16829 task # 2 running
16830
16831 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16832 15 flush;
16833 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16834 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16835 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16836 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16837 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16838 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16839 @end smallexample
16840 @end table
16841
16842 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16843 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16844 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16845
16846 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16847 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16848 the platform being used.
16849 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16850 switching is not supported.
16851
16852 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16853 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16854 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16855 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16856 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16857 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16858
16859 @node Ravenscar Profile
16860 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16861 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16862
16863 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16864 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16865 requirements.
16866
16867 @table @code
16868 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16869 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16870 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16871 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16872 Profile. This is the default.
16873
16874 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16875 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16876 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16877 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16878 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16879 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16880 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16881
16882 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16883 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16884 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16885 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16886
16887 @end table
16888
16889 @node Ada Glitches
16890 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16891 @cindex Ada, problems
16892
16893 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16894 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16895 @value{GDBN},
16896 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16897 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16898
16899 @itemize @bullet
16900 @item
16901 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16902 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16903
16904 @item
16905 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16906 argument lists are treated as positional).
16907
16908 @item
16909 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16910
16911 @item
16912 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16913 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16914 the host machine.
16915
16916 @item
16917 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16918 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16919 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16920 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16921 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16922 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16923 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16924 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16925 you can usually resolve the confusion
16926 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16927 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16928 @end itemize
16929
16930 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16931 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16932 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16933 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16934 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16935 enabled.
16936
16937 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16938 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16939 @table @code
16940
16941 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16942 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16943 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16944 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16945 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16946 This is the default.
16947
16948 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16949 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16950 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16951 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16952 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16953 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16954 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16955
16956 @end table
16957
16958 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16959 @cindex GNAT encoding
16960 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16961 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16962 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16963 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16964 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16965 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16966
16967 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16968 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16969 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16970 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16971 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16972 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16973 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16974 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16975
16976 @table @code
16977
16978 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16979 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16980 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16981 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16982
16983 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16984 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16985 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16986
16987 @end table
16988
16989 @node Unsupported Languages
16990 @section Unsupported Languages
16991
16992 @cindex unsupported languages
16993 @cindex minimal language
16994 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16995 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16996 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16997 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16998 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16999 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17000
17001 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17002 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17003 language.
17004
17005 @node Symbols
17006 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17007
17008 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17009 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17010 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17011 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17012 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17013 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17014 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17015
17016 @cindex symbol names
17017 @cindex names of symbols
17018 @cindex quoting names
17019 @anchor{quoting names}
17020 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17021 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17022 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17023 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17024 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17025 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17026 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17027 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17028
17029 @smallexample
17030 p 'foo.c'::x
17031 @end smallexample
17032
17033 @noindent
17034 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17035
17036 @table @code
17037 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17038 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17039 @kindex set case-sensitive
17040 @item set case-sensitive on
17041 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17042 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17043 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17044 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17045 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17046 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17047 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17048 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17049 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17050 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17051 case-insensitive matches.
17052
17053 @kindex show case-sensitive
17054 @item show case-sensitive
17055 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17056 lookups.
17057
17058 @kindex set print type methods
17059 @item set print type methods
17060 @itemx set print type methods on
17061 @itemx set print type methods off
17062 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17063 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17064 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17065 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17066 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17067 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17068
17069 @kindex show print type methods
17070 @item show print type methods
17071 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17072 classes.
17073
17074 @kindex set print type typedefs
17075 @item set print type typedefs
17076 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17077 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17078
17079 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17080 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17081 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17082 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17083 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17084 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17085 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17086 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17087 types.
17088
17089 @kindex show print type typedefs
17090 @item show print type typedefs
17091 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17092 printing classes.
17093
17094 @kindex info address
17095 @cindex address of a symbol
17096 @item info address @var{symbol}
17097 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17098 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17099 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17100 is always stored.
17101
17102 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17103 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17104 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17105
17106 @kindex info symbol
17107 @cindex symbol from address
17108 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17109 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17110 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17111 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17112 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17113
17114 @smallexample
17115 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17116 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17117 @end smallexample
17118
17119 @noindent
17120 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17121 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17122
17123 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17124 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17125
17126 @smallexample
17127 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17128 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17129 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17130 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17131 @end smallexample
17132
17133 @kindex demangle
17134 @cindex demangle
17135 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17136 Demangle @var{name}.
17137 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17138 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17139
17140 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17141 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17142
17143 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17144 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17145
17146 @kindex whatis
17147 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17148 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17149 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17150 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17151
17152 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17153 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17154 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17155
17156 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17157 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17158 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17159 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17160 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17161 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17162 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17163 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17164 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17165
17166 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17167 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17168 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17169 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17170 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17171 unroll it.
17172
17173 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17174 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17175 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17176
17177 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17178 Available flags are:
17179
17180 @table @code
17181 @item r
17182 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17183 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17184 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17185
17186 @item m
17187 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17188
17189 @item M
17190 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17191 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17192
17193 @item t
17194 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17195 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17196 names are substituted when printing other types.
17197
17198 @item T
17199 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17200 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17201 @end table
17202
17203 @kindex ptype
17204 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17205 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17206 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17207 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17208
17209 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17210 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17211 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17212 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17213 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17214 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17215 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17216 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17217
17218 For example, for this variable declaration:
17219
17220 @smallexample
17221 typedef double real_t;
17222 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17223 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17224 complex_t var;
17225 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17226 @end smallexample
17227
17228 @noindent
17229 the two commands give this output:
17230
17231 @smallexample
17232 @group
17233 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17234 type = complex_t
17235 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17236 type = struct complex @{
17237 real_t real;
17238 double imag;
17239 @}
17240 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17241 type = struct complex
17242 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17243 type = struct complex
17244 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17245 type = struct complex @{
17246 real_t real;
17247 double imag;
17248 @}
17249 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17250 type = real_t *
17251 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17252 type = double *
17253 @end group
17254 @end smallexample
17255
17256 @noindent
17257 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17258 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17259
17260 @cindex incomplete type
17261 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17262 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17263 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17264 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17265 given these declarations:
17266
17267 @smallexample
17268 struct foo;
17269 struct foo *fooptr;
17270 @end smallexample
17271
17272 @noindent
17273 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17274
17275 @smallexample
17276 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17277 $1 = <incomplete type>
17278 @end smallexample
17279
17280 @noindent
17281 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17282 completely specified.
17283
17284 @cindex unknown type
17285 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17286 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17287 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17288 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17289 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17290 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17291 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17292 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17293
17294 @smallexample
17295 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17296 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17297 @end smallexample
17298
17299 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17300 of such variables.
17301
17302 @kindex info types
17303 @item info types @var{regexp}
17304 @itemx info types
17305 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17306 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17307 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17308 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17309 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17310 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17311 name is @code{value}.
17312
17313 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17314 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17315 lists all source files where a type is defined.
17316
17317 @kindex info type-printers
17318 @item info type-printers
17319 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17320 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17321 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17322 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17323 type printers.
17324
17325 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17326
17327 @kindex enable type-printer
17328 @kindex disable type-printer
17329 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17330 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17331 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17332
17333 @kindex info scope
17334 @cindex local variables
17335 @item info scope @var{location}
17336 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17337 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17338 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17339 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17340 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17341
17342 @smallexample
17343 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17344 Scope for command_line_handler:
17345 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17346 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17347 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17348 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17349 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17350 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17351 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17352 @end smallexample
17353
17354 @noindent
17355 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17356 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17357 collect}.
17358
17359 @kindex info source
17360 @item info source
17361 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17362 the function containing the current point of execution:
17363 @itemize @bullet
17364 @item
17365 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17366 @item
17367 the directory it was compiled in,
17368 @item
17369 its length, in lines,
17370 @item
17371 which programming language it is written in,
17372 @item
17373 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17374 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17375 @item
17376 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17377 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17378 @item
17379 whether the debugging information includes information about
17380 preprocessor macros.
17381 @end itemize
17382
17383
17384 @kindex info sources
17385 @item info sources
17386 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17387 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17388 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17389
17390 @kindex info functions
17391 @item info functions
17392 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17393
17394 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17395 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17396 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17397 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17398 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17399 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17400 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17401 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17402
17403 @kindex info variables
17404 @item info variables
17405 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17406 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17407
17408 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17409 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17410 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17411 @var{regexp}.
17412
17413 @kindex info classes
17414 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17415 @item info classes
17416 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17417 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17418 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17419 expression.
17420
17421 @kindex info selectors
17422 @item info selectors
17423 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17424 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17425 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17426 expression.
17427
17428 @ignore
17429 This was never implemented.
17430 @kindex info methods
17431 @item info methods
17432 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17433 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17434 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17435 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17436 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17437 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17438 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17439 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17440 @end ignore
17441
17442 @cindex opaque data types
17443 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17444 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17445 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17446 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17447 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17448 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17449 another source file. The default is on.
17450
17451 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17452 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17453
17454 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17455 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17456 is printed as follows:
17457 @smallexample
17458 @{<no data fields>@}
17459 @end smallexample
17460
17461 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17462 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17463 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17464
17465 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17466 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17467 @item set print symbol-loading
17468 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17469 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17470 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17471 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17472 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17473 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17474 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17475 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17476 can be annoying.
17477 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17478 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17479 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17480 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17481
17482 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17483 @item show print symbol-loading
17484 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17485 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17486
17487 @kindex maint print symbols
17488 @cindex symbol dump
17489 @kindex maint print psymbols
17490 @cindex partial symbol dump
17491 @kindex maint print msymbols
17492 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17493 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17494 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17495 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17496 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17497 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17498 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17499 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17500 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17501 that objfile.
17502 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17503 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17504 @code{main}.
17505 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17506 source file.
17507
17508 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17509 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17510 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17511 tables.
17512 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17513 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17514 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17515 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17516 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17517 ``ELF symbols''.
17518
17519 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17520 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17521
17522 @kindex maint info symtabs
17523 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17524 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17525 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17526 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17527 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17528 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17529 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17530
17531 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17532 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17533 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17534 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17535 structure in more detail. For example:
17536
17537 @smallexample
17538 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17539 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17540 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17541 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17542 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17543 readin no
17544 fullname (null)
17545 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17546 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17547 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17548 dependencies (none)
17549 @}
17550 @}
17551 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17552 (@value{GDBP})
17553 @end smallexample
17554 @noindent
17555 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17556 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17557 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17558 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17559 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17560
17561 @smallexample
17562 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17563 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17564 line 1574.
17565 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17566 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17567 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17568 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17569 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17570 dirname (null)
17571 fullname (null)
17572 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17573 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17574 debugformat DWARF 2
17575 @}
17576 @}
17577 (@value{GDBP})
17578 @end smallexample
17579
17580 @kindex maint info line-table
17581 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17582 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17583 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17584
17585 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17586 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17587 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17588
17589 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17590 @cindex symbol cache size
17591 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17592 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17593 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17594 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17595 with different sizes.
17596
17597 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17598 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17599 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17600
17601 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17602 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17603 @item maint print symbol-cache
17604 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17605 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17606
17607 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17608 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17609 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17610 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17611 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17612
17613 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17614 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17615 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17616 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17617 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17618 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17619
17620 @end table
17621
17622 @node Altering
17623 @chapter Altering Execution
17624
17625 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17626 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17627 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17628 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17629 program.
17630
17631 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17632 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17633 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17634
17635 @menu
17636 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17637 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17638 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17639 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17640 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17641 * Patching:: Patching your program
17642 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17643 @end menu
17644
17645 @node Assignment
17646 @section Assignment to Variables
17647
17648 @cindex assignment
17649 @cindex setting variables
17650 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17651 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17652
17653 @smallexample
17654 print x=4
17655 @end smallexample
17656
17657 @noindent
17658 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17659 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17660 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17661 information on operators in supported languages.
17662
17663 @kindex set variable
17664 @cindex variables, setting
17665 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17666 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17667 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17668 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17669 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17670
17671 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17672 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17673 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17674 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17675 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17676 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17677 command @code{set width}:
17678
17679 @smallexample
17680 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17681 type = double
17682 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17683 $4 = 13
17684 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17685 Invalid syntax in expression.
17686 @end smallexample
17687
17688 @noindent
17689 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17690 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17691
17692 @smallexample
17693 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17694 @end smallexample
17695
17696 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17697 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17698 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17699 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17700 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17701 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17702
17703 @smallexample
17704 @group
17705 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17706 type = double
17707 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17708 $1 = 1
17709 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17710 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17711 $2 = 1
17712 (@value{GDBP}) r
17713 The program being debugged has been started already.
17714 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17715 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17716 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17717 Invalid bfd target.
17718 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17719 The current BFD target is "=4".
17720 @end group
17721 @end smallexample
17722
17723 @noindent
17724 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17725 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17726 @code{g}, use
17727
17728 @smallexample
17729 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17730 @end smallexample
17731
17732 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17733 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17734 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17735 same length or shorter.
17736 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17737 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17738
17739 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17740 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17741 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17742 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17743 and representation in memory), and
17744
17745 @smallexample
17746 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17747 @end smallexample
17748
17749 @noindent
17750 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17751
17752 @node Jumping
17753 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17754
17755 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17756 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17757 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17758
17759 @table @code
17760 @kindex jump
17761 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17762 @item jump @var{location}
17763 @itemx j @var{location}
17764 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17765 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17766 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17767 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17768 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17769
17770 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17771 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17772 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17773 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17774 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17775 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17776 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17777 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17778 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17779 @end table
17780
17781 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17782 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17783 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17784 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17785 example,
17786
17787 @smallexample
17788 set $pc = 0x485
17789 @end smallexample
17790
17791 @noindent
17792 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17793 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17794 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17795
17796 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17797 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17798 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17799 detail.
17800
17801 @c @group
17802 @node Signaling
17803 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17804 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17805
17806 @table @code
17807 @kindex signal
17808 @item signal @var{signal}
17809 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17810 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17811 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17812 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17813
17814 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17815 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17816 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17817 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17818 signal.
17819
17820 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17821 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17822 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17823 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17824 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17825 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17826 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17827 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17828
17829 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17830 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17831 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17832 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17833 passes the signal directly to your program.
17834
17835 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17836 after executing the command.
17837
17838 @kindex queue-signal
17839 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17840 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17841 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17842 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17843 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17844 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17845 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17846 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17847 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17848
17849 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17850 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17851 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17852 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17853 @code{continue} command.
17854
17855 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17856 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17857 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17858 (@pxref{Signals}).
17859 @end table
17860 @c @end group
17861
17862 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17863 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17864
17865 @node Returning
17866 @section Returning from a Function
17867
17868 @table @code
17869 @cindex returning from a function
17870 @kindex return
17871 @item return
17872 @itemx return @var{expression}
17873 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17874 command. If you give an
17875 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17876 value.
17877 @end table
17878
17879 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17880 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17881 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17882 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17883
17884 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17885 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17886 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17887 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17888 of functions.
17889
17890 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17891 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17892 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17893 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17894 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17895
17896 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17897 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17898 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17899 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17900 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17901 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17902 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17903 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17904 assignment into the right register(s).
17905
17906 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17907 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17908 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17909 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17910 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17911 into a @code{long long int}:
17912
17913 @smallexample
17914 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17915 29 return 31;
17916 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17917 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17918 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17919 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17920 (@value{GDBP})
17921 @end smallexample
17922
17923 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17924 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17925 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17926 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17927 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17928 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17929 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17930 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17931
17932 @smallexample
17933 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17934 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17935 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17936 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17937 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17938 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17939 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17940 (@value{GDBP})
17941 @end smallexample
17942
17943 @node Calling
17944 @section Calling Program Functions
17945
17946 @table @code
17947 @cindex calling functions
17948 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17949 @item print @var{expr}
17950 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17951 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17952 debugged.
17953
17954 @kindex call
17955 @item call @var{expr}
17956 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17957 returned values.
17958
17959 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17960 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17961 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17962 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17963 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17964 value history.
17965 @end table
17966
17967 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17968 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17969 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17970 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17971
17972 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17973 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17974 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17975 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17976 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17977 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17978 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17979 in that case is controlled by the
17980 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17981
17982 @table @code
17983 @item set unwindonsignal
17984 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17985 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17986 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17987 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17988 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17989 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17990 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17991 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17992 received.
17993
17994 @item show unwindonsignal
17995 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17996 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17997 @value{GDBN}.
17998
17999 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18000 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18001 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18002 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18003 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18004 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18005 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18006 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18007 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18008 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18009
18010 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18011 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18012 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18013 @value{GDBN}.
18014
18015 @end table
18016
18017 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18018
18019 @cindex no debug info functions
18020 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18021 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18022 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18023 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18024 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18025 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18026
18027 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18028 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18029 declared return type. For example:
18030
18031 @smallexample
18032 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18033 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18034 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18035 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18036 @end smallexample
18037
18038 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18039 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18040 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18041 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18042
18043 @smallexample
18044 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18045 @end smallexample
18046
18047 @noindent
18048 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18049
18050 @smallexample
18051 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18052 @end smallexample
18053
18054 @noindent
18055 these calls are equivalent:
18056
18057 @smallexample
18058 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18059 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18060 @end smallexample
18061
18062 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18063 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18064 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18065 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18066 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18067 float parameters, and no debug info:
18068
18069 @smallexample
18070 float
18071 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18072 float v1, v2;
18073 @{
18074 return v1 * v2;
18075 @}
18076 @end smallexample
18077
18078 @noindent
18079 you call it like this:
18080
18081 @smallexample
18082 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18083 @end smallexample
18084
18085 @node Patching
18086 @section Patching Programs
18087
18088 @cindex patching binaries
18089 @cindex writing into executables
18090 @cindex writing into corefiles
18091
18092 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18093 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18094 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18095 patching your program's binary.
18096
18097 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18098 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18099 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18100 repairs.
18101
18102 @table @code
18103 @kindex set write
18104 @item set write on
18105 @itemx set write off
18106 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18107 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18108 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18109
18110 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18111 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18112 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18113
18114 @item show write
18115 @kindex show write
18116 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18117 as well as reading.
18118 @end table
18119
18120 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18121 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18122 @cindex injecting code
18123 @cindex writing into executables
18124 @cindex compiling code
18125
18126 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18127 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18128 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18129 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18130
18131 @table @code
18132 @kindex compile code
18133 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18134 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18135 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18136 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18137 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18138 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18139 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18140 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18141 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18142 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18143 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18144 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18145
18146 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18147 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18148 E.g.:
18149
18150 @smallexample
18151 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18152 @end smallexample
18153
18154 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18155 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18156 from actual source code. E.g.:
18157
18158 @smallexample
18159 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18160 @end smallexample
18161
18162 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18163 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18164 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18165 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18166 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18167 editor.
18168
18169 @smallexample
18170 compile code
18171 >printf ("hello\n");
18172 >printf ("world\n");
18173 >end
18174 @end smallexample
18175
18176 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18177 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18178 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18179 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18180 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18181 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18182 inferior symbols otherwise.
18183
18184 @kindex compile file
18185 @item compile file @var{filename}
18186 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18187 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18188
18189 @smallexample
18190 compile file /home/user/example.c
18191 @end smallexample
18192 @end table
18193
18194 @table @code
18195 @item compile print @var{expr}
18196 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18197 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18198 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18199 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18200 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18201 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18202 Formats}.
18203
18204 @item compile print
18205 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18206 @cindex reprint the last value
18207 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18208 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18209 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18210 multiple-line editor.
18211 @end table
18212
18213 @noindent
18214 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18215
18216 @table @code
18217 @anchor{set debug compile}
18218 @item set debug compile
18219 @cindex compile command debugging info
18220 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18221 injecting the code. The default is off.
18222
18223 @item show debug compile
18224 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18225 compiling and injecting the code.
18226 @end table
18227
18228 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18229
18230 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18231 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18232 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18233 injecting process.
18234
18235 @noindent
18236 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18237
18238 @table @asis
18239 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18240 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18241 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18242 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18243
18244 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18245 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18246 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18247 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18248 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18249 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18250 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18251 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18252
18253 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18254 @end table
18255
18256 @noindent
18257 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18258
18259 @table @code
18260 @item set compile-args
18261 @cindex compile command options override
18262 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18263 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18264 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18265 compilation.
18266
18267 @item show compile-args
18268 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18269 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18270 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18271 @end table
18272
18273 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18274
18275 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18276 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18277 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18278
18279 @table @asis
18280 @item C code examples and caveats
18281 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18282 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18283 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18284 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18285 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18286
18287 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18288 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18289 much like any other normal debugging session.
18290
18291 @smallexample
18292 void function1 (void)
18293 @{
18294 int i = 42;
18295 printf ("function 1\n");
18296 @}
18297
18298 void function2 (void)
18299 @{
18300 int j = 12;
18301 function1 ();
18302 @}
18303
18304 int main(void)
18305 @{
18306 int k = 6;
18307 int *p;
18308 function2 ();
18309 return 0;
18310 @}
18311 @end smallexample
18312
18313 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18314 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18315 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18316
18317 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18318 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18319 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18320 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18321 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18322
18323 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18324 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18325 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18326 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18327 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18328 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18329 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18330 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18331 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18332 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18333
18334 @smallexample
18335 compile code k = 3;
18336 @end smallexample
18337
18338 @noindent
18339 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18340 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18341 @code{compile} command changes it.
18342
18343 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18344 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18345 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18346 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18347 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18348
18349 @smallexample
18350 compile code j = 3;
18351 @end smallexample
18352
18353 @noindent
18354 will result in a compilation error message.
18355
18356 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18357 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18358 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18359
18360 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18361 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18362 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18363 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18364
18365 @smallexample
18366 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18367 @end smallexample
18368
18369 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18370 command has completed:
18371
18372 @smallexample
18373 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18374 @end smallexample
18375
18376 @noindent
18377 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18378 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18379 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18380 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18381 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18382
18383 @smallexample
18384 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18385 @end smallexample
18386
18387 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18388 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18389 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18390 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18391 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18392 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18393 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18394 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18395
18396 @smallexample
18397 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18398 @end smallexample
18399
18400 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18401 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18402 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18403 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18404 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18405 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18406 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18407
18408 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18409 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18410 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18411 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18412 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18413 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18414
18415 @smallexample
18416 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18417 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18418 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18419 Compilation failed.
18420 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18421 42
18422 @end smallexample
18423
18424 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18425 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18426 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18427 will print to the console.
18428 @end table
18429
18430 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18431
18432 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18433 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18434 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18435 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18436 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18437 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18438 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18439 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18440
18441
18442 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18443 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18444 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18445 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18446 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18447 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18448 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18449
18450 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18451 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18452 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
18453 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
18454 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
18455 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
18456 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
18457
18458 @table @code
18459 @item set compile-gcc
18460 @cindex compile command driver filename override
18461 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
18462 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
18463 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
18464 default.
18465
18466 @item show compile-gcc
18467 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
18468 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
18469 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
18470 @end table
18471
18472 @node GDB Files
18473 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18474
18475 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18476 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18477 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18478 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18479
18480 @menu
18481 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18482 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18483 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18484 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18485 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18486 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18487 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18488 @end menu
18489
18490 @node Files
18491 @section Commands to Specify Files
18492
18493 @cindex symbol table
18494 @cindex core dump file
18495
18496 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18497 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18498 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18499 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18500
18501 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18502 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18503 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18504 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18505 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18506 new files are useful.
18507
18508 @table @code
18509 @cindex executable file
18510 @kindex file
18511 @item file @var{filename}
18512 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18513 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18514 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18515 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18516 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18517 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18518 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18519 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18520
18521 @cindex unlinked object files
18522 @cindex patching object files
18523 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18524 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18525 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18526 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18527 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18528 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18529 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18530 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18531
18532 @item file
18533 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18534 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18535
18536 @kindex exec-file
18537 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18538 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18539 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18540 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18541 discard information on the executable file.
18542
18543 @kindex symbol-file
18544 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18545 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18546 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18547 table and program to run from the same file.
18548
18549 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18550 program's symbol table.
18551
18552 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18553 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18554 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18555 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18556 @value{GDBN}.
18557
18558 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18559 executing it once.
18560
18561 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18562 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18563 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18564 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18565 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18566 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18567 optimized code.
18568
18569 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18570 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18571 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18572 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18573 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18574
18575 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18576 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18577 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18578 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18579 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18580 Warnings and Messages}.)
18581
18582 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18583 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18584 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18585 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18586 in stabs format.
18587
18588 @kindex readnow
18589 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18590 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18591 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18592 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18593 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18594 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18595 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18596 entire symbol table available.
18597
18598 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
18599 @cindex never read symbols
18600 @cindex symbols, never read
18601 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
18602 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
18603 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
18604 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
18605 @xref{--readnever}.
18606
18607 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18608 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18609 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18610 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18611 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18612 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18613 @c files.
18614
18615 @kindex core-file
18616 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18617 @itemx core
18618 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18619 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18620 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18621 executable file itself for other parts.
18622
18623 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18624 to be used.
18625
18626 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18627 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18628 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18629 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18630 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18631
18632 @kindex add-symbol-file
18633 @cindex dynamic linking
18634 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18635 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]}
18636 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18637 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18638 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18639 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18640 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18641 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18642 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18643 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18644 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18645 @var{address} as an expression.
18646
18647 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18648 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18649 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18650 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18651
18652 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18653
18654 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18655 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18656 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18657 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18658 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18659 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18660 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18661 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18662 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18663
18664 @itemize @bullet
18665 @item
18666 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18667 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18668 @item
18669 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18670 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18671 @item
18672 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18673 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18674 @end itemize
18675
18676 @noindent
18677 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18678 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18679 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18680 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18681 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18682 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18683 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18684 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18685 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18686 way.
18687
18688 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18689
18690 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18691 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18692 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18693 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18694 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18695 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18696
18697 @smallexample
18698 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18699 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18700 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18701 (y or n) y
18702 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18703 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18704 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18705 (gdb)
18706 @end smallexample
18707
18708
18709 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18710
18711 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18712 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18713 @cindex load symbols from memory
18714 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18715 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18716 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18717 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18718 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18719 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18720 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18721 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18722 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18723
18724 @kindex section
18725 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18726 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18727 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18728 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18729 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18730 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18731 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18732 their addresses.
18733
18734 @kindex info files
18735 @kindex info target
18736 @item info files
18737 @itemx info target
18738 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18739 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18740 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18741 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18742 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18743 current ones.
18744
18745 @kindex maint info sections
18746 @item maint info sections
18747 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18748 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18749 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18750 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18751 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18752 may be arbitrarily combined):
18753
18754 @table @code
18755 @item ALLOBJ
18756 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18757 @item @var{sections}
18758 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18759 @item @var{section-flags}
18760 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18761 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18762 @table @code
18763 @item ALLOC
18764 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18765 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18766 @item LOAD
18767 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18768 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18769 @item RELOC
18770 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18771 @item READONLY
18772 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18773 @item CODE
18774 Section contains executable code only.
18775 @item DATA
18776 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18777 @item ROM
18778 Section will reside in ROM.
18779 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18780 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18781 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18782 Section is not empty.
18783 @item NEVER_LOAD
18784 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18785 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18786 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18787 COFF shared library information.
18788 @item IS_COMMON
18789 Section contains common symbols.
18790 @end table
18791 @end table
18792 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18793 @cindex read-only sections
18794 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18795 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18796 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18797 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18798 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18799 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18800 enhancement to debugging performance.
18801
18802 The default is off.
18803
18804 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18805 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18806 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18807 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18808
18809 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18810 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18811 @end table
18812
18813 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18814 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18815 name and remembers it that way.
18816
18817 @cindex shared libraries
18818 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18819 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18820 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18821 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18822
18823 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18824 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18825
18826 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18827 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18828 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18829 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18830 debugging a core file).
18831
18832 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18833 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18834 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18835
18836 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18837 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18838 particularly large or there are many of them.
18839
18840 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18841 commands:
18842
18843 @table @code
18844 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18845 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18846 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18847 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18848 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18849 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18850 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18851 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18852
18853 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18854 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18855 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18856 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18857 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18858 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18859 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18860 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18861 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18862
18863 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18864 @item show auto-solib-add
18865 Display the current autoloading mode.
18866 @end table
18867
18868 @cindex load shared library
18869 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18870 command:
18871
18872 @table @code
18873 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18874 @kindex info share
18875 @item info share @var{regex}
18876 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18877 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18878 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18879 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18880
18881 @kindex info dll
18882 @item info dll @var{regex}
18883 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18884
18885 @kindex sharedlibrary
18886 @kindex share
18887 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18888 @itemx share @var{regex}
18889 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18890 Unix regular expression.
18891 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18892 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18893 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18894 loaded.
18895
18896 @item nosharedlibrary
18897 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18898 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18899 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18900 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18901 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18902 discarded.
18903 @end table
18904
18905 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18906 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18907 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18908 Catchpoints}).
18909
18910 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18911 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18912 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18913 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18914
18915 @table @code
18916 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18917 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18918 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18919 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18920 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18921 shared library.
18922
18923 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18924 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18925 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18926 library events happen.
18927 @end table
18928
18929 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18930 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18931 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18932 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18933 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18934 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18935 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18936 not.
18937
18938 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18939 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18940 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18941 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18942 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18943
18944 @table @code
18945 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18946 @cindex system root, alternate
18947 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18948 @kindex set sysroot
18949 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18950 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18951 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18952 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18953 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18954 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18955 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18956 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18957 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18958 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18959 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18960 @var{path}.
18961
18962 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18963 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18964 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18965 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18966 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18967 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18968 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18969 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18970 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18971 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18972 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18973 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18974 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18975 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18976
18977 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18978 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18979 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18980 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18981 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18982
18983 @smallexample
18984 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18985 @end smallexample
18986
18987 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18988 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18989 system:
18990
18991 @smallexample
18992 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18993 @end smallexample
18994
18995 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18996 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18997 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18998 colons:
18999
19000 @smallexample
19001 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19002 @end smallexample
19003
19004 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19005 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19006 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19007 @samp{z}):
19008
19009 @smallexample
19010 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19011 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19012 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19013 @end smallexample
19014
19015 @noindent
19016 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19017 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19018 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19019
19020 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19021 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19022
19023 @smallexample
19024 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19025 @end smallexample
19026
19027 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19028 if you don't want or need to.
19029
19030 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19031 sysroot}.
19032
19033 @cindex default system root
19034 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19035 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19036 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19037 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19038 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19039 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19040 location.
19041
19042 @kindex show sysroot
19043 @item show sysroot
19044 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19045
19046 @kindex set solib-search-path
19047 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19048 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19049 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19050 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19051 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19052 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19053 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19054 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19055 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19056 of shared library symbols.
19057
19058 @kindex show solib-search-path
19059 @item show solib-search-path
19060 Display the current shared library search path.
19061
19062 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19063 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19064 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19065 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19066 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19067
19068 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19069 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19070 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19071 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19072 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19073 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19074 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19075 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19076 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19077 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19078 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19079 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19080 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19081 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19082 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19083 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19084 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19085 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19086 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19087 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19088 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19089 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19090
19091 @table @code
19092 @item unix
19093 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19094 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19095 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19096 the forward slash.
19097
19098 @item dos-based
19099 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19100 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19101 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19102 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19103 considered directory separators.
19104
19105 @item auto
19106 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19107 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19108 This is the default.
19109 @end table
19110 @end table
19111
19112 @cindex file name canonicalization
19113 @cindex base name differences
19114 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19115 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19116 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19117 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19118 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19119 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19120 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19121 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19122 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19123 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19124 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19125 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19126 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19127 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19128 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19129
19130 @table @code
19131 @item set basenames-may-differ
19132 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19133 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19134
19135 @item show basenames-may-differ
19136 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19137 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19138 @end table
19139
19140 @node File Caching
19141 @section File Caching
19142 @cindex caching of opened files
19143 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19144
19145 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19146 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19147 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19148 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19149
19150 @table @code
19151 @kindex maint info bfds
19152 @item maint info bfds
19153 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19154 @value{GDBN}.
19155
19156 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19157 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19158 @kindex bfd caching
19159 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19160 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19161 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19162 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19163 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19164 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19165 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19166 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19167 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19168
19169 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19170 @kindex bfd caching
19171 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19172 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19173
19174 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19175 @kindex bfd caching
19176 @item show debug bfd-cache
19177 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19178 @end table
19179
19180 @node Separate Debug Files
19181 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19182 @cindex separate debugging information files
19183 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19184 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19185 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19186 @cindex global debugging information directories
19187 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19188 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19189
19190 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19191 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19192 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19193 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19194 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19195 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19196 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19197
19198 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19199 file:
19200
19201 @itemize @bullet
19202 @item
19203 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19204 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19205 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19206 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19207 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19208 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19209 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19210 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19211
19212 @item
19213 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19214 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19215 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19216 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19217 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19218 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
19219 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19220 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19221 below.
19222 @end itemize
19223
19224 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19225 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19226
19227 @itemize @bullet
19228 @item
19229 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19230 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19231 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19232 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19233 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19234
19235 @item
19236 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19237 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19238 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19239 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19240 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19241 hex characters, not 10.)
19242 @end itemize
19243
19244 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19245 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19246 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19247 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19248 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19249 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19250
19251 @itemize @minus
19252 @item
19253 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19254 @item
19255 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19256 @item
19257 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19258 @item
19259 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19260 @end itemize
19261
19262 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19263 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19264 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19265 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19266 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19267
19268 @table @code
19269
19270 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19271 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19272 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19273 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19274 concatenating them by a path separator.
19275
19276 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19277 @item show debug-file-directory
19278 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19279 information files.
19280
19281 @end table
19282
19283 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19284 @cindex debug link sections
19285 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19286 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19287
19288 @itemize
19289 @item
19290 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19291 a zero byte,
19292 @item
19293 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19294 boundary within the section, and
19295 @item
19296 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19297 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19298 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19299 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19300 @end itemize
19301
19302 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19303 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19304 described above.
19305
19306 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19307 @cindex build ID sections
19308 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19309 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19310 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19311 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19312 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19313 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19314 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19315 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19316 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19317
19318 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19319 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19320 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19321 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19322 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19323 in an ordinary executable.
19324
19325 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19326 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19327 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19328 following commands:
19329
19330 @smallexample
19331 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19332 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19333 @end smallexample
19334
19335 @noindent
19336 These commands remove the debugging
19337 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19338 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19339 two files:
19340
19341 @itemize @bullet
19342 @item
19343 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19344 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19345
19346 @smallexample
19347 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19348 @end smallexample
19349
19350 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19351 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19352 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19353 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19354
19355 @item
19356 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19357 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19358 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19359 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19360 @end itemize
19361
19362 @noindent
19363
19364 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19365 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19366 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19367
19368 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19369 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19370 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19371 @c different ways!
19372 @ifhtml
19373 @display
19374 @html
19375 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19376 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19377 @end html
19378 @end display
19379 @end ifhtml
19380 @ifnothtml
19381 @display
19382 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19383 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19384 @end display
19385 @end ifnothtml
19386
19387 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19388 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19389 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19390 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19391 CRC.
19392
19393 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19394 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19395 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19396 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19397 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19398
19399 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19400 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19401 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19402 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19403 @code{0xffffffff}.
19404
19405 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19406 @smallexample
19407 unsigned long
19408 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19409 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19410 @{
19411 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19412 @{
19413 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19414 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19415 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19416 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19417 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19418 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19419 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19420 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19421 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19422 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19423 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19424 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19425 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19426 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19427 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19428 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19429 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19430 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19431 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19432 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19433 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19434 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19435 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19436 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19437 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19438 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19439 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19440 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19441 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19442 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19443 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19444 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19445 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19446 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19447 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19448 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19449 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19450 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19451 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19452 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19453 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19454 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19455 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19456 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19457 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19458 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19459 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19460 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19461 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19462 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19463 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19464 0x2d02ef8d
19465 @};
19466 unsigned char *end;
19467
19468 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19469 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19470 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19471 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19472 @}
19473 @end smallexample
19474
19475 @noindent
19476 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19477
19478 @node MiniDebugInfo
19479 @section Debugging information in a special section
19480 @cindex separate debug sections
19481 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19482
19483 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19484 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19485 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19486 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19487
19488 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19489 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19490 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19491 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19492 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19493 debugging information might be included in the section.
19494
19495 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19496 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19497 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19498
19499 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19500 standard utilities:
19501
19502 @smallexample
19503 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19504 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19505 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19506 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19507
19508 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19509 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19510 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19511 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19512 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19513 | sort > funcsyms
19514
19515 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19516 # table.
19517 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19518
19519 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19520 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19521
19522 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19523 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19524 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19525 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19526
19527 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19528 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19529
19530 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19531 # original binary.
19532 xz mini_debuginfo
19533 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19534 @end smallexample
19535
19536 @node Index Files
19537 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19538 @cindex index files
19539 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19540
19541 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19542 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19543 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19544 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19545 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19546 startup.
19547
19548 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19549 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19550 using @command{objcopy}.
19551
19552 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19553
19554 @table @code
19555 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19556 @kindex save gdb-index
19557 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19558 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19559 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19560 @var{directory}.
19561 @end table
19562
19563 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19564 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19565
19566 @smallexample
19567 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19568 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19569 @end smallexample
19570
19571 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19572 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19573 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19574 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19575 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19576 The default is @code{off}.
19577 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19578 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19579
19580 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19581 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19582
19583 @smallexample
19584 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19585 @end smallexample
19586
19587 Instead you must do, for example,
19588
19589 @smallexample
19590 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19591 @end smallexample
19592
19593 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19594 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19595 currently work for programs using Ada.
19596
19597 @node Symbol Errors
19598 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19599
19600 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19601 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19602 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19603 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19604 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19605 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19606 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19607 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19608 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19609 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19610 Messages}).
19611
19612 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19613
19614 @table @code
19615 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19616
19617 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19618 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19619 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19620 in its outer scope blocks.
19621
19622 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19623 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19624 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19625 function.
19626
19627 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19628
19629 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19630 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19631 do so.
19632
19633 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19634 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19635 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19636 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19637 Messages}.)
19638
19639 @item bad block start address patched
19640
19641 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19642 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19643 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19644
19645 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19646 starting on the previous source line.
19647
19648 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19649
19650 @cindex foo
19651 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19652 larger than the size of the string table.
19653
19654 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19655 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19656 with this name.
19657
19658 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19659
19660 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19661 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19662 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19663
19664 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19665 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19666 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19667 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19668 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19669 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19670
19671 @item stub type has NULL name
19672
19673 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19674
19675 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19676 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19677 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19678 it.
19679
19680 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19681
19682 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19683
19684 @end table
19685
19686 @node Data Files
19687 @section GDB Data Files
19688
19689 @cindex prefix for data files
19690 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19691 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19692
19693 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19694 is currently using.
19695
19696 @table @code
19697 @kindex set data-directory
19698 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19699 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19700 to @var{directory}.
19701
19702 @kindex show data-directory
19703 @item show data-directory
19704 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19705 @end table
19706
19707 @cindex default data directory
19708 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19709 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19710 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19711 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19712 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19713 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19714 location.
19715
19716 The data directory may also be specified with the
19717 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19718 @xref{Mode Options}.
19719
19720 @node Targets
19721 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19722
19723 @cindex debugging target
19724 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19725
19726 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19727 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19728 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19729 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19730 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19731 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19732 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19733 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19734
19735 @cindex target architecture
19736 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19737 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19738 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19739 command.
19740
19741 @table @code
19742 @kindex set architecture
19743 @kindex show architecture
19744 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19745 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19746 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19747 supported architectures.
19748
19749 @item show architecture
19750 Show the current target architecture.
19751
19752 @item set processor
19753 @itemx processor
19754 @kindex set processor
19755 @kindex show processor
19756 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19757 and @code{show architecture}.
19758 @end table
19759
19760 @menu
19761 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19762 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19763 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19764 @end menu
19765
19766 @node Active Targets
19767 @section Active Targets
19768
19769 @cindex stacking targets
19770 @cindex active targets
19771 @cindex multiple targets
19772
19773 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19774 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19775 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19776 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19777 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19778 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19779 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19780 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19781 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19782
19783 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19784 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19785 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19786 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19787
19788 @node Target Commands
19789 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19790
19791 @table @code
19792 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19793 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19794 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19795 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19796 protocol of the target machine.
19797
19798 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19799 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19800 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19801
19802 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19803 after executing the command.
19804
19805 @kindex help target
19806 @item help target
19807 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19808 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19809 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19810
19811 @item help target @var{name}
19812 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19813 select it.
19814
19815 @kindex set gnutarget
19816 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19817 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19818 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19819 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19820 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19821 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19822
19823 @quotation
19824 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19825 you must know the actual BFD name.
19826 @end quotation
19827
19828 @noindent
19829 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19830
19831 @kindex show gnutarget
19832 @item show gnutarget
19833 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19834 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19835 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19836 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19837 @end table
19838
19839 @cindex common targets
19840 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19841 configuration):
19842
19843 @table @code
19844 @kindex target
19845 @item target exec @var{program}
19846 @cindex executable file target
19847 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19848 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19849
19850 @item target core @var{filename}
19851 @cindex core dump file target
19852 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19853 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19854
19855 @item target remote @var{medium}
19856 @cindex remote target
19857 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19858 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19859 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19860
19861 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19862 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19863
19864 @smallexample
19865 target remote /dev/ttya
19866 @end smallexample
19867
19868 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19869 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19870 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19871 clobbered by the download.
19872
19873 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19874 @cindex built-in simulator target
19875 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19876 In general,
19877 @smallexample
19878 target sim
19879 load
19880 run
19881 @end smallexample
19882 @noindent
19883 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19884 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19885 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19886 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19887 Processors}.
19888
19889 @item target native
19890 @cindex native target
19891 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19892 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19893 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19894 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19895
19896 @end table
19897
19898 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19899 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19900
19901 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19902 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19903 various aspects of this process.
19904
19905 @table @code
19906
19907 @item set hash
19908 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19909 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19910 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19911 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19912 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19913 monitor.
19914
19915 @item show hash
19916 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19917 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19918
19919 @item set debug monitor
19920 @kindex set debug monitor
19921 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19922 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19923 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19924
19925 @item show debug monitor
19926 @kindex show debug monitor
19927 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19928 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19929 @end table
19930
19931 @table @code
19932
19933 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19934 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19935 @anchor{load}
19936 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19937 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19938 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19939 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19940 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19941 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19942
19943 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19944 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19945 target is @dots{}}''
19946
19947 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19948 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19949 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19950 specifies a fixed address.
19951 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19952
19953 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
19954 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
19955 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
19956
19957 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19958 load programs into flash memory.
19959
19960 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19961 @end table
19962
19963 @table @code
19964
19965 @kindex flash-erase
19966 @item flash-erase
19967 @anchor{flash-erase}
19968
19969 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
19970
19971 @end table
19972
19973 @node Byte Order
19974 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19975
19976 @cindex choosing target byte order
19977 @cindex target byte order
19978
19979 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19980 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19981 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19982 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19983 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19984 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19985
19986 @table @code
19987 @kindex set endian
19988 @item set endian big
19989 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19990
19991 @item set endian little
19992 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19993
19994 @item set endian auto
19995 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19996 executable.
19997
19998 @item show endian
19999 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20000
20001 @end table
20002
20003 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20004 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20005 target system.
20006
20007
20008 @node Remote Debugging
20009 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20010 @cindex remote debugging
20011
20012 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20013 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20014 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20015 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20016 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20017
20018 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20019 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20020 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20021 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20022 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20023 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20024
20025 Other remote targets may be available in your
20026 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20027
20028 @menu
20029 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20030 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20031 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20032 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20033 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20034 @end menu
20035
20036 @node Connecting
20037 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20038 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20039 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20040 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20041 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20042 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20043 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20044
20045 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20046 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20047 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20048 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20049
20050 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20051
20052 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20053 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20054 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20055 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20056
20057 @table @asis
20058
20059 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20060 @item Result of detach or program exit
20061 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20062 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20063 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20064
20065 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20066 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20067 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20068 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20069
20070 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20071 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20072 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20073 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20074
20075 @item Specifying the program to debug
20076 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20077 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20078 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20079 target.
20080
20081 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20082 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20083 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20084
20085 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20086 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20087 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20088 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20089
20090 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20091 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20092 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20093 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20094 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20095 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20096 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20097 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20098 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20099
20100 @item The @code{run} command
20101 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20102 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20103 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20104 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20105 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20106
20107 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20108 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20109 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20110 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20111 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20112
20113 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20114 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20115 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20116 @code{target remote} mode.
20117
20118 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20119 @item Attaching
20120 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20121 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20122 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20123
20124 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20125 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20126 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20127 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20128 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20129
20130 @end table
20131
20132 @anchor{Host and target files}
20133 @subsection Host and Target Files
20134 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20135 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20136
20137 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20138 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20139 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20140 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20141 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20142
20143 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20144 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20145 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20146 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20147 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20148
20149 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20150 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20151 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20152 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20153 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20154 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20155 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20156 target libraries.
20157
20158 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20159 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20160 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20161 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20162 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20163 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20164 programs.
20165
20166 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20167 @cindex remote connection commands
20168 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
20169 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20170 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20171 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20172 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20173 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20174 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20175
20176 @table @code
20177
20178 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20179 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20180 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20181 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20182 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20183
20184 @smallexample
20185 target remote /dev/ttyb
20186 @end smallexample
20187
20188 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20189 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20190 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20191 @code{target} command.
20192
20193 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20194 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20195 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20196 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20197 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20198 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20199 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
20200 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
20201 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
20202 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
20203 target.
20204
20205 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20206 @code{manyfarms}:
20207
20208 @smallexample
20209 target remote manyfarms:2828
20210 @end smallexample
20211
20212 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20213 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20214 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20215 port 1234 on your local machine:
20216
20217 @smallexample
20218 target remote :1234
20219 @end smallexample
20220 @noindent
20221
20222 Note that the colon is still required here.
20223
20224 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20225 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20226 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20227 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20228 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20229
20230 @smallexample
20231 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20232 @end smallexample
20233
20234 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20235 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20236 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20237 cause havoc with your debugging session.
20238
20239 @item target remote | @var{command}
20240 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20241 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20242 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20243 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20244 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20245 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20246 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20247 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20248 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20249
20250 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20251 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20252 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20253
20254 @end table
20255
20256 @cindex interrupting remote programs
20257 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
20258 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20259 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20260 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20261 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20262 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20263
20264 @smallexample
20265 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20266 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20267 @end smallexample
20268
20269 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20270 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20271 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20272 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20273
20274 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20275 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20276
20277 @table @code
20278 @kindex detach (remote)
20279 @item detach
20280 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20281 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20282 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20283 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20284 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20285 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20286 still connected to the target.
20287
20288 @kindex disconnect
20289 @item disconnect
20290 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20291 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20292 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20293 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20294 another target.
20295
20296 @cindex send command to remote monitor
20297 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
20298 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
20299 @kindex monitor
20300 @item monitor @var{cmd}
20301 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
20302 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
20303 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
20304 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
20305 and implement.
20306 @end table
20307
20308 @node File Transfer
20309 @section Sending files to a remote system
20310 @cindex remote target, file transfer
20311 @cindex file transfer
20312 @cindex sending files to remote systems
20313
20314 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20315 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20316 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20317 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20318 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20319 the only way to upload or download files.
20320
20321 Not all remote targets support these commands.
20322
20323 @table @code
20324 @kindex remote put
20325 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20326 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20327 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20328
20329 @kindex remote get
20330 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20331 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20332 on the host system.
20333
20334 @kindex remote delete
20335 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20336 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20337
20338 @end table
20339
20340 @node Server
20341 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20342
20343 @kindex gdbserver
20344 @cindex remote connection without stubs
20345 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20346 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20347 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20348 linking in the usual debugging stub.
20349
20350 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20351 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20352 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20353 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20354 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20355 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20356 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20357 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20358 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20359 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20360 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20361 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20362 choice for debugging.
20363
20364 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20365 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20366 protocol.
20367
20368 @quotation
20369 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20370 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20371 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20372 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20373 @code{gdbserver}.
20374 @end quotation
20375
20376 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20377 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20378 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20379 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20380
20381 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20382 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20383 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20384 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20385 system does all the symbol handling.
20386
20387 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20388 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20389 syntax is:
20390
20391 @smallexample
20392 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20393 @end smallexample
20394
20395 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20396 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20397 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20398 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20399 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20400 @file{/dev/com1}:
20401
20402 @smallexample
20403 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20404 @end smallexample
20405
20406 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20407 with it.
20408
20409 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20410
20411 @smallexample
20412 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20413 @end smallexample
20414
20415 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20416 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20417 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20418 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20419 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20420 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20421 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20422 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20423 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20424 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20425 @code{target remote} command.
20426
20427 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20428 with ssh:
20429
20430 @smallexample
20431 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20432 @end smallexample
20433
20434 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20435 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20436 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20437 You could elide it if you want to.
20438
20439 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20440 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20441 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20442 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20443
20444 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20445 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20446 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20447 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20448
20449 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20450 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20451
20452 @smallexample
20453 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20454 @end smallexample
20455
20456 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20457 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20458
20459 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20460 @value{GDBN} attach command
20461 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20462
20463 @pindex pidof
20464 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20465 @code{pidof} utility:
20466
20467 @smallexample
20468 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20469 @end smallexample
20470
20471 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20472 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20473 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20474
20475 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20476
20477 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20478 port.
20479
20480 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20481 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20482 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20483 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20484 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20485 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20486 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20487 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20488
20489 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20490 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20491 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20492
20493 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20494 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20495 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20496 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20497 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20498 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20499 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20500 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20501 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20502 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20503 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20504 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20505
20506 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20507 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20508
20509 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20510 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20511 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20512 program. For more information,
20513 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20514
20515 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20516 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20517 status information about the debugging process.
20518 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20519 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20520 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20521 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20522
20523 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20524 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20525 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20526 Possible options are:
20527
20528 @table @code
20529 @item none
20530 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20531 @item all
20532 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20533 @item timestamps
20534 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20535 @end table
20536
20537 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20538 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20539
20540 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20541 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20542 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20543 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20544 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20545
20546 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20547 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20548 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20549 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20550
20551 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20552 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20553 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20554 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20555
20556 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20557 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20558 environment:
20559
20560 @smallexample
20561 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20562 @end smallexample
20563
20564 @cindex @option{--selftest}
20565 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
20566
20567 @smallexample
20568 $ gdbserver --selftest
20569 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
20570 @end smallexample
20571
20572 These tests are disabled in release.
20573 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20574
20575 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20576 @itemize
20577
20578 @item
20579 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20580
20581 @item
20582 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20583 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20584 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20585 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20586 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20587 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20588
20589 @item
20590 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20591 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20592 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20593 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20594 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20595 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20596 program is already on the target.
20597
20598 @end itemize
20599
20600 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20601 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20602 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20603
20604 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20605 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20606 Here are the available commands.
20607
20608 @table @code
20609 @item monitor help
20610 List the available monitor commands.
20611
20612 @item monitor set debug 0
20613 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20614 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20615
20616 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20617 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20618 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20619 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20620
20621 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20622 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20623 Possible options are:
20624
20625 @table @code
20626 @item none
20627 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20628 @item all
20629 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20630 @item timestamps
20631 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20632 @end table
20633
20634 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20635 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20636
20637 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20638 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20639 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20640 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20641 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20642 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20643
20644 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20645 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20646
20647 @item monitor exit
20648 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20649 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20650 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20651 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20652 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20653
20654 @end table
20655
20656 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20657 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20658
20659 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20660 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20661
20662 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20663 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20664 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20665 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20666 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20667 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20668 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20669 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20670 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20671 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20672 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20673 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20674
20675 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20676
20677 @table @code
20678 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20679
20680 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20681 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20682 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20683
20684 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20685
20686 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20687 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20688 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20689 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20690 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20691 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20692
20693 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20694
20695 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20696 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20697 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20698 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20699 command for that. For example:
20700
20701 @smallexample
20702 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20703 @end smallexample
20704
20705 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20706 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20707 @end table
20708
20709 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20710 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20711 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20712 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20713 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20714 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20715 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20716 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20717 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20718 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20719
20720 @smallexample
20721 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20722 @end smallexample
20723
20724 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20725
20726 @smallexample
20727 $ gdb myprogram
20728 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20729 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20730 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20731 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20732 @end smallexample
20733
20734 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20735 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20736 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20737 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20738 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20739 tracing.
20740
20741 @node Remote Configuration
20742 @section Remote Configuration
20743
20744 @kindex set remote
20745 @kindex show remote
20746 This section documents the configuration options available when
20747 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20748 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20749 system-call-allowed}.
20750
20751 @table @code
20752 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20753 @cindex address size for remote targets
20754 @cindex bits in remote address
20755 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20756 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20757 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20758 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20759
20760 @item show remoteaddresssize
20761 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20762
20763 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20764 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20765 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20766 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20767 remote targets.
20768
20769 @item show serial baud
20770 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20771
20772 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20773 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20774 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20775
20776 @item show serial parity
20777 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20778
20779 @item set remotebreak
20780 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20781 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20782 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20783 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20784 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20785 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20786 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20787 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20788
20789 @item show remotebreak
20790 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20791 interrupt the remote program.
20792
20793 @item set remoteflow on
20794 @itemx set remoteflow off
20795 @kindex set remoteflow
20796 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20797 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20798
20799 @item show remoteflow
20800 @kindex show remoteflow
20801 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20802
20803 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20804 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20805 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20806 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20807 @code{ascii}.
20808
20809 @item show remotelogbase
20810 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20811 protocol.
20812
20813 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20814 @cindex record serial communications on file
20815 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20816 default is not to record at all.
20817
20818 @item show remotelogfile.
20819 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20820 serial communications.
20821
20822 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20823 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20824 @cindex remote timeout
20825 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20826 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20827
20828 @item show remotetimeout
20829 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20830 responses.
20831
20832 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20833 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20834 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20835 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20836 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20837 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20838 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20839 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20840
20841 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20842 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20843 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20844 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20845 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20846 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20847 as unlimited.
20848
20849 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20850 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20851 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20852
20853 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20854 @itemx show remote exec-file
20855 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20856 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20857 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20858 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20859 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20860 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20861
20862 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20863 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20864 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20865 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20866 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20867 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20868 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20869 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20870 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20871 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20872
20873 @item show interrupt-sequence
20874 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20875 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20876 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20877 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20878
20879 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20880 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20881 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20882 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20883 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20884 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20885
20886 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20887 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20888 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20889
20890 @kindex set tcp
20891 @kindex show tcp
20892 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20893 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20894 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20895 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20896 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20897 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20898 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20899 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20900 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20901
20902 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20903 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20904
20905 @item show tcp auto-retry
20906 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20907
20908 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20909 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20910 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20911 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20912 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20913 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20914 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20915 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20916 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20917 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20918 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20919
20920 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20921 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20922 @end table
20923
20924 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20925 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20926 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20927 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20928 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20929 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20930 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20931 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20932 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20933
20934 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20935 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20936 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20937 @value{GDBN} developers.
20938
20939 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20940 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20941 are:
20942
20943 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20944 @item Command Name
20945 @tab Remote Packet
20946 @tab Related Features
20947
20948 @item @code{fetch-register}
20949 @tab @code{p}
20950 @tab @code{info registers}
20951
20952 @item @code{set-register}
20953 @tab @code{P}
20954 @tab @code{set}
20955
20956 @item @code{binary-download}
20957 @tab @code{X}
20958 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20959
20960 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20961 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20962 @tab @code{info auxv}
20963
20964 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20965 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20966 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20967
20968 @item @code{attach}
20969 @tab @code{vAttach}
20970 @tab @code{attach}
20971
20972 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20973 @tab @code{vCont}
20974 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20975
20976 @item @code{run}
20977 @tab @code{vRun}
20978 @tab @code{run}
20979
20980 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20981 @tab @code{Z0}
20982 @tab @code{break}
20983
20984 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20985 @tab @code{Z1}
20986 @tab @code{hbreak}
20987
20988 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20989 @tab @code{Z2}
20990 @tab @code{watch}
20991
20992 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20993 @tab @code{Z3}
20994 @tab @code{rwatch}
20995
20996 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20997 @tab @code{Z4}
20998 @tab @code{awatch}
20999
21000 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21001 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21002 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21003
21004 @item @code{target-features}
21005 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21006 @tab @code{set architecture}
21007
21008 @item @code{library-info}
21009 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21010 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21011
21012 @item @code{memory-map}
21013 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21014 @tab @code{info mem}
21015
21016 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21017 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21018 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21019
21020 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21021 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21022 @tab @code{info spu}
21023
21024 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21025 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21026 @tab @code{info spu}
21027
21028 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21029 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21030 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21031
21032 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21033 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21034 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21035
21036 @item @code{threads}
21037 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21038 @tab @code{info threads}
21039
21040 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21041 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21042 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21043
21044 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21045 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21046 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21047
21048 @item @code{search-memory}
21049 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21050 @tab @code{find}
21051
21052 @item @code{supported-packets}
21053 @tab @code{qSupported}
21054 @tab Remote communications parameters
21055
21056 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21057 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21058 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21059
21060 @item @code{pass-signals}
21061 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21062 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21063
21064 @item @code{program-signals}
21065 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21066 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21067
21068 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21069 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21070 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21071
21072 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21073 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21074 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21075
21076 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21077 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21078 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21079
21080 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21081 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21082 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21083
21084 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21085 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21086 @tab @code{remote delete}
21087
21088 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21089 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21090 @tab Host I/O
21091
21092 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21093 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21094 @tab Host I/O
21095
21096 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21097 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21098 @tab Host I/O
21099
21100 @item @code{noack-packet}
21101 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21102 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21103
21104 @item @code{osdata}
21105 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21106 @tab @code{info os}
21107
21108 @item @code{query-attached}
21109 @tab @code{qAttached}
21110 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21111
21112 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21113 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21114 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21115
21116 @item @code{trace-status}
21117 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21118 @tab @code{tstatus}
21119
21120 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21121 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21122 @tab Traceframe info
21123
21124 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21125 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21126 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21127
21128 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21129 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21130 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21131
21132 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21133 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21134 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21135
21136 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21137 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21138 @tab @code{set environment}
21139
21140 @item @code{environment-unset}
21141 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21142 @tab @code{unset environment}
21143
21144 @item @code{environment-reset}
21145 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21146 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21147
21148 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21149 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21150 @tab @code{set cwd}
21151
21152 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21153 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21154 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21155
21156 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21157 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21158 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21159
21160 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21161 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21162 @tab @code{break}
21163
21164 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21165 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21166 @tab @code{hbreak}
21167
21168 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21169 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21170 @tab @code{fork}
21171
21172 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21173 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21174 @tab @code{vfork}
21175
21176 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21177 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21178 @tab @code{exec}
21179
21180 @item @code{thread-events}
21181 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21182 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21183
21184 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21185 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21186 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21187
21188 @end multitable
21189
21190 @node Remote Stub
21191 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21192
21193 @cindex debugging stub, example
21194 @cindex remote stub, example
21195 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21196 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21197 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21198 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21199 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21200 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21201 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21202 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21203
21204 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21205 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21206 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21207 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21208 program, you need:
21209
21210 @enumerate
21211 @item
21212 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21213 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21214 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21215
21216 @item
21217 A C subroutine library to support your program's
21218 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21219
21220 @item
21221 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21222 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21223 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21224 documentation.
21225 @end enumerate
21226
21227 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21228 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21229 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21230
21231 @table @emph
21232 @item On the host,
21233 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21234 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21235 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21236
21237 @item On the target,
21238 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21239 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21240 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21241
21242 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21243 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21244 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21245 @end table
21246
21247 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21248 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21249 @sc{sparc} boards.
21250
21251 @cindex remote serial stub list
21252 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21253
21254 @table @code
21255
21256 @item i386-stub.c
21257 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21258 @cindex Intel
21259 @cindex i386
21260 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
21261
21262 @item m68k-stub.c
21263 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
21264 @cindex Motorola 680x0
21265 @cindex m680x0
21266 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
21267
21268 @item sh-stub.c
21269 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
21270 @cindex Renesas
21271 @cindex SH
21272 For Renesas SH architectures.
21273
21274 @item sparc-stub.c
21275 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
21276 @cindex Sparc
21277 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
21278
21279 @item sparcl-stub.c
21280 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
21281 @cindex Fujitsu
21282 @cindex SparcLite
21283 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
21284
21285 @end table
21286
21287 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
21288 recently added stubs.
21289
21290 @menu
21291 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
21292 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
21293 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
21294 @end menu
21295
21296 @node Stub Contents
21297 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
21298
21299 @cindex remote serial stub
21300 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
21301 subroutines:
21302
21303 @table @code
21304 @item set_debug_traps
21305 @findex set_debug_traps
21306 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
21307 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
21308 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
21309 program's startup code.
21310
21311 @item handle_exception
21312 @findex handle_exception
21313 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
21314 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
21315 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
21316 run when a trap is triggered.
21317
21318 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
21319 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
21320 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
21321 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
21322 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
21323 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
21324 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
21325 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
21326 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
21327 machine.
21328
21329 @item breakpoint
21330 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
21331 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
21332 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
21333 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
21334 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
21335 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
21336 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
21337 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21338 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21339 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21340 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
21341
21342 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21343 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21344 start of your debugging session.
21345 @end table
21346
21347 @node Bootstrapping
21348 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21349
21350 @cindex remote stub, support routines
21351 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21352 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21353 debugging target machine.
21354
21355 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21356 serial port.
21357
21358 @table @code
21359 @item int getDebugChar()
21360 @findex getDebugChar
21361 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21362 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21363 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21364
21365 @item void putDebugChar(int)
21366 @findex putDebugChar
21367 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21368 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21369 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21370 @end table
21371
21372 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
21373 @cindex interrupting remote targets
21374 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21375 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21376 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21377 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21378 remote system to stop.
21379
21380 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21381 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21382 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21383 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21384
21385 Other routines you need to supply are:
21386
21387 @table @code
21388 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21389 @findex exceptionHandler
21390 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21391 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21392 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21393 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21394 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21395 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21396 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21397 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21398 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21399 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21400 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21401 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21402 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21403
21404 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21405 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21406 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21407 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21408 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21409
21410 @item void flush_i_cache()
21411 @findex flush_i_cache
21412 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21413 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21414 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21415
21416 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21417 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21418 @end table
21419
21420 @noindent
21421 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21422
21423 @table @code
21424 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21425 @findex memset
21426 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21427 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21428 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21429 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21430 @end table
21431
21432 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21433 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21434 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21435 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21436
21437
21438 @node Debug Session
21439 @subsection Putting it All Together
21440
21441 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
21442 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21443 steps.
21444
21445 @enumerate
21446 @item
21447 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21448 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21449 @display
21450 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21451 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21452 @end display
21453
21454 @item
21455 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21456 procedure is called:
21457
21458 @smallexample
21459 set_debug_traps();
21460 breakpoint();
21461 @end smallexample
21462
21463 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21464 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21465 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21466 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21467 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21468 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21469 progress.
21470
21471 @item
21472 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21473 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21474
21475 @smallexample
21476 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21477 @end smallexample
21478
21479 @noindent
21480 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21481 function in your program, that function is called when
21482 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21483 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21484 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21485
21486 @item
21487 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21488 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21489
21490 @item
21491 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21492 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21493
21494 @item
21495 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21496 @c document that. FIXME.
21497 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21498 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21499
21500 @item
21501 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21502 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21503
21504 @end enumerate
21505
21506 @node Configurations
21507 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21508
21509 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21510 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21511 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21512
21513 There are three major categories of configurations: native
21514 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21515 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21516 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21517 are quite different from each other.
21518
21519 @menu
21520 * Native::
21521 * Embedded OS::
21522 * Embedded Processors::
21523 * Architectures::
21524 @end menu
21525
21526 @node Native
21527 @section Native
21528
21529 This section describes details specific to particular native
21530 configurations.
21531
21532 @menu
21533 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21534 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
21535 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21536 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21537 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21538 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21539 @end menu
21540
21541 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21542 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21543
21544 @cindex libkvm
21545 @cindex kernel memory image
21546 @cindex kernel crash dump
21547
21548 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21549 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21550 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21551 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21552 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21553 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21554 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21555 @code{kvm} target:
21556
21557 @smallexample
21558 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21559 @end smallexample
21560
21561 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21562 argument:
21563
21564 @smallexample
21565 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21566 @end smallexample
21567
21568 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21569 available:
21570
21571 @table @code
21572 @kindex kvm
21573 @item kvm pcb
21574 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21575
21576 @item kvm proc
21577 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21578 modern FreeBSD systems.
21579 @end table
21580
21581 @node SVR4 Process Information
21582 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
21583 @cindex /proc
21584 @cindex examine process image
21585 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21586
21587 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21588 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21589 process using file-system subroutines.
21590
21591 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21592 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21593 information about the process running your program, or about any
21594 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21595 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21596
21597 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21598 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21599
21600 @table @code
21601 @kindex info proc
21602 @cindex process ID
21603 @item info proc
21604 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21605 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21606 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21607 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21608 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21609 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21610 executable file's absolute file name.
21611
21612 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21613 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21614 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21615 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21616 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21617 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21618
21619 @item info proc cmdline
21620 @cindex info proc cmdline
21621 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21622 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21623
21624 @item info proc cwd
21625 @cindex info proc cwd
21626 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21627 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21628
21629 @item info proc exe
21630 @cindex info proc exe
21631 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21632 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21633
21634 @item info proc mappings
21635 @cindex memory address space mappings
21636 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21637 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21638 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21639 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21640 memory access rights to that range.
21641
21642 @item info proc stat
21643 @itemx info proc status
21644 @cindex process detailed status information
21645 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21646 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21647 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21648 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21649 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21650 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21651 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21652
21653 @item info proc all
21654 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21655 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21656
21657 @ignore
21658 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21659 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21660 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21661 @kindex info proc times
21662 @item info proc times
21663 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21664 its children.
21665
21666 @kindex info proc id
21667 @item info proc id
21668 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21669 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21670 @end ignore
21671
21672 @item set procfs-trace
21673 @kindex set procfs-trace
21674 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21675 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21676
21677 @item show procfs-trace
21678 @kindex show procfs-trace
21679 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21680
21681 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21682 @kindex set procfs-file
21683 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21684 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21685 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21686 standard output.
21687
21688 @item show procfs-file
21689 @kindex show procfs-file
21690 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21691
21692 @item proc-trace-entry
21693 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21694 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21695 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21696 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21697 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21698 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21699 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21700 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21701 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21702
21703 @item info pidlist
21704 @kindex info pidlist
21705 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21706 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21707 processes and all the threads within each process.
21708
21709 @item info meminfo
21710 @kindex info meminfo
21711 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21712 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21713 @end table
21714
21715 @node DJGPP Native
21716 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21717 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21718 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21719 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21720
21721 @cindex DPMI
21722 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21723 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21724 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21725 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21726
21727 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21728 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21729 subsection describes those commands.
21730
21731 @table @code
21732 @kindex info dos
21733 @item info dos
21734 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21735 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21736
21737 @kindex sysinfo
21738 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21739 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21740 @item info dos sysinfo
21741 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21742 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21743 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21744
21745 @cindex GDT
21746 @cindex LDT
21747 @cindex IDT
21748 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21749 @cindex descriptor tables display
21750 @item info dos gdt
21751 @itemx info dos ldt
21752 @itemx info dos idt
21753 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21754 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21755 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21756 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21757 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21758 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21759 rights.
21760
21761 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21762 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21763 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21764 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21765 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21766
21767 @cindex garbled pointers
21768 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21769 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21770 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21771 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21772 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21773 debugged program's data segment:
21774
21775 @smallexample
21776 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21777 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21778 @end smallexample
21779
21780 @noindent
21781 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21782 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21783
21784 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21785 @item info dos pde
21786 @itemx info dos pte
21787 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21788 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21789 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21790 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21791 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21792 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21793 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21794 that is currently in use.
21795
21796 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21797 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21798 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21799 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21800 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21801 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21802 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21803
21804 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21805 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21806 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21807 controller.
21808
21809 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21810
21811 @cindex physical address from linear address
21812 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21813 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21814 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21815 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21816 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21817 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21818 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21819
21820 @smallexample
21821 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21822 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21823 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21824 @end smallexample
21825
21826 @noindent
21827 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21828 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21829 attributes of that page.
21830
21831 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21832 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21833 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21834 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21835 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21836 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21837
21838 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21839 transfer buffer:
21840
21841 @smallexample
21842 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21843 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21844 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21845 @end smallexample
21846
21847 @noindent
21848 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21849 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21850 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21851 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21852 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21853
21854 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21855 @end table
21856
21857 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21858 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21859 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21860 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21861
21862 @table @code
21863 @kindex set com1base
21864 @kindex set com1irq
21865 @kindex set com2base
21866 @kindex set com2irq
21867 @kindex set com3base
21868 @kindex set com3irq
21869 @kindex set com4base
21870 @kindex set com4irq
21871 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21872 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21873 port.
21874
21875 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21876 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21877 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21878
21879 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21880 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21881 other 3 COM ports.
21882
21883 @kindex show com1base
21884 @kindex show com1irq
21885 @kindex show com2base
21886 @kindex show com2irq
21887 @kindex show com3base
21888 @kindex show com3irq
21889 @kindex show com4base
21890 @kindex show com4irq
21891 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21892 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21893 lines used by the COM ports.
21894
21895 @item info serial
21896 @kindex info serial
21897 @cindex DOS serial port status
21898 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21899 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21900 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21901 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21902 @end table
21903
21904
21905 @node Cygwin Native
21906 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21907 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21908 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21909 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21910
21911 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21912 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21913
21914 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21915 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21916 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21917 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21918 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21919 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21920 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21921 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21922
21923 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21924 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21925 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21926
21927 @table @code
21928 @kindex info w32
21929 @item info w32
21930 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21931 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21932
21933 @item info w32 selector
21934 This command displays information returned by
21935 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21936 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21937 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21938 Without argument, this command displays information
21939 about the six segment registers.
21940
21941 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21942 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21943 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21944 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21945
21946 @kindex signal-event
21947 @item signal-event @var{id}
21948 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
21949 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
21950
21951 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
21952 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
21953 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
21954 (for x86_64 versions):
21955
21956 @itemize @minus
21957 @item
21958 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
21959 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
21960 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
21961
21962 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
21963 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
21964 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
21965 to attach.
21966
21967 @item
21968 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
21969 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
21970 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
21971 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
21972 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
21973 @end itemize
21974
21975 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21976 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21977 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21978 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21979 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21980 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21981 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21982 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21983 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21984 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21985 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21986
21987 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21988 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21989 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21990 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21991
21992 @kindex set new-console
21993 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21994 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21995 be started in a new console on next start.
21996 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21997 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21998
21999 @kindex show new-console
22000 @item show new-console
22001 Displays whether a new console is used
22002 when the debuggee is started.
22003
22004 @kindex set new-group
22005 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22006 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22007 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22008 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22009 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22010
22011 @kindex show new-group
22012 @item show new-group
22013 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22014
22015 @kindex set debugevents
22016 @item set debugevents
22017 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22018 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22019 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22020 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22021 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22022
22023 @kindex set debugexec
22024 @item set debugexec
22025 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22026 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22027
22028 @kindex set debugexceptions
22029 @item set debugexceptions
22030 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22031 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22032
22033 @kindex set debugmemory
22034 @item set debugmemory
22035 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22036 and writes by the debugger.
22037
22038 @kindex set shell
22039 @item set shell
22040 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22041 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22042
22043 @kindex show shell
22044 @item show shell
22045 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22046
22047 @end table
22048
22049 @menu
22050 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22051 @end menu
22052
22053 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22054 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22055 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22056 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22057
22058 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22059 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22060 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22061 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22062 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22063 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22064 ``minimal symbols''.
22065
22066 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22067 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22068 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22069 program run once to completion.
22070
22071 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22072
22073 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22074 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22075 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22076 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22077 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22078 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22079 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22080 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22081 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22082
22083 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22084 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22085 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22086 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22087 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22088 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22089
22090 @smallexample
22091 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22092 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22093
22094 Non-debugging symbols:
22095 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22096 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22097 @end smallexample
22098
22099 @smallexample
22100 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22101 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22102
22103 Non-debugging symbols:
22104 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22105 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22106 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22107 [etc...]
22108 @end smallexample
22109
22110 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22111
22112 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22113 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22114 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22115 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22116 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22117 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22118 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22119
22120 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22121 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22122 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22123 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22124 problem:
22125
22126 @smallexample
22127 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22128 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22129 @end smallexample
22130
22131 @smallexample
22132 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22133 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22134 @end smallexample
22135
22136 And two possible solutions:
22137
22138 @smallexample
22139 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22140 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22141 @end smallexample
22142
22143 @smallexample
22144 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
22145 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22146 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22147 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22148 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22149 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22150 @end smallexample
22151
22152 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22153 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22154 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22155 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22156 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22157
22158 @smallexample
22159 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22160 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22161 @end smallexample
22162
22163 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22164 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
22165 safe.
22166
22167 @node Hurd Native
22168 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
22169 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
22170
22171 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
22172 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
22173
22174 @table @code
22175 @item set signals
22176 @itemx set sigs
22177 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
22178 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22179 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
22180 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
22181 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
22182 @code{signals}.
22183
22184 @item show signals
22185 @itemx show sigs
22186 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22187 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22188 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22189
22190 @item set signal-thread
22191 @itemx set sigthread
22192 @kindex set signal-thread
22193 @kindex set sigthread
22194 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22195 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22196 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22197 signal-thread}.
22198
22199 @item show signal-thread
22200 @itemx show sigthread
22201 @kindex show signal-thread
22202 @kindex show sigthread
22203 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22204 delivered a signal.
22205
22206 @item set stopped
22207 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22208 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22209 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22210 continued by delivering a signal to it.
22211
22212 @item show stopped
22213 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22214 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22215 stopped.
22216
22217 @item set exceptions
22218 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22219 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
22220 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
22221 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
22222 trapping on.
22223
22224 @item show exceptions
22225 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22226 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
22227
22228 @item set task pause
22229 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
22230 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22231 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22232 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
22233 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
22234 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
22235 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
22236 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
22237 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
22238
22239 @item show task pause
22240 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
22241 Show the current state of task suspension.
22242
22243 @item set task detach-suspend-count
22244 @cindex task suspend count
22245 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22246 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
22247 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
22248
22249 @item show task detach-suspend-count
22250 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
22251
22252 @item set task exception-port
22253 @itemx set task excp
22254 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22255 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
22256 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
22257 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
22258
22259 @item set noninvasive
22260 @cindex noninvasive task options
22261 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
22262 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
22263 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
22264 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
22265
22266 @item info send-rights
22267 @itemx info receive-rights
22268 @itemx info port-rights
22269 @itemx info port-sets
22270 @itemx info dead-names
22271 @itemx info ports
22272 @itemx info psets
22273 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22274 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22275 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22276 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22277 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22278 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
22279 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
22280 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
22281 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
22282
22283 @item set thread pause
22284 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
22285 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22286 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22287 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
22288 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
22289 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
22290 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
22291 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
22292 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
22293 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
22294 only the current thread.
22295
22296 @item show thread pause
22297 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
22298 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
22299
22300 @item set thread run
22301 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22302
22303 @item show thread run
22304 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22305
22306 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
22307 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22308 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22309 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
22310 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
22311 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
22312 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
22313
22314 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
22315 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
22316 detaching.
22317
22318 @item set thread exception-port
22319 @itemx set thread excp
22320 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
22321 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
22322 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
22323
22324 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
22325 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
22326 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
22327 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
22328
22329 @item set thread default
22330 @itemx show thread default
22331 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22332 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
22333 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
22334 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
22335 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
22336 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
22337 the non-default commands.
22338 @end table
22339
22340 @node Darwin
22341 @subsection Darwin
22342 @cindex Darwin
22343
22344 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22345
22346 @table @code
22347 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
22348 @kindex set debug darwin
22349 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
22350 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
22351
22352 @item show debug darwin
22353 @kindex show debug darwin
22354 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
22355
22356 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
22357 @kindex set debug mach-o
22358 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22359 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22360 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
22361 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
22362 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22363 usage.
22364
22365 @item show debug mach-o
22366 @kindex show debug mach-o
22367 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22368
22369 @item set mach-exceptions on
22370 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
22371 @kindex set mach-exceptions
22372 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22373 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
22374 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
22375 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
22376
22377 @item show mach-exceptions
22378 @kindex show mach-exceptions
22379 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
22380 @end table
22381
22382
22383 @node Embedded OS
22384 @section Embedded Operating Systems
22385
22386 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
22387 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
22388 architectures.
22389
22390 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
22391 various real-time operating systems.
22392
22393 @node Embedded Processors
22394 @section Embedded Processors
22395
22396 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22397 configurations.
22398
22399 @cindex send command to simulator
22400 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22401 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22402
22403 @table @code
22404 @item sim @var{command}
22405 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
22406 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22407 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22408 acceptable commands.
22409 @end table
22410
22411
22412 @menu
22413 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
22414 * ARM:: ARM
22415 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
22416 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22417 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22418 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22419 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
22420 * CRIS:: CRIS
22421 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22422 @end menu
22423
22424 @node ARC
22425 @subsection Synopsys ARC
22426 @cindex Synopsys ARC
22427 @cindex ARC specific commands
22428 @cindex ARC600
22429 @cindex ARC700
22430 @cindex ARC EM
22431 @cindex ARC HS
22432
22433 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
22434
22435 @table @code
22436 @item set debug arc
22437 @kindex set debug arc
22438 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
22439 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
22440
22441 @item show debug arc
22442 @kindex show debug arc
22443 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
22444
22445 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
22446 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
22447 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
22448
22449 @end table
22450
22451 @node ARM
22452 @subsection ARM
22453
22454 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22455
22456 @table @code
22457 @item set arm disassembler
22458 @kindex set arm
22459 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
22460 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22461
22462 @item show arm disassembler
22463 @kindex show arm
22464 Show the current disassembly style.
22465
22466 @item set arm apcs32
22467 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22468 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22469
22470 @item show arm apcs32
22471 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22472
22473 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22474 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
22475 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22476
22477 @table @code
22478 @item auto
22479 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22480 @item softfpa
22481 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22482 processors.
22483 @item fpa
22484 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22485 @item softvfp
22486 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22487 @item vfp
22488 VFP co-processor.
22489 @end table
22490
22491 @item show arm fpu
22492 Show the current type of the FPU.
22493
22494 @item set arm abi
22495 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22496
22497 @item show arm abi
22498 Show the currently used ABI.
22499
22500 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22501 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22502 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22503 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22504 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22505 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22506 register).
22507
22508 @item show arm fallback-mode
22509 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22510
22511 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22512 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22513 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22514 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22515 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22516
22517 @item show arm force-mode
22518 Show the current forced instruction mode.
22519
22520 @item set debug arm
22521 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22522 target support subsystem.
22523
22524 @item show debug arm
22525 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22526 @end table
22527
22528 @table @code
22529 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22530 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22531
22532 @table @code
22533 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
22534 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22535 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22536 The default value is @code{all}.
22537
22538 @table @code
22539 @item none
22540 @item demon
22541 @item angel
22542 @item redboot
22543 @item all
22544 @end table
22545 @end table
22546 @end table
22547
22548 @node M68K
22549 @subsection M68k
22550
22551 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22552
22553 @node MicroBlaze
22554 @subsection MicroBlaze
22555 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22556 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22557
22558 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22559 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22560 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22561 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22562 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22563 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22564 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22565 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22566 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22567 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22568 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22569
22570 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22571
22572 @table @code
22573 @item target remote :1234
22574 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22575 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22576
22577 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22578 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22579 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22580
22581 @item load
22582 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22583
22584 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22585 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22586
22587 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22588 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22589 @end table
22590
22591 @node MIPS Embedded
22592 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22593
22594 @noindent
22595 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22596
22597 @table @code
22598 @item set mipsfpu double
22599 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22600 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22601 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22602 @itemx show mipsfpu
22603 @kindex set mipsfpu
22604 @kindex show mipsfpu
22605 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22606 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22607 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22608 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22609 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22610 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22611 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22612 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22613 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22614 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22615 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22616 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22617 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22618
22619 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22620 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22621 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22622
22623 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22624 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22625 @end table
22626
22627 @node PowerPC Embedded
22628 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22629
22630 @cindex DVC register
22631 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22632 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22633
22634 @smallexample
22635 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22636 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22637 @end smallexample
22638
22639 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22640 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22641 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22642 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22643 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22644 or newer.
22645
22646 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22647 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22648 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22649 watching variables of scalar types.
22650
22651 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22652 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22653
22654 @smallexample
22655 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22656 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22657 @end smallexample
22658
22659 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22660 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22661
22662 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22663 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22664 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22665 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22666 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22667 use the @code{break-range} command.
22668
22669 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22670
22671 @table @code
22672 @kindex break-range
22673 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22674 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22675 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22676 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22677 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22678 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22679 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22680 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22681 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22682
22683 @kindex set powerpc
22684 @item set powerpc soft-float
22685 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22686 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22687 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22688 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22689
22690 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22691 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22692 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22693 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22694 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22695 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22696 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22697 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22698
22699 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22700 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22701 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22702 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22703 address of its first byte.
22704
22705 @end table
22706
22707 @node AVR
22708 @subsection Atmel AVR
22709 @cindex AVR
22710
22711 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22712 following AVR-specific commands:
22713
22714 @table @code
22715 @item info io_registers
22716 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22717 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22718 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22719 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22720 @end table
22721
22722 @node CRIS
22723 @subsection CRIS
22724 @cindex CRIS
22725
22726 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22727 following CRIS-specific commands:
22728
22729 @table @code
22730 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22731 @cindex CRIS version
22732 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22733 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22734 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22735
22736 @item show cris-version
22737 Show the current CRIS version.
22738
22739 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22740 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22741 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22742 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22743 @code{R59}.
22744
22745 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22746 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22747
22748 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22749 @cindex CRIS mode
22750 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22751 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22752 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22753
22754 @item show cris-mode
22755 Show the current CRIS mode.
22756 @end table
22757
22758 @node Super-H
22759 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22760 @cindex Super-H
22761
22762 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22763 commands:
22764
22765 @table @code
22766 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22767 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22768 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22769 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22770 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22771 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22772 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22773 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22774 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22775 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22776 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22777 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22778
22779 @item show sh calling-convention
22780 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22781 Show the current calling convention setting.
22782
22783 @end table
22784
22785
22786 @node Architectures
22787 @section Architectures
22788
22789 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22790 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22791
22792 @menu
22793 * AArch64::
22794 * i386::
22795 * Alpha::
22796 * MIPS::
22797 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22798 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22799 * PowerPC::
22800 * Nios II::
22801 * Sparc64::
22802 @end menu
22803
22804 @node AArch64
22805 @subsection AArch64
22806 @cindex AArch64 support
22807
22808 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22809 following special commands:
22810
22811 @table @code
22812 @item set debug aarch64
22813 @kindex set debug aarch64
22814 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22815 messages are to be displayed.
22816
22817 @item show debug aarch64
22818 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22819
22820 @end table
22821
22822 @node i386
22823 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22824
22825 @table @code
22826 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22827 @kindex set struct-convention
22828 @cindex struct return convention
22829 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22830 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22831 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22832 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22833 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22834 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22835 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22836 be returned in a register.
22837
22838 @item show struct-convention
22839 @kindex show struct-convention
22840 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22841 from functions.
22842 @end table
22843
22844
22845 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22846 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22847
22848 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22849 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22850 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22851 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22852 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22853 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22854 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22855
22856 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22857 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22858 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22859 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22860 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22861 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22862
22863 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22864 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22865 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22866
22867 @smallexample
22868 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22869 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22870 @end smallexample
22871
22872 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22873 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22874 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22875 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22876 the pointer.
22877
22878 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22879 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22880 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22881 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22882 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22883
22884 @table @code
22885 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22886 @kindex show mpx bound
22887 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22888
22889 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22890 @kindex set mpx bound
22891 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22892 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22893 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22894 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22895 @end table
22896
22897 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
22898 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
22899 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
22900 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
22901
22902 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
22903 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
22904 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
22905 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
22906 function.
22907
22908 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
22909 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
22910 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
22911 continuing the execution. For example:
22912
22913 @smallexample
22914 $ break *upper
22915 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
22916 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
22917 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
22918 $ print $bnd0
22919 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
22920 @end smallexample
22921
22922 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
22923 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
22924 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
22925
22926 @node Alpha
22927 @subsection Alpha
22928
22929 See the following section.
22930
22931 @node MIPS
22932 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22933
22934 @cindex stack on Alpha
22935 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22936 @cindex Alpha stack
22937 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22938 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22939 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22940 find the beginning of a function.
22941
22942 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22943 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22944 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22945 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22946 commands:
22947
22948 @table @code
22949 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22950 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22951 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22952 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22953 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22954 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22955 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22956 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22957
22958 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22959 Display the current limit.
22960 @end table
22961
22962 @noindent
22963 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22964 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22965
22966 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22967 programs:
22968
22969 @table @code
22970 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22971 @kindex set mips abi
22972 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22973 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22974 values of @var{arg} are:
22975
22976 @table @samp
22977 @item auto
22978 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22979 default).
22980 @item o32
22981 @item o64
22982 @item n32
22983 @item n64
22984 @item eabi32
22985 @item eabi64
22986 @end table
22987
22988 @item show mips abi
22989 @kindex show mips abi
22990 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22991
22992 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22993 @kindex set mips compression
22994 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22995 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22996 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22997 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22998 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22999 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23000 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23001 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23002 provided by the executable.
23003
23004 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23005 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23006 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23007 identified as such.
23008
23009 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23010 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23011 implicitly from an executable.
23012
23013 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23014 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23015 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23016 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23017 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23018
23019 @item show mips compression
23020 @kindex show mips compression
23021 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23022 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23023
23024 @item set mipsfpu
23025 @itemx show mipsfpu
23026 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23027
23028 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23029 @kindex set mips mask-address
23030 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23031 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23032 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23033 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23034 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23035
23036 @item show mips mask-address
23037 @kindex show mips mask-address
23038 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23039 not.
23040
23041 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23042 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23043 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23044 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23045 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23046 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23047
23048 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23049 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23050 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23051
23052 @item set debug mips
23053 @kindex set debug mips
23054 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
23055 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23056
23057 @item show debug mips
23058 @kindex show debug mips
23059 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
23060 @end table
23061
23062
23063 @node HPPA
23064 @subsection HPPA
23065 @cindex HPPA support
23066
23067 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
23068 following special commands:
23069
23070 @table @code
23071 @item set debug hppa
23072 @kindex set debug hppa
23073 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
23074 messages are to be displayed.
23075
23076 @item show debug hppa
23077 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
23078
23079 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
23080 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
23081 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
23082 given @var{address}.
23083
23084 @end table
23085
23086
23087 @node SPU
23088 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23089 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
23090 @cindex SPU
23091
23092 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
23093 it provides the following special commands:
23094
23095 @table @code
23096 @item info spu event
23097 @kindex info spu
23098 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
23099 and pending event status.
23100
23101 @item info spu signal
23102 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
23103 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
23104 notification channels.
23105
23106 @item info spu mailbox
23107 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
23108 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
23109 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
23110
23111 @item info spu dma
23112 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23113 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23114 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23115
23116 @item info spu proxydma
23117 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23118 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23119 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23120
23121 @end table
23122
23123 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
23124 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
23125 special commands:
23126
23127 @table @code
23128 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
23129 @kindex set spu
23130 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
23131 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
23132 function. The default is @code{off}.
23133
23134 @item show spu stop-on-load
23135 @kindex show spu
23136 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
23137
23138 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
23139 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
23140 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
23141 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
23142 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
23143 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
23144
23145 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
23146 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
23147
23148 @end table
23149
23150 @node PowerPC
23151 @subsection PowerPC
23152 @cindex PowerPC architecture
23153
23154 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
23155 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
23156 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
23157 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
23158 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
23159
23160 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
23161 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
23162 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
23163
23164 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
23165 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
23166
23167 @node Nios II
23168 @subsection Nios II
23169 @cindex Nios II architecture
23170
23171 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
23172 it provides the following special commands:
23173
23174 @table @code
23175
23176 @item set debug nios2
23177 @kindex set debug nios2
23178 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
23179 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23180
23181 @item show debug nios2
23182 @kindex show debug nios2
23183 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
23184 @end table
23185
23186 @node Sparc64
23187 @subsection Sparc64
23188 @cindex Sparc64 support
23189 @cindex Application Data Integrity
23190 @subsubsection ADI Support
23191
23192 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
23193 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
23194 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
23195 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
23196 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
23197 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
23198 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
23199 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
23200 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
23201 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
23202 signal.
23203
23204 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
23205 ADI-enabled.
23206
23207 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
23208 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
23209
23210
23211 @table @code
23212 @kindex adi examine
23213 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
23214
23215 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
23216 cacheline.
23217
23218 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
23219 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
23220 block size, to display.
23221
23222 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23223 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
23224
23225 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
23226
23227 @smallexample
23228 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23229 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
23230 @end smallexample
23231
23232 @kindex adi assign
23233 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
23234
23235 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
23236 to an address.
23237
23238 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
23239 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
23240 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
23241
23242 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23243 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
23244
23245 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
23246
23247 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
23248 variable "shmaddr":
23249
23250 @smallexample
23251 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
23252 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23253 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
23254 @end smallexample
23255
23256 @end table
23257
23258 @node Controlling GDB
23259 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
23260
23261 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
23262 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
23263 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
23264 described here.
23265
23266 @menu
23267 * Prompt:: Prompt
23268 * Editing:: Command editing
23269 * Command History:: Command history
23270 * Screen Size:: Screen size
23271 * Numbers:: Numbers
23272 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
23273 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
23274 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
23275 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
23276 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
23277 @end menu
23278
23279 @node Prompt
23280 @section Prompt
23281
23282 @cindex prompt
23283
23284 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
23285 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
23286 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
23287 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
23288 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
23289 which one you are talking to.
23290
23291 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
23292 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
23293 or a prompt that does not.
23294
23295 @table @code
23296 @kindex set prompt
23297 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
23298 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
23299
23300 @kindex show prompt
23301 @item show prompt
23302 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
23303 @end table
23304
23305 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
23306 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
23307 are:
23308
23309 @table @code
23310 @kindex set extended-prompt
23311 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
23312 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
23313 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
23314 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
23315 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
23316 is displayed.
23317
23318 For example:
23319
23320 @smallexample
23321 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
23322 @end smallexample
23323
23324 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
23325 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
23326
23327 @kindex show extended-prompt
23328 @item show extended-prompt
23329 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
23330 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
23331 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
23332 @end table
23333
23334 @node Editing
23335 @section Command Editing
23336 @cindex readline
23337 @cindex command line editing
23338
23339 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
23340 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
23341 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
23342 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
23343 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
23344 debugging sessions.
23345
23346 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
23347 command @code{set}.
23348
23349 @table @code
23350 @kindex set editing
23351 @cindex editing
23352 @item set editing
23353 @itemx set editing on
23354 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
23355
23356 @item set editing off
23357 Disable command line editing.
23358
23359 @kindex show editing
23360 @item show editing
23361 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
23362 @end table
23363
23364 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23365 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
23366 @end ifset
23367 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23368 @xref{Command Line Editing},
23369 @end ifclear
23370 for more details about the Readline
23371 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
23372 encouraged to read that chapter.
23373
23374 @node Command History
23375 @section Command History
23376 @cindex command history
23377
23378 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
23379 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
23380 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
23381 history facility.
23382
23383 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
23384 package, to provide the history facility.
23385 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23386 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
23387 @end ifset
23388 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23389 @xref{Using History Interactively},
23390 @end ifclear
23391 for the detailed description of the History library.
23392
23393 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
23394 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
23395 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
23396 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
23397 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
23398 pressed on a line by itself.
23399
23400 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
23401 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
23402 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
23403 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
23404
23405 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
23406 history.
23407
23408 @table @code
23409 @cindex history substitution
23410 @cindex history file
23411 @kindex set history filename
23412 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
23413 @item set history filename @var{fname}
23414 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
23415 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
23416 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
23417 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
23418 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
23419 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
23420 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
23421 is not set.
23422
23423 @cindex save command history
23424 @kindex set history save
23425 @item set history save
23426 @itemx set history save on
23427 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
23428 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
23429
23430 @item set history save off
23431 Stop recording command history in a file.
23432
23433 @cindex history size
23434 @kindex set history size
23435 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
23436 @item set history size @var{size}
23437 @itemx set history size unlimited
23438 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
23439 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
23440 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
23441 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
23442 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
23443 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
23444
23445 @cindex remove duplicate history
23446 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
23447 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
23448 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
23449 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
23450 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
23451 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
23452 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
23453 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
23454 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
23455
23456 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
23457 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
23458
23459 @end table
23460
23461 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
23462 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23463 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
23464 @end ifset
23465 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23466 @xref{Event Designators},
23467 @end ifclear
23468 for more details.
23469
23470 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
23471 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
23472 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
23473 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
23474 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
23475 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
23476 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
23477 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
23478
23479 The commands to control history expansion are:
23480
23481 @table @code
23482 @item set history expansion on
23483 @itemx set history expansion
23484 @kindex set history expansion
23485 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
23486
23487 @item set history expansion off
23488 Disable history expansion.
23489
23490 @c @group
23491 @kindex show history
23492 @item show history
23493 @itemx show history filename
23494 @itemx show history save
23495 @itemx show history size
23496 @itemx show history expansion
23497 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
23498 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
23499 @c @end group
23500 @end table
23501
23502 @table @code
23503 @kindex show commands
23504 @cindex show last commands
23505 @cindex display command history
23506 @item show commands
23507 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
23508
23509 @item show commands @var{n}
23510 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
23511
23512 @item show commands +
23513 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
23514 @end table
23515
23516 @node Screen Size
23517 @section Screen Size
23518 @cindex size of screen
23519 @cindex screen size
23520 @cindex pagination
23521 @cindex page size
23522 @cindex pauses in output
23523
23524 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23525 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
23526 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23527 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23528 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
23529 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
23530 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23531 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23532
23533 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23534 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23535 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23536 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23537 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23538 width} commands:
23539
23540 @table @code
23541 @kindex set height
23542 @kindex set width
23543 @kindex show width
23544 @kindex show height
23545 @item set height @var{lpp}
23546 @itemx set height unlimited
23547 @itemx show height
23548 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
23549 @itemx set width unlimited
23550 @itemx show width
23551 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23552 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23553 commands display the current settings.
23554
23555 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23556 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23557 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23558 buffer.
23559
23560 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23561 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23562
23563 @item set pagination on
23564 @itemx set pagination off
23565 @kindex set pagination
23566 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23567 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23568 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23569 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23570
23571 @item show pagination
23572 @kindex show pagination
23573 Show the current pagination mode.
23574 @end table
23575
23576 @node Numbers
23577 @section Numbers
23578 @cindex number representation
23579 @cindex entering numbers
23580
23581 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23582 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23583 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23584 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23585 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23586 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23587 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23588 both input and output with the commands described below.
23589
23590 @table @code
23591 @kindex set input-radix
23592 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23593 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23594 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23595 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23596 example, any of
23597
23598 @smallexample
23599 set input-radix 012
23600 set input-radix 10.
23601 set input-radix 0xa
23602 @end smallexample
23603
23604 @noindent
23605 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23606 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23607 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23608 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23609 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23610 change the radix.
23611
23612 @kindex set output-radix
23613 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23614 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23615 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23616 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23617
23618 @kindex show input-radix
23619 @item show input-radix
23620 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23621
23622 @kindex show output-radix
23623 @item show output-radix
23624 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23625
23626 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23627 @itemx show radix
23628 @kindex set radix
23629 @kindex show radix
23630 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23631 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23632 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23633 default value of 10.
23634
23635 @end table
23636
23637 @node ABI
23638 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23639
23640 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23641 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23642 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23643 current ABI.
23644
23645 @cindex OS ABI
23646 @kindex set osabi
23647 @kindex show osabi
23648 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23649
23650 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23651 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23652 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23653 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23654 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23655 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23656 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23657 platform provides.
23658
23659 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23660 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23661 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23662 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23663
23664 @table @code
23665 @item show osabi
23666 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23667
23668 @item set osabi
23669 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23670
23671 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23672 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23673 @end table
23674
23675 @cindex float promotion
23676
23677 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23678 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23679 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23680 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23681 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23682 @code{double} and then passed.
23683
23684 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23685 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23686 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23687
23688 @table @code
23689 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23690 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23691 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23692 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23693 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23694
23695 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23696 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23697 functions.
23698
23699 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23700 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23701 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23702 @end table
23703
23704 @kindex set cp-abi
23705 @kindex show cp-abi
23706 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23707 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23708 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23709 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23710 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23711 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23712 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23713 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23714 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23715 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23716 ``auto''.
23717
23718 @table @code
23719 @item show cp-abi
23720 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23721
23722 @item set cp-abi
23723 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23724
23725 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23726 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23727 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23728 @end table
23729
23730 @node Auto-loading
23731 @section Automatically loading associated files
23732 @cindex auto-loading
23733
23734 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23735 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23736 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23737 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23738 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23739 sources).
23740
23741 @menu
23742 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23743 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23744
23745 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23746 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23747 @end menu
23748
23749 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23750 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23751 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23752
23753 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23754 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23755 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23756
23757 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23758 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23759
23760 @table @code
23761 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23762 @kindex set auto-load off
23763 @item set auto-load off
23764 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23765 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23766 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23767 @smallexample
23768 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23769 @end smallexample
23770
23771 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23772 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23773 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23774 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23775 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23776 @code{set auto-load no}.
23777
23778 @anchor{show auto-load}
23779 @kindex show auto-load
23780 @item show auto-load
23781 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23782 or disabled.
23783
23784 @smallexample
23785 (gdb) show auto-load
23786 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23787 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23788 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23789 is on.
23790 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23791 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23792 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23793 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23794 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23795 @end smallexample
23796
23797 @anchor{info auto-load}
23798 @kindex info auto-load
23799 @item info auto-load
23800 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23801 not.
23802
23803 @smallexample
23804 (gdb) info auto-load
23805 gdb-scripts:
23806 Loaded Script
23807 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23808 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23809 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23810 loaded.
23811 python-scripts:
23812 Loaded Script
23813 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23814 @end smallexample
23815 @end table
23816
23817 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23818
23819 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23820 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23821 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23822 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23823 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23824 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23825 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23826 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23827 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23828 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23829 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23830 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23831 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23832 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23833 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23834 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23835 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23836 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23837 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23838 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23839 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23840 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23841 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23842 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23843 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23844 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23845 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23846 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23847 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23848 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23849 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23850 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23851 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23852 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23853 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23854 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23855 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23856 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23857 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23858 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23859 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23860 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23861 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23862 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23863 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23864 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23865 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23866 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23867 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23868 @end multitable
23869
23870 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23871 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23872 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23873
23874 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23875 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23876 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23877
23878 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23879 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23880
23881 @table @code
23882 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23883 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23884 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23885 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23886 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23887
23888 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23889 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23890 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23891 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23892 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23893
23894 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23895 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23896 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23897 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23898 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23899 @end table
23900
23901 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23902 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23903 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23904
23905 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23906
23907 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23908 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23909
23910 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23911 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23912 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23913 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23914 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23915 library.
23916
23917 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23918 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23919
23920 @table @code
23921 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23922 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23923 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23924 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23925
23926 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23927 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23928 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23929 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23930 enabled or disabled.
23931
23932 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23933 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23934 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23935 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23936 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23937 @end table
23938
23939 @node Auto-loading safe path
23940 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23941 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23942
23943 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23944 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23945 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23946 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23947 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23948
23949 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23950 get loaded:
23951
23952 @smallexample
23953 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23954 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23955 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23956 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23957 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23958 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23959 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23960 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23961 @end smallexample
23962
23963 @noindent
23964 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23965 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23966
23967 @smallexample
23968 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23969 @end smallexample
23970
23971 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23972
23973 @table @code
23974 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23975 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23976 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23977 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23978 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23979 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23980 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23981 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23982 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23983 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23984
23985 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23986 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23987 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23988
23989 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23990 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23991 @item show auto-load safe-path
23992 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23993 scripts.
23994
23995 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23996 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23997 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23998 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23999 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
24000 by the host platform path separator in use.
24001 @end table
24002
24003 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
24004 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
24005 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24006 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
24007 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
24008
24009 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
24010 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
24011 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
24012 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
24013 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
24014 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
24015 init file in the current directory
24016 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
24017
24018 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
24019 example, you could use one of the following ways:
24020
24021 @table @asis
24022 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
24023 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
24024 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
24025 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
24026
24027 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
24028 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
24029 @value{GDBN} session.
24030
24031 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
24032 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24033 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
24034 from trusted sources.
24035
24036 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
24037 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
24038 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
24039 trusted sources.
24040 @end table
24041
24042 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
24043 also suppresses any such warning messages:
24044
24045 @table @asis
24046 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
24047 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24048
24049 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
24050 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
24051 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
24052 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
24053 @end table
24054
24055 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
24056 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
24057 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
24058 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
24059 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
24060 recommended to be entered.
24061
24062 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
24063 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
24064 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
24065
24066 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
24067 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
24068 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
24069 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
24070 be printed.
24071
24072 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24073 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
24074 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
24075
24076 @smallexample
24077 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
24078 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
24079 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
24080 for objfile "/tmp/true".
24081 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
24082 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
24083 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
24084 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
24085 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
24086 @end smallexample
24087
24088 @table @code
24089 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
24090 @kindex set debug auto-load
24091 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
24092 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
24093
24094 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
24095 @kindex show debug auto-load
24096 @item show debug auto-load
24097 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
24098 on or off.
24099 @end table
24100
24101 @node Messages/Warnings
24102 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
24103
24104 @cindex verbose operation
24105 @cindex optional warnings
24106 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
24107 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
24108 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
24109 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
24110
24111 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
24112 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
24113 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24114
24115 @table @code
24116 @kindex set verbose
24117 @item set verbose on
24118 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24119
24120 @item set verbose off
24121 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24122
24123 @kindex show verbose
24124 @item show verbose
24125 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
24126 @end table
24127
24128 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
24129 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
24130 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
24131 Symbol Files}).
24132
24133 @table @code
24134
24135 @kindex set complaints
24136 @item set complaints @var{limit}
24137 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
24138 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
24139 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
24140 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
24141
24142 @kindex show complaints
24143 @item show complaints
24144 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
24145
24146 @end table
24147
24148 @anchor{confirmation requests}
24149 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
24150 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
24151 you try to run a program which is already running:
24152
24153 @smallexample
24154 (@value{GDBP}) run
24155 The program being debugged has been started already.
24156 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
24157 @end smallexample
24158
24159 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
24160 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
24161
24162 @table @code
24163
24164 @kindex set confirm
24165 @cindex flinching
24166 @cindex confirmation
24167 @cindex stupid questions
24168 @item set confirm off
24169 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
24170 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
24171 automatically disables confirmation requests.
24172
24173 @item set confirm on
24174 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
24175
24176 @kindex show confirm
24177 @item show confirm
24178 Displays state of confirmation requests.
24179
24180 @end table
24181
24182 @cindex command tracing
24183 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
24184 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
24185 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
24186 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
24187
24188 @table @code
24189 @kindex set trace-commands
24190 @cindex command scripts, debugging
24191 @item set trace-commands on
24192 Enable command tracing.
24193 @item set trace-commands off
24194 Disable command tracing.
24195 @item show trace-commands
24196 Display the current state of command tracing.
24197 @end table
24198
24199 @node Debugging Output
24200 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
24201 @cindex optional debugging messages
24202
24203 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
24204 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
24205 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
24206 section documents those commands.
24207
24208 @table @code
24209 @kindex set exec-done-display
24210 @item set exec-done-display
24211 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
24212 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
24213 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
24214 @kindex show exec-done-display
24215 @item show exec-done-display
24216 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
24217 notification.
24218 @kindex set debug
24219 @cindex ARM AArch64
24220 @item set debug aarch64
24221 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
24222 The default is off.
24223 @kindex show debug
24224 @item show debug aarch64
24225 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24226 ARM AArch64.
24227 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
24228 @cindex architecture debugging info
24229 @item set debug arch
24230 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
24231 @item show debug arch
24232 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
24233 @item set debug aix-solib
24234 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
24235 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
24236 support module. The default is off.
24237 @item show debug aix-thread
24238 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
24239 @item set debug aix-thread
24240 @cindex AIX threads
24241 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
24242 module.
24243 @item show debug aix-thread
24244 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
24245 @item set debug check-physname
24246 @cindex physname
24247 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
24248 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
24249 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
24250 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
24251 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
24252 both ways and display any discrepancies.
24253 @item show debug check-physname
24254 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
24255 @item set debug coff-pe-read
24256 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
24257 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
24258 exported symbols. The default is off.
24259 @item show debug coff-pe-read
24260 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24261 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24262 @item set debug dwarf-die
24263 @cindex DWARF DIEs
24264 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
24265 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
24266 A value of zero turns off the display.
24267 @item show debug dwarf-die
24268 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
24269 @item set debug dwarf-line
24270 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
24271 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24272 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
24273 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24274 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24275 @item show debug dwarf-line
24276 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
24277 @item set debug dwarf-read
24278 @cindex DWARF Reading
24279 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24280 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
24281 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24282 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24283 @item show debug dwarf-read
24284 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
24285 @item set debug displaced
24286 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
24287 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
24288 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
24289 @item show debug displaced
24290 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
24291 related to displaced stepping.
24292 @item set debug event
24293 @cindex event debugging info
24294 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
24295 default is off.
24296 @item show debug event
24297 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
24298 info.
24299 @item set debug expression
24300 @cindex expression debugging info
24301 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
24302 expression parsing. The default is off.
24303 @item show debug expression
24304 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
24305 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
24306 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
24307 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
24308 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
24309 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
24310 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
24311 @item set debug frame
24312 @cindex frame debugging info
24313 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
24314 default is off.
24315 @item show debug frame
24316 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
24317 info.
24318 @item set debug gnu-nat
24319 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
24320 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
24321 @item show debug gnu-nat
24322 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
24323 @item set debug infrun
24324 @cindex inferior debugging info
24325 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
24326 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
24327 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
24328 @item show debug infrun
24329 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
24330 @item set debug jit
24331 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
24332 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
24333 @item show debug jit
24334 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
24335 @item set debug lin-lwp
24336 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
24337 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
24338 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
24339 @item show debug lin-lwp
24340 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
24341 @item set debug linux-namespaces
24342 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
24343 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
24344 @item show debug linux-namespaces
24345 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
24346 @item set debug mach-o
24347 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
24348 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
24349 processing. The default is off.
24350 @item show debug mach-o
24351 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24352 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24353 @item set debug notification
24354 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
24355 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
24356 The default is off.
24357 @item show debug notification
24358 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
24359 @item set debug observer
24360 @cindex observer debugging info
24361 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
24362 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
24363 @item show debug observer
24364 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
24365 @item set debug overload
24366 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
24367 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
24368 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
24369 is off.
24370 @item show debug overload
24371 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
24372 debugging info.
24373 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
24374 @cindex debug expression parser
24375 @item set debug parser
24376 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
24377 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
24378 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
24379 details. The default is off.
24380 @item show debug parser
24381 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
24382 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
24383 @cindex serial connections, debugging
24384 @cindex debug remote protocol
24385 @cindex remote protocol debugging
24386 @cindex display remote packets
24387 @item set debug remote
24388 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
24389 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
24390 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
24391 @item show debug remote
24392 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
24393
24394 @item set debug separate-debug-file
24395 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
24396 @item show debug separate-debug-file
24397 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
24398
24399 @item set debug serial
24400 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
24401 default is off.
24402 @item show debug serial
24403 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
24404 info.
24405 @item set debug solib-frv
24406 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
24407 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
24408 @item show debug solib-frv
24409 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
24410 messages.
24411 @item set debug symbol-lookup
24412 @cindex symbol lookup
24413 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
24414 The default is 0 (off).
24415 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24416 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24417 @item show debug symbol-lookup
24418 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
24419 @item set debug symfile
24420 @cindex symbol file functions
24421 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
24422 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
24423 @item show debug symfile
24424 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
24425 @item set debug symtab-create
24426 @cindex symbol table creation
24427 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
24428 The default is 0 (off).
24429 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24430 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24431 @item show debug symtab-create
24432 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
24433 @item set debug target
24434 @cindex target debugging info
24435 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
24436 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
24437 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
24438 value of large memory transfers.
24439 @item show debug target
24440 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
24441 info.
24442 @item set debug timestamp
24443 @cindex timestampping debugging info
24444 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
24445 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
24446 message.
24447 @item show debug timestamp
24448 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
24449 debugging info.
24450 @item set debug varobj
24451 @cindex variable object debugging info
24452 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
24453 info. The default is off.
24454 @item show debug varobj
24455 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
24456 debugging info.
24457 @item set debug xml
24458 @cindex XML parser debugging
24459 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
24460 @item show debug xml
24461 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
24462 @end table
24463
24464 @node Other Misc Settings
24465 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
24466 @cindex miscellaneous settings
24467
24468 @table @code
24469 @kindex set interactive-mode
24470 @item set interactive-mode
24471 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
24472 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
24473 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
24474 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
24475 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
24476 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
24477 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
24478 is, non-interactively otherwise.
24479
24480 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
24481 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
24482 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
24483 inside a cygwin window.
24484
24485 @kindex show interactive-mode
24486 @item show interactive-mode
24487 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
24488 @end table
24489
24490 @node Extending GDB
24491 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
24492 @cindex extending GDB
24493
24494 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
24495 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
24496 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
24497 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
24498 being debugged.
24499
24500 @menu
24501 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
24502 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
24503 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
24504 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
24505 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
24506 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
24507 @end menu
24508
24509 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
24510 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
24511 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
24512 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
24513 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24514 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
24515
24516 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
24517 setting:
24518
24519 @table @code
24520 @kindex set script-extension
24521 @kindex show script-extension
24522 @item set script-extension off
24523 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24524
24525 @item set script-extension soft
24526 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24527 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
24528 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
24529 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24530
24531 @item set script-extension strict
24532 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24533 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
24534 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24535
24536 @item show script-extension
24537 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24538
24539 @end table
24540
24541 @node Sequences
24542 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
24543
24544 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24545 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24546 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24547 files.
24548
24549 @menu
24550 * Define:: How to define your own commands
24551 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24552 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24553 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
24554 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24555 @end menu
24556
24557 @node Define
24558 @subsection User-defined Commands
24559
24560 @cindex user-defined command
24561 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24562 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24563 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24564 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
24565 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24566 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
24567
24568 @smallexample
24569 define adder
24570 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24571 end
24572 @end smallexample
24573
24574 @noindent
24575 To execute the command use:
24576
24577 @smallexample
24578 adder 1 2 3
24579 @end smallexample
24580
24581 @noindent
24582 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24583 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24584 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24585 functions calls.
24586
24587 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24588 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24589 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24590 been passed.
24591
24592 @smallexample
24593 define adder
24594 if $argc == 2
24595 print $arg0 + $arg1
24596 end
24597 if $argc == 3
24598 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24599 end
24600 end
24601 @end smallexample
24602
24603 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
24604 to process a variable number of arguments:
24605
24606 @smallexample
24607 define adder
24608 set $i = 0
24609 set $sum = 0
24610 while $i < $argc
24611 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
24612 set $i = $i + 1
24613 end
24614 print $sum
24615 end
24616 @end smallexample
24617
24618 @table @code
24619
24620 @kindex define
24621 @item define @var{commandname}
24622 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24623 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24624 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24625 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24626 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24627 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24628
24629 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24630 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24631 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24632
24633 @kindex document
24634 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24635 @item document @var{commandname}
24636 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24637 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24638 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24639 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24640 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24641 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24642
24643 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24644 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24645 does not change the documentation.
24646
24647 @kindex dont-repeat
24648 @cindex don't repeat command
24649 @item dont-repeat
24650 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24651 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24652 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24653
24654 @kindex help user-defined
24655 @item help user-defined
24656 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24657 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24658 included (if any).
24659
24660 @kindex show user
24661 @item show user
24662 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24663 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24664 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24665 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24666 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24667
24668 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24669 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24670 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24671 @item show max-user-call-depth
24672 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24673 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24674 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24675 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24676 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24677 @end table
24678
24679 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24680 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24681
24682 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24683 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24684 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24685
24686 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24687 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24688 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24689 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24690
24691 @node Hooks
24692 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24693 @cindex command hooks
24694 @cindex hooks, for commands
24695 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24696
24697 @kindex hook
24698 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24699 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24700 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24701 before that command.
24702
24703 @cindex hooks, post-command
24704 @kindex hookpost
24705 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24706 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24707 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24708 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24709 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24710
24711 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24712 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24713
24714 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24715 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24716
24717 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24718 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24719 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24720 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24721 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24722
24723 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24724 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24725 you could define:
24726
24727 @smallexample
24728 define hook-stop
24729 handle SIGALRM nopass
24730 end
24731
24732 define hook-run
24733 handle SIGALRM pass
24734 end
24735
24736 define hook-continue
24737 handle SIGALRM pass
24738 end
24739 @end smallexample
24740
24741 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24742 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24743 you could define:
24744
24745 @smallexample
24746 define hook-echo
24747 echo <<<---
24748 end
24749
24750 define hookpost-echo
24751 echo --->>>\n
24752 end
24753
24754 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24755 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24756 (@value{GDBP})
24757
24758 @end smallexample
24759
24760 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24761 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24762 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24763 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24764 @c or not?
24765 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24766 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24767 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24768
24769 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24770 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24771 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24772
24773 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24774 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24775
24776 @node Command Files
24777 @subsection Command Files
24778
24779 @cindex command files
24780 @cindex scripting commands
24781 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24782 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24783 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24784 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24785 terminal.
24786
24787 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24788 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24789 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24790 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24791 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24792
24793 @table @code
24794 @kindex source
24795 @cindex execute commands from a file
24796 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24797 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24798 @end table
24799
24800 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24801 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24802 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24803 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24804 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24805
24806 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24807 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24808 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24809 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24810 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24811 is not relevant to scripts.
24812
24813 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24814 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24815 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24816 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24817 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24818 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24819 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24820 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24821 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24822 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24823 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24824 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24825 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24826 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24827
24828 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24829 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24830 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24831
24832 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24833 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24834 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24835 when called from command files.
24836
24837 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24838 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24839 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24840 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24841 the next command.
24842
24843 @smallexample
24844 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24845 @end smallexample
24846
24847 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24848 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24849 would be directed to @file{log}.
24850
24851 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24852 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24853 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24854 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24855 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24856 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24857 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24858 conditionally, etc.
24859
24860 @table @code
24861 @kindex if
24862 @kindex else
24863 @item if
24864 @itemx else
24865 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24866 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24867 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24868 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24869 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24870 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24871 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24872
24873 @kindex while
24874 @item while
24875 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24876 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24877 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24878 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24879 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24880 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24881
24882 @kindex loop_break
24883 @item loop_break
24884 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24885 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24886 line.
24887
24888 @kindex loop_continue
24889 @item loop_continue
24890 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24891 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24892 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24893 the controlling expression.
24894
24895 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24896 @item end
24897 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24898 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24899 @end table
24900
24901
24902 @node Output
24903 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24904
24905 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24906 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24907 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24908 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24909 want.
24910
24911 @table @code
24912 @kindex echo
24913 @item echo @var{text}
24914 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24915 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24916 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24917 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24918 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24919 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24920 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24921 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24922 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24923 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24924 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24925
24926 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24927 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24928
24929 @smallexample
24930 echo This is some text\n\
24931 which is continued\n\
24932 onto several lines.\n
24933 @end smallexample
24934
24935 produces the same output as
24936
24937 @smallexample
24938 echo This is some text\n
24939 echo which is continued\n
24940 echo onto several lines.\n
24941 @end smallexample
24942
24943 @kindex output
24944 @item output @var{expression}
24945 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24946 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24947 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24948 on expressions.
24949
24950 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24951 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24952 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24953 Formats}, for more information.
24954
24955 @kindex printf
24956 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24957 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24958 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24959 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24960 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24961 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24962 executing the code below:
24963
24964 @smallexample
24965 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24966 @end smallexample
24967
24968 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24969 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24970 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24971 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24972 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24973 printed.
24974
24975 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24976
24977 @smallexample
24978 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24979 @end smallexample
24980
24981 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24982 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24983 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24984
24985 @itemize @bullet
24986 @item
24987 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24988
24989 @item
24990 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24991 width.
24992
24993 @item
24994 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24995 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24996
24997 @item
24998 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24999 supported.
25000
25001 @item
25002 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
25003
25004 @item
25005 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
25006 @end itemize
25007
25008 @noindent
25009 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
25010 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
25011 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
25012 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
25013
25014 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
25015 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
25016 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
25017 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
25018 supported.
25019
25020 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
25021 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
25022 together with a floating point specifier.
25023 letters:
25024
25025 @itemize @bullet
25026 @item
25027 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
25028
25029 @item
25030 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
25031
25032 @item
25033 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
25034 @end itemize
25035
25036 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
25037 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
25038 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
25039
25040 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
25041 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
25042
25043 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
25044 @smallexample
25045 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
25046 @end smallexample
25047
25048 @anchor{eval}
25049 @kindex eval
25050 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25051 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25052 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
25053
25054 @end table
25055
25056 @node Auto-loading sequences
25057 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
25058 @cindex native script auto-loading
25059
25060 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25061 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
25062 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
25063 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25064
25065 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25066 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25067
25068 @table @code
25069 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
25070 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
25071 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
25072 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
25073
25074 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
25075 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
25076 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
25077 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
25078 disabled.
25079
25080 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
25081 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
25082 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
25083 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
25084 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
25085 auto-loaded.
25086 @end table
25087
25088 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
25089 matching names are printed.
25090
25091 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
25092 @include python.texi
25093
25094 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
25095 @include guile.texi
25096
25097 @node Auto-loading extensions
25098 @section Auto-loading extensions
25099 @cindex auto-loading extensions
25100
25101 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
25102 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25103 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
25104 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
25105 section of modern file formats like ELF.
25106
25107 @menu
25108 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25109 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25110 * Which flavor to choose?::
25111 @end menu
25112
25113 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
25114 debugging commands and features.
25115
25116 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25117 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25118 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
25119 for more information.
25120 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
25121 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
25122
25123 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25124 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25125
25126 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
25127 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25128 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25129 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25130 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25131
25132 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
25133 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
25134 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
25135 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
25136
25137 @table @code
25138 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25139 GDB's own command language
25140 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25141 Python
25142 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25143 Guile
25144 @end table
25145
25146 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
25147 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
25148 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
25149 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
25150 script in the specified extension language.
25151
25152 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
25153 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
25154
25155 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
25156 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25157
25158 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
25159 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
25160 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
25161 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
25162 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
25163 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
25164
25165 @table @code
25166 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
25167 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
25168 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25169 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
25170 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
25171 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
25172
25173 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
25174 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
25175
25176 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
25177 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
25178 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
25179 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
25180
25181 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
25182 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
25183 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
25184 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25185 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25186 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25187 platform.
25188
25189 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25190 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25191 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25192
25193 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
25194 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
25195 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
25196 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25197
25198 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
25199 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
25200 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
25201 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
25202 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
25203 @end table
25204
25205 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
25206 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
25207 @var{objfile} is opened.
25208 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
25209 is evaluated more than once.
25210
25211 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
25212 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25213 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25214
25215 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
25216 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
25217 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25218 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
25219 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
25220 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
25221 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25222
25223 The following entries are supported:
25224
25225 @table @code
25226 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
25227 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
25228 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
25229 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
25230 @end table
25231
25232 @subsubsection Script File Entries
25233
25234 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
25235 in the current directory and then along the source search path
25236 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
25237 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
25238 directory is not relevant to scripts.
25239
25240 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
25241 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
25242
25243 @example
25244 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
25245 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
25246 asm("\
25247 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
25248 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
25249 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
25250 .popsection \n\
25251 ");
25252 @end example
25253
25254 @noindent
25255 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
25256 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
25257
25258 @example
25259 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
25260 @end example
25261
25262 The script name may include directories if desired.
25263
25264 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25265 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25266
25267 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
25268 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
25269 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
25270 will remove duplicates.
25271
25272 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
25273
25274 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
25275 itself instead of loading it from a file.
25276 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
25277 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
25278 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
25279 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
25280 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
25281 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
25282 on its name.
25283
25284 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
25285 testsuite.
25286
25287 @example
25288 #include "symcat.h"
25289 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
25290 asm(
25291 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
25292 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
25293 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
25294 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
25295 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
25296 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
25297 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
25298 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
25299 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
25300 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
25301 ".byte 0\n"
25302 ".popsection\n"
25303 );
25304 @end example
25305
25306 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
25307 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25308 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
25309 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
25310
25311 @node Which flavor to choose?
25312 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
25313
25314 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
25315 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
25316
25317 @noindent
25318 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
25319
25320 @itemize @bullet
25321 @item
25322 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
25323
25324 @item
25325 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
25326
25327 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
25328 in the source search path.
25329 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
25330 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
25331
25332 @item
25333 Doesn't require source code additions.
25334 @end itemize
25335
25336 @noindent
25337 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
25338
25339 @itemize @bullet
25340 @item
25341 Works with static linking.
25342
25343 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
25344 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
25345 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
25346 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
25347 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
25348
25349 @item
25350 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
25351
25352 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
25353 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
25354
25355 @item
25356 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
25357
25358 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
25359 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
25360 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
25361 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
25362 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
25363 top of the source tree to the source search path.
25364 @end itemize
25365
25366 @node Multiple Extension Languages
25367 @section Multiple Extension Languages
25368
25369 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
25370 and generally do not interfere with each other.
25371 There are some things to be aware of, however.
25372
25373 @subsection Python comes first
25374
25375 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
25376 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
25377 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
25378 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
25379 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
25380 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
25381 pretty-printed form of a value).
25382 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
25383 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
25384 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
25385
25386 @node Aliases
25387 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
25388 @cindex aliases for commands
25389
25390 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
25391 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
25392 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
25393 that involves less typing.
25394
25395 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
25396 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
25397 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
25398
25399 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
25400 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
25401 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
25402
25403 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
25404
25405 @table @code
25406
25407 @kindex alias
25408 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
25409
25410 @end table
25411
25412 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
25413 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
25414 underscores.
25415
25416 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
25417 that is being aliased.
25418
25419 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
25420 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
25421 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
25422
25423 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
25424 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
25425
25426 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
25427 of a command so that there is less to type.
25428 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
25429 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
25430 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
25431 The following will accomplish this.
25432
25433 @smallexample
25434 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
25435 @end smallexample
25436
25437 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
25438 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
25439 for it with the @samp{document} command.
25440 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
25441
25442 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
25443 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
25444 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
25445 of a command.
25446
25447 @smallexample
25448 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
25449 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
25450 (gdb) set p elms 20
25451 (gdb) show p elms
25452 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
25453 @end smallexample
25454
25455 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
25456 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
25457 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
25458
25459 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
25460 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
25461
25462 @smallexample
25463 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
25464 @end smallexample
25465
25466 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
25467 alias for a more complex command.
25468 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
25469
25470 @smallexample
25471 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
25472 (gdb) spe 20
25473 @end smallexample
25474
25475 @node Interpreters
25476 @chapter Command Interpreters
25477 @cindex command interpreters
25478
25479 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
25480 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
25481 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
25482
25483 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
25484 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
25485 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
25486 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
25487
25488 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
25489 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
25490 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
25491 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
25492
25493 @table @code
25494 @item console
25495 @cindex console interpreter
25496 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
25497 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
25498 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
25499
25500 @item mi
25501 @cindex mi interpreter
25502 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
25503 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
25504 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
25505 Interface}.
25506
25507 @item mi2
25508 @cindex mi2 interpreter
25509 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
25510
25511 @item mi1
25512 @cindex mi1 interpreter
25513 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
25514
25515 @end table
25516
25517 @cindex invoke another interpreter
25518
25519 @kindex interpreter-exec
25520 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
25521 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
25522 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
25523
25524 @smallexample
25525 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
25526 @end smallexample
25527
25528 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
25529 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
25530
25531 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
25532 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
25533 permanently.
25534
25535 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
25536
25537 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
25538 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
25539 device (usually a tty).
25540
25541 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
25542 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
25543 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
25544 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25545 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25546 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25547 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25548 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25549 the separate MI interpreter.
25550
25551 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25552 @code{new-ui} command:
25553
25554 @kindex new-ui
25555 @cindex new user interface
25556 @smallexample
25557 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25558 @end smallexample
25559
25560 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25561 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25562 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
25563 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25564 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25565 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
25566
25567 @smallexample
25568 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25569 @end smallexample
25570
25571 @noindent
25572 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25573
25574 @node TUI
25575 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25576 @cindex TUI
25577 @cindex Text User Interface
25578
25579 @menu
25580 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
25581 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
25582 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
25583 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
25584 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
25585 @end menu
25586
25587 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25588 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25589 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25590 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
25591 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25592 is available.
25593
25594 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25595 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25596 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25597 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25598 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25599 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25600
25601 @node TUI Overview
25602 @section TUI Overview
25603
25604 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25605
25606 @table @emph
25607 @item command
25608 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25609 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25610 managed using readline.
25611
25612 @item source
25613 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25614 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25615
25616 @item assembly
25617 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25618
25619 @item register
25620 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25621 when their values change.
25622 @end table
25623
25624 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25625 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25626 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25627 indicates the breakpoint type:
25628
25629 @table @code
25630 @item B
25631 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25632
25633 @item b
25634 Breakpoint which was never hit.
25635
25636 @item H
25637 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25638
25639 @item h
25640 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25641 @end table
25642
25643 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25644
25645 @table @code
25646 @item +
25647 Breakpoint is enabled.
25648
25649 @item -
25650 Breakpoint is disabled.
25651 @end table
25652
25653 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25654 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25655 changes.
25656
25657 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25658 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25659 layouts:
25660
25661 @itemize @bullet
25662 @item
25663 source only,
25664
25665 @item
25666 assembly only,
25667
25668 @item
25669 source and assembly,
25670
25671 @item
25672 source and registers, or
25673
25674 @item
25675 assembly and registers.
25676 @end itemize
25677
25678 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25679
25680 @table @emph
25681 @item target
25682 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25683 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25684
25685 @item process
25686 Gives the current process or thread number.
25687 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25688
25689 @item function
25690 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25691 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25692 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25693 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25694
25695 @item line
25696 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25697 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25698
25699 @item pc
25700 Indicates the current program counter address.
25701 @end table
25702
25703 @node TUI Keys
25704 @section TUI Key Bindings
25705 @cindex TUI key bindings
25706
25707 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25708 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25709 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25710 @end ifset
25711 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25712 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25713 @end ifclear
25714 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25715 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25716
25717 @table @kbd
25718 @kindex C-x C-a
25719 @item C-x C-a
25720 @kindex C-x a
25721 @itemx C-x a
25722 @kindex C-x A
25723 @itemx C-x A
25724 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25725 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25726 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25727 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25728 The screen is then refreshed.
25729
25730 @kindex C-x 1
25731 @item C-x 1
25732 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25733 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25734 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25735
25736 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25737
25738 @kindex C-x 2
25739 @item C-x 2
25740 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25741 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25742 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25743 previous layout and the new one.
25744
25745 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25746
25747 @kindex C-x o
25748 @item C-x o
25749 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25750 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25751 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25752
25753 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25754
25755 @kindex C-x s
25756 @item C-x s
25757 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25758 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25759 @end table
25760
25761 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25762
25763 @table @asis
25764 @kindex PgUp
25765 @item @key{PgUp}
25766 Scroll the active window one page up.
25767
25768 @kindex PgDn
25769 @item @key{PgDn}
25770 Scroll the active window one page down.
25771
25772 @kindex Up
25773 @item @key{Up}
25774 Scroll the active window one line up.
25775
25776 @kindex Down
25777 @item @key{Down}
25778 Scroll the active window one line down.
25779
25780 @kindex Left
25781 @item @key{Left}
25782 Scroll the active window one column left.
25783
25784 @kindex Right
25785 @item @key{Right}
25786 Scroll the active window one column right.
25787
25788 @kindex C-L
25789 @item @kbd{C-L}
25790 Refresh the screen.
25791 @end table
25792
25793 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25794 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25795 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25796 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25797 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25798
25799 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25800 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25801 @cindex TUI single key mode
25802
25803 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25804 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25805 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25806
25807 @table @kbd
25808 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25809 @item c
25810 continue
25811
25812 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25813 @item d
25814 down
25815
25816 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25817 @item f
25818 finish
25819
25820 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25821 @item n
25822 next
25823
25824 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25825 @item o
25826 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
25827
25828 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25829 @item q
25830 exit the SingleKey mode.
25831
25832 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25833 @item r
25834 run
25835
25836 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25837 @item s
25838 step
25839
25840 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25841 @item i
25842 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
25843
25844 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25845 @item u
25846 up
25847
25848 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25849 @item v
25850 info locals
25851
25852 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25853 @item w
25854 where
25855 @end table
25856
25857 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25858 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25859 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25860 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25861 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25862 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25863
25864
25865 @node TUI Commands
25866 @section TUI-specific Commands
25867 @cindex TUI commands
25868
25869 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25870 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25871 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25872 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25873
25874 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25875 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25876 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25877 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25878 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25879
25880 @table @code
25881 @item tui enable
25882 @kindex tui enable
25883 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25884 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25885 otherwise a default layout is used.
25886
25887 @item tui disable
25888 @kindex tui disable
25889 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25890
25891 @item info win
25892 @kindex info win
25893 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25894
25895 @item layout @var{name}
25896 @kindex layout
25897 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25898 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25899 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25900
25901 @table @code
25902 @item next
25903 Display the next layout.
25904
25905 @item prev
25906 Display the previous layout.
25907
25908 @item src
25909 Display the source and command windows.
25910
25911 @item asm
25912 Display the assembly and command windows.
25913
25914 @item split
25915 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25916
25917 @item regs
25918 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25919 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25920 register, assembler, and command windows.
25921 @end table
25922
25923 @item focus @var{name}
25924 @kindex focus
25925 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25926 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25927
25928 @table @code
25929 @item next
25930 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25931
25932 @item prev
25933 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25934
25935 @item src
25936 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25937
25938 @item asm
25939 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25940
25941 @item regs
25942 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25943
25944 @item cmd
25945 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25946 @end table
25947
25948 @item refresh
25949 @kindex refresh
25950 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25951
25952 @item tui reg @var{group}
25953 @kindex tui reg
25954 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25955 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25956 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25957 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25958 following groups are available on most targets:
25959 @table @code
25960 @item next
25961 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25962 through all of the available register groups.
25963
25964 @item prev
25965 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25966 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25967 @var{next}.
25968
25969 @item general
25970 Display the general registers.
25971 @item float
25972 Display the floating point registers.
25973 @item system
25974 Display the system registers.
25975 @item vector
25976 Display the vector registers.
25977 @item all
25978 Display all registers.
25979 @end table
25980
25981 @item update
25982 @kindex update
25983 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25984
25985 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25986 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25987 @kindex winheight
25988 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25989 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25990 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25991 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25992 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25993
25994 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25995 @kindex tabset
25996 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25997 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25998 assembly windows.
25999 @end table
26000
26001 @node TUI Configuration
26002 @section TUI Configuration Variables
26003 @cindex TUI configuration variables
26004
26005 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
26006
26007 @table @code
26008 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
26009 @kindex set tui border-kind
26010 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
26011 The possible values are the following:
26012 @table @code
26013 @item space
26014 Use a space character to draw the border.
26015
26016 @item ascii
26017 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
26018
26019 @item acs
26020 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
26021 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
26022 @end table
26023
26024 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
26025 @kindex set tui border-mode
26026 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
26027 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
26028 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
26029 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
26030 @table @code
26031 @item normal
26032 Use normal attributes to display the border.
26033
26034 @item standout
26035 Use standout mode.
26036
26037 @item reverse
26038 Use reverse video mode.
26039
26040 @item half
26041 Use half bright mode.
26042
26043 @item half-standout
26044 Use half bright and standout mode.
26045
26046 @item bold
26047 Use extra bright or bold mode.
26048
26049 @item bold-standout
26050 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
26051 @end table
26052 @end table
26053
26054 @node Emacs
26055 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
26056
26057 @cindex Emacs
26058 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
26059 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
26060 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
26061 @value{GDBN}.
26062
26063 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
26064 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
26065 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
26066 created Emacs buffer.
26067 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
26068
26069 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
26070 things:
26071
26072 @itemize @bullet
26073 @item
26074 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
26075 the GUD buffer.
26076
26077 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
26078 and output done by the program you are debugging.
26079
26080 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
26081 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
26082 in this way.
26083
26084 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
26085 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
26086 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
26087 stop.
26088
26089 @item
26090 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
26091
26092 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
26093 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
26094 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
26095 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
26096 and the source.
26097
26098 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
26099 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
26100 @end itemize
26101
26102 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
26103 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
26104 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
26105 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
26106
26107 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
26108 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
26109 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
26110 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
26111 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
26112 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
26113 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
26114 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
26115 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
26116
26117 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
26118 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
26119 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
26120 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
26121
26122 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
26123 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
26124 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
26125 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
26126 one you want.
26127
26128 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
26129 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
26130
26131 @table @kbd
26132 @item C-h m
26133 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
26134
26135 @item C-c C-s
26136 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
26137 update the display window to show the current file and location.
26138
26139 @item C-c C-n
26140 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
26141 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
26142 to show the current file and location.
26143
26144 @item C-c C-i
26145 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
26146 display window accordingly.
26147
26148 @item C-c C-f
26149 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
26150 @code{finish} command.
26151
26152 @item C-c C-r
26153 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
26154 command.
26155
26156 @item C-c <
26157 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
26158 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
26159 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
26160
26161 @item C-c >
26162 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
26163 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
26164 @end table
26165
26166 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
26167 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
26168
26169 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
26170 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
26171 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
26172 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
26173 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
26174 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
26175 speedbar displays watch expressions.
26176
26177 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
26178 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
26179 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
26180 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
26181 frame.
26182
26183 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
26184 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26185 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26186 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26187 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
26188 to correspond properly with the code.
26189
26190 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
26191 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
26192 Emacs Manual}).
26193
26194 @node GDB/MI
26195 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
26196
26197 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
26198
26199 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
26200 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
26201 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
26202 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
26203 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
26204 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
26205
26206 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
26207 in the form of a reference manual.
26208
26209 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
26210 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
26211 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
26212
26213 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
26214
26215 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
26216 This chapter uses the following notation:
26217
26218 @itemize @bullet
26219 @item
26220 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
26221
26222 @item
26223 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
26224 it may or may not be given.
26225
26226 @item
26227 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26228 may repeat zero or more times.
26229
26230 @item
26231 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26232 may repeat one or more times.
26233
26234 @item
26235 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
26236 @end itemize
26237
26238 @ignore
26239 @heading Dependencies
26240 @end ignore
26241
26242 @menu
26243 * GDB/MI General Design::
26244 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
26245 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
26246 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
26247 * GDB/MI Output Records::
26248 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
26249 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
26250 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
26251 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26252 * GDB/MI Program Context::
26253 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
26254 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
26255 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
26256 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
26257 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
26258 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
26259 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
26260 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
26261 * GDB/MI File Commands::
26262 @ignore
26263 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
26264 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
26265 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
26266 @end ignore
26267 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
26268 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
26269 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
26270 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
26271 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
26272 @end menu
26273
26274 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26275 @node GDB/MI General Design
26276 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
26277 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
26278
26279 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
26280 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
26281 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
26282 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
26283 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
26284 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
26285 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
26286 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
26287 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
26288 a command and reported as part of that command response.
26289
26290 The important examples of notifications are:
26291 @itemize @bullet
26292
26293 @item
26294 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
26295 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
26296 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
26297 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
26298 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
26299 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
26300 command itself was successfully executed.
26301
26302 @item
26303 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
26304 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
26305 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
26306 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
26307 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
26308 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
26309
26310 @item
26311 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
26312 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
26313 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
26314 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
26315 orthogonal frontend design.
26316
26317 @end itemize
26318
26319 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
26320 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
26321 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
26322 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
26323 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
26324 the user interface.
26325
26326
26327 @menu
26328 * Context management::
26329 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
26330 * Thread groups::
26331 @end menu
26332
26333 @node Context management
26334 @subsection Context management
26335
26336 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
26337
26338 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
26339 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
26340 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
26341 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
26342 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
26343 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
26344 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
26345 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
26346 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
26347
26348 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
26349 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
26350 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
26351 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
26352 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
26353 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
26354 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
26355 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
26356 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
26357 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
26358 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
26359
26360 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
26361 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
26362 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
26363 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
26364 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
26365 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
26366 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
26367 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
26368 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
26369 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
26370
26371 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
26372 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
26373 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
26374 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
26375 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
26376 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
26377 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
26378 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
26379 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
26380 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
26381 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
26382 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
26383 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
26384 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
26385 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
26386 @samp{--frame} options.
26387
26388 @subsubsection Language
26389
26390 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
26391 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
26392 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
26393 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
26394 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
26395 For instance:
26396
26397 @smallexample
26398 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
26399 ^done,value="4"
26400 (gdb)
26401 @end smallexample
26402
26403 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
26404 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
26405 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
26406
26407 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
26408 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
26409
26410 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
26411 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
26412 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
26413 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
26414 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
26415 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
26416 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
26417 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
26418 @code{-list-target-features} command.
26419
26420 @table @code
26421 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
26422 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
26423 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
26424
26425 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
26426 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
26427 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
26428
26429 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
26430 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
26431 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
26432 MI commands even while the target is running.
26433
26434 @item -gdb-show mi-async
26435 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
26436 @end table
26437
26438 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
26439 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
26440 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
26441 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
26442 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
26443 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
26444
26445 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
26446 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
26447 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
26448 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
26449 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
26450 are running.
26451
26452 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
26453 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
26454 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
26455 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
26456 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
26457 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
26458 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
26459 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
26460 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
26461 @samp{--thread} option).
26462
26463 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
26464 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
26465 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
26466 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
26467
26468 @node Thread groups
26469 @subsection Thread groups
26470 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
26471 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
26472 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
26473 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
26474 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
26475
26476 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
26477 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
26478 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
26479 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
26480 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
26481 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
26482 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
26483 into processes.
26484
26485 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
26486 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
26487 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
26488 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
26489 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
26490 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
26491 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
26492 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
26493 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
26494 the members of specific thread group.
26495
26496 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
26497 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
26498 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
26499 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
26500 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
26501 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
26502 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
26503 after attaching to that thread group.
26504
26505 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
26506 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
26507 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
26508 such thread groups.
26509
26510 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26511 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
26512 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
26513
26514 @menu
26515 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
26516 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
26517 @end menu
26518
26519 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
26520 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
26521
26522 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
26523 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
26524 @table @code
26525 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
26526 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
26527
26528 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
26529 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
26530 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
26531
26532 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
26533 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
26534 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
26535
26536 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26537 "any sequence of digits"
26538
26539 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
26540 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
26541
26542 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
26543 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
26544
26545 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
26546 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
26547
26548 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
26549 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
26550 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
26551
26552 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26553 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26554
26555 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26556 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26557 @end table
26558
26559 @noindent
26560 Notes:
26561
26562 @itemize @bullet
26563 @item
26564 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26565 output is described below.
26566
26567 @item
26568 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26569 finishes.
26570
26571 @item
26572 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26573 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26574 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
26575 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26576 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26577 @end itemize
26578
26579 Pragmatics:
26580
26581 @itemize @bullet
26582 @item
26583 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26584
26585 @item
26586 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26587 @end itemize
26588
26589 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26590 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26591
26592 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26593 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26594 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26595 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
26596 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
26597 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26598
26599 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26600 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26601 @var{token}.
26602
26603 @table @code
26604 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
26605 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26606
26607 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26608 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26609
26610 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26611 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26612
26613 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26614 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26615
26616 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26617 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26618
26619 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26620 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26621
26622 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26623 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26624
26625 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26626 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26627
26628 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26629 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26630
26631 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26632 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26633 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26634
26635 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
26636 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26637
26638 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26639 @code{ @var{string} }
26640
26641 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
26642 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26643
26644 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
26645 @code{@var{c-string}}
26646
26647 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26648 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26649
26650 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26651 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26652 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26653
26654 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26655 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26656
26657 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26658 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26659
26660 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26661 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26662
26663 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26664 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26665
26666 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26667 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26668
26669 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26670 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26671 @end table
26672
26673 @noindent
26674 Notes:
26675
26676 @itemize @bullet
26677 @item
26678 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26679
26680 @item
26681 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26682 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26683 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26684 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26685 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26686 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26687 prior command.
26688
26689 @item
26690 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26691 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26692 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26693 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26694
26695 @item
26696 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26697 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26698 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26699 @samp{*}.
26700
26701 @item
26702 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26703 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26704 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26705 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26706
26707 @item
26708 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26709 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26710 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26711 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26712
26713 @item
26714 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26715 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26716 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26717
26718 @item
26719 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26720 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26721 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26722 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26723
26724 @item
26725 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26726 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26727 @var{values}.
26728
26729
26730 @end itemize
26731
26732 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26733 details about the various output records.
26734
26735 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26736 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26737 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26738
26739 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26740 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26741
26742 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26743 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26744 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26745 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26746 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26747 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26748
26749 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26750 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26751 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26752
26753 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26754 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26755 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26756 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26757
26758 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26759 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26760
26761 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26762 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26763 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26764 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26765 might change.
26766
26767 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26768 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26769 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26770 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26771
26772 @itemize @bullet
26773 @item
26774 New MI commands may be added.
26775
26776 @item
26777 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26778
26779 @item
26780 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26781 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26782
26783 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26784 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26785
26786 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26787 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26788 @end itemize
26789
26790 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26791 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26792 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26793 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26794 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26795
26796 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26797 @c version?
26798
26799 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26800 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26801 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26802 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26803 @cindex mailing lists
26804
26805 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26806 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26807 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26808
26809 @menu
26810 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26811 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26812 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26813 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26814 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26815 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26816 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26817 @end menu
26818
26819 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26820 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26821
26822 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26823 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26824 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26825 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26826
26827 @table @code
26828 @findex ^done
26829 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26830 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26831 values.
26832
26833 @item "^running"
26834 @findex ^running
26835 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26836 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26837 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26838 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26839 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26840 which threads are resumed.
26841
26842 @item "^connected"
26843 @findex ^connected
26844 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26845
26846 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26847 @findex ^error
26848 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26849 the corresponding error message.
26850
26851 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26852 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26853 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26854
26855 @table @samp
26856 @item "undefined-command"
26857 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26858 @end table
26859
26860 @item "^exit"
26861 @findex ^exit
26862 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26863
26864 @end table
26865
26866 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26867 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26868
26869 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26870 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26871 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26872 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26873 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26874
26875 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26876 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26877 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26878 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26879 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26880
26881 @table @code
26882 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26883 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26884 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26885
26886 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26887 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26888 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26889 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26890
26891 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26892 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26893 internals.
26894 @end table
26895
26896 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26897 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26898
26899 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26900 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26901 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26902 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26903 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26904 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26905
26906 The following is the list of possible async records:
26907
26908 @table @code
26909
26910 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26911 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26912 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26913 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26914 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26915 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26916 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26917 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26918 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26919 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26920 it run freely.
26921
26922 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26923 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26924 following values:
26925
26926 @table @code
26927 @item breakpoint-hit
26928 A breakpoint was reached.
26929 @item watchpoint-trigger
26930 A watchpoint was triggered.
26931 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26932 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26933 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26934 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26935 @item function-finished
26936 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26937 @item location-reached
26938 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26939 @item watchpoint-scope
26940 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26941 @item end-stepping-range
26942 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26943 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26944 @item exited-signalled
26945 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26946 @item exited
26947 The inferior exited.
26948 @item exited-normally
26949 The inferior exited normally.
26950 @item signal-received
26951 A signal was received by the inferior.
26952 @item solib-event
26953 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26954 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26955 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26956 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26957 @item fork
26958 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26959 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26960 @item vfork
26961 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26962 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26963 @item syscall-entry
26964 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26965 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26966 @item syscall-return
26967 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26968 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26969 @item exec
26970 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26971 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26972 @end table
26973
26974 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26975 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26976 Depending on whether all-stop
26977 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26978 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26979 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26980 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26981 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26982 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26983 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26984 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26985 if such information is not available.
26986
26987 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26988 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26989 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26990 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26991 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26992 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26993 cannot be used in any way.
26994
26995 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26996 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26997 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26998 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26999 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
27000 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
27001
27002 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
27003 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
27004 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
27005 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
27006 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
27007 only when the inferior exited with some code.
27008
27009 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27010 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27011 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
27012 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
27013 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
27014
27015 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
27016 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
27017 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
27018 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
27019 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
27020 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
27021 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
27022 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
27023 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
27024
27025 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
27026 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
27027
27028 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
27029 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
27030 that thread.
27031
27032 @item =library-loaded,...
27033 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
27034 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
27035 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
27036 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
27037 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
27038 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
27039 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
27040 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
27041 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
27042 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
27043 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
27044 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
27045 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
27046 to this library.
27047
27048 @item =library-unloaded,...
27049 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
27050 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
27051 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
27052 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
27053 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
27054 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
27055 thread groups.
27056
27057 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
27058 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
27059 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
27060 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
27061 frame is @var{tpnum}.
27062
27063 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
27064 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
27065 initial value @var{initial}.
27066
27067 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
27068 @itemx =tsv-deleted
27069 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
27070 trace state variables are deleted.
27071
27072 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
27073 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
27074 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
27075 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
27076 value of trace state variable is known.
27077
27078 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
27079 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
27080 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
27081 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
27082 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
27083 user.
27084
27085 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
27086 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
27087 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
27088
27089 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
27090 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
27091
27092 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
27093 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
27094 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
27095 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
27096 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
27097
27098 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
27099 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
27100 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
27101 for existing method and format values.
27102
27103 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
27104 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
27105 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
27106 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
27107 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
27108 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
27109
27110 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
27111 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
27112 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
27113 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
27114 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
27115 executable code.
27116 @end table
27117
27118 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
27119 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
27120
27121 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
27122 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
27123 following fields:
27124
27125 @table @code
27126 @item number
27127 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
27128 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
27129 @samp{1.2}.
27130
27131 @item type
27132 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
27133 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
27134
27135 @item catch-type
27136 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
27137 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
27138
27139 @item disp
27140 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
27141 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
27142 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
27143
27144 @item enabled
27145 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
27146 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
27147 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
27148
27149 @item addr
27150 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
27151 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
27152 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
27153 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
27154 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
27155
27156 @item func
27157 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
27158 If not known, this field is not present.
27159
27160 @item filename
27161 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
27162 If not known, this field is not present.
27163
27164 @item fullname
27165 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
27166 known. If not known, this field is not present.
27167
27168 @item line
27169 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
27170 If not known, this field is not present.
27171
27172 @item at
27173 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
27174 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
27175 by a symbol name.
27176
27177 @item pending
27178 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
27179 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
27180
27181 @item evaluated-by
27182 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
27183 @samp{target}.
27184
27185 @item thread
27186 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
27187 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
27188
27189 @item task
27190 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
27191 field will hold the task identifier.
27192
27193 @item cond
27194 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
27195
27196 @item ignore
27197 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
27198
27199 @item enable
27200 The enable count of the breakpoint.
27201
27202 @item traceframe-usage
27203 FIXME.
27204
27205 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
27206 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
27207
27208 @item mask
27209 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
27210
27211 @item pass
27212 A tracepoint's pass count.
27213
27214 @item original-location
27215 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
27216 This field is optional.
27217
27218 @item times
27219 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
27220
27221 @item installed
27222 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
27223 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
27224 is not.
27225
27226 @item what
27227 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
27228
27229 @end table
27230
27231 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
27232 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
27233
27234 @smallexample
27235 -> -break-insert main
27236 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27237 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27238 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27239 times="0"@}
27240 <- (gdb)
27241 @end smallexample
27242
27243 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
27244 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
27245
27246 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
27247 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
27248 fields:
27249
27250 @table @code
27251 @item level
27252 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
27253 zero. This field is always present.
27254
27255 @item func
27256 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
27257 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
27258
27259 @item addr
27260 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
27261
27262 @item file
27263 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
27264 address. This field may be absent.
27265
27266 @item line
27267 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
27268 may be absent.
27269
27270 @item from
27271 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
27272 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
27273
27274 @end table
27275
27276 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
27277 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
27278
27279 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
27280 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
27281 stated otherwise.
27282
27283 @table @code
27284 @item id
27285 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
27286
27287 @item target-id
27288 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
27289
27290 @item details
27291 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
27292 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
27293 frontend. This field is optional.
27294
27295 @item name
27296 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27297 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27298 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27299 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27300 field is omitted.
27301
27302 @item state
27303 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
27304 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
27305
27306 @item frame
27307 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
27308 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
27309 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
27310
27311 @item core
27312 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
27313 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
27314 @end table
27315
27316 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
27317 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
27318
27319 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
27320 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
27321 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
27322 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
27323 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
27324 the @code{exception-message} field.
27325
27326 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27327 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
27328 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
27329 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
27330
27331 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
27332 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
27333 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
27334 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
27335
27336 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
27337 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
27338
27339 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
27340
27341 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
27342 information of the breakpoint.
27343
27344 @smallexample
27345 -> -break-insert main
27346 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27347 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27348 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27349 times="0"@}
27350 <- (gdb)
27351 @end smallexample
27352
27353 @subheading Program Execution
27354
27355 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
27356 reason that execution stopped.
27357
27358 @smallexample
27359 -> -exec-run
27360 <- ^running
27361 <- (gdb)
27362 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
27363 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
27364 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
27365 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
27366 <- (gdb)
27367 -> -exec-continue
27368 <- ^running
27369 <- (gdb)
27370 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27371 <- (gdb)
27372 @end smallexample
27373
27374 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
27375
27376 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
27377
27378 @smallexample
27379 -> (gdb)
27380 <- -gdb-exit
27381 <- ^exit
27382 @end smallexample
27383
27384 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
27385 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
27386 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
27387 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
27388 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
27389 fails to exit in reasonable time.
27390
27391 @subheading A Bad Command
27392
27393 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
27394
27395 @smallexample
27396 -> -rubbish
27397 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
27398 <- (gdb)
27399 @end smallexample
27400
27401
27402 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27403 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
27404 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
27405
27406 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
27407 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
27408
27409 @subheading Motivation
27410
27411 The motivation for this collection of commands.
27412
27413 @subheading Introduction
27414
27415 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
27416
27417 @subheading Commands
27418
27419 For each command in the block, the following is described:
27420
27421 @subsubheading Synopsis
27422
27423 @smallexample
27424 -command @var{args}@dots{}
27425 @end smallexample
27426
27427 @subsubheading Result
27428
27429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27430
27431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
27432
27433 @subsubheading Example
27434
27435 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
27436 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
27437
27438
27439 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27440 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
27441 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
27442
27443 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
27444 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
27445 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27446 breakpoints.
27447
27448 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
27449 @findex -break-after
27450
27451 @subsubheading Synopsis
27452
27453 @smallexample
27454 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
27455 @end smallexample
27456
27457 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
27458 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
27459 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
27460 @samp{-break-list} command below.
27461
27462 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27463
27464 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
27465
27466 @subsubheading Example
27467
27468 @smallexample
27469 (gdb)
27470 -break-insert main
27471 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27472 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27473 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27474 times="0"@}
27475 (gdb)
27476 -break-after 1 3
27477 ~
27478 ^done
27479 (gdb)
27480 -break-list
27481 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27482 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27483 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27484 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27485 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27486 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27487 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27488 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27489 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27490 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27491 (gdb)
27492 @end smallexample
27493
27494 @ignore
27495 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
27496 @findex -break-catch
27497 @end ignore
27498
27499 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
27500 @findex -break-commands
27501
27502 @subsubheading Synopsis
27503
27504 @smallexample
27505 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
27506 @end smallexample
27507
27508 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
27509 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
27510 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
27511 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
27512 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
27513 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
27514
27515 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27516
27517 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
27518
27519 @subsubheading Example
27520
27521 @smallexample
27522 (gdb)
27523 -break-insert main
27524 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27525 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27526 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27527 times="0"@}
27528 (gdb)
27529 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
27530 ^done
27531 (gdb)
27532 @end smallexample
27533
27534 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
27535 @findex -break-condition
27536
27537 @subsubheading Synopsis
27538
27539 @smallexample
27540 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
27541 @end smallexample
27542
27543 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
27544 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
27545 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
27546 command below).
27547
27548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27549
27550 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
27551
27552 @subsubheading Example
27553
27554 @smallexample
27555 (gdb)
27556 -break-condition 1 1
27557 ^done
27558 (gdb)
27559 -break-list
27560 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27561 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27562 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27563 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27564 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27565 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27566 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27567 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27568 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27569 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27570 (gdb)
27571 @end smallexample
27572
27573 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27574 @findex -break-delete
27575
27576 @subsubheading Synopsis
27577
27578 @smallexample
27579 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27580 @end smallexample
27581
27582 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27583 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27584
27585 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27586
27587 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27588
27589 @subsubheading Example
27590
27591 @smallexample
27592 (gdb)
27593 -break-delete 1
27594 ^done
27595 (gdb)
27596 -break-list
27597 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27598 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27599 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27600 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27601 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27602 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27603 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27604 body=[]@}
27605 (gdb)
27606 @end smallexample
27607
27608 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27609 @findex -break-disable
27610
27611 @subsubheading Synopsis
27612
27613 @smallexample
27614 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27615 @end smallexample
27616
27617 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
27618 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27619
27620 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27621
27622 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27623
27624 @subsubheading Example
27625
27626 @smallexample
27627 (gdb)
27628 -break-disable 2
27629 ^done
27630 (gdb)
27631 -break-list
27632 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27633 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27634 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27635 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27636 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27637 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27638 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27639 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27640 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27641 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27642 (gdb)
27643 @end smallexample
27644
27645 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27646 @findex -break-enable
27647
27648 @subsubheading Synopsis
27649
27650 @smallexample
27651 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27652 @end smallexample
27653
27654 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27655
27656 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27657
27658 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27659
27660 @subsubheading Example
27661
27662 @smallexample
27663 (gdb)
27664 -break-enable 2
27665 ^done
27666 (gdb)
27667 -break-list
27668 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27669 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27670 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27671 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27672 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27673 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27674 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27675 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27676 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27677 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27678 (gdb)
27679 @end smallexample
27680
27681 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27682 @findex -break-info
27683
27684 @subsubheading Synopsis
27685
27686 @smallexample
27687 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27688 @end smallexample
27689
27690 @c REDUNDANT???
27691 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27692
27693 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27694 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27695 table.
27696
27697 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27698
27699 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27700
27701 @subsubheading Example
27702 N.A.
27703
27704 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27705 @findex -break-insert
27706 @anchor{-break-insert}
27707
27708 @subsubheading Synopsis
27709
27710 @smallexample
27711 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27712 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27713 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27714 @end smallexample
27715
27716 @noindent
27717 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27718
27719 @table @var
27720 @item linespec location
27721 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27722
27723 @item explicit location
27724 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27725 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27726 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27727
27728 @table @samp
27729 @item --source @var{filename}
27730 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27731 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27732
27733 @item --function @var{function}
27734 The name of a function or method.
27735
27736 @item --label @var{label}
27737 The name of a label.
27738
27739 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27740 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27741 @end table
27742
27743 @item address location
27744 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27745 @end table
27746
27747 @noindent
27748 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27749
27750 @table @samp
27751 @item -t
27752 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27753 @item -h
27754 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27755 @item -f
27756 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27757 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27758 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27759 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27760 cannot be parsed.
27761 @item -d
27762 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27763 @item -a
27764 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27765 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27766 @item -c @var{condition}
27767 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27768 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27769 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27770 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27771 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27772 @var{thread-id}.
27773 @end table
27774
27775 @subsubheading Result
27776
27777 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27778 resulting breakpoint.
27779
27780 Note: this format is open to change.
27781 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27782
27783 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27784
27785 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27786 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27787
27788 @subsubheading Example
27789
27790 @smallexample
27791 (gdb)
27792 -break-insert main
27793 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27794 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27795 times="0"@}
27796 (gdb)
27797 -break-insert -t foo
27798 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27799 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27800 times="0"@}
27801 (gdb)
27802 -break-list
27803 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27804 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27805 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27806 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27807 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27808 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27809 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27810 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27811 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27812 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27813 times="0"@},
27814 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27815 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27816 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27817 times="0"@}]@}
27818 (gdb)
27819 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27820 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27821 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27822 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27823 @c times="0"@}
27824 @c (gdb)
27825 @end smallexample
27826
27827 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27828 @findex -dprintf-insert
27829
27830 @subsubheading Synopsis
27831
27832 @smallexample
27833 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27834 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27835 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27836 [ @var{argument} ]
27837 @end smallexample
27838
27839 @noindent
27840 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27841 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27842
27843 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27844
27845 @table @samp
27846 @item -t
27847 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27848 @item -f
27849 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27850 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27851 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27852 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27853 cannot be parsed.
27854 @item -d
27855 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27856 @item -c @var{condition}
27857 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27858 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27859 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27860 to @var{ignore-count}.
27861 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27862 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27863 @var{thread-id}.
27864 @end table
27865
27866 @subsubheading Result
27867
27868 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27869 resulting breakpoint.
27870
27871 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27872
27873 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27874
27875 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27876
27877 @subsubheading Example
27878
27879 @smallexample
27880 (gdb)
27881 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27882 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27883 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27884 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27885 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27886 original-location="foo"@}
27887 (gdb)
27888 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27889 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27890 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27891 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27892 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27893 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27894 (gdb)
27895 @end smallexample
27896
27897 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27898 @findex -break-list
27899
27900 @subsubheading Synopsis
27901
27902 @smallexample
27903 -break-list
27904 @end smallexample
27905
27906 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27907
27908 @table @samp
27909 @item Number
27910 number of the breakpoint
27911 @item Type
27912 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27913 @item Disposition
27914 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27915 or @samp{nokeep}
27916 @item Enabled
27917 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27918 @item Address
27919 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27920 @item What
27921 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27922 name, line number
27923 @item Thread-groups
27924 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27925 @item Times
27926 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27927 @end table
27928
27929 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27930 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27931
27932 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27933
27934 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27935
27936 @subsubheading Example
27937
27938 @smallexample
27939 (gdb)
27940 -break-list
27941 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27942 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27943 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27944 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27945 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27946 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27947 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27948 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27949 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27950 times="0"@},
27951 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27952 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27953 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27954 (gdb)
27955 @end smallexample
27956
27957 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27958
27959 @smallexample
27960 (gdb)
27961 -break-list
27962 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27963 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27964 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27965 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27966 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27967 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27968 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27969 body=[]@}
27970 (gdb)
27971 @end smallexample
27972
27973 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27974 @findex -break-passcount
27975
27976 @subsubheading Synopsis
27977
27978 @smallexample
27979 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27980 @end smallexample
27981
27982 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27983 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27984 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27985 command @samp{passcount}.
27986
27987 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27988 @findex -break-watch
27989
27990 @subsubheading Synopsis
27991
27992 @smallexample
27993 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27994 @end smallexample
27995
27996 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27997 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27998 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27999 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
28000 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
28001 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
28002 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
28003 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
28004
28005 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
28006 breakpoints inserted.
28007
28008 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28009
28010 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
28011 @samp{rwatch}.
28012
28013 @subsubheading Example
28014
28015 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
28016
28017 @smallexample
28018 (gdb)
28019 -break-watch x
28020 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
28021 (gdb)
28022 -exec-continue
28023 ^running
28024 (gdb)
28025 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
28026 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
28027 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28028 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
28029 (gdb)
28030 @end smallexample
28031
28032 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
28033 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
28034 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
28035
28036 @smallexample
28037 (gdb)
28038 -break-watch C
28039 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
28040 (gdb)
28041 -exec-continue
28042 ^running
28043 (gdb)
28044 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
28045 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28046 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28047 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28048 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
28049 (gdb)
28050 -exec-continue
28051 ^running
28052 (gdb)
28053 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
28054 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28055 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28056 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28057 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28058 (gdb)
28059 @end smallexample
28060
28061 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
28062 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
28063 deleted.
28064
28065 @smallexample
28066 (gdb)
28067 -break-watch C
28068 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
28069 (gdb)
28070 -break-list
28071 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28072 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28073 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28074 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28075 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28076 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28077 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28078 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28079 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28080 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28081 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28082 times="1"@},
28083 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28084 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28085 (gdb)
28086 -exec-continue
28087 ^running
28088 (gdb)
28089 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
28090 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28091 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28092 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28093 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
28094 (gdb)
28095 -break-list
28096 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28097 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28098 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28099 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28100 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28101 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28102 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28103 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28104 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28105 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28106 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28107 times="1"@},
28108 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28109 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
28110 (gdb)
28111 -exec-continue
28112 ^running
28113 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
28114 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28115 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28116 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28117 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28118 (gdb)
28119 -break-list
28120 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28121 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28122 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28123 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28124 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28125 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28126 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28127 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28128 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28129 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28130 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
28131 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
28132 (gdb)
28133 @end smallexample
28134
28135
28136 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28137 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28138 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
28139
28140 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28141 catchpoints.
28142
28143 @menu
28144 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28145 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28146 @end menu
28147
28148 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28149 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28150
28151 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
28152 @findex -catch-load
28153
28154 @subsubheading Synopsis
28155
28156 @smallexample
28157 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28158 @end smallexample
28159
28160 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
28161 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28162 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
28163 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28164 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
28165
28166
28167 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28168
28169 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
28170
28171 @subsubheading Example
28172
28173 @smallexample
28174 -catch-load -t foo.so
28175 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28176 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
28177 (gdb)
28178 @end smallexample
28179
28180
28181 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
28182 @findex -catch-unload
28183
28184 @subsubheading Synopsis
28185
28186 @smallexample
28187 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28188 @end smallexample
28189
28190 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
28191 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28192 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
28193 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28194 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
28195
28196 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28197
28198 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
28199
28200 @subsubheading Example
28201
28202 @smallexample
28203 -catch-unload -d bar.so
28204 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28205 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
28206 (gdb)
28207 @end smallexample
28208
28209 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28210 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28211
28212 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
28213 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
28214
28215 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
28216 @findex -catch-assert
28217
28218 @subsubheading Synopsis
28219
28220 @smallexample
28221 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
28222 @end smallexample
28223
28224 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
28225
28226 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28227
28228 @table @samp
28229 @item -c @var{condition}
28230 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28231 @item -d
28232 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28233 @item -t
28234 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28235 @end table
28236
28237 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28238
28239 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
28240
28241 @subsubheading Example
28242
28243 @smallexample
28244 -catch-assert
28245 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28246 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
28247 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
28248 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
28249 (gdb)
28250 @end smallexample
28251
28252 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
28253 @findex -catch-exception
28254
28255 @subsubheading Synopsis
28256
28257 @smallexample
28258 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28259 [ -t ] [ -u ]
28260 @end smallexample
28261
28262 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
28263 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28264 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28265 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28266 catchpoints.
28267
28268 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28269
28270 @table @samp
28271 @item -c @var{condition}
28272 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28273 @item -d
28274 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28275 @item -e @var{exception-name}
28276 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
28277 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
28278 @item -t
28279 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28280 @item -u
28281 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
28282 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
28283 @end table
28284
28285 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28286
28287 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
28288 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
28289
28290 @subsubheading Example
28291
28292 @smallexample
28293 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
28294 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28295 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
28296 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
28297 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
28298 (gdb)
28299 @end smallexample
28300
28301 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28302 @node GDB/MI Program Context
28303 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
28304
28305 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
28306 @findex -exec-arguments
28307
28308
28309 @subsubheading Synopsis
28310
28311 @smallexample
28312 -exec-arguments @var{args}
28313 @end smallexample
28314
28315 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
28316 @samp{-exec-run}.
28317
28318 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28319
28320 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
28321
28322 @subsubheading Example
28323
28324 @smallexample
28325 (gdb)
28326 -exec-arguments -v word
28327 ^done
28328 (gdb)
28329 @end smallexample
28330
28331
28332 @ignore
28333 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
28334 @findex -exec-show-arguments
28335
28336 @subsubheading Synopsis
28337
28338 @smallexample
28339 -exec-show-arguments
28340 @end smallexample
28341
28342 Print the arguments of the program.
28343
28344 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28345
28346 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
28347
28348 @subsubheading Example
28349 N.A.
28350 @end ignore
28351
28352
28353 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
28354 @findex -environment-cd
28355
28356 @subsubheading Synopsis
28357
28358 @smallexample
28359 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
28360 @end smallexample
28361
28362 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
28363
28364 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28365
28366 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
28367
28368 @subsubheading Example
28369
28370 @smallexample
28371 (gdb)
28372 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28373 ^done
28374 (gdb)
28375 @end smallexample
28376
28377
28378 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
28379 @findex -environment-directory
28380
28381 @subsubheading Synopsis
28382
28383 @smallexample
28384 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28385 @end smallexample
28386
28387 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
28388 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
28389 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
28390 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28391 occurs as normal.
28392 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28393 multiple directories in a single command
28394 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28395 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28396 If blanks are needed as
28397 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28398 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28399 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28400 character must not be used
28401 in any directory name.
28402 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
28403
28404 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28405
28406 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
28407
28408 @subsubheading Example
28409
28410 @smallexample
28411 (gdb)
28412 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28413 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28414 (gdb)
28415 -environment-directory ""
28416 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28417 (gdb)
28418 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
28419 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
28420 (gdb)
28421 -environment-directory -r
28422 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
28423 (gdb)
28424 @end smallexample
28425
28426
28427 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
28428 @findex -environment-path
28429
28430 @subsubheading Synopsis
28431
28432 @smallexample
28433 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28434 @end smallexample
28435
28436 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
28437 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
28438 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
28439 supplied in addition to the
28440 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28441 occurs as normal.
28442 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28443 multiple directories in a single command
28444 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28445 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28446 If blanks are needed as
28447 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28448 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28449 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28450 character must not be used
28451 in any directory name.
28452 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
28453
28454
28455 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28456
28457 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
28458
28459 @subsubheading Example
28460
28461 @smallexample
28462 (gdb)
28463 -environment-path
28464 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
28465 (gdb)
28466 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
28467 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
28468 (gdb)
28469 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
28470 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
28471 (gdb)
28472 @end smallexample
28473
28474
28475 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
28476 @findex -environment-pwd
28477
28478 @subsubheading Synopsis
28479
28480 @smallexample
28481 -environment-pwd
28482 @end smallexample
28483
28484 Show the current working directory.
28485
28486 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28487
28488 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
28489
28490 @subsubheading Example
28491
28492 @smallexample
28493 (gdb)
28494 -environment-pwd
28495 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
28496 (gdb)
28497 @end smallexample
28498
28499 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28500 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
28501 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
28502
28503
28504 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
28505 @findex -thread-info
28506
28507 @subsubheading Synopsis
28508
28509 @smallexample
28510 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
28511 @end smallexample
28512
28513 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
28514 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
28515 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
28516 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
28517 current thread.
28518
28519 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28520
28521 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
28522 about all threads.
28523
28524 @subsubheading Result
28525
28526 The result contains the following attributes:
28527
28528 @table @samp
28529 @item threads
28530 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
28531 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
28532
28533 @item current-thread-id
28534 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
28535 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
28536 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
28537 the command.
28538
28539 @end table
28540
28541 @subsubheading Example
28542
28543 @smallexample
28544 -thread-info
28545 ^done,threads=[
28546 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28547 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28548 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28549 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28550 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28551 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28552 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28553 state="running"@}],
28554 current-thread-id="1"
28555 (gdb)
28556 @end smallexample
28557
28558 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28559 @findex -thread-list-ids
28560
28561 @subsubheading Synopsis
28562
28563 @smallexample
28564 -thread-list-ids
28565 @end smallexample
28566
28567 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28568 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28569 threads.
28570
28571 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28572 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28573
28574 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28575
28576 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28577
28578 @subsubheading Example
28579
28580 @smallexample
28581 (gdb)
28582 -thread-list-ids
28583 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28584 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28585 (gdb)
28586 @end smallexample
28587
28588
28589 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28590 @findex -thread-select
28591
28592 @subsubheading Synopsis
28593
28594 @smallexample
28595 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28596 @end smallexample
28597
28598 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28599 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28600 topmost frame for that thread.
28601
28602 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28603 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
28604
28605 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28606
28607 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28608
28609 @subsubheading Example
28610
28611 @smallexample
28612 (gdb)
28613 -exec-next
28614 ^running
28615 (gdb)
28616 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28617 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28618 (gdb)
28619 -thread-list-ids
28620 ^done,
28621 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28622 number-of-threads="3"
28623 (gdb)
28624 -thread-select 3
28625 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
28626 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28627 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28628 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28629 (gdb)
28630 @end smallexample
28631
28632 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28633 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28634 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28635
28636 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28637 @findex -ada-task-info
28638
28639 @subsubheading Synopsis
28640
28641 @smallexample
28642 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28643 @end smallexample
28644
28645 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28646 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28647
28648 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28649
28650 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28651 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28652
28653 @subsubheading Result
28654
28655 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28656 defined for each Ada task:
28657
28658 @table @samp
28659 @item current
28660 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28661
28662 @item id
28663 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28664
28665 @item task-id
28666 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28667
28668 @item thread-id
28669 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28670 task.
28671
28672 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28673 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28674 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28675
28676 @item parent-id
28677 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28678 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28679
28680 @item priority
28681 The base priority of the task.
28682
28683 @item state
28684 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28685 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28686
28687 @item name
28688 The name of the task.
28689
28690 @end table
28691
28692 @subsubheading Example
28693
28694 @smallexample
28695 -ada-task-info
28696 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28697 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28698 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28699 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28700 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28701 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28702 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28703 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28704 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28705 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28706 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28707 (gdb)
28708 @end smallexample
28709
28710 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28711 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28712 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28713
28714 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28715 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28716 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28717 other cases.
28718
28719 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28720 @findex -exec-continue
28721
28722 @subsubheading Synopsis
28723
28724 @smallexample
28725 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28726 @end smallexample
28727
28728 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28729 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28730 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28731 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28732 @itemize @bullet
28733 @item
28734 breakpoints or watchpoints
28735 @item
28736 signals or exceptions
28737 @item
28738 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28739 @item
28740 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28741 @end itemize
28742 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28743 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28744 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28745 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28746 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28747 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28748
28749 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28750
28751 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28752
28753 @subsubheading Example
28754
28755 @smallexample
28756 -exec-continue
28757 ^running
28758 (gdb)
28759 @@Hello world
28760 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28761 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28762 line="13"@}
28763 (gdb)
28764 @end smallexample
28765
28766
28767 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28768 @findex -exec-finish
28769
28770 @subsubheading Synopsis
28771
28772 @smallexample
28773 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28774 @end smallexample
28775
28776 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28777 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28778 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28779 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28780 function was called.
28781
28782 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28783
28784 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28785
28786 @subsubheading Example
28787
28788 Function returning @code{void}.
28789
28790 @smallexample
28791 -exec-finish
28792 ^running
28793 (gdb)
28794 @@hello from foo
28795 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28796 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28797 (gdb)
28798 @end smallexample
28799
28800 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28801 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28802 value itself.
28803
28804 @smallexample
28805 -exec-finish
28806 ^running
28807 (gdb)
28808 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28809 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28810 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28811 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28812 (gdb)
28813 @end smallexample
28814
28815
28816 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28817 @findex -exec-interrupt
28818
28819 @subsubheading Synopsis
28820
28821 @smallexample
28822 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28823 @end smallexample
28824
28825 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28826 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28827 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28828 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28829 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28830
28831 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28832 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28833 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28834 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28835
28836 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28837 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28838 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28839 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28840
28841 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28842
28843 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28844
28845 @subsubheading Example
28846
28847 @smallexample
28848 (gdb)
28849 111-exec-continue
28850 111^running
28851
28852 (gdb)
28853 222-exec-interrupt
28854 222^done
28855 (gdb)
28856 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28857 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28858 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28859 (gdb)
28860
28861 (gdb)
28862 -exec-interrupt
28863 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28864 (gdb)
28865 @end smallexample
28866
28867 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28868 @findex -exec-jump
28869
28870 @subsubheading Synopsis
28871
28872 @smallexample
28873 -exec-jump @var{location}
28874 @end smallexample
28875
28876 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28877 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28878 different forms of @var{location}.
28879
28880 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28881
28882 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28883
28884 @subsubheading Example
28885
28886 @smallexample
28887 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28888 *running,thread-id="all"
28889 ^running
28890 @end smallexample
28891
28892
28893 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28894 @findex -exec-next
28895
28896 @subsubheading Synopsis
28897
28898 @smallexample
28899 -exec-next [--reverse]
28900 @end smallexample
28901
28902 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28903 of the next source line is reached.
28904
28905 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28906 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28907 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28908 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28909 source line where the function was called.
28910
28911
28912 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28913
28914 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28915
28916 @subsubheading Example
28917
28918 @smallexample
28919 -exec-next
28920 ^running
28921 (gdb)
28922 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28923 (gdb)
28924 @end smallexample
28925
28926
28927 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28928 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28929
28930 @subsubheading Synopsis
28931
28932 @smallexample
28933 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28934 @end smallexample
28935
28936 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28937 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28938 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28939 printed as well.
28940
28941 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28942 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28943 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28944 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28945 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28946
28947 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28948
28949 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28950
28951 @subsubheading Example
28952
28953 @smallexample
28954 (gdb)
28955 -exec-next-instruction
28956 ^running
28957
28958 (gdb)
28959 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28960 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28961 (gdb)
28962 @end smallexample
28963
28964
28965 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28966 @findex -exec-return
28967
28968 @subsubheading Synopsis
28969
28970 @smallexample
28971 -exec-return
28972 @end smallexample
28973
28974 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28975 Displays the new current frame.
28976
28977 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28978
28979 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28980
28981 @subsubheading Example
28982
28983 @smallexample
28984 (gdb)
28985 200-break-insert callee4
28986 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28987 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28988 (gdb)
28989 000-exec-run
28990 000^running
28991 (gdb)
28992 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28993 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28994 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28995 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28996 (gdb)
28997 205-break-delete
28998 205^done
28999 (gdb)
29000 111-exec-return
29001 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
29002 args=[@{name="strarg",
29003 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29004 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29005 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
29006 (gdb)
29007 @end smallexample
29008
29009
29010 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
29011 @findex -exec-run
29012
29013 @subsubheading Synopsis
29014
29015 @smallexample
29016 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
29017 @end smallexample
29018
29019 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
29020 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
29021 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
29022 the program has exited exceptionally.
29023
29024 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
29025 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
29026 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
29027 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
29028 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
29029
29030 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
29031 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
29032 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
29033 (@pxref{Starting}).
29034
29035 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29036
29037 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
29038
29039 @subsubheading Examples
29040
29041 @smallexample
29042 (gdb)
29043 -break-insert main
29044 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29045 (gdb)
29046 -exec-run
29047 ^running
29048 (gdb)
29049 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29050 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29051 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29052 (gdb)
29053 @end smallexample
29054
29055 @noindent
29056 Program exited normally:
29057
29058 @smallexample
29059 (gdb)
29060 -exec-run
29061 ^running
29062 (gdb)
29063 x = 55
29064 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29065 (gdb)
29066 @end smallexample
29067
29068 @noindent
29069 Program exited exceptionally:
29070
29071 @smallexample
29072 (gdb)
29073 -exec-run
29074 ^running
29075 (gdb)
29076 x = 55
29077 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
29078 (gdb)
29079 @end smallexample
29080
29081 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
29082 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
29083
29084 @smallexample
29085 (gdb)
29086 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
29087 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
29088 @end smallexample
29089
29090
29091 @c @subheading -exec-signal
29092
29093
29094 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
29095 @findex -exec-step
29096
29097 @subsubheading Synopsis
29098
29099 @smallexample
29100 -exec-step [--reverse]
29101 @end smallexample
29102
29103 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29104 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
29105 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
29106 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
29107 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
29108 previously executed source line.
29109
29110 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29111
29112 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
29113
29114 @subsubheading Example
29115
29116 Stepping into a function:
29117
29118 @smallexample
29119 -exec-step
29120 ^running
29121 (gdb)
29122 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29123 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
29124 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
29125 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
29126 (gdb)
29127 @end smallexample
29128
29129 Regular stepping:
29130
29131 @smallexample
29132 -exec-step
29133 ^running
29134 (gdb)
29135 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
29136 (gdb)
29137 @end smallexample
29138
29139
29140 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
29141 @findex -exec-step-instruction
29142
29143 @subsubheading Synopsis
29144
29145 @smallexample
29146 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
29147 @end smallexample
29148
29149 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
29150 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
29151 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
29152 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
29153 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
29154 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
29155 as well.
29156
29157 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29158
29159 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
29160
29161 @subsubheading Example
29162
29163 @smallexample
29164 (gdb)
29165 -exec-step-instruction
29166 ^running
29167
29168 (gdb)
29169 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29170 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29171 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29172 (gdb)
29173 -exec-step-instruction
29174 ^running
29175
29176 (gdb)
29177 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29178 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29179 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29180 (gdb)
29181 @end smallexample
29182
29183
29184 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
29185 @findex -exec-until
29186
29187 @subsubheading Synopsis
29188
29189 @smallexample
29190 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
29191 @end smallexample
29192
29193 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
29194 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
29195 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
29196 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
29197
29198 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29199
29200 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
29201
29202 @subsubheading Example
29203
29204 @smallexample
29205 (gdb)
29206 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
29207 ^running
29208 (gdb)
29209 x = 55
29210 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29211 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
29212 (gdb)
29213 @end smallexample
29214
29215 @ignore
29216 @subheading -file-clear
29217 Is this going away????
29218 @end ignore
29219
29220 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29221 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
29222 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
29223
29224 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
29225 @findex -enable-frame-filters
29226
29227 @smallexample
29228 -enable-frame-filters
29229 @end smallexample
29230
29231 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
29232 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
29233 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29234 request that this functionality be enabled.
29235
29236 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29237
29238 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29239 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29240
29241 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
29242 @findex -stack-info-frame
29243
29244 @subsubheading Synopsis
29245
29246 @smallexample
29247 -stack-info-frame
29248 @end smallexample
29249
29250 Get info on the selected frame.
29251
29252 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29253
29254 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
29255 (without arguments).
29256
29257 @subsubheading Example
29258
29259 @smallexample
29260 (gdb)
29261 -stack-info-frame
29262 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29263 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29264 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
29265 (gdb)
29266 @end smallexample
29267
29268 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
29269 @findex -stack-info-depth
29270
29271 @subsubheading Synopsis
29272
29273 @smallexample
29274 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
29275 @end smallexample
29276
29277 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
29278 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
29279
29280 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29281
29282 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29283
29284 @subsubheading Example
29285
29286 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
29287
29288 @smallexample
29289 (gdb)
29290 -stack-info-depth
29291 ^done,depth="12"
29292 (gdb)
29293 -stack-info-depth 4
29294 ^done,depth="4"
29295 (gdb)
29296 -stack-info-depth 12
29297 ^done,depth="12"
29298 (gdb)
29299 -stack-info-depth 11
29300 ^done,depth="11"
29301 (gdb)
29302 -stack-info-depth 13
29303 ^done,depth="12"
29304 (gdb)
29305 @end smallexample
29306
29307 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
29308 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
29309 @findex -stack-list-arguments
29310
29311 @subsubheading Synopsis
29312
29313 @smallexample
29314 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29315 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29316 @end smallexample
29317
29318 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
29319 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
29320 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
29321 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
29322 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
29323 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
29324 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
29325 which case only existing frames will be returned.
29326
29327 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29328 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29329 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29330 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29331 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29332 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29333
29334 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
29335 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
29336 are still displayed, however.
29337
29338 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
29339 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29340
29341 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29342
29343 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
29344 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
29345 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
29346
29347 @subsubheading Example
29348
29349 @smallexample
29350 (gdb)
29351 -stack-list-frames
29352 ^done,
29353 stack=[
29354 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29355 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29356 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
29357 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29358 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29359 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
29360 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
29361 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29362 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
29363 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
29364 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29365 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
29366 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
29367 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29368 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
29369 (gdb)
29370 -stack-list-arguments 0
29371 ^done,
29372 stack-args=[
29373 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29374 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
29375 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
29376 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
29377 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29378 (gdb)
29379 -stack-list-arguments 1
29380 ^done,
29381 stack-args=[
29382 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29383 frame=@{level="1",
29384 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29385 frame=@{level="2",args=[
29386 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29387 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29388 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
29389 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29390 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
29391 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
29392 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29393 (gdb)
29394 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
29395 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
29396 (gdb)
29397 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
29398 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
29399 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29400 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
29401 (gdb)
29402 @end smallexample
29403
29404 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
29405
29406
29407 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
29408 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
29409 @findex -stack-list-frames
29410
29411 @subsubheading Synopsis
29412
29413 @smallexample
29414 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29415 @end smallexample
29416
29417 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
29418 following info:
29419
29420 @table @samp
29421 @item @var{level}
29422 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
29423 @item @var{addr}
29424 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
29425 @item @var{func}
29426 Function name.
29427 @item @var{file}
29428 File name of the source file where the function lives.
29429 @item @var{fullname}
29430 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
29431 @item @var{line}
29432 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
29433 @item @var{from}
29434 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
29435 if the frame's function is not known.
29436 @end table
29437
29438 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
29439 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
29440 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
29441 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
29442 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
29443 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
29444 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
29445 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29446 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29447
29448 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29449
29450 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
29451
29452 @subsubheading Example
29453
29454 Full stack backtrace:
29455
29456 @smallexample
29457 (gdb)
29458 -stack-list-frames
29459 ^done,stack=
29460 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
29461 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
29462 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29463 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29464 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29465 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29466 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29467 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29468 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29469 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29470 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29471 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29472 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29473 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29474 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29475 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29476 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29477 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29478 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29479 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29480 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29481 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29482 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
29483 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
29484 (gdb)
29485 @end smallexample
29486
29487 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
29488
29489 @smallexample
29490 (gdb)
29491 -stack-list-frames 3 5
29492 ^done,stack=
29493 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29494 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29495 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29496 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29497 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29498 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29499 (gdb)
29500 @end smallexample
29501
29502 Show a single frame:
29503
29504 @smallexample
29505 (gdb)
29506 -stack-list-frames 3 3
29507 ^done,stack=
29508 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29509 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29510 (gdb)
29511 @end smallexample
29512
29513
29514 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29515 @findex -stack-list-locals
29516 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
29517
29518 @subsubheading Synopsis
29519
29520 @smallexample
29521 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29522 @end smallexample
29523
29524 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
29525 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29526 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29527 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29528 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29529 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29530 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29531 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29532 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29533 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29534
29535 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29536 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
29537 variables are still displayed, however.
29538
29539 This command is deprecated in favor of the
29540 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29541
29542 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29543
29544 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29545
29546 @subsubheading Example
29547
29548 @smallexample
29549 (gdb)
29550 -stack-list-locals 0
29551 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29552 (gdb)
29553 -stack-list-locals --all-values
29554 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29555 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29556 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
29557 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29558 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29559 (gdb)
29560 @end smallexample
29561
29562 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29563 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29564 @findex -stack-list-variables
29565
29566 @subsubheading Synopsis
29567
29568 @smallexample
29569 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29570 @end smallexample
29571
29572 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29573 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29574 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29575 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29576 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29577 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29578 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29579
29580 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29581 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
29582 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29583
29584 @subsubheading Example
29585
29586 @smallexample
29587 (gdb)
29588 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29589 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29590 (gdb)
29591 @end smallexample
29592
29593
29594 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29595 @findex -stack-select-frame
29596
29597 @subsubheading Synopsis
29598
29599 @smallexample
29600 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29601 @end smallexample
29602
29603 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29604 the stack.
29605
29606 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29607 option to every command.
29608
29609 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29610
29611 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29612 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29613
29614 @subsubheading Example
29615
29616 @smallexample
29617 (gdb)
29618 -stack-select-frame 2
29619 ^done
29620 (gdb)
29621 @end smallexample
29622
29623 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29624 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29625 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29626
29627 @ignore
29628
29629 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29630
29631 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29632 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29633 used by @code{Insight}.
29634
29635 The two main reasons for that are:
29636
29637 @enumerate 1
29638 @item
29639 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29640
29641 @item
29642 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29643 now).
29644 @end enumerate
29645
29646 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29647 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29648 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29649 hints about their use.
29650
29651 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29652 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29653 least, the following operations:
29654
29655 @itemize @bullet
29656 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29657 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29658 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29659 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29660 @end itemize
29661
29662 @end ignore
29663
29664 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29665
29666 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29667
29668 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29669 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29670 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29671 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29672 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29673 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29674 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29675 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29676 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29677 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29678 object, or to change display format.
29679
29680 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29681 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29682 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29683 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29684 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29685 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29686 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29687 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29688 child will be created.
29689
29690 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29691 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29692 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29693 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29694 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29695
29696 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29697 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29698 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29699 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29700 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29701 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29702 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29703 variables that frontend has created.
29704
29705 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29706 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29707 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29708 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29709 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29710 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29711 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29712 implicitly updated.
29713
29714 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29715 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29716 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29717 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29718 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29719 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29720 frame. Consider this example:
29721
29722 @smallexample
29723 void do_work(...)
29724 @{
29725 struct work_state state;
29726
29727 if (...)
29728 do_work(...);
29729 @}
29730 @end smallexample
29731
29732 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29733 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29734 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29735 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29736 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29737
29738 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29739 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29740 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29741 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29742 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29743 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29744
29745 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29746 access this functionality:
29747
29748 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29749 @item @strong{Operation}
29750 @tab @strong{Description}
29751
29752 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29753 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29754 @item @code{-var-create}
29755 @tab create a variable object
29756 @item @code{-var-delete}
29757 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29758 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29759 @tab set the display format of this variable
29760 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29761 @tab show the display format of this variable
29762 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29763 @tab tells how many children this object has
29764 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29765 @tab return a list of the object's children
29766 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29767 @tab show the type of this variable object
29768 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29769 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29770 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29771 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29772 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29773 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29774 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29775 @tab get the value of this variable
29776 @item @code{-var-assign}
29777 @tab set the value of this variable
29778 @item @code{-var-update}
29779 @tab update the variable and its children
29780 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29781 @tab set frozeness attribute
29782 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29783 @tab set range of children to display on update
29784 @end multitable
29785
29786 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29787 how it can be used.
29788
29789 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29790
29791 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29792 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29793
29794 @smallexample
29795 -enable-pretty-printing
29796 @end smallexample
29797
29798 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29799 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29800 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29801 request that this functionality be enabled.
29802
29803 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29804
29805 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29806 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29807
29808 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29809 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29810
29811 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29812 @findex -var-create
29813
29814 @subsubheading Synopsis
29815
29816 @smallexample
29817 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29818 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29819 @end smallexample
29820
29821 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29822 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29823 register.
29824
29825 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29826 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29827 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29828 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29829 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29830
29831 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29832 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29833 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29834 object must be created.
29835
29836 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29837 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29838
29839 @itemize @bullet
29840 @item
29841 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29842
29843 @item
29844 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29845
29846 @item
29847 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29848 @end itemize
29849
29850 @cindex dynamic varobj
29851 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29852 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29853 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29854 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29855 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29856 compatibility for existing clients.
29857
29858 @subsubheading Result
29859
29860 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29861 are:
29862
29863 @table @samp
29864 @item name
29865 The name of the varobj.
29866
29867 @item numchild
29868 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29869 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29870 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29871
29872 @item value
29873 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29874 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29875 will not be interesting.
29876
29877 @item type
29878 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29879 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29880 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29881 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29882 @emph{declared} one.
29883
29884 @item thread-id
29885 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29886 thread's global identifier.
29887
29888 @item has_more
29889 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29890 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29891
29892 @item dynamic
29893 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29894 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29895 then this attribute will not be present.
29896
29897 @item displayhint
29898 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29899 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29900 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29901 @end table
29902
29903 Typical output will look like this:
29904
29905 @smallexample
29906 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29907 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29908 @end smallexample
29909
29910
29911 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29912 @findex -var-delete
29913
29914 @subsubheading Synopsis
29915
29916 @smallexample
29917 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29918 @end smallexample
29919
29920 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29921 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29922
29923 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29924
29925
29926 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29927 @findex -var-set-format
29928
29929 @subsubheading Synopsis
29930
29931 @smallexample
29932 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29933 @end smallexample
29934
29935 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29936 @var{format-spec}.
29937
29938 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29939 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29940
29941 @smallexample
29942 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29943 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29944 @end smallexample
29945
29946 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29947 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29948 for pointers, etc.).
29949
29950 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29951 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29952 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29953 zero-hexadecimal format.
29954
29955 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29956 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29957
29958 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29959 @findex -var-show-format
29960
29961 @subsubheading Synopsis
29962
29963 @smallexample
29964 -var-show-format @var{name}
29965 @end smallexample
29966
29967 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29968
29969 @smallexample
29970 @var{format} @expansion{}
29971 @var{format-spec}
29972 @end smallexample
29973
29974
29975 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29976 @findex -var-info-num-children
29977
29978 @subsubheading Synopsis
29979
29980 @smallexample
29981 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29982 @end smallexample
29983
29984 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29985
29986 @smallexample
29987 numchild=@var{n}
29988 @end smallexample
29989
29990 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29991 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29992 be available.
29993
29994
29995 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29996 @findex -var-list-children
29997
29998 @subsubheading Synopsis
29999
30000 @smallexample
30001 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
30002 @end smallexample
30003 @anchor{-var-list-children}
30004
30005 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
30006 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
30007 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
30008 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
30009 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
30010 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
30011 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
30012 and unions.
30013
30014 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
30015 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
30016 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
30017 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
30018 reported.
30019
30020 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
30021 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
30022 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
30023 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
30024 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
30025 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
30026 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
30027 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
30028 the visible items.
30029
30030 For each child the following results are returned:
30031
30032 @table @var
30033
30034 @item name
30035 Name of the variable object created for this child.
30036
30037 @item exp
30038 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
30039 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
30040
30041 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
30042 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
30043
30044 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
30045 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
30046 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
30047 type and value are not present.
30048
30049 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
30050 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
30051 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
30052
30053 @item numchild
30054 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
30055 0.
30056
30057 @item type
30058 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
30059 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30060 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30061 @emph{declared} one.
30062
30063 @item value
30064 If values were requested, this is the value.
30065
30066 @item thread-id
30067 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
30068 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
30069
30070 @item frozen
30071 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
30072
30073 @item displayhint
30074 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30075 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30076 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30077
30078 @item dynamic
30079 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30080 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30081 then this attribute will not be present.
30082
30083 @end table
30084
30085 The result may have its own attributes:
30086
30087 @table @samp
30088 @item displayhint
30089 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30090 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30091 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30092
30093 @item has_more
30094 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
30095 remaining after the end of the selected range.
30096 @end table
30097
30098 @subsubheading Example
30099
30100 @smallexample
30101 (gdb)
30102 -var-list-children n
30103 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30104 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30105 (gdb)
30106 -var-list-children --all-values n
30107 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30108 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30109 @end smallexample
30110
30111
30112 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
30113 @findex -var-info-type
30114
30115 @subsubheading Synopsis
30116
30117 @smallexample
30118 -var-info-type @var{name}
30119 @end smallexample
30120
30121 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
30122 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
30123 @value{GDBN} CLI:
30124
30125 @smallexample
30126 type=@var{typename}
30127 @end smallexample
30128
30129
30130 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
30131 @findex -var-info-expression
30132
30133 @subsubheading Synopsis
30134
30135 @smallexample
30136 -var-info-expression @var{name}
30137 @end smallexample
30138
30139 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
30140 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
30141 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
30142
30143 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
30144 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
30145
30146 @smallexample
30147 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
30148 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
30149 @end smallexample
30150
30151 @noindent
30152 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
30153 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
30154
30155 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
30156 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
30157 is of limited use.
30158
30159 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
30160 @findex -var-info-path-expression
30161
30162 @subsubheading Synopsis
30163
30164 @smallexample
30165 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
30166 @end smallexample
30167
30168 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
30169 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
30170 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
30171 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
30172 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
30173 watchpoint from a variable object.
30174
30175 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
30176 and will give an error when invoked on one.
30177
30178 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
30179 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
30180 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
30181 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
30182 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
30183 @smallexample
30184 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
30185 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
30186 @end smallexample
30187
30188 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
30189 @findex -var-show-attributes
30190
30191 @subsubheading Synopsis
30192
30193 @smallexample
30194 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
30195 @end smallexample
30196
30197 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
30198
30199 @smallexample
30200 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
30201 @end smallexample
30202
30203 @noindent
30204 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
30205
30206 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
30207 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
30208
30209 @subsubheading Synopsis
30210
30211 @smallexample
30212 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
30213 @end smallexample
30214
30215 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
30216 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
30217 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
30218 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
30219 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
30220 the current display format will be used. The current display format
30221 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
30222
30223 @smallexample
30224 value=@var{value}
30225 @end smallexample
30226
30227 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
30228 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
30229
30230 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
30231 @findex -var-assign
30232
30233 @subsubheading Synopsis
30234
30235 @smallexample
30236 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
30237 @end smallexample
30238
30239 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
30240 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
30241 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
30242 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
30243
30244 @subsubheading Example
30245
30246 @smallexample
30247 (gdb)
30248 -var-assign var1 3
30249 ^done,value="3"
30250 (gdb)
30251 -var-update *
30252 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
30253 (gdb)
30254 @end smallexample
30255
30256 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
30257 @findex -var-update
30258
30259 @subsubheading Synopsis
30260
30261 @smallexample
30262 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
30263 @end smallexample
30264
30265 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
30266 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
30267 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
30268 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
30269 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
30270 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
30271 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
30272 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
30273 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
30274 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
30275 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
30276 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
30277 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
30278
30279 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
30280 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
30281 diagnostic.
30282
30283 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
30284 only the selected range of children will be reported.
30285
30286 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
30287 @samp{changelist}.
30288
30289 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
30290
30291 @table @samp
30292 @item name
30293 The name of the varobj.
30294
30295 @item value
30296 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
30297 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
30298
30299 @item in_scope
30300 @anchor{-var-update}
30301 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
30302
30303 @table @code
30304 @item "true"
30305 The variable object's current value is valid.
30306
30307 @item "false"
30308 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
30309 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
30310 scope.
30311
30312 @item "invalid"
30313 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
30314 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
30315 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
30316 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
30317 objects.
30318 @end table
30319
30320 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
30321 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
30322
30323 @item type_changed
30324 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
30325 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
30326 be @samp{false}.
30327
30328 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
30329 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
30330 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
30331 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
30332 unset.
30333
30334 @item new_type
30335 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
30336 hold the new type.
30337
30338 @item new_num_children
30339 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
30340 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
30341
30342 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
30343 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
30344 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
30345 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
30346 children which may be available.
30347
30348 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
30349 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
30350 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
30351 only happen at the end of the update range).
30352
30353 @item displayhint
30354 The display hint, if any.
30355
30356 @item has_more
30357 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
30358 available outside the varobj's update range.
30359
30360 @item dynamic
30361 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30362 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30363 then this attribute will not be present.
30364
30365 @item new_children
30366 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
30367 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
30368 be listed in this attribute.
30369 @end table
30370
30371 @subsubheading Example
30372
30373 @smallexample
30374 (gdb)
30375 -var-assign var1 3
30376 ^done,value="3"
30377 (gdb)
30378 -var-update --all-values var1
30379 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
30380 type_changed="false"@}]
30381 (gdb)
30382 @end smallexample
30383
30384 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
30385 @findex -var-set-frozen
30386 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
30387
30388 @subsubheading Synopsis
30389
30390 @smallexample
30391 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
30392 @end smallexample
30393
30394 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
30395 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
30396 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
30397 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
30398 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
30399 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
30400 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
30401 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
30402 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
30403 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
30404 @code{-var-update} does.
30405
30406 @subsubheading Example
30407
30408 @smallexample
30409 (gdb)
30410 -var-set-frozen V 1
30411 ^done
30412 (gdb)
30413 @end smallexample
30414
30415 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
30416 @findex -var-set-update-range
30417 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
30418
30419 @subsubheading Synopsis
30420
30421 @smallexample
30422 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
30423 @end smallexample
30424
30425 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
30426 @code{-var-update}.
30427
30428 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
30429 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
30430 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
30431 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
30432
30433 @subsubheading Example
30434
30435 @smallexample
30436 (gdb)
30437 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
30438 ^done
30439 @end smallexample
30440
30441 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
30442 @findex -var-set-visualizer
30443 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
30444
30445 @subsubheading Synopsis
30446
30447 @smallexample
30448 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
30449 @end smallexample
30450
30451 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
30452
30453 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
30454 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
30455
30456 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
30457 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
30458 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
30459 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
30460 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
30461 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
30462 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
30463
30464 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
30465 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
30466 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
30467 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
30468
30469 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
30470 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
30471 can be used to check this.
30472
30473 @subsubheading Example
30474
30475 Resetting the visualizer:
30476
30477 @smallexample
30478 (gdb)
30479 -var-set-visualizer V None
30480 ^done
30481 @end smallexample
30482
30483 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
30484
30485 @smallexample
30486 (gdb)
30487 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
30488 ^done
30489 @end smallexample
30490
30491 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
30492 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
30493
30494 @smallexample
30495 (gdb)
30496 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
30497 ^done
30498 @end smallexample
30499
30500 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30501 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
30502 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
30503
30504 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
30505 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
30506 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
30507 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
30508
30509 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
30510 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
30511
30512 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30513 @c @subheading -data-assign
30514 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30515 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
30516 @c set variable
30517 @c @subsubheading Example
30518 @c N.A.
30519
30520 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30521 @findex -data-disassemble
30522
30523 @subsubheading Synopsis
30524
30525 @smallexample
30526 -data-disassemble
30527 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30528 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30529 -- @var{mode}
30530 @end smallexample
30531
30532 @noindent
30533 Where:
30534
30535 @table @samp
30536 @item @var{start-addr}
30537 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30538 @item @var{end-addr}
30539 is the end address
30540 @item @var{filename}
30541 is the name of the file to disassemble
30542 @item @var{linenum}
30543 is the line number to disassemble around
30544 @item @var{lines}
30545 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30546 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30547 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30548 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30549 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30550 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30551 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30552 are displayed.
30553 @item @var{mode}
30554 is one of:
30555 @itemize @bullet
30556 @item 0 disassembly only
30557 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30558 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30559 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30560 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30561 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30562 @end itemize
30563
30564 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
30565 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30566 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30567 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30568 @end table
30569
30570 @subsubheading Result
30571
30572 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30573 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30574 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30575
30576 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30577 following fields:
30578
30579 @table @code
30580 @item address
30581 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30582
30583 @item func-name
30584 The name of the function this instruction is within.
30585
30586 @item offset
30587 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30588
30589 @item inst
30590 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30591
30592 @item opcodes
30593 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
30594 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30595
30596 @end table
30597
30598 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30599 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30600
30601 @table @code
30602 @item line
30603 The line number within @samp{file}.
30604
30605 @item file
30606 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30607 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30608 used.
30609
30610 @item fullname
30611 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
30612 using the source file search path
30613 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30614 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30615
30616 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30617 present in the debug information.
30618
30619 @item line_asm_insn
30620 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30621 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30622 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30623 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30624 @samp{opcodes}.
30625
30626 @end table
30627
30628 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30629 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30630 adjust its format.
30631
30632 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30633
30634 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30635
30636 @subsubheading Example
30637
30638 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30639
30640 @smallexample
30641 (gdb)
30642 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30643 ^done,
30644 asm_insns=[
30645 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30646 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30647 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30648 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30649 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30650 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30651 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30652 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30653 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30654 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30655 (gdb)
30656 @end smallexample
30657
30658 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30659 @code{main}.
30660
30661 @smallexample
30662 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30663 ^done,asm_insns=[
30664 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30665 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30666 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30667 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30668 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30669 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30670 [@dots{}]
30671 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30672 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30673 (gdb)
30674 @end smallexample
30675
30676 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30677
30678 @smallexample
30679 (gdb)
30680 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30681 ^done,asm_insns=[
30682 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30683 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30684 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30685 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30686 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30687 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30688 (gdb)
30689 @end smallexample
30690
30691 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30692
30693 @smallexample
30694 (gdb)
30695 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30696 ^done,asm_insns=[
30697 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30698 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30699 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30700 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30701 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30702 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30703 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30704 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30705 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30706 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30707 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30708 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30709 (gdb)
30710 @end smallexample
30711
30712
30713 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30714 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30715
30716 @subsubheading Synopsis
30717
30718 @smallexample
30719 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30720 @end smallexample
30721
30722 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30723 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30724 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30725
30726 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30727
30728 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30729 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30730 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30731
30732 @subsubheading Example
30733
30734 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30735 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30736 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30737 output.
30738
30739 @smallexample
30740 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30741 211^done,value="1"
30742 (gdb)
30743 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30744 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30745 (gdb)
30746 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30747 411^done,value="4"
30748 (gdb)
30749 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30750 511^done,value="4"
30751 (gdb)
30752 @end smallexample
30753
30754
30755 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30756 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30757
30758 @subsubheading Synopsis
30759
30760 @smallexample
30761 -data-list-changed-registers
30762 @end smallexample
30763
30764 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30765
30766 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30767
30768 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30769 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30770
30771 @subsubheading Example
30772
30773 On a PPC MBX board:
30774
30775 @smallexample
30776 (gdb)
30777 -exec-continue
30778 ^running
30779
30780 (gdb)
30781 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30782 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30783 line="5"@}
30784 (gdb)
30785 -data-list-changed-registers
30786 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30787 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30788 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30789 (gdb)
30790 @end smallexample
30791
30792
30793 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30794 @findex -data-list-register-names
30795
30796 @subsubheading Synopsis
30797
30798 @smallexample
30799 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30800 @end smallexample
30801
30802 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30803 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30804 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30805 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30806 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30807 include empty register names.
30808
30809 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30810
30811 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30812 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30813 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30814
30815 @subsubheading Example
30816
30817 For the PPC MBX board:
30818 @smallexample
30819 (gdb)
30820 -data-list-register-names
30821 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30822 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30823 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30824 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30825 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30826 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30827 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30828 (gdb)
30829 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30830 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30831 (gdb)
30832 @end smallexample
30833
30834 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30835 @findex -data-list-register-values
30836
30837 @subsubheading Synopsis
30838
30839 @smallexample
30840 -data-list-register-values
30841 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30842 @end smallexample
30843
30844 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30845 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30846 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30847 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30848 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30849 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30850
30851 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30852
30853 @table @code
30854 @item x
30855 Hexadecimal
30856 @item o
30857 Octal
30858 @item t
30859 Binary
30860 @item d
30861 Decimal
30862 @item r
30863 Raw
30864 @item N
30865 Natural
30866 @end table
30867
30868 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30869
30870 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30871 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30872
30873 @subsubheading Example
30874
30875 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30876 don't appear in the actual output):
30877
30878 @smallexample
30879 (gdb)
30880 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30881 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30882 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30883 (gdb)
30884 -data-list-register-values x
30885 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30886 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30887 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30888 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30889 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30890 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30891 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30892 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30893 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30894 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30895 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30896 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30897 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30898 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30899 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30900 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30901 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30902 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30903 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30904 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30905 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30906 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30907 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30908 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30909 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30910 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30911 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30912 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30913 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30914 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30915 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30916 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30917 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30918 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30919 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30920 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30921 (gdb)
30922 @end smallexample
30923
30924
30925 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30926 @findex -data-read-memory
30927
30928 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30929
30930 @subsubheading Synopsis
30931
30932 @smallexample
30933 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30934 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30935 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30936 @end smallexample
30937
30938 @noindent
30939 where:
30940
30941 @table @samp
30942 @item @var{address}
30943 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30944 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30945 quoted using the C convention.
30946
30947 @item @var{word-format}
30948 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30949 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30950 ,Output Formats}).
30951
30952 @item @var{word-size}
30953 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30954
30955 @item @var{nr-rows}
30956 The number of rows in the output table.
30957
30958 @item @var{nr-cols}
30959 The number of columns in the output table.
30960
30961 @item @var{aschar}
30962 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30963 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30964 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30965 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30966
30967 @item @var{byte-offset}
30968 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30969 @end table
30970
30971 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30972 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30973 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30974 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30975 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30976 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30977 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30978 @samp{addr}.
30979
30980 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30981 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30982 @samp{prev-page}.
30983
30984 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30985
30986 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30987 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30988
30989 @subsubheading Example
30990
30991 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30992 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30993 word. Display each word in hex.
30994
30995 @smallexample
30996 (gdb)
30997 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30998 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30999 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
31000 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
31001 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
31002 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
31003 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
31004 (gdb)
31005 @end smallexample
31006
31007 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
31008 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
31009
31010 @smallexample
31011 (gdb)
31012 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
31013 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
31014 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
31015 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
31016 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
31017 (gdb)
31018 @end smallexample
31019
31020 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
31021 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
31022 used as the non-printable character.
31023
31024 @smallexample
31025 (gdb)
31026 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
31027 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
31028 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
31029 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
31030 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31031 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31032 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31033 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31034 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
31035 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
31036 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
31037 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
31038 (gdb)
31039 @end smallexample
31040
31041 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
31042 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
31043
31044 @subsubheading Synopsis
31045
31046 @smallexample
31047 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
31048 @var{address} @var{count}
31049 @end smallexample
31050
31051 @noindent
31052 where:
31053
31054 @table @samp
31055 @item @var{address}
31056 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31057 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31058 quoted using the C convention.
31059
31060 @item @var{count}
31061 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
31062 literal.
31063
31064 @item @var{offset}
31065 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
31066 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
31067 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
31068 arithmetics itself.
31069
31070 @end table
31071
31072 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
31073 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
31074 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
31075 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
31076 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
31077 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
31078
31079 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
31080 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
31081 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
31082 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
31083 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
31084 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
31085 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
31086 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
31087
31088 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
31089 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
31090 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
31091 and has the following fields:
31092
31093 @table @code
31094 @item begin
31095 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31096
31097 @item end
31098 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31099
31100 @item offset
31101 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
31102 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
31103
31104 @item contents
31105 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
31106
31107 @end table
31108
31109
31110
31111 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31112
31113 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
31114
31115 @subsubheading Example
31116
31117 @smallexample
31118 (gdb)
31119 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
31120 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
31121 end="0xbffff15e",
31122 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
31123 (gdb)
31124 @end smallexample
31125
31126
31127 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
31128 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
31129
31130 @subsubheading Synopsis
31131
31132 @smallexample
31133 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
31134 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
31135 @end smallexample
31136
31137 @noindent
31138 where:
31139
31140 @table @samp
31141 @item @var{address}
31142 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31143 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
31144 be quoted using the C convention.
31145
31146 @item @var{contents}
31147 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
31148 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
31149
31150 @item @var{count}
31151 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
31152 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
31153 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
31154 @var{count} memory units.
31155
31156 @end table
31157
31158 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31159
31160 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31161
31162 @subsubheading Example
31163
31164 @smallexample
31165 (gdb)
31166 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
31167 ^done
31168 (gdb)
31169 @end smallexample
31170
31171 @smallexample
31172 (gdb)
31173 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
31174 ^done
31175 (gdb)
31176 @end smallexample
31177
31178 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31179 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
31180 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
31181
31182 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
31183 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
31184
31185 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
31186 @findex -trace-find
31187
31188 @subsubheading Synopsis
31189
31190 @smallexample
31191 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
31192 @end smallexample
31193
31194 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
31195 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
31196 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
31197
31198 @table @samp
31199
31200 @item none
31201 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
31202
31203 @item frame-number
31204 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
31205 that index.
31206
31207 @item tracepoint-number
31208 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
31209 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
31210
31211 @item pc
31212 An address is required as parameter. Finds
31213 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
31214 address.
31215
31216 @item pc-inside-range
31217 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
31218 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
31219 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31220
31221 @item pc-outside-range
31222 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
31223 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
31224 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31225
31226 @item line
31227 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
31228 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
31229 the specified location.
31230
31231 @end table
31232
31233 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
31234 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
31235
31236 @table @samp
31237 @item found
31238 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
31239 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
31240
31241 @item traceframe
31242 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
31243 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31244
31245 @item tracepoint
31246 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
31247 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31248
31249 @item frame
31250 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
31251 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
31252 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
31253
31254 @end table
31255
31256 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31257
31258 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
31259
31260 @subheading -trace-define-variable
31261 @findex -trace-define-variable
31262
31263 @subsubheading Synopsis
31264
31265 @smallexample
31266 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
31267 @end smallexample
31268
31269 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
31270 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
31271 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
31272 with the @samp{$} character.
31273
31274 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31275
31276 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
31277
31278 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
31279 @findex -trace-frame-collected
31280
31281 @subsubheading Synopsis
31282
31283 @smallexample
31284 -trace-frame-collected
31285 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
31286 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
31287 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
31288 [--memory-contents]
31289 @end smallexample
31290
31291 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
31292 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
31293 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
31294 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
31295 See the output description table below for more details.
31296
31297 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
31298 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
31299 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
31300 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
31301 memory range and which is a computed expression.
31302
31303 For instance, if the actions were
31304 @smallexample
31305 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
31306 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
31307 @end smallexample
31308
31309 @noindent
31310 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
31311 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
31312 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
31313 objects would be computed expressions.
31314
31315 An example output would be:
31316
31317 @smallexample
31318 (gdb)
31319 -trace-frame-collected
31320 ^done,
31321 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
31322 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
31323 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
31324 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
31325 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
31326 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
31327 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
31328 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
31329 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
31330 ...
31331 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
31332 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
31333 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
31334 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
31335 (gdb)
31336 @end smallexample
31337
31338 Where:
31339
31340 @table @code
31341 @item explicit-variables
31342 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
31343 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
31344 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
31345 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
31346 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
31347 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
31348 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
31349 arrays, structures and unions.
31350
31351 @item computed-expressions
31352 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
31353 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
31354 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
31355 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
31356
31357 @item registers
31358 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
31359 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
31360 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
31361 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
31362 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
31363
31364 @item tvars
31365 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
31366 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
31367 current value are returned.
31368
31369 @item memory
31370 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
31371 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
31372 collected memory range and has the following fields:
31373
31374 @table @code
31375 @item address
31376 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
31377
31378 @item length
31379 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
31380
31381 @item contents
31382 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
31383 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
31384
31385 @end table
31386
31387 @end table
31388
31389 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31390
31391 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31392
31393 @subsubheading Example
31394
31395 @subheading -trace-list-variables
31396 @findex -trace-list-variables
31397
31398 @subsubheading Synopsis
31399
31400 @smallexample
31401 -trace-list-variables
31402 @end smallexample
31403
31404 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
31405 table has the following fields:
31406
31407 @table @samp
31408 @item name
31409 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
31410
31411 @item initial
31412 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
31413 field is always present.
31414
31415 @item current
31416 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
31417 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
31418 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
31419 presently running.
31420
31421 @end table
31422
31423 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31424
31425 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
31426
31427 @subsubheading Example
31428
31429 @smallexample
31430 (gdb)
31431 -trace-list-variables
31432 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
31433 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31434 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
31435 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
31436 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
31437 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
31438 (gdb)
31439 @end smallexample
31440
31441 @subheading -trace-save
31442 @findex -trace-save
31443
31444 @subsubheading Synopsis
31445
31446 @smallexample
31447 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
31448 @end smallexample
31449
31450 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
31451 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
31452 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
31453 to perform the save.
31454
31455 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
31456 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
31457 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
31458
31459 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31460
31461 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
31462
31463
31464 @subheading -trace-start
31465 @findex -trace-start
31466
31467 @subsubheading Synopsis
31468
31469 @smallexample
31470 -trace-start
31471 @end smallexample
31472
31473 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
31474 have any fields.
31475
31476 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31477
31478 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
31479
31480 @subheading -trace-status
31481 @findex -trace-status
31482
31483 @subsubheading Synopsis
31484
31485 @smallexample
31486 -trace-status
31487 @end smallexample
31488
31489 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
31490 the following fields:
31491
31492 @table @samp
31493
31494 @item supported
31495 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
31496 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
31497 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
31498 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
31499 started. This field is always present.
31500
31501 @item running
31502 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
31503 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
31504 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31505
31506 @item stop-reason
31507 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
31508 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
31509 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31510 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
31511 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31512 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31513 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31514 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31515 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31516
31517 @item stopping-tracepoint
31518 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
31519 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31520 @samp{passcount}.
31521
31522 @item frames
31523 @itemx frames-created
31524 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31525 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31526 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31527 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
31528
31529 @item buffer-size
31530 @itemx buffer-free
31531 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31532 remaining space. These fields are optional.
31533
31534 @item circular
31535 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
31536 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31537 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31538 and may fill up.
31539
31540 @item disconnected
31541 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
31542 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31543 that the trace run will stop.
31544
31545 @item trace-file
31546 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
31547 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31548
31549 @end table
31550
31551 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31552
31553 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31554
31555 @subheading -trace-stop
31556 @findex -trace-stop
31557
31558 @subsubheading Synopsis
31559
31560 @smallexample
31561 -trace-stop
31562 @end smallexample
31563
31564 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31565 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31566 @samp{running} fields are not output.
31567
31568 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31569
31570 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31571
31572
31573 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31574 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31575 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31576
31577
31578 @ignore
31579 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31580 @findex -symbol-info-address
31581
31582 @subsubheading Synopsis
31583
31584 @smallexample
31585 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31586 @end smallexample
31587
31588 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31589
31590 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31591
31592 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31593
31594 @subsubheading Example
31595 N.A.
31596
31597
31598 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31599 @findex -symbol-info-file
31600
31601 @subsubheading Synopsis
31602
31603 @smallexample
31604 -symbol-info-file
31605 @end smallexample
31606
31607 Show the file for the symbol.
31608
31609 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31610
31611 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31612 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
31613
31614 @subsubheading Example
31615 N.A.
31616
31617
31618 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31619 @findex -symbol-info-function
31620
31621 @subsubheading Synopsis
31622
31623 @smallexample
31624 -symbol-info-function
31625 @end smallexample
31626
31627 Show which function the symbol lives in.
31628
31629 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31630
31631 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31632
31633 @subsubheading Example
31634 N.A.
31635
31636
31637 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31638 @findex -symbol-info-line
31639
31640 @subsubheading Synopsis
31641
31642 @smallexample
31643 -symbol-info-line
31644 @end smallexample
31645
31646 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31647
31648 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31649
31650 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31651 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31652
31653 @subsubheading Example
31654 N.A.
31655
31656
31657 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31658 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31659
31660 @subsubheading Synopsis
31661
31662 @smallexample
31663 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31664 @end smallexample
31665
31666 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31667
31668 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31669
31670 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31671
31672 @subsubheading Example
31673 N.A.
31674
31675
31676 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31677 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31678
31679 @subsubheading Synopsis
31680
31681 @smallexample
31682 -symbol-list-functions
31683 @end smallexample
31684
31685 List the functions in the executable.
31686
31687 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31688
31689 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31690 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31691
31692 @subsubheading Example
31693 N.A.
31694 @end ignore
31695
31696
31697 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31698 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31699
31700 @subsubheading Synopsis
31701
31702 @smallexample
31703 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31704 @end smallexample
31705
31706 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31707 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31708 ascending PC order.
31709
31710 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31711
31712 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31713
31714 @subsubheading Example
31715 @smallexample
31716 (gdb)
31717 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31718 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31719 (gdb)
31720 @end smallexample
31721
31722
31723 @ignore
31724 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31725 @findex -symbol-list-types
31726
31727 @subsubheading Synopsis
31728
31729 @smallexample
31730 -symbol-list-types
31731 @end smallexample
31732
31733 List all the type names.
31734
31735 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31736
31737 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31738 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31739
31740 @subsubheading Example
31741 N.A.
31742
31743
31744 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31745 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31746
31747 @subsubheading Synopsis
31748
31749 @smallexample
31750 -symbol-list-variables
31751 @end smallexample
31752
31753 List all the global and static variable names.
31754
31755 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31756
31757 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31758
31759 @subsubheading Example
31760 N.A.
31761
31762
31763 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31764 @findex -symbol-locate
31765
31766 @subsubheading Synopsis
31767
31768 @smallexample
31769 -symbol-locate
31770 @end smallexample
31771
31772 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31773
31774 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31775
31776 @subsubheading Example
31777 N.A.
31778
31779
31780 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31781 @findex -symbol-type
31782
31783 @subsubheading Synopsis
31784
31785 @smallexample
31786 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31787 @end smallexample
31788
31789 Show type of @var{variable}.
31790
31791 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31792
31793 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31794 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31795
31796 @subsubheading Example
31797 N.A.
31798 @end ignore
31799
31800
31801 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31802 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31803 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31804
31805 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31806 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31807
31808 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31809 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31810
31811 @subsubheading Synopsis
31812
31813 @smallexample
31814 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31815 @end smallexample
31816
31817 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31818 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31819 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31820 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31821 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31822 notification.
31823
31824 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31825
31826 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31827
31828 @subsubheading Example
31829
31830 @smallexample
31831 (gdb)
31832 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31833 ^done
31834 (gdb)
31835 @end smallexample
31836
31837
31838 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31839 @findex -file-exec-file
31840
31841 @subsubheading Synopsis
31842
31843 @smallexample
31844 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31845 @end smallexample
31846
31847 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31848 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31849 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31850 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31851 notification.
31852
31853 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31854
31855 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31856
31857 @subsubheading Example
31858
31859 @smallexample
31860 (gdb)
31861 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31862 ^done
31863 (gdb)
31864 @end smallexample
31865
31866
31867 @ignore
31868 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31869 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31870
31871 @subsubheading Synopsis
31872
31873 @smallexample
31874 -file-list-exec-sections
31875 @end smallexample
31876
31877 List the sections of the current executable file.
31878
31879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31880
31881 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31882 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31883 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31884
31885 @subsubheading Example
31886 N.A.
31887 @end ignore
31888
31889
31890 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31891 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31892
31893 @subsubheading Synopsis
31894
31895 @smallexample
31896 -file-list-exec-source-file
31897 @end smallexample
31898
31899 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31900 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31901 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31902 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31903
31904 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31905
31906 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31907
31908 @subsubheading Example
31909
31910 @smallexample
31911 (gdb)
31912 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31913 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31914 (gdb)
31915 @end smallexample
31916
31917
31918 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31919 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31920
31921 @subsubheading Synopsis
31922
31923 @smallexample
31924 -file-list-exec-source-files
31925 @end smallexample
31926
31927 List the source files for the current executable.
31928
31929 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31930 name) of a source file.
31931
31932 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31933
31934 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31935 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31936
31937 @subsubheading Example
31938 @smallexample
31939 (gdb)
31940 -file-list-exec-source-files
31941 ^done,files=[
31942 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31943 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31944 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31945 (gdb)
31946 @end smallexample
31947
31948 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31949 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31950
31951 @subsubheading Synopsis
31952
31953 @smallexample
31954 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
31955 @end smallexample
31956
31957 List the shared libraries in the program.
31958 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
31959 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31960
31961 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31962
31963 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
31964 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
31965 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
31966 library. Each range has the following fields:
31967
31968 @table @samp
31969 @item from
31970 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
31971 @item to
31972 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
31973 @end table
31974
31975 @subsubheading Example
31976 @smallexample
31977 (gdb)
31978 -file-list-exec-source-files
31979 ^done,shared-libraries=[
31980 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
31981 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
31982 (gdb)
31983 @end smallexample
31984
31985
31986 @ignore
31987 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31988 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31989
31990 @subsubheading Synopsis
31991
31992 @smallexample
31993 -file-list-symbol-files
31994 @end smallexample
31995
31996 List symbol files.
31997
31998 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31999
32000 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
32001
32002 @subsubheading Example
32003 N.A.
32004 @end ignore
32005
32006
32007 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
32008 @findex -file-symbol-file
32009
32010 @subsubheading Synopsis
32011
32012 @smallexample
32013 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
32014 @end smallexample
32015
32016 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
32017 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
32018 produced, except for a completion notification.
32019
32020 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32021
32022 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
32023
32024 @subsubheading Example
32025
32026 @smallexample
32027 (gdb)
32028 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32029 ^done
32030 (gdb)
32031 @end smallexample
32032
32033 @ignore
32034 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32035 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
32036 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
32037
32038 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
32039
32040 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
32041
32042 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
32043
32044 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
32045
32046 @c @subheading -overlay-map
32047
32048 @c @subheading -overlay-off
32049
32050 @c @subheading -overlay-on
32051
32052 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
32053
32054 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32055 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
32056 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
32057
32058 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
32059
32060 @c @subheading -signal-handle
32061
32062 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
32063
32064 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
32065 @end ignore
32066
32067
32068 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32069 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
32070 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
32071
32072
32073 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
32074 @findex -target-attach
32075
32076 @subsubheading Synopsis
32077
32078 @smallexample
32079 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
32080 @end smallexample
32081
32082 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
32083 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
32084 group, the id previously returned by
32085 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
32086
32087 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32088
32089 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
32090
32091 @subsubheading Example
32092 @smallexample
32093 (gdb)
32094 -target-attach 34
32095 =thread-created,id="1"
32096 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
32097 ^done
32098 (gdb)
32099 @end smallexample
32100
32101 @ignore
32102 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
32103 @findex -target-compare-sections
32104
32105 @subsubheading Synopsis
32106
32107 @smallexample
32108 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
32109 @end smallexample
32110
32111 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
32112 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
32113
32114 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32115
32116 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
32117
32118 @subsubheading Example
32119 N.A.
32120 @end ignore
32121
32122
32123 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
32124 @findex -target-detach
32125
32126 @subsubheading Synopsis
32127
32128 @smallexample
32129 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
32130 @end smallexample
32131
32132 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
32133 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
32134 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
32135
32136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32137
32138 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
32139
32140 @subsubheading Example
32141
32142 @smallexample
32143 (gdb)
32144 -target-detach
32145 ^done
32146 (gdb)
32147 @end smallexample
32148
32149
32150 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
32151 @findex -target-disconnect
32152
32153 @subsubheading Synopsis
32154
32155 @smallexample
32156 -target-disconnect
32157 @end smallexample
32158
32159 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
32160 generally not resumed.
32161
32162 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32163
32164 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
32165
32166 @subsubheading Example
32167
32168 @smallexample
32169 (gdb)
32170 -target-disconnect
32171 ^done
32172 (gdb)
32173 @end smallexample
32174
32175
32176 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
32177 @findex -target-download
32178
32179 @subsubheading Synopsis
32180
32181 @smallexample
32182 -target-download
32183 @end smallexample
32184
32185 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
32186 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
32187
32188 @table @samp
32189 @item section
32190 The name of the section.
32191 @item section-sent
32192 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
32193 @item section-size
32194 The size of the section.
32195 @item total-sent
32196 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
32197 @item total-size
32198 The size of the overall executable to download.
32199 @end table
32200
32201 @noindent
32202 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
32203 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
32204
32205 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
32206 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
32207
32208 @table @samp
32209 @item section
32210 The name of the section.
32211 @item section-size
32212 The size of the section.
32213 @item total-size
32214 The size of the overall executable to download.
32215 @end table
32216
32217 @noindent
32218 At the end, a summary is printed.
32219
32220 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32221
32222 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
32223
32224 @subsubheading Example
32225
32226 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
32227 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
32228
32229 @smallexample
32230 (gdb)
32231 -target-download
32232 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
32233 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
32234 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
32235 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
32236 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
32237 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
32238 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
32239 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
32240 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
32241 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
32242 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
32243 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
32244 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
32245 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
32246 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
32247 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
32248 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
32249 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
32250 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
32251 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
32252 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
32253 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
32254 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
32255 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
32256 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
32257 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
32258 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
32259 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32260 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32261 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
32262 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
32263 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
32264 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
32265 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
32266 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
32267 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
32268 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
32269 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
32270 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
32271 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
32272 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
32273 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
32274 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
32275 write-rate="429"
32276 (gdb)
32277 @end smallexample
32278
32279
32280 @ignore
32281 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
32282 @findex -target-exec-status
32283
32284 @subsubheading Synopsis
32285
32286 @smallexample
32287 -target-exec-status
32288 @end smallexample
32289
32290 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
32291 not, for instance).
32292
32293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32294
32295 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
32296
32297 @subsubheading Example
32298 N.A.
32299
32300
32301 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
32302 @findex -target-list-available-targets
32303
32304 @subsubheading Synopsis
32305
32306 @smallexample
32307 -target-list-available-targets
32308 @end smallexample
32309
32310 List the possible targets to connect to.
32311
32312 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32313
32314 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
32315
32316 @subsubheading Example
32317 N.A.
32318
32319
32320 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
32321 @findex -target-list-current-targets
32322
32323 @subsubheading Synopsis
32324
32325 @smallexample
32326 -target-list-current-targets
32327 @end smallexample
32328
32329 Describe the current target.
32330
32331 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32332
32333 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
32334 other things).
32335
32336 @subsubheading Example
32337 N.A.
32338
32339
32340 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
32341 @findex -target-list-parameters
32342
32343 @subsubheading Synopsis
32344
32345 @smallexample
32346 -target-list-parameters
32347 @end smallexample
32348
32349 @c ????
32350 @end ignore
32351
32352 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32353
32354 No equivalent.
32355
32356 @subsubheading Example
32357 N.A.
32358
32359 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
32360 @findex -target-flash-erase
32361
32362 @subsubheading Synopsis
32363
32364 @smallexample
32365 -target-flash-erase
32366 @end smallexample
32367
32368 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
32369
32370 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
32371
32372 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
32373 addresses and memory region sizes.
32374
32375 @smallexample
32376 (gdb)
32377 -target-flash-erase
32378 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
32379 (gdb)
32380 @end smallexample
32381
32382 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
32383 @findex -target-select
32384
32385 @subsubheading Synopsis
32386
32387 @smallexample
32388 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
32389 @end smallexample
32390
32391 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
32392
32393 @table @samp
32394 @item @var{type}
32395 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
32396 @item @var{parameters}
32397 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
32398 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
32399 @end table
32400
32401 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
32402 which the target program is, in the following form:
32403
32404 @smallexample
32405 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
32406 args=[@var{arg list}]
32407 @end smallexample
32408
32409 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32410
32411 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
32412
32413 @subsubheading Example
32414
32415 @smallexample
32416 (gdb)
32417 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
32418 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
32419 (gdb)
32420 @end smallexample
32421
32422 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32423 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
32424 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
32425
32426
32427 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
32428 @findex -target-file-put
32429
32430 @subsubheading Synopsis
32431
32432 @smallexample
32433 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
32434 @end smallexample
32435
32436 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
32437 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
32438
32439 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32440
32441 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
32442
32443 @subsubheading Example
32444
32445 @smallexample
32446 (gdb)
32447 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
32448 ^done
32449 (gdb)
32450 @end smallexample
32451
32452
32453 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
32454 @findex -target-file-get
32455
32456 @subsubheading Synopsis
32457
32458 @smallexample
32459 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
32460 @end smallexample
32461
32462 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
32463 on the host system.
32464
32465 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32466
32467 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
32468
32469 @subsubheading Example
32470
32471 @smallexample
32472 (gdb)
32473 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
32474 ^done
32475 (gdb)
32476 @end smallexample
32477
32478
32479 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
32480 @findex -target-file-delete
32481
32482 @subsubheading Synopsis
32483
32484 @smallexample
32485 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
32486 @end smallexample
32487
32488 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
32489
32490 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32491
32492 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
32493
32494 @subsubheading Example
32495
32496 @smallexample
32497 (gdb)
32498 -target-file-delete remotefile
32499 ^done
32500 (gdb)
32501 @end smallexample
32502
32503
32504 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32505 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
32506 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32507
32508 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
32509 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
32510
32511 @subsubheading Synopsis
32512
32513 @smallexample
32514 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
32515 @end smallexample
32516
32517 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
32518 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
32519 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32520
32521 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32522
32523 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
32524
32525 @subsubheading Result
32526
32527 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
32528 defined for each exception:
32529
32530 @table @samp
32531 @item name
32532 The name of the exception.
32533
32534 @item address
32535 The address of the exception.
32536
32537 @end table
32538
32539 @subsubheading Example
32540
32541 @smallexample
32542 -info-ada-exceptions aint
32543 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
32544 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32545 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
32546 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
32547 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
32548 @end smallexample
32549
32550 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
32551
32552 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
32553 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
32554 Catchpoint Commands}.
32555
32556
32557 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32558 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
32559 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
32560
32561 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
32562 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
32563 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
32564 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
32565
32566 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
32567 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
32568 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
32569
32570 @subsubheading Synopsis
32571
32572 @smallexample
32573 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
32574 @end smallexample
32575
32576 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
32577
32578 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
32579 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32580 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
32581 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32582 dash.
32583
32584 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32585
32586 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32587
32588 @subsubheading Result
32589
32590 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
32591
32592 @table @samp
32593 @item exists
32594 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32595 @code{"false"} otherwise.
32596
32597 @end table
32598
32599 @subsubheading Example
32600
32601 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32602
32603 @smallexample
32604 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32605 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32606 @end smallexample
32607
32608 @noindent
32609 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32610 to the debugger:
32611
32612 @smallexample
32613 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32614 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32615 @end smallexample
32616
32617 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32618 @findex -list-features
32619 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32620
32621 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32622 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
32623 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32624 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32625 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32626 startup.
32627
32628 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32629 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32630 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
32631 is given below.
32632
32633 Example output:
32634
32635 @smallexample
32636 (gdb) -list-features
32637 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32638 @end smallexample
32639
32640 The current list of features is:
32641
32642 @ftable @samp
32643 @item frozen-varobjs
32644 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32645 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32646 of @code{-varobj-create}.
32647 @item pending-breakpoints
32648 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32649 command.
32650 @item python
32651 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32652 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32653 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32654 @item thread-info
32655 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32656 @item data-read-memory-bytes
32657 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32658 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32659 @item breakpoint-notifications
32660 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32661 CLI will be announced via async records.
32662 @item ada-task-info
32663 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32664 @item language-option
32665 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32666 option (@pxref{Context management}).
32667 @item info-gdb-mi-command
32668 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32669 @item undefined-command-error-code
32670 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32671 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32672 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32673 @item exec-run-start-option
32674 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32675 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32676 @end ftable
32677
32678 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32679 @findex -list-target-features
32680
32681 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32682 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32683 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32684 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32685 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32686 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32687 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32688 Example output:
32689
32690 @smallexample
32691 (gdb) -list-target-features
32692 ^done,result=["async"]
32693 @end smallexample
32694
32695 The current list of features is:
32696
32697 @table @samp
32698 @item async
32699 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32700 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32701 while the target is running.
32702
32703 @item reverse
32704 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32705 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32706
32707 @end table
32708
32709 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32710 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32711 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32712
32713 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32714
32715 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32716 @findex -gdb-exit
32717
32718 @subsubheading Synopsis
32719
32720 @smallexample
32721 -gdb-exit
32722 @end smallexample
32723
32724 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32725
32726 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32727
32728 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32729
32730 @subsubheading Example
32731
32732 @smallexample
32733 (gdb)
32734 -gdb-exit
32735 ^exit
32736 @end smallexample
32737
32738
32739 @ignore
32740 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32741 @findex -exec-abort
32742
32743 @subsubheading Synopsis
32744
32745 @smallexample
32746 -exec-abort
32747 @end smallexample
32748
32749 Kill the inferior running program.
32750
32751 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32752
32753 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32754
32755 @subsubheading Example
32756 N.A.
32757 @end ignore
32758
32759
32760 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32761 @findex -gdb-set
32762
32763 @subsubheading Synopsis
32764
32765 @smallexample
32766 -gdb-set
32767 @end smallexample
32768
32769 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32770 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32771
32772 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32773
32774 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32775
32776 @subsubheading Example
32777
32778 @smallexample
32779 (gdb)
32780 -gdb-set $foo=3
32781 ^done
32782 (gdb)
32783 @end smallexample
32784
32785
32786 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32787 @findex -gdb-show
32788
32789 @subsubheading Synopsis
32790
32791 @smallexample
32792 -gdb-show
32793 @end smallexample
32794
32795 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32796
32797 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32798
32799 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32800
32801 @subsubheading Example
32802
32803 @smallexample
32804 (gdb)
32805 -gdb-show annotate
32806 ^done,value="0"
32807 (gdb)
32808 @end smallexample
32809
32810 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32811
32812
32813 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32814 @findex -gdb-version
32815
32816 @subsubheading Synopsis
32817
32818 @smallexample
32819 -gdb-version
32820 @end smallexample
32821
32822 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32823
32824 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32825
32826 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32827 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32828
32829 @subsubheading Example
32830
32831 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32832 @c box in TeX.
32833 @smallexample
32834 (gdb)
32835 -gdb-version
32836 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32837 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32838 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32839 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32840 ~ certain conditions.
32841 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32842 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32843 ~ details.
32844 ~This GDB was configured as
32845 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32846 ^done
32847 (gdb)
32848 @end smallexample
32849
32850 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32851 @findex -list-thread-groups
32852
32853 @subheading Synopsis
32854
32855 @smallexample
32856 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32857 @end smallexample
32858
32859 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32860 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32861 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32862 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32863 top-level thread groups.
32864
32865 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32866 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32867 available on the target.
32868
32869 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32870 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32871 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32872 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32873 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32874 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32875 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32876 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32877
32878 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32879 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32880 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32881 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32882 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32883 @samp{threads} field.
32884
32885 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32886 the following caveats:
32887
32888 @itemize @bullet
32889 @item
32890 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32891 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32892 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32893
32894 @item
32895 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32896 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32897 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32898 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32899 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32900 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32901
32902 @end itemize
32903
32904 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32905 have the following fields:
32906
32907 @table @code
32908 @item id
32909 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32910 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32911 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32912
32913 @item type
32914 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32915 valid type.
32916
32917 @item pid
32918 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32919 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32920
32921 @item exit-code
32922 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32923 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32924 only if the process is not running.
32925
32926 @item num_children
32927 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32928 absent for an available thread group.
32929
32930 @item threads
32931 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32932 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32933 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32934
32935 @item cores
32936 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32937 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32938 such information is not available.
32939
32940 @item executable
32941 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32942 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32943 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32944
32945 @end table
32946
32947 @subheading Example
32948
32949 @smallexample
32950 @value{GDBP}
32951 -list-thread-groups
32952 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32953 -list-thread-groups 17
32954 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32955 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32956 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32957 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32958 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32959 -list-thread-groups --available
32960 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32961 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32962 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32963 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32964 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32965 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32966 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32967 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32968 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32969 @end smallexample
32970
32971 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32972 @findex -info-os
32973
32974 @subsubheading Synopsis
32975
32976 @smallexample
32977 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32978 @end smallexample
32979
32980 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32981 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32982 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32983 of data of that type.
32984
32985 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32986 system.
32987
32988 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32989
32990 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32991
32992 @subsubheading Example
32993
32994 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32995 like this:
32996
32997 @smallexample
32998 @value{GDBP}
32999 -info-os
33000 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
33001 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
33002 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
33003 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
33004 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
33005 col2="CPUs"@},
33006 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
33007 col2="File descriptors"@},
33008 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
33009 col2="Kernel modules"@},
33010 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
33011 col2="Message queues"@},
33012 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
33013 col2="Processes"@},
33014 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
33015 col2="Process groups"@},
33016 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
33017 col2="Semaphores"@},
33018 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
33019 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
33020 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
33021 col2="Sockets"@},
33022 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
33023 col2="Threads"@}]
33024 @value{GDBP}
33025 -info-os processes
33026 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
33027 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
33028 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
33029 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
33030 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
33031 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
33032 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
33033 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
33034 ...
33035 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
33036 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
33037 (gdb)
33038 @end smallexample
33039
33040 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
33041 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
33042 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
33043 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
33044 @code{info os} omits it.)
33045
33046 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
33047 @findex -add-inferior
33048
33049 @subheading Synopsis
33050
33051 @smallexample
33052 -add-inferior
33053 @end smallexample
33054
33055 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
33056 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
33057 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
33058 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
33059 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
33060 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
33061
33062 @subheading Example
33063
33064 @smallexample
33065 @value{GDBP}
33066 -add-inferior
33067 ^done,inferior="i3"
33068 @end smallexample
33069
33070 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
33071 @findex -interpreter-exec
33072
33073 @subheading Synopsis
33074
33075 @smallexample
33076 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
33077 @end smallexample
33078 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
33079
33080 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
33081
33082 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33083
33084 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
33085
33086 @subheading Example
33087
33088 @smallexample
33089 (gdb)
33090 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
33091 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
33092 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
33093 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
33094 ^done
33095 (gdb)
33096 @end smallexample
33097
33098 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
33099 @findex -inferior-tty-set
33100
33101 @subheading Synopsis
33102
33103 @smallexample
33104 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33105 @end smallexample
33106
33107 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
33108
33109 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33110
33111 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
33112
33113 @subheading Example
33114
33115 @smallexample
33116 (gdb)
33117 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33118 ^done
33119 (gdb)
33120 @end smallexample
33121
33122 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
33123 @findex -inferior-tty-show
33124
33125 @subheading Synopsis
33126
33127 @smallexample
33128 -inferior-tty-show
33129 @end smallexample
33130
33131 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
33132
33133 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33134
33135 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
33136
33137 @subheading Example
33138
33139 @smallexample
33140 (gdb)
33141 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33142 ^done
33143 (gdb)
33144 -inferior-tty-show
33145 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
33146 (gdb)
33147 @end smallexample
33148
33149 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
33150 @findex -enable-timings
33151
33152 @subheading Synopsis
33153
33154 @smallexample
33155 -enable-timings [yes | no]
33156 @end smallexample
33157
33158 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
33159 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
33160 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
33161 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
33162
33163 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33164
33165 No equivalent.
33166
33167 @subheading Example
33168
33169 @smallexample
33170 (gdb)
33171 -enable-timings
33172 ^done
33173 (gdb)
33174 -break-insert main
33175 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
33176 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
33177 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
33178 times="0"@},
33179 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
33180 (gdb)
33181 -enable-timings no
33182 ^done
33183 (gdb)
33184 -exec-run
33185 ^running
33186 (gdb)
33187 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
33188 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
33189 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
33190 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
33191 (gdb)
33192 @end smallexample
33193
33194 @node Annotations
33195 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
33196
33197 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
33198 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
33199 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
33200 relatively high level.
33201
33202 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
33203 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
33204
33205 @ignore
33206 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
33207 @end ignore
33208
33209 @menu
33210 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
33211 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
33212 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
33213 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
33214 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
33215 * Annotations for Running::
33216 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
33217 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
33218 @end menu
33219
33220 @node Annotations Overview
33221 @section What is an Annotation?
33222 @cindex annotations
33223
33224 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
33225 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
33226 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
33227 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
33228 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
33229 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
33230 cannot contain newline characters.
33231
33232 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
33233 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
33234 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
33235 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
33236 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
33237 means those three characters as output.
33238
33239 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
33240 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
33241 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
33242 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
33243 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
33244 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
33245 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
33246 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
33247 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
33248
33249 @table @code
33250 @kindex set annotate
33251 @item set annotate @var{level}
33252 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
33253 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
33254
33255 @item show annotate
33256 @kindex show annotate
33257 Show the current annotation level.
33258 @end table
33259
33260 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
33261
33262 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
33263
33264 @smallexample
33265 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
33266 GNU gdb 6.0
33267 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33268 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
33269 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
33270 under certain conditions.
33271 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33272 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
33273 for details.
33274 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
33275
33276 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33277 (@value{GDBP})
33278 ^Z^Zprompt
33279 @kbd{quit}
33280
33281 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33282 $
33283 @end smallexample
33284
33285 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
33286 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
33287 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
33288 output from @value{GDBN}.
33289
33290 @node Server Prefix
33291 @section The Server Prefix
33292 @cindex server prefix
33293
33294 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
33295 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
33296 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
33297 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
33298 a transparent manner.
33299
33300 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
33301 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
33302 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
33303 @code{print} command.
33304
33305 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
33306 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
33307
33308 @node Prompting
33309 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
33310
33311 @cindex annotations for prompts
33312 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
33313 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
33314 over, etc.
33315
33316 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
33317 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
33318 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
33319 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
33320 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
33321 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
33322 features the following annotations:
33323
33324 @smallexample
33325 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33326 ^Z^Zprompt
33327 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33328 @end smallexample
33329
33330 The input types are
33331
33332 @table @code
33333 @findex pre-prompt annotation
33334 @findex prompt annotation
33335 @findex post-prompt annotation
33336 @item prompt
33337 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
33338
33339 @findex pre-commands annotation
33340 @findex commands annotation
33341 @findex post-commands annotation
33342 @item commands
33343 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
33344 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
33345
33346 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
33347 @findex overload-choice annotation
33348 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
33349 @item overload-choice
33350 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
33351
33352 @findex pre-query annotation
33353 @findex query annotation
33354 @findex post-query annotation
33355 @item query
33356 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
33357
33358 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
33359 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
33360 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
33361 @item prompt-for-continue
33362 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
33363 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
33364 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
33365 presence of annotations.
33366 @end table
33367
33368 @node Errors
33369 @section Errors
33370 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
33371
33372 @findex quit annotation
33373 @smallexample
33374 ^Z^Zquit
33375 @end smallexample
33376
33377 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
33378
33379 @findex error annotation
33380 @smallexample
33381 ^Z^Zerror
33382 @end smallexample
33383
33384 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
33385
33386 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
33387 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
33388 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
33389 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
33390 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
33391 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
33392 to the top level.
33393
33394 @findex error-begin annotation
33395 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
33396
33397 @smallexample
33398 ^Z^Zerror-begin
33399 @end smallexample
33400
33401 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
33402 message.
33403
33404 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
33405 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
33406 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
33407
33408 @node Invalidation
33409 @section Invalidation Notices
33410
33411 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
33412 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
33413 changed.
33414
33415 @table @code
33416 @findex frames-invalid annotation
33417 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
33418
33419 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
33420 have changed.
33421
33422 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
33423 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
33424
33425 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
33426 deleted a breakpoint.
33427 @end table
33428
33429 @node Annotations for Running
33430 @section Running the Program
33431 @cindex annotations for running programs
33432
33433 @findex starting annotation
33434 @findex stopping annotation
33435 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
33436 @code{step} or @code{continue},
33437
33438 @smallexample
33439 ^Z^Zstarting
33440 @end smallexample
33441
33442 is output. When the program stops,
33443
33444 @smallexample
33445 ^Z^Zstopped
33446 @end smallexample
33447
33448 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
33449 annotations describe how the program stopped.
33450
33451 @table @code
33452 @findex exited annotation
33453 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
33454 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
33455 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
33456
33457 @findex signalled annotation
33458 @findex signal-name annotation
33459 @findex signal-name-end annotation
33460 @findex signal-string annotation
33461 @findex signal-string-end annotation
33462 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
33463 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
33464 annotation continues:
33465
33466 @smallexample
33467 @var{intro-text}
33468 ^Z^Zsignal-name
33469 @var{name}
33470 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
33471 @var{middle-text}
33472 ^Z^Zsignal-string
33473 @var{string}
33474 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
33475 @var{end-text}
33476 @end smallexample
33477
33478 @noindent
33479 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
33480 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
33481 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
33482 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
33483 user's benefit and have no particular format.
33484
33485 @findex signal annotation
33486 @item ^Z^Zsignal
33487 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
33488 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
33489 terminated with it.
33490
33491 @findex breakpoint annotation
33492 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
33493 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
33494
33495 @findex watchpoint annotation
33496 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
33497 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
33498 @end table
33499
33500 @node Source Annotations
33501 @section Displaying Source
33502 @cindex annotations for source display
33503
33504 @findex source annotation
33505 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
33506
33507 @smallexample
33508 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
33509 @end smallexample
33510
33511 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
33512 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
33513 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
33514 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
33515 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
33516 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
33517 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
33518 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
33519 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
33520 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
33521 depend on the language).
33522
33523 @node JIT Interface
33524 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
33525 @cindex just-in-time compilation
33526 @cindex JIT compilation interface
33527
33528 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
33529 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
33530 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
33531 performance while maintaining platform independence.
33532
33533 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
33534 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
33535 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
33536 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
33537 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
33538 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
33539
33540 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
33541 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
33542 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
33543 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
33544 LLVM JIT.
33545
33546 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
33547 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
33548 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
33549 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
33550 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33551 out about additional code.
33552
33553 @menu
33554 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
33555 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
33556 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
33557 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
33558 @end menu
33559
33560 @node Declarations
33561 @section JIT Declarations
33562
33563 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33564 implement the interface:
33565
33566 @smallexample
33567 typedef enum
33568 @{
33569 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33570 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33571 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33572 @} jit_actions_t;
33573
33574 struct jit_code_entry
33575 @{
33576 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33577 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33578 const char *symfile_addr;
33579 uint64_t symfile_size;
33580 @};
33581
33582 struct jit_descriptor
33583 @{
33584 uint32_t version;
33585 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33586 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
33587 uint32_t action_flag;
33588 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33589 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33590 @};
33591
33592 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
33593 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33594
33595 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33596 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
33597 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33598 @end smallexample
33599
33600 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33601 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33602 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33603
33604 @node Registering Code
33605 @section Registering Code
33606
33607 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33608
33609 @itemize @bullet
33610 @item
33611 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33612 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33613
33614 @item
33615 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33616 file.
33617
33618 @item
33619 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33620
33621 @item
33622 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33623
33624 @item
33625 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33626 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33627 @end itemize
33628
33629 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33630 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33631 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33632 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33633
33634 @node Unregistering Code
33635 @section Unregistering Code
33636
33637 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33638
33639 @itemize @bullet
33640 @item
33641 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33642
33643 @item
33644 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33645
33646 @item
33647 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33648 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33649 @end itemize
33650
33651 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33652 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33653
33654 @node Custom Debug Info
33655 @section Custom Debug Info
33656 @cindex custom JIT debug info
33657 @cindex JIT debug info reader
33658
33659 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33660 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33661 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33662 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33663 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33664 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33665 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33666 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33667 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33668
33669 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33670 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33671 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33672 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33673 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33674 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33675 compiler.
33676
33677 @menu
33678 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33679 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33680 @end menu
33681
33682 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33683 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33684 @kindex jit-reader-load
33685 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33686
33687 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33688 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33689
33690 @table @code
33691 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33692 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33693 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33694 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33695 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33696 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33697 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33698
33699 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33700 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33701 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33702 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33703 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33704
33705 @item jit-reader-unload
33706 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33707
33708 @end table
33709
33710 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33711 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33712 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33713
33714 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33715 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33716
33717 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33718 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33719 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33720 the system include directory.
33721
33722 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33723 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33724 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33725
33726 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33727 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33728
33729 @findex gdb_init_reader
33730 @smallexample
33731 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33732 @end smallexample
33733
33734 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33735
33736 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33737 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33738 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33739 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33740 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33741 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33742
33743 @smallexample
33744 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33745 @{
33746 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33747 int reader_version;
33748
33749 /* For use by the reader. */
33750 void *priv_data;
33751
33752 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33753 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33754 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33755 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33756 @};
33757 @end smallexample
33758
33759 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33760 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33761
33762 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33763 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33764 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33765 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33766 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33767 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33768 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33769 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33770 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33771 target's address space.
33772
33773 @node In-Process Agent
33774 @chapter In-Process Agent
33775 @cindex debugging agent
33776 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33777 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33778 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33779 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33780 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33781 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33782 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33783 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33784 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33785 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33786 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33787 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33788 behavior without interrupting it.
33789
33790 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33791 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33792 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33793 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33794 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33795 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33796 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33797 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33798 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33799
33800 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33801 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33802 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33803 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33804
33805 @anchor{Control Agent}
33806 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33807 debugging with the following commands:
33808
33809 @table @code
33810 @kindex set agent on
33811 @item set agent on
33812 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33813 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33814 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33815 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33816 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33817 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33818
33819 @kindex set agent off
33820 @item set agent off
33821 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33822 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33823
33824 @kindex show agent
33825 @item show agent
33826 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33827 the in-process agent.
33828 @end table
33829
33830 @menu
33831 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33832 @end menu
33833
33834 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33835 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33836 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33837
33838 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33839 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33840 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33841 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33842 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33843 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33844 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33845 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33846 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33847
33848 @menu
33849 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33850 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33851 @end menu
33852
33853 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33854 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33855 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33856
33857 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33858 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33859
33860 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33861 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33862 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33863 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33864
33865 @enumerate
33866 @item
33867 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33868 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33869 @item
33870 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33871 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33872 the other one.
33873 @end enumerate
33874
33875 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33876
33877 @enumerate
33878 @item
33879 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33880 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33881 @anchor{agent expression object}
33882 @item
33883 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33884 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33885 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33886 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33887 @item
33888 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33889 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33890
33891 @end enumerate
33892
33893 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33894 object:
33895
33896 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33897 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33898 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33899 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33900 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33901 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33902 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33903 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33904 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33905 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33906 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33907 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33908 memory address for collecting.
33909 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33910 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33911 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33912 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33913 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33914 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33915 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33916 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33917 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33918 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33919 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33920 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33921 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33922 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33923 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33924 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33925 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33926 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33927 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33928 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33929 @ref{agent expression object}
33930 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33931 @ref{agent expression object}
33932 @item actions @tab variable
33933 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33934 @end multitable
33935
33936 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33937 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33938 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33939
33940 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33941 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33942
33943 @table @samp
33944
33945 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33946 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33947 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33948 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33949 in IPA finally.
33950
33951 Replies:
33952 @table @samp
33953 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33954 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33955 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33956 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33957 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33958 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33959 @item E @var{NN}
33960 for an error
33961
33962 @end table
33963
33964 @item close
33965 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33966 is about to kill inferiors.
33967
33968 @item qTfSTM
33969 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33970 @item qTsSTM
33971 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33972 @item qTSTMat
33973 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33974 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33975 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33976
33977 Replies:
33978 @table @samp
33979 @item E @var{NN}
33980 for an error
33981 @end table
33982 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33983 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33984 @end table
33985
33986 @node GDB Bugs
33987 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33988 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33989 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33990
33991 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33992
33993 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33994 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33995 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33996 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33997
33998 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33999 information that enables us to fix the bug.
34000
34001 @menu
34002 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
34003 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
34004 @end menu
34005
34006 @node Bug Criteria
34007 @section Have You Found a Bug?
34008 @cindex bug criteria
34009
34010 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
34011
34012 @itemize @bullet
34013 @cindex fatal signal
34014 @cindex debugger crash
34015 @cindex crash of debugger
34016 @item
34017 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
34018 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
34019
34020 @cindex error on valid input
34021 @item
34022 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
34023 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
34024 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
34025
34026 @cindex invalid input
34027 @item
34028 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
34029 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
34030 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
34031 for traditional practice''.
34032
34033 @item
34034 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
34035 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
34036 @end itemize
34037
34038 @node Bug Reporting
34039 @section How to Report Bugs
34040 @cindex bug reports
34041 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
34042
34043 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
34044 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
34045 contact that organization first.
34046
34047 You can find contact information for many support companies and
34048 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
34049 distribution.
34050 @c should add a web page ref...
34051
34052 @ifset BUGURL
34053 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
34054 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34055 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
34056 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
34057 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
34058 be used.
34059
34060 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
34061 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
34062 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
34063 @samp{bug-gdb}.
34064
34065 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
34066 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
34067 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
34068 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
34069 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
34070 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
34071 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
34072 bug reports to the mailing list.
34073 @end ifset
34074 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
34075 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34076 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
34077 @end ifclear
34078 @end ifset
34079
34080 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
34081 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
34082 fact or leave it out, state it!
34083
34084 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
34085 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
34086 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
34087 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
34088 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
34089 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
34090 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
34091 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
34092 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
34093
34094 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
34095 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
34096 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
34097 self-contained.
34098
34099 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
34100 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
34101 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
34102 bugs properly.
34103
34104 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
34105
34106 @itemize @bullet
34107 @item
34108 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
34109 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
34110 version}.
34111
34112 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
34113 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
34114
34115 @item
34116 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
34117 version number.
34118
34119 @item
34120 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
34121 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
34122 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
34123 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
34124
34125 @item
34126 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
34127 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
34128
34129 @item
34130 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
34131 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
34132 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
34133 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
34134 those compilers.
34135
34136 @item
34137 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
34138 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
34139 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
34140 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
34141
34142 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
34143 and then we might not encounter the bug.
34144
34145 @item
34146 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
34147 reproduce the bug.
34148
34149 @item
34150 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
34151 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
34152
34153 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
34154 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
34155 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
34156 a chance to make a mistake.
34157
34158 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
34159 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
34160 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
34161 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
34162 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
34163 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
34164 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
34165 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
34166
34167 @pindex script
34168 @cindex recording a session script
34169 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
34170 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
34171 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
34172 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
34173
34174 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
34175 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
34176
34177 @item
34178 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
34179 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
34180 it by context, not by line number.
34181
34182 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
34183 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
34184
34185 @end itemize
34186
34187 Here are some things that are not necessary:
34188
34189 @itemize @bullet
34190 @item
34191 A description of the envelope of the bug.
34192
34193 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
34194 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
34195 changes will not affect it.
34196
34197 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
34198 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
34199 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
34200 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
34201
34202 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
34203 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
34204 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
34205 less time, and so on.
34206
34207 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
34208 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
34209
34210 @item
34211 A patch for the bug.
34212
34213 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
34214 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
34215 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
34216 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
34217
34218 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
34219 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
34220 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
34221 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
34222
34223 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
34224 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
34225 help us to understand.
34226
34227 @item
34228 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
34229
34230 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
34231 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
34232 @end itemize
34233
34234 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
34235 @c and consists of the two following files:
34236 @c rluser.texi
34237 @c hsuser.texi
34238 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
34239 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
34240 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
34241 @include rluser.texi
34242 @include hsuser.texi
34243 @end ifclear
34244
34245 @node In Memoriam
34246 @appendix In Memoriam
34247
34248 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
34249 contributors:
34250
34251 @table @code
34252 @item Fred Fish
34253 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
34254 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
34255 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
34256
34257 @item Michael Snyder
34258 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
34259 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
34260 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
34261 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
34262 @end table
34263
34264 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
34265 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
34266
34267 @node Formatting Documentation
34268 @appendix Formatting Documentation
34269
34270 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
34271 @cindex reference card
34272 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
34273 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
34274 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
34275 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
34276 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
34277 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
34278
34279 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
34280 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
34281
34282 @smallexample
34283 make refcard.dvi
34284 @end smallexample
34285
34286 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
34287 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
34288 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
34289 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
34290 your @sc{dvi} output program.
34291
34292 @cindex documentation
34293
34294 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
34295 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
34296 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
34297 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
34298 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
34299 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
34300
34301 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
34302 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
34303 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
34304 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
34305 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
34306 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
34307 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
34308 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
34309
34310 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
34311 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
34312 @code{makeinfo}.
34313
34314 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
34315 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
34316 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
34317
34318 @smallexample
34319 cd gdb
34320 make gdb.info
34321 @end smallexample
34322
34323 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
34324 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
34325 Texinfo definitions file.
34326
34327 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
34328 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
34329 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
34330 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
34331 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
34332 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
34333 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
34334
34335 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
34336 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
34337 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
34338 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
34339 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
34340 directory.
34341
34342 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
34343 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
34344 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
34345 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
34346
34347 @smallexample
34348 make gdb.dvi
34349 @end smallexample
34350
34351 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
34352
34353 @node Installing GDB
34354 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
34355 @cindex installation
34356
34357 @menu
34358 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
34359 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
34360 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
34361 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
34362 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
34363 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
34364 @end menu
34365
34366 @node Requirements
34367 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
34368 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
34369
34370 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
34371 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
34372
34373 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
34374 @table @asis
34375 @item ISO C90 compiler
34376 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
34377 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
34378
34379 @end table
34380
34381 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
34382 @table @asis
34383 @item Expat
34384 @anchor{Expat}
34385 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
34386 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
34387 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
34388 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
34389 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
34390 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
34391
34392 Expat is used for:
34393
34394 @itemize @bullet
34395 @item
34396 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
34397 @item
34398 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
34399 @item
34400 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
34401 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
34402 @item
34403 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
34404 @item
34405 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
34406 @item
34407 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
34408 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
34409 @end itemize
34410
34411 @item MPFR
34412 @anchor{MPFR}
34413 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
34414 library. This library may be included with your operating system
34415 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34416 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
34417 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
34418 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
34419 option to specify its location.
34420
34421 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
34422 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
34423 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
34424 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
34425
34426 @item zlib
34427 @cindex compressed debug sections
34428 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
34429 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
34430 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
34431 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
34432 information in such binaries.
34433
34434 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
34435 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34436 @url{http://zlib.net}.
34437
34438 @item iconv
34439 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
34440 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
34441 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
34442 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
34443
34444 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
34445 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
34446 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
34447 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
34448
34449 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
34450 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
34451 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
34452
34453 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
34454 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
34455 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
34456 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
34457 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
34458 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
34459 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
34460 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
34461 @end table
34462
34463 @node Running Configure
34464 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
34465 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
34466 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
34467 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
34468 build the @code{gdb} program.
34469 @iftex
34470 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
34471 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
34472 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
34473 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
34474 @end iftex
34475
34476 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
34477 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
34478 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
34479
34480 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
34481 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
34482
34483 @table @code
34484 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
34485 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
34486
34487 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
34488 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
34489
34490 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
34491 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
34492
34493 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
34494 @sc{gnu} include files
34495
34496 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
34497 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
34498
34499 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
34500 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
34501
34502 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
34503 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
34504
34505 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
34506 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
34507
34508 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
34509 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
34510 @end table
34511
34512 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
34513 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
34514 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
34515
34516 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
34517 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
34518 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
34519 argument.
34520
34521 For example:
34522
34523 @smallexample
34524 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34525 ./configure @var{host}
34526 make
34527 @end smallexample
34528
34529 @noindent
34530 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
34531 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
34532 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
34533 correct value by examining your system.)
34534
34535 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
34536 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
34537 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
34538 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
34539
34540 @need 750
34541 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
34542 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
34543 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
34544
34545 @smallexample
34546 sh configure @var{host}
34547 @end smallexample
34548
34549 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
34550 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
34551 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
34552 @file{configure}
34553 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
34554 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
34555
34556 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
34557 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
34558 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
34559 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
34560 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
34561 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
34562 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
34563 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
34564 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34565
34566 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34567 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34568 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
34569 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34570 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34571
34572 @node Separate Objdir
34573 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34574
34575 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34576 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34577 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34578 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34579 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
34580 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34581 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34582 program specified there.
34583
34584 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34585 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
34586 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
34587 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
34588 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
34589 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
34590
34591 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
34592 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
34593
34594 @smallexample
34595 @group
34596 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34597 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34598 cd ../gdb-sun4
34599 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34600 make
34601 @end group
34602 @end smallexample
34603
34604 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34605 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34606 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
34607 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34608 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34609 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34610
34611 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34612 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
34613 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34614 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
34615 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34616
34617 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34618 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34619 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34620 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34621 You specify a cross-debugging target by
34622 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34623
34624 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34625 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34626 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34627
34628 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34629 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
34630 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34631 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34632 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34633
34634 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34635 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34636 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34637 with each other.
34638
34639 @node Config Names
34640 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34641
34642 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34643 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34644 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34645 of information in the following pattern:
34646
34647 @smallexample
34648 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34649 @end smallexample
34650
34651 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34652 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34653 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34654
34655 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34656 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34657 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34658 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34659 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34660 abbreviations---for example:
34661
34662 @smallexample
34663 % sh config.sub i386-linux
34664 i386-pc-linux-gnu
34665 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
34666 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34667 % sh config.sub hp9k700
34668 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34669 % sh config.sub sun4
34670 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34671 % sh config.sub sun3
34672 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34673 % sh config.sub i986v
34674 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34675 @end smallexample
34676
34677 @noindent
34678 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34679 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34680
34681 @node Configure Options
34682 @section @file{configure} Options
34683
34684 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34685 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34686 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34687 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34688
34689 @smallexample
34690 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34691 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34692 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34693 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34694 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34695 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34696 @var{host}
34697 @end smallexample
34698
34699 @noindent
34700 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34701 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34702 @samp{--}.
34703
34704 @table @code
34705 @item --help
34706 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34707
34708 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34709 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34710 @file{@var{dir}}.
34711
34712 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34713 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34714 @file{@var{dir}}.
34715
34716 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34717 @need 2000
34718 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34719 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34720 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34721 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34722 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34723 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34724 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34725 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34726 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34727 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34728 @var{dirname}.
34729
34730 @item --norecursion
34731 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34732 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34733
34734 @item --target=@var{target}
34735 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34736 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34737 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34738
34739 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34740
34741 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34742 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34743
34744 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34745 @end table
34746
34747 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34748 needed for special purposes only.
34749
34750 @node System-wide configuration
34751 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34752 @cindex system-wide init file
34753
34754 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34755 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34756 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34757
34758 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34759
34760 @table @code
34761 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34762 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34763 @var{file}.
34764 @end table
34765
34766 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34767 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34768
34769 @itemize @bullet
34770 @item
34771 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34772 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34773 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34774 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34775 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34776 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34777
34778 @item
34779 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34780 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34781 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34782 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34783 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34784 @end itemize
34785
34786 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34787 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34788 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34789 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34790 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34791 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34792 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34793 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34794 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34795 reread.
34796
34797 @menu
34798 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34799 @end menu
34800
34801 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34802 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34803 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34804
34805 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34806 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34807 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34808 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34809 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34810 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34811
34812 The following scripts are currently available:
34813 @itemize @bullet
34814
34815 @item @file{elinos.py}
34816 @pindex elinos.py
34817 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34818 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34819 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34820 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34821 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34822 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34823
34824 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34825 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34826 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34827 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34828 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34829 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34830
34831 @end itemize
34832
34833 @node Maintenance Commands
34834 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34835 @cindex maintenance commands
34836 @cindex internal commands
34837
34838 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34839 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34840 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34841 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34842 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34843
34844 @table @code
34845 @kindex maint agent
34846 @kindex maint agent-eval
34847 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34848 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34849 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34850 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34851 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34852 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34853 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34854 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34855 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34856 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34857 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34858 addition and return the sum.
34859 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34860 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34861
34862 @kindex maint agent-printf
34863 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34864 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34865 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34866 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34867 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34868
34869 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34870 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34871 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34872 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34873 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34874 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34875 is shown:
34876
34877 @table @code
34878 @item breakpoint
34879 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34880
34881 @item watchpoint
34882 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34883
34884 @item longjmp
34885 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34886 @code{longjmp} calls.
34887
34888 @item longjmp resume
34889 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34890
34891 @item until
34892 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34893
34894 @item finish
34895 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34896
34897 @item shlib events
34898 Shared library events.
34899
34900 @end table
34901
34902 @kindex maint info btrace
34903 @item maint info btrace
34904 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34905
34906 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34907 @item maint btrace packet-history
34908 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34909 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34910 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34911 recording format.
34912
34913 @table @code
34914 @item bts
34915 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34916 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34917
34918 @table @asis
34919 @item Block number
34920 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34921 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34922 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34923 @end table
34924
34925 @item pt
34926 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34927 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34928 information is printed:
34929
34930 @table @asis
34931 @item Packet number
34932 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34933 @item Trace offset
34934 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34935 @item Packet opcode and payload
34936 @end table
34937 @end table
34938
34939 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34940 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34941 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34942 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34943 needed.
34944
34945 @kindex maint btrace clear
34946 @item maint btrace clear
34947 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34948 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34949
34950 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34951 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34952 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34953 buffer.
34954
34955 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34956 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34957 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34958 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34959 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34960 packet history.
34961
34962 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34963 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34964 @cindex displaced stepping support
34965 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34966 @item set displaced-stepping
34967 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34968 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34969 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34970 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34971 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34972 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34973
34974 @table @code
34975 @item set displaced-stepping on
34976 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34977 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34978
34979 @item set displaced-stepping off
34980 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34981 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34982
34983 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34984 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34985 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34986 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34987 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34988 @end table
34989
34990 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34991 @item maint check-psymtabs
34992 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34993 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34994
34995 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34996 @item maint check-symtabs
34997 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34998
34999 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
35000 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
35001 Expand symbol tables.
35002 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
35003 names matching @var{regexp}.
35004
35005 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
35006 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
35007 @cindex demangler crashes
35008 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
35009 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
35010 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
35011 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
35012 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
35013 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
35014 option to terminate the current session.
35015
35016 @kindex maint cplus first_component
35017 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
35018 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
35019
35020 @kindex maint cplus namespace
35021 @item maint cplus namespace
35022 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
35023
35024 @kindex maint deprecate
35025 @kindex maint undeprecate
35026 @cindex deprecated commands
35027 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
35028 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
35029 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
35030 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
35031 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
35032 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
35033 the replacement as part of the warning.
35034
35035 @kindex maint dump-me
35036 @item maint dump-me
35037 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
35038 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
35039 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
35040 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
35041
35042 @kindex maint internal-error
35043 @kindex maint internal-warning
35044 @kindex maint demangler-warning
35045 @cindex demangler crashes
35046 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35047 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35048 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35049
35050 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
35051 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
35052 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
35053 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
35054 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
35055 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
35056 @value{GDBN} session.
35057
35058 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
35059 used as the text of the error or warning message.
35060
35061 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
35062
35063 @smallexample
35064 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
35065 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
35066 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
35067 debugging may prove unreliable.
35068 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
35069 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
35070 (@value{GDBP})
35071 @end smallexample
35072
35073 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
35074 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
35075 @cindex demangler crashes
35076
35077 @kindex maint set internal-error
35078 @kindex maint show internal-error
35079 @kindex maint set internal-warning
35080 @kindex maint show internal-warning
35081 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
35082 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
35083 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35084 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
35085 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35086 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
35087 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35088 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
35089 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
35090 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
35091 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
35092 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
35093 described in the table below.
35094
35095 @table @samp
35096 @item quit
35097 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35098 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
35099
35100 @item corefile
35101 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35102 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
35103 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
35104 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
35105 disabled.
35106 @end table
35107
35108 @kindex maint packet
35109 @item maint packet @var{text}
35110 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
35111 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
35112 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
35113 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
35114 checksum.
35115
35116 @kindex maint print architecture
35117 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35118 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
35119 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
35120
35121 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35122 @item maint print c-tdesc
35123 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
35124 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
35125 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
35126 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
35127 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
35128 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
35129 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
35130 modify XML target descriptions.
35131
35132 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
35133 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
35134 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
35135 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
35136
35137 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
35138 @item maint print dummy-frames
35139 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
35140
35141 @smallexample
35142 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
35143 @dots{}
35144 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
35145 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
35146 58 return (a + b);
35147 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
35148 @dots{}
35149 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
35150 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
35151 (@value{GDBP})
35152 @end smallexample
35153
35154 Takes an optional file parameter.
35155
35156 @kindex maint print registers
35157 @kindex maint print raw-registers
35158 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
35159 @kindex maint print register-groups
35160 @kindex maint print remote-registers
35161 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35162 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35163 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35164 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35165 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35166 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
35167
35168 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
35169 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
35170 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
35171 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
35172 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
35173 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
35174 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
35175 and offsets in the `G' packets.
35176
35177 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
35178 write the information.
35179
35180 @kindex maint print reggroups
35181 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35182 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
35183 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
35184 information.
35185
35186 The register groups info looks like this:
35187
35188 @smallexample
35189 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
35190 Group Type
35191 general user
35192 float user
35193 all user
35194 vector user
35195 system user
35196 save internal
35197 restore internal
35198 @end smallexample
35199
35200 @kindex flushregs
35201 @item flushregs
35202 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
35203
35204 @kindex maint print objfiles
35205 @cindex info for known object files
35206 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
35207 Print a dump of all known object files.
35208 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
35209 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
35210 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
35211
35212 @kindex maint print user-registers
35213 @cindex user registers
35214 @item maint print user-registers
35215 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
35216 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
35217 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
35218 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
35219 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
35220 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
35221 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
35222
35223 @kindex maint print section-scripts
35224 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
35225 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
35226 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
35227 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
35228 matching @var{regexp}.
35229 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
35230 and the full path if known.
35231 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
35232
35233 @kindex maint print statistics
35234 @cindex bcache statistics
35235 @item maint print statistics
35236 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
35237 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
35238 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
35239 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
35240 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
35241 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
35242 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
35243 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
35244 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
35245 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
35246 lengths.
35247
35248 @kindex maint print target-stack
35249 @cindex target stack description
35250 @item maint print target-stack
35251 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
35252 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
35253 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
35254 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
35255 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
35256 address.
35257
35258 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
35259 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
35260
35261 @kindex maint print type
35262 @cindex type chain of a data type
35263 @item maint print type @var{expr}
35264 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
35265 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
35266 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
35267 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
35268 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
35269
35270 @kindex maint selftest
35271 @cindex self tests
35272 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
35273 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
35274 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
35275 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
35276 name will by ran.
35277
35278 @kindex "maint info selftests"
35279 @cindex self tests
35280 @item maint info selftests
35281 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
35282
35283 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35284 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35285 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35286 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35287 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
35288 information.
35289
35290 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
35291 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
35292 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
35293 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
35294 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
35295 always see the disassembly form.
35296
35297 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
35298
35299 @smallexample
35300 (gdb) info addr argc
35301 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
35302 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
35303 @end smallexample
35304
35305 For more information on these expressions, see
35306 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
35307
35308 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35309 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35310 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35311 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35312 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
35313
35314 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
35315 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
35316 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
35317 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
35318 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
35319 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
35320 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
35321 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
35322 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
35323
35324 @kindex maint set profile
35325 @kindex maint show profile
35326 @cindex profiling GDB
35327 @item maint set profile
35328 @itemx maint show profile
35329 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
35330
35331 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
35332 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
35333 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
35334 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
35335 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
35336 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
35337 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
35338
35339 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
35340 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
35341
35342 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
35343 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
35344 @cindex hardware debug registers
35345 @item maint set show-debug-regs
35346 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
35347 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
35348 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
35349 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
35350 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
35351 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
35352
35353 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
35354 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
35355 @item maint set show-all-tib
35356 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
35357 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
35358 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
35359 command.
35360
35361 @kindex maint set target-async
35362 @kindex maint show target-async
35363 @item maint set target-async
35364 @itemx maint show target-async
35365 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
35366 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
35367 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
35368 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
35369
35370 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
35371 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
35372 @item maint set target-non-stop
35373 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
35374
35375 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
35376 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
35377 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
35378 if supported by the target.
35379
35380 @table @code
35381 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
35382 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
35383 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
35384
35385 @item maint set target-non-stop on
35386 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
35387 does not indicate support.
35388
35389 @item maint set target-non-stop off
35390 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
35391 target supports it.
35392 @end table
35393
35394 @kindex maint set per-command
35395 @kindex maint show per-command
35396 @item maint set per-command
35397 @itemx maint show per-command
35398 @cindex resources used by commands
35399
35400 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
35401 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
35402
35403 @table @code
35404 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
35405 @itemx maint show per-command space
35406 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
35407 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
35408 took, following the command's own output.
35409 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35410 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35411
35412 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
35413 @itemx maint show per-command time
35414 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
35415 for each command.
35416 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
35417 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
35418 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
35419 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
35420 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
35421 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
35422 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
35423 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
35424 spent by the program been debugged.
35425 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35426 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35427
35428 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
35429 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
35430 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
35431 for each command.
35432 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
35433
35434 @enumerate a
35435 @item
35436 number of symbol tables
35437 @item
35438 number of primary symbol tables
35439 @item
35440 number of blocks in the blockvector
35441 @end enumerate
35442 @end table
35443
35444 @kindex maint space
35445 @cindex memory used by commands
35446 @item maint space @var{value}
35447 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
35448 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35449
35450 @kindex maint time
35451 @cindex time of command execution
35452 @item maint time @var{value}
35453 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
35454 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35455
35456 @kindex maint translate-address
35457 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
35458 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
35459 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
35460 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
35461 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
35462 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
35463 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
35464
35465 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
35466 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
35467 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
35468
35469 @end table
35470
35471 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
35472 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
35473
35474 @table @code
35475 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
35476 @kindex set watchdog
35477 @cindex watchdog timer
35478 @cindex timeout for commands
35479 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
35480 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
35481 reports and error and the command is aborted.
35482
35483 @item show watchdog
35484 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
35485 @end table
35486
35487 @node Remote Protocol
35488 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
35489
35490 @menu
35491 * Overview::
35492 * Packets::
35493 * Stop Reply Packets::
35494 * General Query Packets::
35495 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
35496 * Tracepoint Packets::
35497 * Host I/O Packets::
35498 * Interrupts::
35499 * Notification Packets::
35500 * Remote Non-Stop::
35501 * Packet Acknowledgment::
35502 * Examples::
35503 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
35504 * Library List Format::
35505 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
35506 * Memory Map Format::
35507 * Thread List Format::
35508 * Traceframe Info Format::
35509 * Branch Trace Format::
35510 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
35511 @end menu
35512
35513 @node Overview
35514 @section Overview
35515
35516 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
35517 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
35518 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
35519 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
35520
35521 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
35522 transmitted and received data, respectively.
35523
35524 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
35525 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
35526 @cindex remote serial protocol
35527 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
35528 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
35529 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
35530 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
35531 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
35532
35533 @smallexample
35534 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35535 @end smallexample
35536 @noindent
35537
35538 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
35539 @noindent
35540 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
35541 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
35542 eight bit unsigned checksum).
35543
35544 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
35545 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
35546
35547 @smallexample
35548 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35549 @end smallexample
35550
35551 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
35552 @noindent
35553 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
35554 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
35555 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
35556
35557 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
35558 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35559 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
35560 retransmission):
35561
35562 @smallexample
35563 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35564 <- @code{+}
35565 @end smallexample
35566 @noindent
35567
35568 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
35569 once a connection is established.
35570 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
35571
35572 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
35573 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
35574 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
35575 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
35576 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
35577 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
35578 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
35579
35580 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
35581 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
35582 exceptions).
35583
35584 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
35585 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
35586 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
35587 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
35588
35589 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
35590 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
35591 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
35592
35593 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
35594 @anchor{Binary Data}
35595 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
35596 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
35597 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
35598 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
35599 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
35600 binary data.
35601
35602 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
35603 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
35604 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
35605 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
35606 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
35607 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
35608 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
35609 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
35610 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
35611 (described next).
35612
35613 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35614 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35615 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35616 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35617 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35618 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35619 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35620 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
35621 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
35622 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35623 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
35624 3}} more times.
35625
35626 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35627 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35628 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35629 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35630 @samp{0*"00}.
35631
35632 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35633 error number. That number is not well defined.
35634
35635 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35636 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35637 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
35638 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35639 on that response.
35640
35641 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35642 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35643 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35644 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35645 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35646 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
35647
35648 @node Packets
35649 @section Packets
35650
35651 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35652 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35653 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35654 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35655
35656 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35657 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
35658 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35659 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35660 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
35661 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35662 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35663 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35664 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35665 @var{baz}.
35666
35667 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35668 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
35669 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35670 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35671 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
35672 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35673 pick any thread.
35674
35675 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35676 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35677 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35678 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35679 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35680 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35681 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35682 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35683 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35684 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35685 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35686 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35687 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35688
35689 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35690 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35691 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35692 more information.
35693
35694 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35695 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35696
35697 Here are the packet descriptions.
35698
35699 @table @samp
35700
35701 @item !
35702 @cindex @samp{!} packet
35703 @anchor{extended mode}
35704 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35705 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35706 debugged.
35707
35708 Reply:
35709 @table @samp
35710 @item OK
35711 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35712 @end table
35713
35714 @item ?
35715 @cindex @samp{?} packet
35716 @anchor{? packet}
35717 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35718 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35719 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35720
35721 Reply:
35722 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35723
35724 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35725 @cindex @samp{A} packet
35726 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35727 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35728 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35729
35730 Reply:
35731 @table @samp
35732 @item OK
35733 The arguments were set.
35734 @item E @var{NN}
35735 An error occurred.
35736 @end table
35737
35738 @item b @var{baud}
35739 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35740 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35741 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35742
35743 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35744 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35745 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35746
35747 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35748 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35749 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35750 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35751 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35752
35753 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35754 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35755 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35756 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35757
35758 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35759 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35760
35761 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35762 @anchor{bc}
35763 @item bc
35764 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35765 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35766
35767 Reply:
35768 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35769
35770 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35771 @anchor{bs}
35772 @item bs
35773 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35774 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35775
35776 Reply:
35777 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35778
35779 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35780 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35781 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35782 is omitted, resume at current address.
35783
35784 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35785 packet}.
35786
35787 Reply:
35788 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35789
35790 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35791 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35792 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35793 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35794
35795 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35796 packet}.
35797
35798 Reply:
35799 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35800
35801 @item d
35802 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35803 Toggle debug flag.
35804
35805 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35806 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35807
35808 @item D
35809 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35810 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35811 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35812 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35813 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35814
35815 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35816 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35817 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35818 big-endian hex string.
35819
35820 Reply:
35821 @table @samp
35822 @item OK
35823 for success
35824 @item E @var{NN}
35825 for an error
35826 @end table
35827
35828 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35829 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35830 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35831 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35832 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35833
35834 @item g
35835 @anchor{read registers packet}
35836 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35837 Read general registers.
35838
35839 Reply:
35840 @table @samp
35841 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35842 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35843 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35844 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35845 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35846 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
35847
35848 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35849 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35850 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35851 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35852 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35853 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35854 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35855 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35856
35857 @smallexample
35858 -> @code{g}
35859 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35860 @end smallexample
35861
35862 @item E @var{NN}
35863 for an error.
35864 @end table
35865
35866 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35867 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35868 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35869 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35870
35871 Reply:
35872 @table @samp
35873 @item OK
35874 for success
35875 @item E @var{NN}
35876 for an error
35877 @end table
35878
35879 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35880 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35881 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35882 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35883 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35884 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35885 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35886 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35887 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35888
35889 Reply:
35890 @table @samp
35891 @item OK
35892 for success
35893 @item E @var{NN}
35894 for an error
35895 @end table
35896
35897 @c FIXME: JTC:
35898 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35899 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35900 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35901 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35902 @c described. For example:
35903 @c
35904 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35905 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35906 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35907 @c
35908 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35909 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35910 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35911
35912 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35913 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35914 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35915 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35916 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35917 step starting at that address.
35918
35919 @item I
35920 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35921 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35922 step packet}.
35923
35924 @item k
35925 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35926 Kill request.
35927
35928 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35929
35930 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35931 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35932
35933 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35934
35935 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35936 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35937 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35938
35939 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35940 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35941 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35942
35943 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35944 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35945 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35946 (@pxref{? packet}).
35947
35948 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35949 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35950 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35951 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35952 any particular boundary.
35953
35954 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35955 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35956 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35957 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35958 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35959 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35960 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35961 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35962
35963 Reply:
35964 @table @samp
35965 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35966 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35967 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35968 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35969 @item E @var{NN}
35970 @var{NN} is errno
35971 @end table
35972
35973 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35974 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35975 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35976 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35977 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35978
35979 Reply:
35980 @table @samp
35981 @item OK
35982 for success
35983 @item E @var{NN}
35984 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35985 written).
35986 @end table
35987
35988 @item p @var{n}
35989 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35990 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35991 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35992 register value is encoded.
35993
35994 Reply:
35995 @table @samp
35996 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35997 the register's value
35998 @item E @var{NN}
35999 for an error
36000 @item @w{}
36001 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
36002 @end table
36003
36004 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
36005 @anchor{write register packet}
36006 @cindex @samp{P} packet
36007 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
36008 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
36009 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
36010
36011 Reply:
36012 @table @samp
36013 @item OK
36014 for success
36015 @item E @var{NN}
36016 for an error
36017 @end table
36018
36019 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
36020 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
36021 @cindex @samp{q} packet
36022 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
36023 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
36024 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
36025
36026 @item r
36027 @cindex @samp{r} packet
36028 Reset the entire system.
36029
36030 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
36031
36032 @item R @var{XX}
36033 @cindex @samp{R} packet
36034 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
36035 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36036
36037 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
36038
36039 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36040 @cindex @samp{s} packet
36041 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
36042 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
36043
36044 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36045 packet}.
36046
36047 Reply:
36048 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36049
36050 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36051 @anchor{step with signal packet}
36052 @cindex @samp{S} packet
36053 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
36054 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
36055
36056 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36057 packet}.
36058
36059 Reply:
36060 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36061
36062 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
36063 @cindex @samp{t} packet
36064 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
36065 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
36066 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
36067
36068 @item T @var{thread-id}
36069 @cindex @samp{T} packet
36070 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36071
36072 Reply:
36073 @table @samp
36074 @item OK
36075 thread is still alive
36076 @item E @var{NN}
36077 thread is dead
36078 @end table
36079
36080 @item v
36081 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
36082 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
36083
36084 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
36085 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
36086 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
36087 The process ID is a
36088 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
36089 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
36090 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
36091
36092 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
36093 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
36094 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
36095 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
36096 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
36097 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
36098 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
36099 @c stopping or restarting threads.
36100
36101 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36102
36103 Reply:
36104 @table @samp
36105 @item E @var{nn}
36106 for an error
36107 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36108 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36109 @item OK
36110 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
36111 @end table
36112
36113 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
36114 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
36115 @anchor{vCont packet}
36116 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
36117
36118 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
36119 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
36120 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
36121 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
36122 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
36123 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
36124 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
36125 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
36126 error.
36127
36128 Currently supported actions are:
36129
36130 @table @samp
36131 @item c
36132 Continue.
36133 @item C @var{sig}
36134 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36135 @item s
36136 Step.
36137 @item S @var{sig}
36138 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36139 @item t
36140 Stop.
36141 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
36142 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
36143 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
36144 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
36145 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
36146 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
36147
36148 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
36149 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
36150 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
36151 jumps to @var{start}).
36152
36153 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
36154 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
36155 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
36156
36157 @end table
36158
36159 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
36160 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
36161 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
36162
36163 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
36164 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
36165 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
36166 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
36167 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
36168 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
36169 as an implementation detail.
36170
36171 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
36172 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
36173 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
36174 stopped.
36175
36176 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
36177 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
36178 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
36179
36180 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
36181 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
36182
36183 Reply:
36184 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36185
36186 @item vCont?
36187 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
36188 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
36189
36190 Reply:
36191 @table @samp
36192 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
36193 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
36194 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
36195 @item @w{}
36196 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
36197 @end table
36198
36199 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
36200 @item vCtrlC
36201 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
36202 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
36203 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
36204 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
36205 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
36206 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
36207 variant.
36208
36209 Reply:
36210 @table @samp
36211 @item E @var{nn}
36212 for an error
36213 @item OK
36214 for success
36215 @end table
36216
36217 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
36218 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
36219 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
36220 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
36221
36222 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
36223 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
36224 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
36225 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
36226 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
36227 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
36228 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
36229 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
36230 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36231 packet is received.
36232
36233 Reply:
36234 @table @samp
36235 @item OK
36236 for success
36237 @item E @var{NN}
36238 for an error
36239 @end table
36240
36241 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36242 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
36243 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
36244 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
36245 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
36246 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
36247 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
36248 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
36249 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
36250 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
36251 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
36252 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
36253
36254
36255 Reply:
36256 @table @samp
36257 @item OK
36258 for success
36259 @item E.memtype
36260 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
36261 @item E @var{NN}
36262 for an error
36263 @end table
36264
36265 @item vFlashDone
36266 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
36267 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
36268 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
36269 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
36270 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
36271 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36272 request is completed.
36273
36274 @item vKill;@var{pid}
36275 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
36276 @anchor{vKill packet}
36277 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
36278 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
36279 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
36280 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
36281
36282 Reply:
36283 @table @samp
36284 @item E @var{nn}
36285 for an error
36286 @item OK
36287 for success
36288 @end table
36289
36290 @item vMustReplyEmpty
36291 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
36292 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
36293 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
36294 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
36295
36296 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
36297 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
36298 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
36299 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
36300 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
36301 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
36302
36303 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
36304 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
36305 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
36306 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
36307 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
36308 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
36309 state.
36310
36311 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
36312
36313 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36314
36315 Reply:
36316 @table @samp
36317 @item E @var{nn}
36318 for an error
36319 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36320 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36321 @end table
36322
36323 @item vStopped
36324 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
36325 @xref{Notification Packets}.
36326
36327 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36328 @anchor{X packet}
36329 @cindex @samp{X} packet
36330 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
36331 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
36332 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
36333 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36334
36335 Reply:
36336 @table @samp
36337 @item OK
36338 for success
36339 @item E @var{NN}
36340 for an error
36341 @end table
36342
36343 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36344 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36345 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
36346 @cindex @samp{z} packet
36347 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
36348 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
36349 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
36350
36351 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
36352 separately.
36353
36354 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
36355 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
36356 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
36357 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
36358 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
36359 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
36360
36361 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36362 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36363 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
36364 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
36365 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
36366 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
36367
36368 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
36369 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
36370 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
36371 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
36372 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
36373 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
36374 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
36375 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
36376 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
36377 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
36378 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
36379 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
36380 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36381
36382 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
36383 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
36384
36385 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
36386 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
36387
36388 @table @samp
36389
36390 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36391 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36392 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
36393
36394 @end table
36395
36396 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
36397 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36398 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
36399 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
36400 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
36401 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
36402 separators. Each expression has the following form:
36403
36404 @table @samp
36405
36406 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36407 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36408 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
36409
36410 @end table
36411
36412 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
36413 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
36414 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
36415 target, is not defined.}
36416
36417 Reply:
36418 @table @samp
36419 @item OK
36420 success
36421 @item @w{}
36422 not supported
36423 @item E @var{NN}
36424 for an error
36425 @end table
36426
36427 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36428 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36429 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
36430 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
36431 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
36432 address @var{addr}.
36433
36434 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
36435 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
36436 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
36437 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
36438
36439 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
36440 movement.}
36441
36442 Reply:
36443 @table @samp
36444 @item OK
36445 success
36446 @item @w{}
36447 not supported
36448 @item E @var{NN}
36449 for an error
36450 @end table
36451
36452 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36453 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36454 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
36455 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
36456 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36457 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36458
36459 Reply:
36460 @table @samp
36461 @item OK
36462 success
36463 @item @w{}
36464 not supported
36465 @item E @var{NN}
36466 for an error
36467 @end table
36468
36469 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36470 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36471 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
36472 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
36473 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36474 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36475
36476 Reply:
36477 @table @samp
36478 @item OK
36479 success
36480 @item @w{}
36481 not supported
36482 @item E @var{NN}
36483 for an error
36484 @end table
36485
36486 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36487 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36488 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
36489 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
36490 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36491 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36492
36493 Reply:
36494 @table @samp
36495 @item OK
36496 success
36497 @item @w{}
36498 not supported
36499 @item E @var{NN}
36500 for an error
36501 @end table
36502
36503 @end table
36504
36505 @node Stop Reply Packets
36506 @section Stop Reply Packets
36507 @cindex stop reply packets
36508
36509 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
36510 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
36511 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
36512 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
36513 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
36514 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
36515 @value{GDBN} source code.
36516
36517 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
36518 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
36519 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36520
36521 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
36522 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
36523 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
36524 components.
36525
36526 @table @samp
36527
36528 @item S @var{AA}
36529 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36530 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
36531 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
36532
36533 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
36534 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
36535 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36536 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
36537 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
36538 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
36539 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
36540 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
36541
36542 @itemize @bullet
36543 @item
36544 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
36545 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
36546 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
36547 two-digit hex number.
36548
36549 @item
36550 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
36551 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36552
36553 @item
36554 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
36555 the core on which the stop event was detected.
36556
36557 @item
36558 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
36559 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
36560 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
36561 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
36562
36563 @item
36564 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
36565 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
36566 future.
36567 @end itemize
36568
36569 The currently defined stop reasons are:
36570
36571 @table @samp
36572 @item watch
36573 @itemx rwatch
36574 @itemx awatch
36575 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
36576 hex.
36577
36578 @item syscall_entry
36579 @itemx syscall_return
36580 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
36581 syscall number, in hex.
36582
36583 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
36584 @item library
36585 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
36586 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
36587 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
36588
36589 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
36590 @item replaylog
36591 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
36592 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
36593 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
36594 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
36595 for more information.
36596
36597 @item swbreak
36598 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
36599 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
36600 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
36601 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
36602 part must be left empty.
36603
36604 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
36605 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
36606 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
36607 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
36608 address.
36609
36610 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36611 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36612 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36613 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36614 indicating support.
36615
36616 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
36617
36618 @item hwbreak
36619 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
36620 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
36621
36622 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
36623 apply.
36624
36625 @cindex fork events, remote reply
36626 @item fork
36627 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
36628 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36629 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36630 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36631 fork events.
36632
36633 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36634 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36635 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36636 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36637 indicating support.
36638
36639 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
36640 @item vfork
36641 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
36642 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36643 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36644 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36645 vfork events.
36646
36647 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36648 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36649 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36650 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36651 indicating support.
36652
36653 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36654 @item vforkdone
36655 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36656 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36657 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36658 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
36659 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36660
36661 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36662 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36663 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36664 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36665 indicating support.
36666
36667 @cindex exec events, remote reply
36668 @item exec
36669 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36670 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36671 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36672
36673 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36674 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36675 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36676 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36677 indicating support.
36678
36679 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
36680 @anchor{thread create event}
36681 @item create
36682 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
36683 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36684 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
36685 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
36686 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
36687 @var{r} part is ignored.
36688
36689 @end table
36690
36691 @item W @var{AA}
36692 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36693 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
36694 applicable to certain targets.
36695
36696 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36697 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36698 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36699 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36700 hex strings.
36701
36702 @item X @var{AA}
36703 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36704 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36705
36706 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36707 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36708 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36709 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36710 hex strings.
36711
36712 @anchor{thread exit event}
36713 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36714 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36715
36716 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
36717 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36718 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36719 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36720
36721 @item N
36722 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
36723 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
36724 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
36725 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36726 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
36727 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36728 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36729 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
36730 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36731 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36732 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
36733 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36734 support.
36735
36736 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36737 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36738 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
36739 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36740 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36741
36742 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36743 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36744 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36745 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36746 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36747 system calls.
36748
36749 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36750 this very system call.
36751
36752 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36753 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36754 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36755 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36756 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36757 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36758
36759 @end table
36760
36761 @node General Query Packets
36762 @section General Query Packets
36763 @cindex remote query requests
36764
36765 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36766 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36767 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36768 sending information to and from the stub.
36769
36770 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36771 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36772 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36773 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36774 conventions:
36775
36776 @itemize @bullet
36777 @item
36778 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36779 @item
36780 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36781 letter.
36782 @item
36783 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36784 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36785 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36786 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36787 @end itemize
36788
36789 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36790 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36791 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36792 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36793 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36794 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36795 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36796 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36797 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36798 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36799 packet.}.
36800
36801 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36802 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36803 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36804 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36805 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36806
36807 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36808
36809 @table @samp
36810
36811 @item QAgent:1
36812 @itemx QAgent:0
36813 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36814 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36815
36816 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36817 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36818 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36819 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36820 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36821 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36822 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36823 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36824 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36825 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36826 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36827
36828 @item qC
36829 @cindex current thread, remote request
36830 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36831 Return the current thread ID.
36832
36833 Reply:
36834 @table @samp
36835 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36836 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36837 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36838 @item @r{(anything else)}
36839 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36840 @end table
36841
36842 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36843 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36844 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36845 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36846 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36847 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36848 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36849 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36850
36851 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36852 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36853 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36854 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36855 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36856 detect trailing zeros.
36857
36858 Reply:
36859 @table @samp
36860 @item E @var{NN}
36861 An error (such as memory fault)
36862 @item C @var{crc32}
36863 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36864 @end table
36865
36866 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36867 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36868 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36869 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36870 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36871 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36872 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36873 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36874 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36875 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36876 randomization.
36877
36878 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36879
36880 Reply:
36881 @table @samp
36882 @item OK
36883 The request succeeded.
36884
36885 @item E @var{nn}
36886 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36887
36888 @item @w{}
36889 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36890 by the stub.
36891 @end table
36892
36893 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36894 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36895 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36896 address space randomization.
36897
36898 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
36899 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
36900 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
36901 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
36902 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
36903 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
36904 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
36905 inferior using a shell or not.
36906
36907 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
36908 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
36909 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
36910 values are considered an error.
36911
36912 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36913 mode}).
36914
36915 Reply:
36916 @table @samp
36917 @item OK
36918 The request succeeded.
36919
36920 @item E @var{nn}
36921 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36922 @end table
36923
36924 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36925 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36926 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36927 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
36928
36929 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
36930 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
36931
36932 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
36933 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
36934 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
36935 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
36936 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
36937 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
36938 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
36939 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
36940 environment}).
36941
36942 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
36943 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
36944 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
36945 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
36946 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
36947 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
36948 not be present.
36949
36950 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36951 mode}).
36952
36953 Reply:
36954 @table @samp
36955 @item OK
36956 The request succeeded.
36957 @end table
36958
36959 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36960 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36961 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36962 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36963 inferior.
36964
36965 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
36966 @pxref{set environment}.
36967
36968 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
36969 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
36970 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
36971 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
36972 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
36973 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
36974 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
36975 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
36976
36977 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
36978 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
36979
36980 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36981 mode}).
36982
36983 Reply:
36984 @table @samp
36985 @item OK
36986 The request succeeded.
36987 @end table
36988
36989 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36990 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36991 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36992 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36993 inferior.
36994
36995 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
36996 @pxref{unset environment}.
36997
36998 @item QEnvironmentReset
36999 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
37000 @cindex reset environment, remote request
37001 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
37002 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
37003 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
37004 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
37005 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
37006 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
37007 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
37008 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
37009 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
37010
37011 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37012 mode}).
37013
37014 Reply:
37015 @table @samp
37016 @item OK
37017 The request succeeded.
37018 @end table
37019
37020 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37021 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37022 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37023 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37024 inferior.
37025
37026 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
37027 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
37028 @cindex set working directory, remote request
37029 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
37030 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
37031 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
37032
37033 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
37034 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
37035 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
37036 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
37037 directory to its original, empty value.
37038
37039 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37040 mode}).
37041
37042 Reply:
37043 @table @samp
37044 @item OK
37045 The request succeeded.
37046 @end table
37047
37048 @item qfThreadInfo
37049 @itemx qsThreadInfo
37050 @cindex list active threads, remote request
37051 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
37052 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
37053 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
37054 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
37055 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
37056 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
37057 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
37058 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
37059
37060 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
37061
37062 Reply:
37063 @table @samp
37064 @item m @var{thread-id}
37065 A single thread ID
37066 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
37067 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
37068 @item l
37069 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37070 @end table
37071
37072 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37073 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
37074 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
37075 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
37076 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
37077 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37078 fields.
37079
37080 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
37081 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
37082 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
37083 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
37084 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
37085
37086 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
37087 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
37088 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
37089 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
37090 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
37091
37092 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
37093 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37094
37095 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
37096 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
37097 information associated with the variable.)
37098
37099 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
37100 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
37101 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
37102 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
37103 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
37104 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
37105
37106 Reply:
37107 @table @samp
37108 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37109 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
37110 local storage requested.
37111
37112 @item E @var{nn}
37113 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37114
37115 @item @w{}
37116 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37117 @end table
37118
37119 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
37120 @cindex get thread information block address
37121 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
37122 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
37123
37124 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
37125
37126 Reply:
37127 @table @samp
37128 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37129 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
37130 thread information block.
37131
37132 @item E @var{nn}
37133 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
37134 address could not be retrieved.
37135
37136 @item @w{}
37137 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37138 @end table
37139
37140 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
37141 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
37142 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
37143 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
37144 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
37145 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
37146 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
37147
37148 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
37149
37150 Reply:
37151 @table @samp
37152 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
37153 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
37154 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
37155 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
37156 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
37157 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
37158 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
37159 @end table
37160
37161 @item qOffsets
37162 @cindex section offsets, remote request
37163 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
37164 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
37165 image.
37166
37167 Reply:
37168 @table @samp
37169 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
37170 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
37171 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
37172 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
37173 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
37174 segments by the supplied offsets.
37175
37176 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
37177 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
37178 to the @code{Bss} section.}
37179
37180 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
37181 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
37182 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
37183 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
37184 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
37185 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
37186 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
37187 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
37188 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
37189 @end table
37190
37191 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
37192 @cindex thread information, remote request
37193 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
37194 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
37195 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
37196 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
37197
37198 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
37199 (see below).
37200
37201 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
37202
37203 @item QNonStop:1
37204 @itemx QNonStop:0
37205 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
37206 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
37207 @anchor{QNonStop}
37208 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
37209 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
37210
37211 Reply:
37212 @table @samp
37213 @item OK
37214 The request succeeded.
37215
37216 @item E @var{nn}
37217 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37218
37219 @item @w{}
37220 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
37221 the stub.
37222 @end table
37223
37224 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37225 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37226 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
37227 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
37228
37229 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
37230 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
37231 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
37232 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37233 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
37234 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
37235 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
37236
37237 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
37238 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
37239 is listed, every system call should be reported.
37240
37241 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
37242 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
37243 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
37244 report the requested syscalls.
37245
37246 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
37247 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37248
37249 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
37250 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
37251 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
37252 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
37253
37254 Reply:
37255 @table @samp
37256 @item OK
37257 The request succeeded.
37258
37259 @item E @var{nn}
37260 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
37261
37262 @item @w{}
37263 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
37264 the stub.
37265 @end table
37266
37267 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
37268 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
37269 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37270 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37271
37272 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37273 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
37274 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37275 @anchor{QPassSignals}
37276 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
37277 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37278 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37279 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
37280 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
37281 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
37282 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
37283 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
37284 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
37285
37286 Reply:
37287 @table @samp
37288 @item OK
37289 The request succeeded.
37290
37291 @item E @var{nn}
37292 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37293
37294 @item @w{}
37295 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
37296 the stub.
37297 @end table
37298
37299 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
37300 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
37301 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37302 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37303
37304 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37305 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
37306 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
37307 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
37308 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
37309 Others should be silently discarded.
37310
37311 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
37312 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
37313 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
37314 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
37315 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
37316 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
37317 signals.
37318
37319 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
37320 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
37321
37322 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37323 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37324 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
37325 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
37326 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37327
37328 Reply:
37329 @table @samp
37330 @item OK
37331 The request succeeded.
37332
37333 @item E @var{nn}
37334 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37335
37336 @item @w{}
37337 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
37338 by the stub.
37339 @end table
37340
37341 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
37342 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
37343 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37344 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37345
37346 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
37347 @item QThreadEvents:1
37348 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
37349 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
37350 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
37351
37352 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
37353 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
37354 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
37355 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
37356 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
37357 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
37358 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
37359 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
37360 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
37361 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37362
37363 Reply:
37364 @table @samp
37365 @item OK
37366 The request succeeded.
37367
37368 @item E @var{nn}
37369 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37370
37371 @item @w{}
37372 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
37373 the stub.
37374 @end table
37375
37376 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
37377 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
37378
37379 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
37380 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
37381 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
37382 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
37383 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
37384 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
37385 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
37386 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
37387 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
37388
37389 Reply:
37390 @table @samp
37391 @item OK
37392 A command response with no output.
37393 @item @var{OUTPUT}
37394 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
37395 @item E @var{NN}
37396 Indicate a badly formed request.
37397 @item @w{}
37398 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
37399 @end table
37400
37401 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
37402 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37403 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37404 packets.)
37405
37406 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
37407 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
37408 @ifnotinfo
37409 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
37410 @end ifnotinfo
37411 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
37412 @anchor{qSearch memory}
37413 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
37414 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
37415 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
37416
37417 Reply:
37418 @table @samp
37419 @item 0
37420 The pattern was not found.
37421 @item 1,address
37422 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
37423 @item E @var{NN}
37424 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
37425 @item @w{}
37426 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
37427 @end table
37428
37429 @item QStartNoAckMode
37430 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
37431 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
37432 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
37433 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
37434
37435 Reply:
37436 @table @samp
37437 @item OK
37438 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
37439 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
37440 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
37441 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
37442 @item @w{}
37443 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
37444 @end table
37445
37446 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
37447 @cindex supported packets, remote query
37448 @cindex features of the remote protocol
37449 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
37450 @anchor{qSupported}
37451 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
37452 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
37453 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
37454 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
37455 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
37456 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
37457 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
37458 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
37459 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
37460 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
37461 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
37462 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
37463 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
37464 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
37465
37466 Reply:
37467 @table @samp
37468 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
37469 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
37470 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
37471 possible forms).
37472 @item @w{}
37473 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
37474 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
37475 @end table
37476
37477 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
37478 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
37479 are:
37480
37481 @table @samp
37482 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
37483 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
37484 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
37485 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
37486 @item @var{name}+
37487 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
37488 need an associated value.
37489 @item @var{name}-
37490 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
37491 @item @var{name}?
37492 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
37493 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
37494 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
37495 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
37496 @end table
37497
37498 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
37499 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
37500 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
37501 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
37502 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
37503
37504 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
37505 are defined:
37506
37507 @table @samp
37508 @item multiprocess
37509 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
37510 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37511 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37512 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37513 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
37514
37515 @item xmlRegisters
37516 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
37517 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
37518 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
37519 description.
37520
37521 @item qRelocInsn
37522 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
37523 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37524 instruction reply packet}).
37525
37526 @item swbreak
37527 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
37528 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37529
37530 @item hwbreak
37531 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
37532 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37533
37534 @item fork-events
37535 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
37536 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37537 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37538 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37539
37540 @item vfork-events
37541 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
37542 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37543 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37544 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37545
37546 @item exec-events
37547 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
37548 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37549 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37550 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37551
37552 @item vContSupported
37553 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
37554 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
37555 @end table
37556
37557 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
37558 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
37559 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
37560 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
37561 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
37562 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
37563 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
37564 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
37565 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
37566 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
37567 all the features it supports.
37568
37569 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
37570 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
37571
37572 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
37573 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
37574 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
37575 form response.
37576
37577 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
37578 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
37579 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
37580 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
37581
37582 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
37583 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
37584 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
37585 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
37586 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
37587
37588 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
37589
37590 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
37591 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
37592 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
37593 @item Feature Name
37594 @tab Value Required
37595 @tab Default
37596 @tab Probe Allowed
37597
37598 @item @samp{PacketSize}
37599 @tab Yes
37600 @tab @samp{-}
37601 @tab No
37602
37603 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
37604 @tab No
37605 @tab @samp{-}
37606 @tab Yes
37607
37608 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37609 @tab No
37610 @tab @samp{-}
37611 @tab Yes
37612
37613 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37614 @tab No
37615 @tab @samp{-}
37616 @tab Yes
37617
37618 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
37619 @tab No
37620 @tab @samp{-}
37621 @tab Yes
37622
37623 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
37624 @tab No
37625 @tab @samp{-}
37626 @tab Yes
37627
37628 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
37629 @tab No
37630 @tab @samp{-}
37631 @tab Yes
37632
37633 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
37634 @tab No
37635 @tab @samp{-}
37636 @tab Yes
37637
37638 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
37639 @tab No
37640 @tab @samp{-}
37641 @tab No
37642
37643 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
37644 @tab No
37645 @tab @samp{-}
37646 @tab Yes
37647
37648 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
37649 @tab No
37650 @tab @samp{-}
37651 @tab Yes
37652
37653 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
37654 @tab No
37655 @tab @samp{-}
37656 @tab Yes
37657
37658 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
37659 @tab No
37660 @tab @samp{-}
37661 @tab Yes
37662
37663 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
37664 @tab No
37665 @tab @samp{-}
37666 @tab Yes
37667
37668 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
37669 @tab No
37670 @tab @samp{-}
37671 @tab Yes
37672
37673 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
37674 @tab No
37675 @tab @samp{-}
37676 @tab Yes
37677
37678 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37679 @tab No
37680 @tab @samp{-}
37681 @tab Yes
37682
37683 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37684 @tab No
37685 @tab @samp{-}
37686 @tab Yes
37687
37688 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37689 @tab No
37690 @tab @samp{-}
37691 @tab Yes
37692
37693 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
37694 @tab Yes
37695 @tab @samp{-}
37696 @tab Yes
37697
37698 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
37699 @tab Yes
37700 @tab @samp{-}
37701 @tab Yes
37702
37703 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
37704 @tab Yes
37705 @tab @samp{-}
37706 @tab Yes
37707
37708 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
37709 @tab Yes
37710 @tab @samp{-}
37711 @tab Yes
37712
37713 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
37714 @tab Yes
37715 @tab @samp{-}
37716 @tab Yes
37717
37718 @item @samp{QNonStop}
37719 @tab No
37720 @tab @samp{-}
37721 @tab Yes
37722
37723 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
37724 @tab No
37725 @tab @samp{-}
37726 @tab Yes
37727
37728 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
37729 @tab No
37730 @tab @samp{-}
37731 @tab Yes
37732
37733 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
37734 @tab No
37735 @tab @samp{-}
37736 @tab Yes
37737
37738 @item @samp{multiprocess}
37739 @tab No
37740 @tab @samp{-}
37741 @tab No
37742
37743 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
37744 @tab No
37745 @tab @samp{-}
37746 @tab No
37747
37748 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
37749 @tab No
37750 @tab @samp{-}
37751 @tab No
37752
37753 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
37754 @tab No
37755 @tab @samp{-}
37756 @tab No
37757
37758 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
37759 @tab No
37760 @tab @samp{-}
37761 @tab No
37762
37763 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
37764 @tab No
37765 @tab @samp{-}
37766 @tab No
37767
37768 @item @samp{QAgent}
37769 @tab No
37770 @tab @samp{-}
37771 @tab No
37772
37773 @item @samp{QAllow}
37774 @tab No
37775 @tab @samp{-}
37776 @tab No
37777
37778 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
37779 @tab No
37780 @tab @samp{-}
37781 @tab No
37782
37783 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
37784 @tab No
37785 @tab @samp{-}
37786 @tab No
37787
37788 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
37789 @tab No
37790 @tab @samp{-}
37791 @tab No
37792
37793 @item @samp{tracenz}
37794 @tab No
37795 @tab @samp{-}
37796 @tab No
37797
37798 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
37799 @tab No
37800 @tab @samp{-}
37801 @tab No
37802
37803 @item @samp{swbreak}
37804 @tab No
37805 @tab @samp{-}
37806 @tab No
37807
37808 @item @samp{hwbreak}
37809 @tab No
37810 @tab @samp{-}
37811 @tab No
37812
37813 @item @samp{fork-events}
37814 @tab No
37815 @tab @samp{-}
37816 @tab No
37817
37818 @item @samp{vfork-events}
37819 @tab No
37820 @tab @samp{-}
37821 @tab No
37822
37823 @item @samp{exec-events}
37824 @tab No
37825 @tab @samp{-}
37826 @tab No
37827
37828 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
37829 @tab No
37830 @tab @samp{-}
37831 @tab No
37832
37833 @item @samp{no-resumed}
37834 @tab No
37835 @tab @samp{-}
37836 @tab No
37837
37838 @end multitable
37839
37840 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
37841
37842 @table @samp
37843 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
37844 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
37845 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
37846 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
37847 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
37848 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
37849 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
37850 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
37851 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
37852 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
37853
37854 @item qXfer:auxv:read
37855 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
37856 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37857
37858 @item qXfer:btrace:read
37859 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37860 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37861
37862 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37863 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37864 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37865
37866 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
37867 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37868 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37869
37870 @item qXfer:features:read
37871 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37872 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37873
37874 @item qXfer:libraries:read
37875 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37876 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37877
37878 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37879 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37880 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37881
37882 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37883 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37884 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37885 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37886
37887 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
37888 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37889 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37890
37891 @item qXfer:sdata:read
37892 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37893 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37894
37895 @item qXfer:spu:read
37896 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37897 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37898
37899 @item qXfer:spu:write
37900 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37901 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37902
37903 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
37904 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37905 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37906
37907 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
37908 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37909 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37910
37911 @item qXfer:threads:read
37912 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37913 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37914
37915 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37916 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37917 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37918
37919 @item qXfer:uib:read
37920 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37921 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37922
37923 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
37924 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37925 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37926
37927 @item QNonStop
37928 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37929 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
37930
37931 @item QCatchSyscalls
37932 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37933 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37934
37935 @item QPassSignals
37936 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37937 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37938
37939 @item QStartNoAckMode
37940 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37941 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37942
37943 @item multiprocess
37944 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37945 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37946 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37947 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37948 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37949 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37950 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37951 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37952 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37953 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37954 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37955
37956 @item qXfer:osdata:read
37957 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37958 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37959
37960 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
37961 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37962 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37963 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37964
37965 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37966 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37967 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37968
37969 @item ReverseContinue
37970 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37971 (@pxref{bc}).
37972
37973 @item ReverseStep
37974 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37975 (@pxref{bs}).
37976
37977 @item TracepointSource
37978 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37979 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37980
37981 @item QAgent
37982 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37983
37984 @item QAllow
37985 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37986
37987 @item QDisableRandomization
37988 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37989
37990 @item StaticTracepoint
37991 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37992 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37993
37994 @item InstallInTrace
37995 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37996 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37997
37998 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37999 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
38000 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
38001 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
38002
38003 @item QTBuffer:size
38004 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
38005 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
38006
38007 @item tracenz
38008 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
38009 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
38010 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
38011
38012 @item BreakpointCommands
38013 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
38014 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
38015 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
38016
38017 @item Qbtrace:off
38018 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
38019
38020 @item Qbtrace:bts
38021 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
38022
38023 @item Qbtrace:pt
38024 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
38025
38026 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
38027 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
38028
38029 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
38030 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
38031
38032 @item swbreak
38033 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
38034 breakpoints.
38035
38036 @item hwbreak
38037 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
38038 breakpoints.
38039
38040 @item fork-events
38041 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
38042
38043 @item vfork-events
38044 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
38045 and vforkdone events.
38046
38047 @item exec-events
38048 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
38049
38050 @item vContSupported
38051 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
38052 @samp{vCont?} packet.
38053
38054 @item QThreadEvents
38055 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
38056
38057 @item no-resumed
38058 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
38059
38060 @end table
38061
38062 @item qSymbol::
38063 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
38064 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
38065 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
38066 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
38067
38068 Reply:
38069 @table @samp
38070 @item OK
38071 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38072 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38073 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
38074 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
38075 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
38076 below.
38077 @end table
38078
38079 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
38080 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
38081
38082 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
38083 target has previously requested.
38084
38085 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
38086 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
38087 will be empty.
38088
38089 Reply:
38090 @table @samp
38091 @item OK
38092 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38093 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38094 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
38095 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
38096 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
38097 @end table
38098
38099 @item qTBuffer
38100 @itemx QTBuffer
38101 @itemx QTDisconnected
38102 @itemx QTDP
38103 @itemx QTDPsrc
38104 @itemx QTDV
38105 @itemx qTfP
38106 @itemx qTfV
38107 @itemx QTFrame
38108 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
38109
38110 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38111
38112 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
38113 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
38114 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
38115 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
38116 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
38117 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
38118 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
38119 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
38120 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
38121 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
38122 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
38123
38124 Reply:
38125 @table @samp
38126 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38127 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
38128 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
38129 the thread's attributes.
38130 @end table
38131
38132 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
38133 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38134 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38135 packets.)
38136
38137 @item QTNotes
38138 @itemx qTP
38139 @itemx QTSave
38140 @itemx qTsP
38141 @itemx qTsV
38142 @itemx QTStart
38143 @itemx QTStop
38144 @itemx QTEnable
38145 @itemx QTDisable
38146 @itemx QTinit
38147 @itemx QTro
38148 @itemx qTStatus
38149 @itemx qTV
38150 @itemx qTfSTM
38151 @itemx qTsSTM
38152 @itemx qTSTMat
38153 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38154
38155 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38156 @cindex read special object, remote request
38157 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
38158 @anchor{qXfer read}
38159 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
38160 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
38161 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
38162 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
38163 additional details about what data to access.
38164
38165 Reply:
38166 @table @samp
38167 @item m @var{data}
38168 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
38169 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
38170 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
38171 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
38172 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
38173 request.
38174
38175 @item l @var{data}
38176 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
38177 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
38178 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
38179
38180 @item l
38181 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
38182 There is no more data to be read.
38183
38184 @item E00
38185 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38186
38187 @item E @var{nn}
38188 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
38189 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38190
38191 @item @w{}
38192 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
38193 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
38194 @end table
38195
38196 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38197 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38198 formats, listed above.
38199
38200 @table @samp
38201 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38202 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
38203 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
38204 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
38205
38206 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38207 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38208
38209 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38210 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
38211
38212 Return a description of the current branch trace.
38213 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
38214 packet may have one of the following values:
38215
38216 @table @code
38217 @item all
38218 Returns all available branch trace.
38219
38220 @item new
38221 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
38222 the last read request.
38223
38224 @item delta
38225 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
38226 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
38227 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
38228 used to stitch traces together.
38229
38230 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
38231 @end table
38232
38233 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38234 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38235
38236 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38237 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
38238
38239 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
38240 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
38241
38242 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38243 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38244
38245 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38246 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
38247 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
38248 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
38249 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
38250 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
38251 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
38252
38253 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38254 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38255
38256 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38257 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
38258 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
38259 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
38260 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
38261
38262 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38263 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38264
38265 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38266 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
38267 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
38268 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38269 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38270
38271 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
38272 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
38273 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
38274
38275 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38276 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38277
38278 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38279 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
38280 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
38281 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
38282 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
38283 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
38284 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38285 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
38286
38287 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
38288 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
38289
38290 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38291 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38292
38293 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
38294 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
38295 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
38296 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
38297
38298 @table @code
38299 @item start=@var{address}
38300 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38301 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
38302 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
38303 chosen as the starting point.
38304
38305 @item prev=@var{address}
38306 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38307 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
38308 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
38309 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
38310 exists prior to the starting point.
38311
38312 @end table
38313
38314 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
38315 ignored.
38316
38317 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38318 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
38319 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
38320 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38321 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38322
38323 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38324 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38325
38326 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38327 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
38328
38329 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
38330 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
38331 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
38332 Action Lists}.
38333
38334 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38335 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38336 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38337
38338 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38339 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
38340 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
38341 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38342 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38343
38344 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38345 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38346 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38347
38348 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38349 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
38350 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38351 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
38352 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38353 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38354 in that context to be accessed.
38355
38356 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38357 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38358 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38359
38360 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38361 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
38362 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
38363 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38364 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38365
38366 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38367 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38368
38369 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38370 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
38371
38372 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
38373 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
38374 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38375
38376 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38377 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38378
38379 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38380 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
38381
38382 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
38383 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
38384
38385 This packet is not probed by default.
38386
38387 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38388 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
38389 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
38390 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
38391 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
38392
38393 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38394 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38395
38396 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38397 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
38398 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
38399 @xref{Operating System Information}.
38400
38401 @end table
38402
38403 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38404 @cindex write data into object, remote request
38405 @anchor{qXfer write}
38406 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
38407 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
38408 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
38409 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
38410 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
38411 to access.
38412
38413 Reply:
38414 @table @samp
38415 @item @var{nn}
38416 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
38417 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
38418
38419 @item E00
38420 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38421
38422 @item E @var{nn}
38423 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
38424 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38425
38426 @item @w{}
38427 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
38428 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
38429 @end table
38430
38431 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38432 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38433 formats, listed above.
38434
38435 @table @samp
38436 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38437 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
38438 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
38439 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38440 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
38441
38442 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38443 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38444 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38445
38446 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38447 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
38448 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38449 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
38450 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38451 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38452 in that context to be accessed.
38453
38454 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38455 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38456 @end table
38457
38458 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
38459 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
38460 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
38461 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
38462 must respond with an empty packet.
38463
38464 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
38465 @cindex query attached, remote request
38466 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
38467 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
38468 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
38469 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
38470 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
38471 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
38472 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
38473
38474 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
38475 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
38476 the @code{quit} command.
38477
38478 Reply:
38479 @table @samp
38480 @item 1
38481 The remote server attached to an existing process.
38482 @item 0
38483 The remote server created a new process.
38484 @item E @var{NN}
38485 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38486 @end table
38487
38488 @item Qbtrace:bts
38489 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
38490
38491 Reply:
38492 @table @samp
38493 @item OK
38494 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38495 @item E.errtext
38496 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38497 @end table
38498
38499 @item Qbtrace:pt
38500 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
38501
38502 Reply:
38503 @table @samp
38504 @item OK
38505 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38506 @item E.errtext
38507 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38508 @end table
38509
38510 @item Qbtrace:off
38511 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
38512
38513 Reply:
38514 @table @samp
38515 @item OK
38516 Branch tracing has been disabled.
38517 @item E.errtext
38518 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38519 @end table
38520
38521 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
38522 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38523 btrace recording method in bts format.
38524
38525 Reply:
38526 @table @samp
38527 @item OK
38528 The ring buffer size has been set.
38529 @item E.errtext
38530 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38531 @end table
38532
38533 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
38534 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38535 btrace recording method in pt format.
38536
38537 Reply:
38538 @table @samp
38539 @item OK
38540 The ring buffer size has been set.
38541 @item E.errtext
38542 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38543 @end table
38544
38545 @end table
38546
38547 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38548 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38549
38550 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
38551 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
38552 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
38553
38554 @menu
38555 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
38556 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
38557 @end menu
38558
38559 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
38560 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
38561
38562 @menu
38563 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
38564 @end menu
38565
38566 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
38567 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
38568 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
38569
38570 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38571
38572 @table @r
38573
38574 @item 2
38575 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
38576
38577 @item 3
38578 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
38579
38580 @item 4
38581 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
38582
38583 @end table
38584
38585 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
38586 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
38587
38588 @menu
38589 * MIPS Register packet Format::
38590 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
38591 @end menu
38592
38593 @node MIPS Register packet Format
38594 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
38595 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
38596
38597 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
38598 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
38599 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
38600 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
38601 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
38602 most-significant -- least-significant.
38603
38604 @table @r
38605
38606 @item MIPS32
38607 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
38608 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
38609 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
38610
38611 @item MIPS64
38612 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
38613 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
38614 as @code{MIPS32}.
38615
38616 @end table
38617
38618 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
38619 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
38620 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
38621
38622 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38623
38624 @table @r
38625
38626 @item 2
38627 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
38628
38629 @item 3
38630 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38631
38632 @item 4
38633 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
38634
38635 @item 5
38636 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38637
38638 @end table
38639
38640 @node Tracepoint Packets
38641 @section Tracepoint Packets
38642 @cindex tracepoint packets
38643 @cindex packets, tracepoint
38644
38645 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
38646 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
38647
38648 @table @samp
38649
38650 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
38651 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
38652 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
38653 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
38654 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
38655 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
38656 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
38657 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
38658 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
38659 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
38660 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
38661 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
38662 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
38663 actions.
38664
38665 Replies:
38666 @table @samp
38667 @item OK
38668 The packet was understood and carried out.
38669 @item qRelocInsn
38670 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38671 @item @w{}
38672 The packet was not recognized.
38673 @end table
38674
38675 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
38676 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
38677 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
38678 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
38679 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
38680 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
38681 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
38682
38683 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
38684 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
38685 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
38686 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
38687 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
38688 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
38689 tracepoint actions.
38690
38691 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
38692 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
38693 following forms:
38694
38695 @table @samp
38696
38697 @item R @var{mask}
38698 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
38699 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
38700 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
38701 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
38702 not fit in a 32-bit word.
38703
38704 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
38705 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
38706 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
38707 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
38708 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
38709 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
38710 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
38711
38712 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38713 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
38714 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
38715 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
38716 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
38717 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
38718 packet).
38719
38720 @end table
38721
38722 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
38723 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
38724 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
38725 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
38726 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
38727 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
38728 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
38729 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
38730
38731 Replies:
38732 @table @samp
38733 @item OK
38734 The packet was understood and carried out.
38735 @item qRelocInsn
38736 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38737 @item @w{}
38738 The packet was not recognized.
38739 @end table
38740
38741 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
38742 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
38743 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
38744 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
38745 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
38746 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
38747 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
38748 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
38749
38750 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
38751 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
38752 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
38753 fit in a single packet.
38754 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
38755 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
38756
38757 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
38758 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
38759 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
38760 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
38761
38762 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
38763 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
38764 query packets.
38765
38766 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
38767 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
38768 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
38769 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
38770 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
38771 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
38772 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
38773 be found.
38774
38775 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
38776 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
38777 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
38778 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
38779 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
38780 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
38781 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
38782 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
38783 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
38784 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
38785 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
38786 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
38787 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
38788 variable.
38789
38790 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
38791 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
38792 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
38793 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
38794 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
38795
38796 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
38797 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
38798 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
38799 one of the following forms:
38800
38801 @table @samp
38802 @item F @var{f}
38803 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
38804 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
38805 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
38806
38807 @item T @var{t}
38808 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
38809 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
38810
38811 @end table
38812
38813 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
38814 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38815 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
38816 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
38817
38818 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
38819 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38820 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
38821 is a hexadecimal number.
38822
38823 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
38824 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38825 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
38826 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
38827 numbers.
38828
38829 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
38830 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
38831 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
38832
38833 @item qTMinFTPILen
38834 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
38835 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
38836 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
38837 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
38838 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
38839 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
38840 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
38841 arrange for that.
38842
38843 Replies:
38844
38845 @table @samp
38846 @item 0
38847 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
38848 @item @var{length}
38849 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
38850 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
38851 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
38852 regardless of size.
38853 @item E
38854 An error has occurred.
38855 @item @w{}
38856 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38857 @end table
38858
38859 @item QTStart
38860 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38861 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
38862 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
38863 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38864 instruction reply packet}).
38865
38866 @item QTStop
38867 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38868 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
38869
38870 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38871 @anchor{QTEnable}
38872 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38873 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38874 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38875 of data from it will resume.
38876
38877 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38878 @anchor{QTDisable}
38879 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38880 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38881 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38882 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38883
38884 @item QTinit
38885 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38886 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38887
38888 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38889 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38890 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
38891 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38892 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38893
38894 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38895 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
38896 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38897 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38898
38899 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38900 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38901 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38902 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38903 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38904 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38905
38906 @item qTStatus
38907 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38908 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38909
38910 The reply has the form:
38911
38912 @table @samp
38913
38914 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38915 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38916 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
38917 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38918
38919 @end table
38920
38921 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38922 explanations as one of the optional fields:
38923
38924 @table @samp
38925
38926 @item tnotrun:0
38927 No trace has been run yet.
38928
38929 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38930 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
38931 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38932 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38933 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
38934
38935 @item tfull:0
38936 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38937
38938 @item tdisconnected:0
38939 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38940
38941 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38942 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38943
38944 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38945 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
38946 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38947 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38948 is hex encoded.
38949
38950 @item tunknown:0
38951 The trace stopped for some other reason.
38952
38953 @end table
38954
38955 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38956 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38957 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38958 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38959 trace.
38960
38961 @table @samp
38962
38963 @item tframes:@var{n}
38964 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38965
38966 @item tcreated:@var{n}
38967 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38968 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38969
38970 @item tsize:@var{n}
38971 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38972
38973 @item tfree:@var{n}
38974 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38975
38976 @item circular:@var{n}
38977 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38978 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38979 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38980 and may fill up.
38981
38982 @item disconn:@var{n}
38983 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38984 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38985 that the trace run will stop.
38986
38987 @end table
38988
38989 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38990 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38991 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38992 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38993 address @var{addr}.
38994
38995 Replies:
38996 @table @samp
38997 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38998 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38999 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
39000 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
39001 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
39002
39003 @end table
39004
39005 @item qTV:@var{var}
39006 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
39007 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
39008 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
39009
39010 Replies:
39011 @table @samp
39012 @item V@var{value}
39013 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
39014 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
39015 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
39016 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
39017 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
39018 program is running.
39019
39020 @item U
39021 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
39022 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
39023 was not collected.
39024 @end table
39025
39026 @item qTfP
39027 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
39028 @itemx qTsP
39029 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
39030 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
39031 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
39032 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
39033 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
39034 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
39035
39036 @item qTfV
39037 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
39038 @itemx qTsV
39039 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
39040 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
39041 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
39042 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
39043 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
39044 trace state variables.
39045
39046 @item qTfSTM
39047 @itemx qTsSTM
39048 @anchor{qTfSTM}
39049 @anchor{qTsSTM}
39050 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
39051 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
39052 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
39053 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
39054 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
39055 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
39056
39057 Reply:
39058 @table @samp
39059 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
39060 A single marker
39061 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
39062 a comma-separated list of markers
39063 @item l
39064 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
39065 @item E @var{nn}
39066 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39067 @item @w{}
39068 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
39069 stub.
39070 @end table
39071
39072 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
39073 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
39074
39075 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
39076 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
39077 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
39078 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
39079 @dfn{last}).
39080
39081 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
39082 @anchor{qTSTMat}
39083 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
39084 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
39085 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
39086 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
39087 tracepoint markers.
39088
39089 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
39090 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
39091 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
39092 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
39093 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
39094 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
39095
39096 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
39097 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
39098 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
39099 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
39100 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
39101 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
39102 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
39103 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
39104 available.
39105
39106 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
39107 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
39108 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
39109
39110 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
39111 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
39112 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
39113 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
39114 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
39115 use whatever size it prefers.
39116
39117 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
39118 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
39119 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
39120 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
39121 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
39122
39123 @end table
39124
39125 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
39126 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
39127 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
39128 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
39129 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
39130 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
39131 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
39132 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
39133 it had executed in the original location.
39134
39135 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
39136 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
39137 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
39138 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
39139 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
39140 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
39141 format of the request is:
39142
39143 @table @samp
39144 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
39145
39146 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
39147 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
39148 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
39149 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
39150 memory starting at @var{to}.
39151 @end table
39152
39153 Replies:
39154 @table @samp
39155 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
39156 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
39157 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
39158 @item E @var{NN}
39159 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
39160 relocating the instruction.
39161 @end table
39162
39163 @node Host I/O Packets
39164 @section Host I/O Packets
39165 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
39166 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
39167
39168 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
39169 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
39170 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
39171 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
39172 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
39173 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
39174 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
39175 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
39176 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
39177 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
39178
39179 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
39180 its arguments. They have this format:
39181
39182 @table @samp
39183
39184 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
39185 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
39186 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
39187 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
39188 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
39189 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
39190 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
39191 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
39192 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
39193
39194 @end table
39195
39196 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
39197
39198 @table @samp
39199
39200 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
39201 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
39202 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
39203 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
39204 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
39205 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
39206 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
39207 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
39208 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
39209 @var{attachment}.
39210
39211 @item @w{}
39212 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
39213
39214 @end table
39215
39216 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
39217
39218 @table @samp
39219 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
39220 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
39221 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
39222 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
39223 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
39224 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
39225 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
39226
39227 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
39228 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
39229 -1 if an error occurs.
39230
39231 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
39232 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
39233 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
39234 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
39235 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
39236 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
39237 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
39238 @var{count} was zero.
39239
39240 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39241 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39242 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39243 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39244 some characters were escaped.
39245
39246 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
39247 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
39248 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
39249 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
39250 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
39251 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
39252 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
39253 error occurred.
39254
39255 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
39256 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
39257 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
39258 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
39259 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
39260 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
39261
39262 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
39263 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
39264 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
39265
39266 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
39267 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
39268 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
39269
39270 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39271 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39272 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39273 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39274 some characters were escaped.
39275
39276 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
39277 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
39278 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
39279 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
39280 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
39281 inferior(s).
39282
39283 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
39284 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
39285 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
39286 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
39287 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
39288 operation.
39289
39290 @end table
39291
39292 @node Interrupts
39293 @section Interrupts
39294 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
39295 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
39296
39297 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
39298 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
39299 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
39300 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
39301
39302 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
39303 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
39304 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
39305 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
39306 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
39307
39308 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
39309 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
39310 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
39311 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
39312 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
39313 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
39314 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
39315 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
39316
39317 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
39318 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
39319 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
39320
39321 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
39322 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
39323 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
39324 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
39325 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
39326 @code{0x03}.
39327
39328 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
39329 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
39330 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
39331 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
39332 currently-executing threads and processes.
39333 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
39334 running program, it should send one of the stop
39335 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
39336 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
39337 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
39338 Interrupts received while the
39339 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
39340 it is resumed next time.
39341
39342 @node Notification Packets
39343 @section Notification Packets
39344 @cindex notification packets
39345 @cindex packets, notification
39346
39347 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
39348 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
39349 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
39350 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
39351 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
39352 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
39353 is not a problem.
39354
39355 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
39356 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
39357 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
39358 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
39359 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
39360 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
39361 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
39362
39363 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
39364 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
39365
39366 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
39367 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
39368 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
39369 not they understand it.
39370
39371 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
39372 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
39373 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
39374 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
39375 recipients.
39376
39377 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
39378 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
39379 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
39380 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
39381 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
39382
39383 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
39384 @table @samp
39385 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
39386 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
39387 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
39388 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
39389 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
39390 @item @var{ack}
39391 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
39392 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
39393 @end table
39394
39395 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
39396 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
39397
39398 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
39399 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
39400 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
39401 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
39402 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
39403 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
39404 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
39405 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
39406 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
39407 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
39408
39409 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
39410 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
39411 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
39412 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
39413 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
39414 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
39415
39416 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
39417 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
39418 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
39419 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
39420 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
39421
39422 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
39423 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
39424 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
39425 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
39426 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
39427 normally.
39428
39429 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
39430 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
39431 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
39432 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
39433 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
39434 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
39435 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
39436 the process shall be repeated.
39437
39438 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
39439 following example:
39440 @smallexample
39441 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
39442 @code{...}
39443 -> @code{vStopped}
39444 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
39445 -> @code{vStopped}
39446 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
39447 -> @code{vStopped}
39448 <- @code{OK}
39449 @end smallexample
39450
39451 The following notifications are defined:
39452 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
39453
39454 @item Notification
39455 @tab Ack
39456 @tab Event
39457 @tab Description
39458
39459 @item Stop
39460 @tab vStopped
39461 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
39462 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
39463 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
39464 @value{GDBN}.
39465 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
39466
39467 @end multitable
39468
39469 @node Remote Non-Stop
39470 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
39471
39472 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
39473 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
39474 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
39475 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39476
39477 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
39478 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
39479 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
39480 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
39481 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
39482 probe the target state after a mode change.
39483
39484 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
39485 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
39486 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
39487 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
39488 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
39489 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
39490 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
39491 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
39492 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
39493 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
39494 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
39495
39496 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
39497 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
39498 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
39499 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
39500 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
39501 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
39502 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
39503 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
39504 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
39505 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
39506 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
39507 @samp{OK}.
39508
39509 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
39510 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
39511 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
39512 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
39513 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
39514 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
39515 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
39516 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
39517 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
39518 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
39519 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
39520 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
39521 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
39522
39523 @node Packet Acknowledgment
39524 @section Packet Acknowledgment
39525
39526 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39527 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39528 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
39529 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
39530 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
39531 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
39532 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
39533
39534 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
39535 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
39536 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
39537 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
39538 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
39539
39540 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
39541 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
39542 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
39543 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
39544
39545 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
39546 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
39547 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
39548 @pxref{qSupported}.
39549 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
39550 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
39551 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
39552 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
39553 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
39554 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
39555 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
39556
39557 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
39558 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
39559 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
39560 connection.
39561 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
39562 new connection is established,
39563 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
39564 for the current connection, once disabled.
39565
39566 @node Examples
39567 @section Examples
39568
39569 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
39570 does not get any direct output:
39571
39572 @smallexample
39573 -> @code{R00}
39574 <- @code{+}
39575 @emph{target restarts}
39576 -> @code{?}
39577 <- @code{+}
39578 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39579 -> @code{+}
39580 @end smallexample
39581
39582 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
39583
39584 @smallexample
39585 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
39586 <- @code{+}
39587 -> @code{s}
39588 <- @code{+}
39589 @emph{time passes}
39590 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39591 -> @code{+}
39592 -> @code{g}
39593 <- @code{+}
39594 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
39595 -> @code{+}
39596 @end smallexample
39597
39598 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39599 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39600 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
39601
39602 @menu
39603 * File-I/O Overview::
39604 * Protocol Basics::
39605 * The F Request Packet::
39606 * The F Reply Packet::
39607 * The Ctrl-C Message::
39608 * Console I/O::
39609 * List of Supported Calls::
39610 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
39611 * Constants::
39612 * File-I/O Examples::
39613 @end menu
39614
39615 @node File-I/O Overview
39616 @subsection File-I/O Overview
39617 @cindex file-i/o overview
39618
39619 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
39620 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
39621 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
39622 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
39623 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
39624 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
39625
39626 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
39627 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
39628 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
39629 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
39630 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
39631
39632 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
39633 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
39634 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
39635 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
39636 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
39637 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
39638 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
39639
39640 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
39641 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
39642 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
39643 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
39644 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
39645
39646 @smallexample
39647 (@value{GDBP}) continue
39648 <- target requests 'system call X'
39649 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
39650 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
39651 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
39652 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
39653 @end smallexample
39654
39655 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
39656 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
39657 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
39658 system are not supported by this protocol.
39659
39660 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
39661
39662 @node Protocol Basics
39663 @subsection Protocol Basics
39664 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
39665
39666 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
39667 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
39668 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
39669 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
39670 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
39671 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
39672 to call the appropriate host system call:
39673
39674 @itemize @bullet
39675 @item
39676 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
39677
39678 @item
39679 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
39680 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
39681 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
39682 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
39683
39684 @end itemize
39685
39686 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
39687
39688 @itemize @bullet
39689 @item
39690 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
39691 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
39692 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
39693 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
39694 packet.
39695
39696 @item
39697 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
39698 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
39699
39700 @item
39701 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
39702
39703 @item
39704 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
39705
39706 @item
39707 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
39708 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
39709 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
39710 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
39711 packet.
39712
39713 @end itemize
39714
39715 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
39716 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
39717
39718 @itemize @bullet
39719 @item
39720 Return value.
39721
39722 @item
39723 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
39724
39725 @item
39726 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
39727
39728 @end itemize
39729
39730 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
39731 the latest continue or step action.
39732
39733 @node The F Request Packet
39734 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
39735 @cindex file-i/o request packet
39736 @cindex @code{F} request packet
39737
39738 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
39739
39740 @table @samp
39741 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
39742
39743 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
39744 This is just the name of the function.
39745
39746 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
39747 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
39748 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
39749 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
39750 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
39751 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
39752 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
39753
39754 @end table
39755
39756
39757
39758 @node The F Reply Packet
39759 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
39760 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
39761 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
39762
39763 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
39764
39765 @table @samp
39766
39767 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
39768
39769 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
39770
39771 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
39772 representation.
39773 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
39774
39775 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
39776 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
39777 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
39778
39779 @smallexample
39780 F0,0,C
39781 @end smallexample
39782
39783 @noindent
39784 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
39785
39786 @smallexample
39787 F-1,4,C
39788 @end smallexample
39789
39790 @noindent
39791 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
39792
39793 @end table
39794
39795
39796 @node The Ctrl-C Message
39797 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
39798 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
39799
39800 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
39801 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
39802 the target should behave as if it had
39803 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
39804 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
39805 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
39806 packet.
39807
39808 It's important for the target to know in which
39809 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
39810
39811 @itemize @bullet
39812 @item
39813 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
39814
39815 @item
39816 The system call on the host has been finished.
39817
39818 @end itemize
39819
39820 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
39821 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
39822 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
39823 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
39824 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
39825 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
39826
39827 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
39828 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
39829 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
39830 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
39831 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
39832 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
39833 or the full action has been completed.
39834
39835 @node Console I/O
39836 @subsection Console I/O
39837 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
39838
39839 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
39840 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
39841 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
39842 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
39843 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
39844 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
39845 conditions is met:
39846
39847 @itemize @bullet
39848 @item
39849 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
39850 @code{read}
39851 system call is treated as finished.
39852
39853 @item
39854 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
39855 newline.
39856
39857 @item
39858 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
39859 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39860
39861 @end itemize
39862
39863 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39864 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39865 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39866 is stopped at the user's request.
39867
39868
39869 @node List of Supported Calls
39870 @subsection List of Supported Calls
39871 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39872
39873 @menu
39874 * open::
39875 * close::
39876 * read::
39877 * write::
39878 * lseek::
39879 * rename::
39880 * unlink::
39881 * stat/fstat::
39882 * gettimeofday::
39883 * isatty::
39884 * system::
39885 @end menu
39886
39887 @node open
39888 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
39889 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
39890
39891 @table @asis
39892 @item Synopsis:
39893 @smallexample
39894 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39895 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39896 @end smallexample
39897
39898 @item Request:
39899 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39900
39901 @noindent
39902 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39903
39904 @table @code
39905 @item O_CREAT
39906 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
39907 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39908 are concerned.
39909
39910 @item O_EXCL
39911 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39912 an error and open() fails.
39913
39914 @item O_TRUNC
39915 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39916 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39917 truncated to zero length.
39918
39919 @item O_APPEND
39920 The file is opened in append mode.
39921
39922 @item O_RDONLY
39923 The file is opened for reading only.
39924
39925 @item O_WRONLY
39926 The file is opened for writing only.
39927
39928 @item O_RDWR
39929 The file is opened for reading and writing.
39930 @end table
39931
39932 @noindent
39933 Other bits are silently ignored.
39934
39935
39936 @noindent
39937 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39938
39939 @table @code
39940 @item S_IRUSR
39941 User has read permission.
39942
39943 @item S_IWUSR
39944 User has write permission.
39945
39946 @item S_IRGRP
39947 Group has read permission.
39948
39949 @item S_IWGRP
39950 Group has write permission.
39951
39952 @item S_IROTH
39953 Others have read permission.
39954
39955 @item S_IWOTH
39956 Others have write permission.
39957 @end table
39958
39959 @noindent
39960 Other bits are silently ignored.
39961
39962
39963 @item Return value:
39964 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39965 occurred.
39966
39967 @item Errors:
39968
39969 @table @code
39970 @item EEXIST
39971 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39972
39973 @item EISDIR
39974 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39975
39976 @item EACCES
39977 The requested access is not allowed.
39978
39979 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39980 @var{pathname} was too long.
39981
39982 @item ENOENT
39983 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39984
39985 @item ENODEV
39986 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39987
39988 @item EROFS
39989 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39990 write access was requested.
39991
39992 @item EFAULT
39993 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39994
39995 @item ENOSPC
39996 No space on device to create the file.
39997
39998 @item EMFILE
39999 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
40000
40001 @item ENFILE
40002 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
40003 has been reached.
40004
40005 @item EINTR
40006 The call was interrupted by the user.
40007 @end table
40008
40009 @end table
40010
40011 @node close
40012 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
40013 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
40014
40015 @table @asis
40016 @item Synopsis:
40017 @smallexample
40018 int close(int fd);
40019 @end smallexample
40020
40021 @item Request:
40022 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
40023
40024 @item Return value:
40025 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
40026
40027 @item Errors:
40028
40029 @table @code
40030 @item EBADF
40031 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
40032
40033 @item EINTR
40034 The call was interrupted by the user.
40035 @end table
40036
40037 @end table
40038
40039 @node read
40040 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
40041 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
40042
40043 @table @asis
40044 @item Synopsis:
40045 @smallexample
40046 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
40047 @end smallexample
40048
40049 @item Request:
40050 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40051
40052 @item Return value:
40053 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
40054 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
40055 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
40056
40057 @item Errors:
40058
40059 @table @code
40060 @item EBADF
40061 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40062 reading.
40063
40064 @item EFAULT
40065 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40066
40067 @item EINTR
40068 The call was interrupted by the user.
40069 @end table
40070
40071 @end table
40072
40073 @node write
40074 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
40075 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
40076
40077 @table @asis
40078 @item Synopsis:
40079 @smallexample
40080 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
40081 @end smallexample
40082
40083 @item Request:
40084 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40085
40086 @item Return value:
40087 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
40088 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
40089 is returned.
40090
40091 @item Errors:
40092
40093 @table @code
40094 @item EBADF
40095 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40096 writing.
40097
40098 @item EFAULT
40099 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40100
40101 @item EFBIG
40102 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
40103 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
40104
40105 @item ENOSPC
40106 No space on device to write the data.
40107
40108 @item EINTR
40109 The call was interrupted by the user.
40110 @end table
40111
40112 @end table
40113
40114 @node lseek
40115 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
40116 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
40117
40118 @table @asis
40119 @item Synopsis:
40120 @smallexample
40121 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
40122 @end smallexample
40123
40124 @item Request:
40125 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
40126
40127 @var{flag} is one of:
40128
40129 @table @code
40130 @item SEEK_SET
40131 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
40132
40133 @item SEEK_CUR
40134 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
40135 bytes.
40136
40137 @item SEEK_END
40138 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
40139 bytes.
40140 @end table
40141
40142 @item Return value:
40143 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
40144 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
40145 value of -1 is returned.
40146
40147 @item Errors:
40148
40149 @table @code
40150 @item EBADF
40151 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
40152
40153 @item ESPIPE
40154 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
40155
40156 @item EINVAL
40157 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
40158
40159 @item EINTR
40160 The call was interrupted by the user.
40161 @end table
40162
40163 @end table
40164
40165 @node rename
40166 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
40167 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
40168
40169 @table @asis
40170 @item Synopsis:
40171 @smallexample
40172 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
40173 @end smallexample
40174
40175 @item Request:
40176 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
40177
40178 @item Return value:
40179 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40180
40181 @item Errors:
40182
40183 @table @code
40184 @item EISDIR
40185 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
40186 directory.
40187
40188 @item EEXIST
40189 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
40190
40191 @item EBUSY
40192 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
40193 process.
40194
40195 @item EINVAL
40196 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
40197 of itself.
40198
40199 @item ENOTDIR
40200 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
40201 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
40202 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
40203
40204 @item EFAULT
40205 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
40206
40207 @item EACCES
40208 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40209
40210 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40211
40212 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
40213
40214 @item ENOENT
40215 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
40216
40217 @item EROFS
40218 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40219
40220 @item ENOSPC
40221 The device containing the file has no room for the new
40222 directory entry.
40223
40224 @item EINTR
40225 The call was interrupted by the user.
40226 @end table
40227
40228 @end table
40229
40230 @node unlink
40231 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
40232 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
40233
40234 @table @asis
40235 @item Synopsis:
40236 @smallexample
40237 int unlink(const char *pathname);
40238 @end smallexample
40239
40240 @item Request:
40241 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
40242
40243 @item Return value:
40244 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40245
40246 @item Errors:
40247
40248 @table @code
40249 @item EACCES
40250 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40251
40252 @item EPERM
40253 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
40254
40255 @item EBUSY
40256 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
40257 being used by another process.
40258
40259 @item EFAULT
40260 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40261
40262 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40263 @var{pathname} was too long.
40264
40265 @item ENOENT
40266 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40267
40268 @item ENOTDIR
40269 A component of the path is not a directory.
40270
40271 @item EROFS
40272 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40273
40274 @item EINTR
40275 The call was interrupted by the user.
40276 @end table
40277
40278 @end table
40279
40280 @node stat/fstat
40281 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
40282 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
40283 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
40284
40285 @table @asis
40286 @item Synopsis:
40287 @smallexample
40288 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
40289 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
40290 @end smallexample
40291
40292 @item Request:
40293 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
40294 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
40295
40296 @item Return value:
40297 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40298
40299 @item Errors:
40300
40301 @table @code
40302 @item EBADF
40303 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
40304
40305 @item ENOENT
40306 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
40307 path is an empty string.
40308
40309 @item ENOTDIR
40310 A component of the path is not a directory.
40311
40312 @item EFAULT
40313 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40314
40315 @item EACCES
40316 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40317
40318 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40319 @var{pathname} was too long.
40320
40321 @item EINTR
40322 The call was interrupted by the user.
40323 @end table
40324
40325 @end table
40326
40327 @node gettimeofday
40328 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
40329 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
40330
40331 @table @asis
40332 @item Synopsis:
40333 @smallexample
40334 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
40335 @end smallexample
40336
40337 @item Request:
40338 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
40339
40340 @item Return value:
40341 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
40342
40343 @item Errors:
40344
40345 @table @code
40346 @item EINVAL
40347 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
40348
40349 @item EFAULT
40350 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40351 @end table
40352
40353 @end table
40354
40355 @node isatty
40356 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
40357 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
40358
40359 @table @asis
40360 @item Synopsis:
40361 @smallexample
40362 int isatty(int fd);
40363 @end smallexample
40364
40365 @item Request:
40366 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
40367
40368 @item Return value:
40369 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
40370
40371 @item Errors:
40372
40373 @table @code
40374 @item EINTR
40375 The call was interrupted by the user.
40376 @end table
40377
40378 @end table
40379
40380 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
40381 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
40382 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
40383 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
40384 needed.
40385
40386
40387 @node system
40388 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
40389 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
40390
40391 @table @asis
40392 @item Synopsis:
40393 @smallexample
40394 int system(const char *command);
40395 @end smallexample
40396
40397 @item Request:
40398 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
40399
40400 @item Return value:
40401 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
40402 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
40403 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
40404 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
40405 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
40406 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
40407 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
40408
40409 @item Errors:
40410
40411 @table @code
40412 @item EINTR
40413 The call was interrupted by the user.
40414 @end table
40415
40416 @end table
40417
40418 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
40419 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
40420 the host is simplified before it's returned
40421 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
40422 is discarded, and the return value consists
40423 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
40424
40425 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
40426 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
40427 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
40428
40429 @table @code
40430 @item set remote system-call-allowed
40431 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
40432 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
40433 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
40434
40435 @item show remote system-call-allowed
40436 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
40437 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
40438 protocol.
40439 @end table
40440
40441 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40442 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40443 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40444
40445 @menu
40446 * Integral Datatypes::
40447 * Pointer Values::
40448 * Memory Transfer::
40449 * struct stat::
40450 * struct timeval::
40451 @end menu
40452
40453 @node Integral Datatypes
40454 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
40455 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40456
40457 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
40458 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
40459 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
40460
40461 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
40462 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
40463
40464 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
40465
40466 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
40467 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
40468
40469 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
40470
40471 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
40472 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
40473 byte order.
40474
40475 @node Pointer Values
40476 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
40477 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
40478
40479 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
40480 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
40481 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
40482 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
40483
40484 @smallexample
40485 @code{1aaf/12}
40486 @end smallexample
40487
40488 @noindent
40489 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
40490 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
40491 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
40492 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
40493
40494 @smallexample
40495 @code{123456/d}
40496 @end smallexample
40497
40498 @node Memory Transfer
40499 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
40500 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
40501
40502 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
40503 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
40504 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
40505 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
40506 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
40507 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
40508 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
40509
40510
40511 @node struct stat
40512 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
40513 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
40514
40515 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
40516 is defined as follows:
40517
40518 @smallexample
40519 struct stat @{
40520 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
40521 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
40522 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
40523 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
40524 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
40525 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
40526 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
40527 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
40528 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
40529 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
40530 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
40531 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
40532 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
40533 @};
40534 @end smallexample
40535
40536 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40537 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40538 structure is of size 64 bytes.
40539
40540 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
40541 range of values.
40542
40543 @table @code
40544
40545 @item st_dev
40546 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
40547
40548 @item st_ino
40549 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40550
40551 @item st_mode
40552 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
40553 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
40554
40555 @item st_uid
40556 @itemx st_gid
40557 @itemx st_rdev
40558 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40559
40560 @item st_atime
40561 @itemx st_mtime
40562 @itemx st_ctime
40563 These values have a host and file system dependent
40564 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
40565 support exact timing values.
40566 @end table
40567
40568 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
40569 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
40570 continuing.
40571
40572 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
40573 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
40574 get truncated on the target.
40575
40576 @node struct timeval
40577 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
40578 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
40579
40580 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
40581 is defined as follows:
40582
40583 @smallexample
40584 struct timeval @{
40585 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
40586 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
40587 @};
40588 @end smallexample
40589
40590 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40591 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40592 structure is of size 8 bytes.
40593
40594 @node Constants
40595 @subsection Constants
40596 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
40597
40598 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
40599 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
40600 values before and after the call as needed.
40601
40602 @menu
40603 * Open Flags::
40604 * mode_t Values::
40605 * Errno Values::
40606 * Lseek Flags::
40607 * Limits::
40608 @end menu
40609
40610 @node Open Flags
40611 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
40612 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
40613
40614 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
40615
40616 @smallexample
40617 O_RDONLY 0x0
40618 O_WRONLY 0x1
40619 O_RDWR 0x2
40620 O_APPEND 0x8
40621 O_CREAT 0x200
40622 O_TRUNC 0x400
40623 O_EXCL 0x800
40624 @end smallexample
40625
40626 @node mode_t Values
40627 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
40628 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
40629
40630 All values are given in octal representation.
40631
40632 @smallexample
40633 S_IFREG 0100000
40634 S_IFDIR 040000
40635 S_IRUSR 0400
40636 S_IWUSR 0200
40637 S_IXUSR 0100
40638 S_IRGRP 040
40639 S_IWGRP 020
40640 S_IXGRP 010
40641 S_IROTH 04
40642 S_IWOTH 02
40643 S_IXOTH 01
40644 @end smallexample
40645
40646 @node Errno Values
40647 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
40648 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
40649
40650 All values are given in decimal representation.
40651
40652 @smallexample
40653 EPERM 1
40654 ENOENT 2
40655 EINTR 4
40656 EBADF 9
40657 EACCES 13
40658 EFAULT 14
40659 EBUSY 16
40660 EEXIST 17
40661 ENODEV 19
40662 ENOTDIR 20
40663 EISDIR 21
40664 EINVAL 22
40665 ENFILE 23
40666 EMFILE 24
40667 EFBIG 27
40668 ENOSPC 28
40669 ESPIPE 29
40670 EROFS 30
40671 ENAMETOOLONG 91
40672 EUNKNOWN 9999
40673 @end smallexample
40674
40675 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
40676 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
40677
40678 @node Lseek Flags
40679 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
40680 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
40681
40682 @smallexample
40683 SEEK_SET 0
40684 SEEK_CUR 1
40685 SEEK_END 2
40686 @end smallexample
40687
40688 @node Limits
40689 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
40690 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
40691
40692 All values are given in decimal representation.
40693
40694 @smallexample
40695 INT_MIN -2147483648
40696 INT_MAX 2147483647
40697 UINT_MAX 4294967295
40698 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
40699 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
40700 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
40701 @end smallexample
40702
40703 @node File-I/O Examples
40704 @subsection File-I/O Examples
40705 @cindex file-i/o examples
40706
40707 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40708 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
40709
40710 @smallexample
40711 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
40712 @emph{request memory read from target}
40713 -> @code{m1234,6}
40714 <- XXXXXX
40715 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
40716 -> @code{F6}
40717 @end smallexample
40718
40719 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40720 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
40721
40722 @smallexample
40723 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40724 @emph{request memory write to target}
40725 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40726 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
40727 -> @code{F6}
40728 @end smallexample
40729
40730 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
40731 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
40732
40733 @smallexample
40734 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40735 -> @code{F-1,9}
40736 @end smallexample
40737
40738 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
40739 host is called:
40740
40741 @smallexample
40742 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40743 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
40744 <- @code{T02}
40745 @end smallexample
40746
40747 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
40748 host is called:
40749
40750 @smallexample
40751 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40752 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40753 <- @code{T02}
40754 @end smallexample
40755
40756 @node Library List Format
40757 @section Library List Format
40758 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40759
40760 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
40761 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
40762 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
40763 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
40764 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
40765 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
40766 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40767 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
40768 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
40769 are loaded.
40770
40771 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
40772 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
40773 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
40774 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
40775
40776 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
40777 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
40778 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
40779 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
40780 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
40781 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
40782
40783 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40784 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40785
40786 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
40787 offset, looks like this:
40788
40789 @smallexample
40790 <library-list>
40791 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
40792 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
40793 </library>
40794 </library-list>
40795 @end smallexample
40796
40797 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
40798 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
40799
40800 @smallexample
40801 <library-list>
40802 <library name="sharedlib.o">
40803 <section address="0x10000000"/>
40804 <section address="0x20000000"/>
40805 <section address="0x30000000"/>
40806 </library>
40807 </library-list>
40808 @end smallexample
40809
40810 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
40811
40812 @smallexample
40813 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
40814 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
40815 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40816 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
40817 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40818 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
40819 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40820 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
40821 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40822 @end smallexample
40823
40824 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
40825 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
40826 section for each library.
40827
40828 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40829 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40830 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40831
40832 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
40833 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
40834 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
40835 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
40836
40837 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
40838 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
40839 target, the following parameters are reported:
40840
40841 @itemize @minus
40842 @item
40843 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
40844 @code{struct link_map}.
40845 @item
40846 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
40847 (Thread Local Storage) access.
40848 @item
40849 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
40850 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
40851 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
40852 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
40853 @item
40854 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
40855 @end itemize
40856
40857 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40858 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
40859 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40860
40861 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40862 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40863
40864 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40865 looks like this:
40866
40867 @smallexample
40868 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40869 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40870 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40871 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40872 l_ld="0x152350"/>
40873 </library-list-svr>
40874 @end smallexample
40875
40876 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40877
40878 @smallexample
40879 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40880 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
40881 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40882 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
40883 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
40884 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40885 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
40886 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
40887 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
40888 @end smallexample
40889
40890 @node Memory Map Format
40891 @section Memory Map Format
40892 @cindex memory map format
40893
40894 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40895 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
40896 memory map.
40897
40898 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40899 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40900 lists memory regions.
40901
40902 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40903 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
40904
40905 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40906
40907 @smallexample
40908 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40909 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
40910 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40911 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40912 <memory-map>
40913 region...
40914 </memory-map>
40915 @end smallexample
40916
40917 Each region can be either:
40918
40919 @itemize
40920
40921 @item
40922 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40923 bytes from there:
40924
40925 @smallexample
40926 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40927 @end smallexample
40928
40929
40930 @item
40931 A region of read-only memory:
40932
40933 @smallexample
40934 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40935 @end smallexample
40936
40937
40938 @item
40939 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40940 bytes in length:
40941
40942 @smallexample
40943 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40944 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40945 </memory>
40946 @end smallexample
40947
40948 @end itemize
40949
40950 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40951 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40952 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40953
40954 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40955
40956 @smallexample
40957 <!-- ................................................... -->
40958 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40959 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40960 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
40961 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40962 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40963 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
40964 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40965 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
40966 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40967 and its type, or device. -->
40968 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
40969 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40970 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40971 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40972 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40973 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
40974 @end smallexample
40975
40976 @node Thread List Format
40977 @section Thread List Format
40978 @cindex thread list format
40979
40980 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40981 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40982 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40983 the following structure:
40984
40985 @smallexample
40986 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40987 <threads>
40988 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40989 ... description ...
40990 </thread>
40991 </threads>
40992 @end smallexample
40993
40994 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40995 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40996 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40997 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40998 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40999 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
41000 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
41001 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
41002
41003
41004 @node Traceframe Info Format
41005 @section Traceframe Info Format
41006 @cindex traceframe info format
41007
41008 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
41009 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
41010 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
41011 collected in a traceframe.
41012
41013 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
41014 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
41015
41016 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41017 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41018
41019 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41020
41021 @smallexample
41022 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41023 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
41024 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41025 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
41026 <traceframe-info>
41027 block...
41028 </traceframe-info>
41029 @end smallexample
41030
41031 Each traceframe block can be either:
41032
41033 @itemize
41034
41035 @item
41036 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
41037 @var{length} bytes from there:
41038
41039 @smallexample
41040 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41041 @end smallexample
41042
41043 @item
41044 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
41045 collected:
41046
41047 @smallexample
41048 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
41049 @end smallexample
41050
41051 @end itemize
41052
41053 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
41054
41055 @smallexample
41056 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
41057 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41058
41059 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
41060 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
41061 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
41062 <!ELEMENT tvar>
41063 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
41064 @end smallexample
41065
41066 @node Branch Trace Format
41067 @section Branch Trace Format
41068 @cindex branch trace format
41069
41070 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
41071 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
41072 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
41073 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
41074
41075 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
41076 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
41077
41078 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41079 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41080
41081 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41082
41083 @smallexample
41084 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41085 <!DOCTYPE btrace
41086 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
41087 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
41088 <btrace>
41089 block...
41090 </btrace>
41091 @end smallexample
41092
41093 @itemize
41094
41095 @item
41096 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
41097 and ending at @var{end}:
41098
41099 @smallexample
41100 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
41101 @end smallexample
41102
41103 @end itemize
41104
41105 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
41106
41107 @smallexample
41108 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
41109 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41110
41111 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
41112 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
41113 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
41114
41115 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
41116
41117 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
41118
41119 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
41120 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
41121 family CDATA #REQUIRED
41122 model CDATA #REQUIRED
41123 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
41124
41125 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
41126 @end smallexample
41127
41128 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
41129 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
41130 @cindex branch trace configuration format
41131
41132 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
41133 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
41134 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
41135
41136 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
41137 settings for that format. The following information is described:
41138
41139 @table @code
41140 @item bts
41141 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
41142 @table @code
41143 @item size
41144 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
41145 @end table
41146 @item pt
41147 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
41148 PT}) format.
41149 @table @code
41150 @item size
41151 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
41152 @end table
41153 @end table
41154
41155 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41156 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41157
41158 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
41159
41160 @smallexample
41161 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
41162 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41163
41164 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
41165 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41166
41167 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
41168 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41169 @end smallexample
41170
41171 @include agentexpr.texi
41172
41173 @node Target Descriptions
41174 @appendix Target Descriptions
41175 @cindex target descriptions
41176
41177 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
41178 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
41179 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
41180 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
41181 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
41182 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
41183 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
41184
41185 @itemize @bullet
41186 @item
41187 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
41188 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
41189 @item
41190 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
41191 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
41192 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
41193 @item
41194 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
41195 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
41196 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
41197 @end itemize
41198
41199 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
41200 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
41201 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
41202 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
41203 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
41204
41205 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41206 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
41207
41208 @menu
41209 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
41210 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
41211 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
41212 descriptions.
41213 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
41214 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
41215 @end menu
41216
41217 @node Retrieving Descriptions
41218 @section Retrieving Descriptions
41219
41220 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
41221 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
41222 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
41223 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
41224 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
41225 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
41226 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
41227 Format}.
41228
41229 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
41230 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
41231 specify a file are:
41232
41233 @table @code
41234 @cindex set tdesc filename
41235 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
41236 Read the target description from @var{path}.
41237
41238 @cindex unset tdesc filename
41239 @item unset tdesc filename
41240 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
41241 will use the description supplied by the current target.
41242
41243 @cindex show tdesc filename
41244 @item show tdesc filename
41245 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
41246 @end table
41247
41248
41249 @node Target Description Format
41250 @section Target Description Format
41251 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
41252
41253 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
41254 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
41255 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
41256 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
41257 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
41258 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
41259 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
41260
41261 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
41262 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
41263 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
41264 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
41265 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
41266
41267 Here is a simple target description:
41268
41269 @smallexample
41270 <target version="1.0">
41271 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
41272 </target>
41273 @end smallexample
41274
41275 @noindent
41276 This minimal description only says that the target uses
41277 the x86-64 architecture.
41278
41279 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
41280 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
41281 are explained further below.
41282
41283 @smallexample
41284 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41285 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
41286 <target version="1.0">
41287 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
41288 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
41289 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
41290 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
41291 </target>
41292 @end smallexample
41293
41294 @noindent
41295 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
41296 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
41297 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
41298 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
41299 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
41300 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
41301 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
41302 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
41303 the version mismatch.
41304
41305 @subsection Inclusion
41306 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
41307 @cindex XInclude
41308 @ifnotinfo
41309 @cindex <xi:include>
41310 @end ifnotinfo
41311
41312 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
41313 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
41314 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
41315 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
41316 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
41317
41318 @smallexample
41319 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
41320 @end smallexample
41321
41322 @noindent
41323 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
41324 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
41325 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
41326 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
41327 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
41328 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
41329 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
41330 original description.
41331
41332 @subsection Architecture
41333 @cindex <architecture>
41334
41335 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
41336
41337 @smallexample
41338 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
41339 @end smallexample
41340
41341 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41342 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41343
41344 @subsection OS ABI
41345 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
41346
41347 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41348 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41349
41350 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
41351
41352 @smallexample
41353 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
41354 @end smallexample
41355
41356 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
41357 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
41358
41359 @subsection Compatible Architecture
41360 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
41361
41362 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41363 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41364
41365 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
41366
41367 @smallexample
41368 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
41369 @end smallexample
41370
41371 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41372 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41373
41374 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
41375 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
41376 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
41377 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
41378 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
41379 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
41380 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
41381
41382 @smallexample
41383 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
41384 <compatible>spu</compatible>
41385 @end smallexample
41386
41387 @subsection Features
41388 @cindex <feature>
41389
41390 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
41391 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
41392 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
41393 has this form:
41394
41395 @smallexample
41396 <feature name="@var{name}">
41397 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
41398 @var{reg}@dots{}
41399 </feature>
41400 @end smallexample
41401
41402 @noindent
41403 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
41404 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
41405 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
41406 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
41407
41408 @subsection Types
41409
41410 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
41411 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
41412 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
41413 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
41414 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
41415 and enum types.
41416
41417 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
41418 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
41419 Types must be defined before they are used.
41420
41421 @cindex <vector>
41422 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
41423 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
41424 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
41425 @var{count}:
41426
41427 @smallexample
41428 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
41429 @end smallexample
41430
41431 @cindex <union>
41432 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
41433 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
41434 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
41435 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
41436
41437 @smallexample
41438 <union id="@var{id}">
41439 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41440 @dots{}
41441 </union>
41442 @end smallexample
41443
41444 @cindex <struct>
41445 @cindex <flags>
41446 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
41447 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
41448 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
41449 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
41450 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
41451 specified.
41452
41453 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
41454
41455 @smallexample
41456 <struct id="@var{id}">
41457 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41458 @dots{}
41459 </struct>
41460 @end smallexample
41461
41462 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
41463 No implicit padding is added.
41464
41465 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
41466
41467 @smallexample
41468 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41469 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41470 @dots{}
41471 </struct>
41472 @end smallexample
41473
41474 @smallexample
41475 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41476 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41477 @dots{}
41478 </flags>
41479 @end smallexample
41480
41481 The @var{name} value is required.
41482 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
41483 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
41484 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
41485
41486 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
41487 is optional.
41488 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
41489 and zero represents the least significant bit.
41490
41491 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
41492 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
41493
41494 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
41495
41496 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
41497 defining them with @samp{struct}:
41498
41499 @itemize @bullet
41500 @item
41501 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
41502 @item
41503 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
41504 @end itemize
41505
41506 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
41507 defining them with @samp{flags}:
41508
41509 @itemize @bullet
41510 @item
41511 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
41512
41513 @smallexample
41514 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
41515 $1 = 42
41516 @end smallexample
41517
41518 @end itemize
41519
41520 @subsection Registers
41521 @cindex <reg>
41522
41523 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
41524
41525 @smallexample
41526 <reg name="@var{name}"
41527 bitsize="@var{size}"
41528 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
41529 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
41530 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
41531 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
41532 @end smallexample
41533
41534 @noindent
41535 The components are as follows:
41536
41537 @table @var
41538
41539 @item name
41540 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
41541
41542 @item bitsize
41543 The register's size, in bits.
41544
41545 @item regnum
41546 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
41547 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
41548 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
41549 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
41550 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
41551 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
41552 in order of increasing register number.
41553
41554 @item save-restore
41555 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
41556 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
41557 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
41558 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
41559 ABI.
41560
41561 @item type
41562 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
41563 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
41564 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
41565 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
41566 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
41567 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
41568
41569 @item group
41570 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
41571 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
41572 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
41573 in @code{info registers}.
41574
41575 @end table
41576
41577 @node Predefined Target Types
41578 @section Predefined Target Types
41579 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
41580
41581 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
41582 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
41583 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
41584 types. The currently supported types are:
41585
41586 @table @code
41587
41588 @item bool
41589 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
41590
41591 @item int8
41592 @itemx int16
41593 @itemx int32
41594 @itemx int64
41595 @itemx int128
41596 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41597
41598 @item uint8
41599 @itemx uint16
41600 @itemx uint32
41601 @itemx uint64
41602 @itemx uint128
41603 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41604
41605 @item code_ptr
41606 @itemx data_ptr
41607 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
41608 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
41609 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
41610 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
41611 may be marked as data pointers.
41612
41613 @item ieee_single
41614 Single precision IEEE floating point.
41615
41616 @item ieee_double
41617 Double precision IEEE floating point.
41618
41619 @item arm_fpa_ext
41620 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
41621
41622 @item i387_ext
41623 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
41624
41625 @item i386_eflags
41626 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
41627
41628 @item i386_mxcsr
41629 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
41630
41631 @end table
41632
41633 @node Enum Target Types
41634 @section Enum Target Types
41635 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
41636
41637 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
41638 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
41639
41640 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
41641
41642 @smallexample
41643 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41644 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
41645 @dots{}
41646 </enum>
41647 @end smallexample
41648
41649 Enums must be defined before they are used.
41650
41651 @smallexample
41652 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
41653 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
41654 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
41655 </enum>
41656 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
41657 <field name="X" start="0"/>
41658 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
41659 </flags>
41660 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
41661 @end smallexample
41662
41663 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
41664 would be printed as:
41665
41666 @smallexample
41667 (gdb) info register flags
41668 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
41669 @end smallexample
41670
41671 @node Standard Target Features
41672 @section Standard Target Features
41673 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
41674
41675 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
41676 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
41677 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
41678 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
41679 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
41680 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
41681 can recognize them.
41682
41683 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
41684 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
41685 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
41686 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
41687 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
41688 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
41689 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
41690 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
41691
41692 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
41693 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
41694 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
41695
41696 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
41697 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
41698 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
41699 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
41700
41701 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
41702 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
41703 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
41704
41705 @menu
41706 * AArch64 Features::
41707 * ARC Features::
41708 * ARM Features::
41709 * i386 Features::
41710 * MicroBlaze Features::
41711 * MIPS Features::
41712 * M68K Features::
41713 * NDS32 Features::
41714 * Nios II Features::
41715 * PowerPC Features::
41716 * S/390 and System z Features::
41717 * Sparc Features::
41718 * TIC6x Features::
41719 @end menu
41720
41721
41722 @node AArch64 Features
41723 @subsection AArch64 Features
41724 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
41725
41726 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
41727 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
41728 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41729
41730 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41731 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
41732 and @samp{fpcr}.
41733
41734 @node ARC Features
41735 @subsection ARC Features
41736 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
41737
41738 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
41739 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
41740 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
41741 that one of the core registers features is present.
41742 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
41743
41744 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
41745 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41746 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41747 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
41748 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41749 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
41750 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
41751
41752 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
41753 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
41754 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
41755 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
41756 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
41757 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41758
41759 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
41760 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41761 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41762 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
41763 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
41764 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
41765 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
41766 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
41767 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
41768 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
41769
41770 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
41771 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
41772
41773 @node ARM Features
41774 @subsection ARM Features
41775 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
41776
41777 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
41778 ARM targets.
41779 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
41780 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41781
41782 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
41783 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
41784 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
41785 and @samp{xpsr}.
41786
41787 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
41788 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
41789
41790 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
41791 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
41792 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
41793 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
41794
41795 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
41796 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
41797 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
41798 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
41799 halves of the double-precision registers.
41800
41801 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
41802 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
41803 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
41804 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
41805 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
41806 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
41807
41808 @node i386 Features
41809 @subsection i386 Features
41810 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
41811
41812 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
41813 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41814
41815 @itemize @minus
41816 @item
41817 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
41818 @item
41819 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
41820 @item
41821 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
41822 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
41823 @item
41824 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
41825 @item
41826 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
41827 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
41828 @end itemize
41829
41830 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
41831
41832 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
41833 describe registers:
41834
41835 @itemize @minus
41836 @item
41837 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
41838 @item
41839 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
41840 @item
41841 @samp{mxcsr}
41842 @end itemize
41843
41844 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
41845 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
41846 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
41847
41848 @itemize @minus
41849 @item
41850 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
41851 @item
41852 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
41853 @end itemize
41854
41855 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
41856 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
41857
41858 @itemize @minus
41859 @item
41860 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
41861 @item
41862 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
41863 @end itemize
41864
41865 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
41866 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
41867
41868 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
41869 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
41870
41871 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
41872 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
41873 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
41874
41875 @itemize @minus
41876 @item
41877 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41878 @end itemize
41879
41880 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
41881
41882 @itemize @minus
41883 @item
41884 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41885 @end itemize
41886
41887 It should
41888 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
41889
41890 @itemize @minus
41891 @item
41892 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
41893 @item
41894 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
41895 @end itemize
41896
41897 It should
41898 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
41899
41900 @itemize @minus
41901 @item
41902 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41903 @end itemize
41904
41905 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
41906 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
41907 valid for i386 and amd64.
41908
41909 @node MicroBlaze Features
41910 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
41911 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
41912
41913 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
41914 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41915 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
41916 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
41917 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
41918
41919 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
41920 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
41921
41922 @node MIPS Features
41923 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
41924 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
41925
41926 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
41927 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
41928 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
41929 on the target.
41930
41931 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
41932 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
41933 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41934
41935 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
41936 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
41937 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
41938 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41939
41940 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
41941 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41942 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
41943 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41944
41945 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
41946 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41947 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41948
41949 @node M68K Features
41950 @subsection M68K Features
41951 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41952
41953 @table @code
41954 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41955 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41956 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41957 One of those features must be always present.
41958 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41959 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
41960 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41961 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41962
41963 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41964 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
41965 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41966 @samp{fpiaddr}.
41967 @end table
41968
41969 @node NDS32 Features
41970 @subsection NDS32 Features
41971 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41972
41973 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41974 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41975 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41976 and @samp{pc}.
41977
41978 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41979 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41980 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41981 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41982
41983 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41984 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41985 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41986 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41987 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
41988 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41989 support to it could be totally removed some day.
41990
41991 @node Nios II Features
41992 @subsection Nios II Features
41993 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41994
41995 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41996 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41997 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41998 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41999 @samp{mpuacc}).
42000
42001 @node PowerPC Features
42002 @subsection PowerPC Features
42003 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
42004
42005 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
42006 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
42007 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
42008 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42009
42010 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
42011 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
42012
42013 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
42014 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
42015 and @samp{vrsave}.
42016
42017 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
42018 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
42019 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
42020 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
42021 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
42022 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
42023
42024 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
42025 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
42026 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
42027 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
42028 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
42029 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
42030 user.
42031
42032 @node S/390 and System z Features
42033 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
42034 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
42035 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
42036
42037 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
42038 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
42039 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
42040 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
42041 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
42042 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
42043 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
42044 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
42045 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
42046
42047 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
42048 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
42049 @samp{fpc}.
42050
42051 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
42052 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
42053
42054 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
42055 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
42056 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
42057 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
42058 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
42059 32-bit wide.
42060
42061 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
42062 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
42063 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
42064
42065 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
42066 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
42067 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
42068 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
42069 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
42070 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
42071 @samp{v31}.
42072
42073 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
42074 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
42075 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
42076
42077 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
42078 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
42079 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
42080
42081 @node Sparc Features
42082 @subsection Sparc Features
42083 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
42084 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
42085 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42086 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42087
42088 @itemize @minus
42089 @item
42090 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
42091 @item
42092 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
42093 @item
42094 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
42095 @item
42096 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
42097 @end itemize
42098
42099 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42100
42101 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42102 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42103
42104 @itemize @minus
42105 @item
42106 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
42107 @item
42108 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
42109 @end itemize
42110
42111 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42112 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42113
42114 @itemize @minus
42115 @item
42116 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
42117 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
42118 @item
42119 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
42120 for sparc64
42121 @end itemize
42122
42123 @node TIC6x Features
42124 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
42125 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
42126 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
42127 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
42128 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
42129 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
42130
42131 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
42132 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
42133 through @samp{B31}.
42134
42135 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
42136 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
42137
42138 @node Operating System Information
42139 @appendix Operating System Information
42140 @cindex operating system information
42141
42142 @menu
42143 * Process list::
42144 @end menu
42145
42146 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
42147 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
42148 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
42149 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
42150 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
42151 on a different aspect of target.
42152
42153 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
42154 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
42155 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
42156 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
42157
42158 @node Process list
42159 @appendixsection Process list
42160 @cindex operating system information, process list
42161
42162 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
42163 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
42164 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
42165 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
42166
42167 An example document is:
42168
42169 @smallexample
42170 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42171 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
42172 <osdata type="processes">
42173 <item>
42174 <column name="pid">1</column>
42175 <column name="user">root</column>
42176 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
42177 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
42178 </item>
42179 </osdata>
42180 @end smallexample
42181
42182 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
42183 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
42184 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
42185 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
42186 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
42187 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
42188 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
42189
42190 @node Trace File Format
42191 @appendix Trace File Format
42192 @cindex trace file format
42193
42194 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
42195 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
42196
42197 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
42198 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
42199 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
42200 in the future.
42201
42202 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
42203 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
42204 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
42205 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
42206 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
42207 of this section.
42208
42209 @table @code
42210 @item R @var{size}
42211 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
42212 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
42213 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
42214 a single trace file.
42215
42216 @item status @var{status}
42217 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
42218 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
42219 file.
42220
42221 @item tp @var{payload}
42222 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42223 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
42224 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42225 reply packets.
42226
42227 @item tsv @var{payload}
42228 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42229 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
42230 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42231 reply packets.
42232
42233 @item tdesc @var{payload}
42234 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
42235 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
42236 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
42237 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
42238 file. Includes are not allowed.
42239
42240 @end table
42241
42242 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
42243 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
42244 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
42245 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
42246 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
42247 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
42248 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
42249 endianness.
42250
42251 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
42252
42253 @table @code
42254 @item R @var{bytes}
42255 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
42256 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
42257 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
42258
42259 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
42260 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
42261 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
42262 @var{length} bytes.
42263
42264 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
42265 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
42266 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
42267
42268 @end table
42269
42270 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
42271 of blocks.
42272
42273 @node Index Section Format
42274 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
42275 @cindex .gdb_index section format
42276 @cindex index section format
42277
42278 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
42279 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
42280 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
42281 description.
42282
42283 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
42284 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
42285 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
42286 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
42287 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
42288 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
42289
42290 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
42291
42292 @enumerate
42293 @item
42294 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
42295 unless otherwise noted:
42296
42297 @enumerate
42298 @item
42299 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
42300 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
42301 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
42302 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
42303 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
42304 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
42305 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
42306
42307 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
42308 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
42309 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
42310 currently not flagged as deprecated.
42311
42312 @item
42313 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
42314
42315 @item
42316 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
42317 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
42318 to the next offset.
42319
42320 @item
42321 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
42322
42323 @item
42324 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
42325
42326 @item
42327 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
42328 @end enumerate
42329
42330 @item
42331 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
42332 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
42333 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
42334 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
42335 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
42336 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
42337 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
42338 CU indices.
42339
42340 @item
42341 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
42342 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
42343 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
42344 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
42345
42346 @item
42347 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
42348 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
42349
42350 @enumerate
42351 @item
42352 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
42353
42354 @item
42355 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
42356 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
42357
42358 @item
42359 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
42360 @end enumerate
42361
42362 @item
42363 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
42364 the hash table is always a power of 2.
42365
42366 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
42367 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
42368 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
42369 constant pool.
42370
42371 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
42372 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
42373 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
42374
42375 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
42376 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
42377 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
42378 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
42379 index version:
42380
42381 @table @asis
42382 @item Version 4
42383 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
42384
42385 @item Versions 5 to 7
42386 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
42387 @end table
42388
42389 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
42390
42391 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
42392 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
42393 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
42394 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
42395 collision.
42396
42397 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
42398 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
42399 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
42400 the code.
42401
42402 @item
42403 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
42404 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
42405 strings.
42406
42407 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
42408 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
42409 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
42410 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
42411 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
42412 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
42413
42414 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
42415 @end enumerate
42416
42417 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
42418 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
42419 CU index+attributes value for each use.
42420
42421 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
42422 (bit 0 = LSB):
42423
42424 @table @asis
42425
42426 @item Bits 0-23
42427 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
42428 @item Bits 24-27
42429 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
42430 @item Bits 28-30
42431 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
42432
42433 @table @asis
42434 @item 0
42435 This value is reserved and should not be used.
42436 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
42437 with previous versions of the index.
42438 @item 1
42439 The symbol is a type.
42440 @item 2
42441 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
42442 @item 3
42443 The symbol is a function.
42444 @item 4
42445 Any other kind of symbol.
42446 @item 5,6,7
42447 These values are reserved.
42448 @end table
42449
42450 @item Bit 31
42451 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
42452
42453 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
42454 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
42455 @value{GDBN} sources.
42456
42457 @end table
42458
42459 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
42460 global/static attributes in the index.
42461
42462 @smallexample
42463 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
42464 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
42465 switch (die->tag)
42466 @{
42467 case DW_TAG_typedef:
42468 case DW_TAG_base_type:
42469 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
42470 kind = TYPE;
42471 is_static = 1;
42472 break;
42473 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
42474 kind = VARIABLE;
42475 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42476 break;
42477 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
42478 kind = FUNCTION;
42479 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
42480 break;
42481 case DW_TAG_constant:
42482 kind = VARIABLE;
42483 is_static = ! is_external;
42484 break;
42485 case DW_TAG_variable:
42486 kind = VARIABLE;
42487 is_static = ! is_external;
42488 break;
42489 case DW_TAG_namespace:
42490 kind = TYPE;
42491 is_static = 0;
42492 break;
42493 case DW_TAG_class_type:
42494 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
42495 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
42496 case DW_TAG_union_type:
42497 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
42498 kind = TYPE;
42499 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42500 break;
42501 default:
42502 assert (0);
42503 @}
42504 @end smallexample
42505
42506 @node Man Pages
42507 @appendix Manual pages
42508 @cindex Man pages
42509
42510 @menu
42511 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
42512 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
42513 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
42514 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
42515 @end menu
42516
42517 @node gdb man
42518 @heading gdb man
42519
42520 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
42521
42522 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
42523 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
42524 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
42525 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
42526 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
42527 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
42528 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
42529 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
42530 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
42531 @c man end
42532
42533 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
42534 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
42535 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
42536 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
42537
42538 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
42539 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
42540
42541 @itemize @bullet
42542 @item
42543 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
42544
42545 @item
42546 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
42547
42548 @item
42549 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
42550
42551 @item
42552 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
42553 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
42554 @end itemize
42555
42556 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
42557 Modula-2.
42558
42559 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
42560 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
42561 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
42562 by using the command @code{help}.
42563
42564 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
42565 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
42566 executable program as the argument:
42567
42568 @smallexample
42569 gdb program
42570 @end smallexample
42571
42572 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
42573
42574 @smallexample
42575 gdb program core
42576 @end smallexample
42577
42578 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
42579 to debug a running process:
42580
42581 @smallexample
42582 gdb program 1234
42583 gdb -p 1234
42584 @end smallexample
42585
42586 @noindent
42587 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
42588 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
42589 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
42590
42591 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
42592
42593 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
42594 @table @env
42595 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42596 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
42597
42598 @item run [@var{arglist}]
42599 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
42600
42601 @item bt
42602 Backtrace: display the program stack.
42603
42604 @item print @var{expr}
42605 Display the value of an expression.
42606
42607 @item c
42608 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
42609
42610 @item next
42611 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
42612 function calls in the line.
42613
42614 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42615 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
42616
42617 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42618 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
42619
42620 @item step
42621 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
42622 function calls in the line.
42623
42624 @item help [@var{name}]
42625 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
42626 about using @value{GDBN}.
42627
42628 @item quit
42629 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
42630 @end table
42631
42632 @ifset man
42633 For full details on @value{GDBN},
42634 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42635 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
42636 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
42637 @end ifset
42638 @c man end
42639
42640 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
42641 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
42642 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
42643 encountered with no
42644 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
42645 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
42646 Many options have
42647 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
42648 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
42649 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
42650 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
42651 more usual convention.)
42652
42653 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
42654 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
42655 option is used.
42656
42657 @table @env
42658 @item -help
42659 @itemx -h
42660 List all options, with brief explanations.
42661
42662 @item -symbols=@var{file}
42663 @itemx -s @var{file}
42664 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
42665
42666 @item -write
42667 Enable writing into executable and core files.
42668
42669 @item -exec=@var{file}
42670 @itemx -e @var{file}
42671 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
42672 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
42673 dump.
42674
42675 @item -se=@var{file}
42676 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
42677 file.
42678
42679 @item -core=@var{file}
42680 @itemx -c @var{file}
42681 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
42682
42683 @item -command=@var{file}
42684 @itemx -x @var{file}
42685 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
42686
42687 @item -ex @var{command}
42688 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
42689
42690 @item -directory=@var{directory}
42691 @itemx -d @var{directory}
42692 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
42693
42694 @item -nh
42695 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
42696
42697 @item -nx
42698 @itemx -n
42699 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
42700
42701 @item -quiet
42702 @itemx -q
42703 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
42704 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
42705
42706 @item -batch
42707 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
42708 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
42709 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
42710 commands in the command files.
42711
42712 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
42713 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
42714 more useful, the message
42715
42716 @smallexample
42717 Program exited normally.
42718 @end smallexample
42719
42720 @noindent
42721 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
42722 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
42723
42724 @item -cd=@var{directory}
42725 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
42726 instead of the current directory.
42727
42728 @item -fullname
42729 @itemx -f
42730 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
42731 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
42732 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
42733 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
42734 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
42735 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
42736 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
42737 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
42738
42739 @item -b @var{bps}
42740 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
42741 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
42742
42743 @item -tty=@var{device}
42744 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
42745 @end table
42746 @c man end
42747
42748 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
42749 @ifset man
42750 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42751 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42752 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42753
42754 @smallexample
42755 info gdb
42756 @end smallexample
42757
42758 @noindent
42759 should give you access to the complete manual.
42760
42761 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42762 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42763 @end ifset
42764 @c man end
42765
42766 @node gdbserver man
42767 @heading gdbserver man
42768
42769 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
42770 @format
42771 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
42772 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42773
42774 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42775
42776 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42777 @c man end
42778 @end format
42779
42780 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
42781 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
42782 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
42783
42784 @ifclear man
42785 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
42786 @end ifclear
42787 @ifset man
42788 Usage (server (target) side):
42789 @end ifset
42790
42791 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
42792 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
42793 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
42794 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
42795
42796 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
42797 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
42798 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
42799
42800 @smallexample
42801 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
42802 @end smallexample
42803
42804 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
42805
42806 @smallexample
42807 @ifset man
42808 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
42809 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
42810 @end ifset
42811 @ifclear man
42812 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
42813 @end ifclear
42814 @end smallexample
42815
42816 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
42817 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
42818 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
42819
42820 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
42821
42822 @smallexample
42823 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
42824 @end smallexample
42825
42826 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
42827 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
42828 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
42829 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
42830 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
42831 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
42832 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
42833 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
42834 print an error message and exit.
42835
42836 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
42837 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
42838
42839 @smallexample
42840 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42841 @end smallexample
42842
42843 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42844 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42845
42846 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42847 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
42848 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
42849 the program you want to debug.
42850
42851 @smallexample
42852 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42853 @end smallexample
42854
42855 @ifclear man
42856 @subheading Usage (host side)
42857 @end ifclear
42858 @ifset man
42859 Usage (host side):
42860 @end ifset
42861
42862 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
42863 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
42864 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
42865 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
42866 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
42867 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
42868 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
42869 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
42870 descriptor. For example:
42871
42872 @smallexample
42873 @ifset man
42874 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
42875 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
42876 @end ifset
42877 @ifclear man
42878 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
42879 @end ifclear
42880 @end smallexample
42881
42882 @noindent
42883 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
42884
42885 @smallexample
42886 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
42887 @end smallexample
42888
42889 @noindent
42890 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
42891 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
42892 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
42893 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
42894 `Connection refused'.
42895
42896 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
42897 described in
42898 @ifset man
42899 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
42900 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
42901 @end ifset
42902 @ifclear man
42903 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
42904 @end ifclear
42905 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
42906
42907 @smallexample
42908 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
42909 @end smallexample
42910
42911 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
42912 case.
42913 @c man end
42914
42915 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
42916 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
42917
42918 @itemize @bullet
42919
42920 @item
42921 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
42922
42923 @smallexample
42924 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42925 @end smallexample
42926
42927 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
42928 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
42929 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
42930 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
42931 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
42932 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
42933 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42934
42935 @item
42936 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
42937 program:
42938
42939 @smallexample
42940 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42941 @end smallexample
42942
42943 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
42944 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
42945 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
42946 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42947
42948 @item
42949 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
42950
42951 @smallexample
42952 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42953 @end smallexample
42954
42955 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
42956 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
42957 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
42958 debug several processes in the same session.
42959 @end itemize
42960
42961 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
42962
42963 @table @env
42964
42965 @item --help
42966 List all options, with brief explanations.
42967
42968 @item --version
42969 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
42970
42971 @item --attach
42972 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
42973
42974 @smallexample
42975 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42976 @end smallexample
42977
42978 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42979 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42980
42981 @item --multi
42982 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42983 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
42984 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
42985 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
42986
42987 @smallexample
42988 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42989 @end smallexample
42990
42991 @item --debug
42992 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42993 process.
42994 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42995 the developers.
42996
42997 @item --remote-debug
42998 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42999 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
43000 the developers.
43001
43002 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
43003 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
43004 of debugging output.
43005 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
43006
43007 @item --wrapper
43008 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
43009 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
43010 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
43011 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
43012
43013 @item --once
43014 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
43015 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
43016 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
43017 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
43018
43019 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
43020
43021 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
43022 @c QDisableRandomization.
43023
43024 @end table
43025 @c man end
43026
43027 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
43028 @ifset man
43029 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43030 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43031 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43032
43033 @smallexample
43034 info gdb
43035 @end smallexample
43036
43037 should give you access to the complete manual.
43038
43039 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43040 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43041 @end ifset
43042 @c man end
43043
43044 @node gcore man
43045 @heading gcore
43046
43047 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
43048
43049 @format
43050 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
43051 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
43052 @c man end
43053 @end format
43054
43055 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
43056 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
43057 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
43058 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
43059 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
43060 running without any change.
43061 @c man end
43062
43063 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
43064 @table @env
43065 @item -o @var{filename}
43066 The optional argument
43067 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
43068 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
43069 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
43070 @end table
43071 @c man end
43072
43073 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
43074 @ifset man
43075 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43076 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43077 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43078
43079 @smallexample
43080 info gdb
43081 @end smallexample
43082
43083 @noindent
43084 should give you access to the complete manual.
43085
43086 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43087 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43088 @end ifset
43089 @c man end
43090
43091 @node gdbinit man
43092 @heading gdbinit
43093
43094 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
43095
43096 @format
43097 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
43098 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43099 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43100 @end ifset
43101
43102 ~/.gdbinit
43103
43104 ./.gdbinit
43105 @c man end
43106 @end format
43107
43108 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
43109 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
43110 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
43111 described in
43112 @ifset man
43113 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
43114 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
43115 @end ifset
43116 @ifclear man
43117 @ref{Sequences}.
43118 @end ifclear
43119
43120 Please read more in
43121 @ifset man
43122 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
43123 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
43124 @end ifset
43125 @ifclear man
43126 @ref{Startup}.
43127 @end ifclear
43128
43129 @table @env
43130 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43131 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43132 @end ifset
43133 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43134 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
43135 @end ifclear
43136 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43137 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
43138 See more in
43139 @ifset man
43140 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
43141 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
43142 @end ifset
43143 @ifclear man
43144 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
43145 @end ifclear
43146
43147 @item ~/.gdbinit
43148 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43149 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
43150
43151 @item ./.gdbinit
43152 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
43153 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
43154 See more in
43155 @ifset man
43156 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
43157 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
43158 @end ifset
43159 @ifclear man
43160 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
43161 @end ifclear
43162 @end table
43163 @c man end
43164
43165 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
43166 @ifset man
43167 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
43168
43169 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43170 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43171 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43172
43173 @smallexample
43174 info gdb
43175 @end smallexample
43176
43177 should give you access to the complete manual.
43178
43179 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43180 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43181 @end ifset
43182 @c man end
43183
43184 @include gpl.texi
43185
43186 @node GNU Free Documentation License
43187 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
43188 @include fdl.texi
43189
43190 @node Concept Index
43191 @unnumbered Concept Index
43192
43193 @printindex cp
43194
43195 @node Command and Variable Index
43196 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
43197
43198 @printindex fn
43199
43200 @tex
43201 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
43202 % meantime:
43203 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
43204 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
43205 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
43206 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
43207 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
43208 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
43209 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
43210 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
43211 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
43212 \page\colophon
43213 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
43214 @end tex
43215
43216 @bye
This page took 2.192256 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.